Decolonizing Native Histories: Collaboration, Knowledge, and Language in the Americas 9780822394853

An interdisciplinary collection that addresses the racial and ethnic politics of knowledge production and indigenous act

148 107 2MB

English Pages 272 [269] Year 2011

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD FILE

Polecaj historie

Decolonizing Native Histories: Collaboration, Knowledge, and Language in the Americas
 9780822394853

Citation preview

Decolonizing native Histories

​narrating native histories Series editors

Editorial Advisory Board

K.​Tsianina​Lomawaima​

Denise​Y.​Arnold

Florencia​E.​Mallon​

Charles​R.​Hale

Alcida​Rita​Ramos​

Roberta​Hill

Joanne​Rappaport​

Noenoe​K.​Silva



David​Wilkins



Juan​de​Dios​Yapita

Decolonizing native Histories

Collaboration, Knowledge, and Language in the Americas Edited​by​Florencia​E.​Mallon Selected​essays​translated​by​Gladys​McCormick Duke university Press

DurHam & lonDon

2012

©​2012​Duke​University​Press All​rights​reserved Printed​in​the​United​States​of​America​​ on​acid-​free​paper​♾ Designed​by​Amy​Ruth​Buchanan Typeset​in​Minion​and​Officina​Sans​​ by​Tseng​Information​Systems,​Inc. Library​of​Congress​Cataloging-​in-​​ Publication​Data​appear​on​the​last​​ printed​page​of​this​book.

contents

About​the​Series vii Florencia​e.​Mallon 1 Introduction.​Decolonizing​Knowledge,​​ Language,​and​Narrative

Part one

Land, Sovereignty, and Self-Determination​.......................................................  21 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui 27 Hawaiian​Nationhood,​Self-​Determination,​​ and​International​Law riet​Delsing 54 Issues​of​Land​and​Sovereignty:​The​Uneasy​​ Relationship​between​Chile​and​Rapa​Nui

Part two

Indigenous Writing and Experiences with Collaboration​................................ 79 FernanDo​garcés​V. 85 Quechua​Knowledge,​Orality,​and​Writings:​​ The​Newspaper​Conosur Ñawpagman Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos​pacho 122 Collaboration​and​Historical​Writing:​​ Challenges​for​the​Indigenous–Academic​Dialogue Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus 144 The​Taller​Tzotzil​of​Chiapas,​Mexico:​​ A​Native​Language​Publishing​Project,​1985–2002

Part tHree

Generations of Indigenous Activism and Internal Debates​............................ 175 brian​KlopoteK 179 Dangerous​Decolonizing:​Indians​​ and​Blacks​and​the​Legacy​of​Jim​Crow eDgar​esquit 196 Nationalist​Contradictions:​Pan-​Mayanism,​​ Representations​of​the​Past,​and​the​​ Reproduction​of​Inequalities​in​Guatemala Conclusion 219 References 221 Contributors 243 Index 247

vi contents

about tHe series

Narrating​Native​Histories​aims​to​foster​a​rethinking​of​the​ethical,​methodological,​and​conceptual​frameworks​within​which​we​locate​our​work​on​Native​ histories​and​cultures.​We​seek​to​create​a​space​for​effective​and​ongoing​conversations​between​North​and​South,​Natives​and​non-​Natives,​academics​and​ activists,​throughout​the​Americas​and​the​Pacific​region.​We​are​committed​to​ complicating​and​transgressing​the​disciplinary​and​epistemological​boundaries​ of​established​academic​discourses​on​Native​peoples. ​ This​ series​ encourages​ symmetrical,​ horizontal,​ collaborative,​ and​ auto-​ ethnographies;​work​that​recognizes​Native​intellectuals,​cultural​interpreters,​ and​alternative​knowledge​producers​within​broader​academic​and​intellectual​ worlds;​projects​that​decolonize​the​relationship​between​orality​and​textuality;​ narratives​that​productively​work​the​tensions​between​the​norms​of​Native​cultures​and​the​requirements​for​evidence​in​academic​circles;​and​analyses​that​ contribute​ to​ an​ understanding​ of​ Native​ peoples’​ relationships​ with​ nation-​ states,​including​histories​of​expropriation​and​exclusion​as​well​as​projects​for​ autonomy​and​sovereignty. ​ Decolonizing Native Histories​represents​an​innovative​effort​to​motivate​dialogue​between​scholars​living​in​the​North​and​South,​academics​and​nonacademic​activist​intellectuals,​indigenous​and​nonindigenous​researchers,​and​the​ different​but​overlapping​forms​of​knowledge​that​arise​out​of​these​subject​positions.​Bringing​together​research​on​Native​Latin​America,​North​America,​and​ the​Pacific,​this​book​enquires​into​a​series​of​pressing​issues:​How​do​debates​ over​Native​sovereignty​vary​over​the​three​regions?​What​does​it​mean​to​be​an​ indigenous​researcher,​and​how​might​nonindigenous​scholars​most​effectively​ collaborate​with​their​Native​counterparts?​How​should​scholars—whether​Native​or​non-​Native—who​are​committed​to​Native​struggles​ask​hard​questions​ of​activists?​What​routes​must​we​take​to​decolonize​scholarship​in​the​twenty-​ first​century?​The​answers,​which​range​from​examinations​of​Native​status​in​ Hawai‘i​and​Easter​Island,​to​evaluations​of​collaborative​research​and​writing​ techniques​in​Latin​America,​and​to​approaches​to​race​as​a​critical​component​ of​nativeness​in​North​America,​all​contribute​to​the​dialogue​we​will​need​to​ decolonize​our​scholarship​in​the​new​millennium.

Florencia e. mallon

Introduction

Decolonizing​Knowledge,​Language,​and​Narrative

This​book​was​born​at​a​conference​entitled​Narrating​Native​Histories​held​ at​the​University​of​Wisconsin,​Madison,​in​April​2005,​a​meeting​which​ itself​ was​ the​ result​ of​ exchanges​ and​ collaborations​ among​ faculty​ colleagues​from​various​disciplinary​departments​and​with​different​regional​ specialties​who​shared​an​interest​in​Native​studies.1​Narrating​Native​Histories​brought​together​intellectuals​and​scholar-​activists,​both​Native​and​ non-​Native,​from​Hawai‘i​and​the​Americas.​For​three​days​we​exchanged​ views​on​how​to​establish​collaborations​across​differences​of​language,​culture,​region,​ and​historical​ experience​ that​would​permit​us​to​disengage​ ethnography​as​well​as​other​forms​of​narrative​and​research​from​their​colonial​moorings. ​ Given​the​crucial​role​of​the​concepts​colonialism​and​decolonization​in​ the​project​of​our​conference,​in​the​book​series​by​the​same​name​that​it​ helped​generate,​and​in​this​book,​which​brings​together​a​selection​of​the​ papers​ originally​ presented​ in​ 2005,​ it​ is​ important​ to​ begin​ with​ at​ least​ some​rudimentary​definitions​of​them.​For​the​purposes​of​the​conference​ as​well​as​in​this​volume​we​have​used​these​notions​quite​expansively,​to​ define​relationships​of​domination​and​inequality​that​arose​historically​in​ different​parts​of​the​world​with​the​expansion​of​Europe.​As​these​notions​ apply​to​indigenous​peoples,​they​involve​the​conquest​and​expropriation​of​ territories;​massive​loss​of​life​through​war,​forced​labor,​and​disease;​erasure​ or​marginalization​of​cultures​and​languages;​and​the​redefinition​of​a​process​of​violent​conquest​as​“inevitable”​because​of​supposed​differences​in​ levels​of​“civilization.”​As​has​been​well​documented,​the​alleged​differences​ of​culture​and​so-​called​progress​between​colonizer​and​colonized​were​then​

used​to​construct​a​vision​of​a​world​order​in​which​certain​peoples​were​ always​lower​on​the​evolutionary​chain,​what​the​subalternist​scholar​Dipesh​Chakrabarty​has​termed​the​“not-​yet”​principle​of​historical​evolution​ (Chakrabarty​ 2000).​ Among​ the​ notions​ central​ to​ this​ worldview​ is​ the​ racial​construction​of​white​privilege.​Decolonization,​therefore,​involves​the​ questioning​of​the​racial​and​evolutionary​bases​of​colonial​power,​and​how​ these​have​tended​to​underlie​the​construction​of​knowledge.2 ​ We​came​together​in​Madison​animated​by​a​common​agenda.​Since​the​ 1970s,​when​Native​leaders​from​the​Americas​joined​their​fellow​activists​ from​other​parts​of​the​world​in​reformulating​the​un ​agenda​for​indigenous​ peoples’​rights​as​a​part​of​international​human​rights,​indigenous​demands​ for​ political​ and​ cultural​ recognition​ have​ generated​ a​ series​ of​ strong,​ identity-​based​ Native​ movements​ that​ have​ challenged​ the​ integrationist​ policies​ of​ nation-​states.​ As​ part​ of​ this​ new​ political​ and​ cultural​ dynamism,​Native​peoples​have​generated​their​own​intellectuals,​who​have​taken​ center​stage​in​debates​over​cultural​interpretation​and​translation​and​over​ the​narration​of​Native​histories.​In​such​a​context,​the​intellectual​agency​ of​Native​peoples​themselves​has​been​placed​squarely​on​the​agenda​of​all​ research​and​writing​about​and​with​indigenous​societies.​Scholars​working​ on​and​collaborating​ with​Native​ societies,​ whether​ themselves​ Native​or​ non-​Native,​have​therefore​been​challenged​to​rethink​the​ethical,​methodological,​and​conceptual​frameworks​within​which​we​locate​our​work​on​ questions​of​Native​histories​and​cultures. ​ Yet​despite​these​challenges,​the​anthropologist​and​activist​Víctor​Montejo​suggested​nearly​a​decade​ago​that,​despite​declarations​to​the​contrary​ since​the​mid-​1980s,​change​on​the​ground​was​slow​in​coming​(Montejo​ 2002).​While​critiques​of​traditional​research​methods​and​postures​started​ an​animated​and​prolonged​debate​in​anthropology​(see​especially​Clifford​ and​Marcus​1986),​we​still​have​a​long​way​to​go​in​moving​such​debates​ more​ fully​ into​ the​ area​ of​ concrete​ ethnographic​ and​ dialogic​ methodologies​and​political​positions.​Inspired​in​part​by​the​pioneering​efforts​of​ such​Native​scholars​as​Devon​Mihesuah​(1998,​2004),​Linda​Tuhiwai​Smith​ (1999),​and​Angela​Cavender​Wilson​(1998a,​1998b,​2004),​we​wished​to​look​ comparatively​across​distinct​regional,​tribal,​and​historical​differences​in​ order​to​attempt​to​formulate​a​broader​ethical​and​methodological​agenda. ​ This​vision,​as​implied​above,​not​only​inspired​the​conference,​but​also​ inaugurated​the​series​Narrating​Native​Histories.​Several​volumes​that​take​ seriously​the​principles​discussed​at​the​conference,​as​well​as​reflecting​the​ 2 introDuction

synergy​between​intellectual​vision​and​debate,​on​the​one​hand,​and​concrete​projects​and​methodologies​on​the​other,​have​already​found​a​home​ there.​ In​ both​ the​ conference​ and​ the​ series,​ moreover,​ we​ were​ and​ are​ committed​to​troubling​relations​between​North​and​South​and​between​the​ Americas​and​the​Pacific​region.​At​the​conference​our​method​was​to​discuss,​with​the​help​of​simultaneous​language​interpretation,​common​issues​ across​differences​of​culture,​region,​and​history.​We​began​by​asking​ourselves​questions​around​five​themes. ​ First,​building​from​the​perception​that​traditional​academic​narratives​ about​indigenous​peoples​are​still​embedded​in​a​colonial​framework,​both​ epistemologically​and​politically,​we​wondered​what​it​would​mean​to​shift​ ethnography​and​other​forms​of​research​and​narrative​away​from​more​traditional​and​vertical​forms​of​engagement​toward​more​symmetrical,​horizontal​approaches​or​counternarratives.​How​would​we​nurture​collaborative​relationships​that​respect​the​rights​of​Native​people​and​their​cultural​ experts​to​make​decisions​about​the​use​to​which​their​knowledge​is​put​as​ well​as​their​right​to​be​recognized​as​coauthors​or​participants​in​the​production​of​knowledge?​Who​gets​to​talk​about​what,​and​in​which​language? ​ Second,​ we​ wished​ to​ consider​ the​ relationship​ of​ language​ to​ power​ and​also​to​empowerment.​In​addition​to​recognizing​the​urgent​nature​of​ projects​to​recover​and​strengthen​indigenous​languages—projects​on​which​ a​number​of​the​conference​participants​have​worked​and​are​working—we​ discussed​the​inescapable​interactions​between​language,​the​legitimation​ of​voice,​and​the​power​relations​embedded​in​all​research​contexts.​How​ do​social,​political,​economic,​and​cultural​factors​shape​the​research​we​do​ and​the​stories​we​tell?​As​researchers​and​writers​committed​to​the​cultures​ about​which​we​write,​what​can​we​do​to​further​the​process​of​recognition​ of​Native​intellectuals,​cultural​interpreters,​and​alternative​knowledge​producers​within​the​broader​academic​and​intellectual​worlds? ​ Third,​as​a​matter​related​to​issues​of​language​and​power,​we​talked​about​ some​ of​ the​ ways​ in​ which​ colonialism​ had​ marked​ orality​ as​ inferior​ to​ textuality,​and​thus​had​considered​societies​with​different​record​systems​ as​“primitive”​or​“prehistorical.”​If​language,​the​law,​and​the​archive​have​ historically​served​as​instruments​of​colonialism,​we​wondered,​how​could​ these​same​instruments​be​used​in​the​construction​of​autonomy?​As​researchers,​what​is​our​role​in​the​process​of​recovery,​preservation,​and​extension​of​Native​literary​and​narrative​traditions?​What​is​the​relationship​ between​orality​and​textuality​in​this​process?​Is​it​possible​to​decolonize​ introDuction 3

language,​law,​and​history​so​that​they​become​tools​in​the​construction​of​ horizontal​relations​between​peoples? ​ Fourth,​we​considered​the​importance​of​storytelling​traditions.​Among​ many​indigenous​peoples​storytelling​has​served​as​a​form​of​cultural​preservation​ and​ protection,​ memory​ and​ empowerment,​ legitimacy​ and​ autonomy.​Is​it​possible​to​productively​work​through​the​tensions​between​ these​broader​intellectual​narratives​within​Native​cultures​and​the​requirements​of​evidence​in​the​academy?​How​can​academic​researchers​weave​ distinct,​divergent,​and​sometimes​conflictual​strands​into​their​stories​without​betraying​their​own​principles​or​those​of​their​interlocutors? ​ Finally,​we​recognized​the​many​challenges​associated​with​making​autonomy​a​viable​option​in​today’s​world.​As​indigenous​movements​throughout​the​world​have​demanded​respect​for​cultural,​political,​and​territorial​ autonomy,​questions​concerning​citizenship,​political​coalitions,​policy​options,​ and​ the​ legal​ ramifications​ of​ autonomy​ have​ become​ increasingly​ complex.​How​can​we​establish​a​useful​dialogue​among​the​extremely​diverse​experiences​with​and​practices​of​autonomy​and​sovereignty​that​exist​ in​the​Americas​and​the​Pacific​region?​How​can​researchers​profitably​involve​themselves​in​these​debates​in​a​way​that​is​useful​to​Native​societies? ​ Beginning​with​these​five​themes,​we​threaded​them​through​particular​ topics,​including​indigenous​sovereignty;​collaboration​and​truth​telling​in​ research​methodologies;​intercultural​conversations​on​translation,​inscription,​and​the​boundaries​between​inside​and​outside;​and​the​nature​of​intellectual​and​cultural​authority.​Part​of​what​we​found​along​the​way​was​exhilarating,​in​the​sense​that​there​were​points​of​commonality​and​solidarity​ across​otherwise​seemingly​unbridgeable​distances—geographical,​cultural,​ and​linguistic.​People​who​could​communicate​only​through​simultaneous​ interpretation​nevertheless​found​that​they​could​recognize​their​common​ struggles​to​recover​Native​languages​and,​through​them,​a​distinct​voice.​Or​ they​shared​perspectives​in​which​the​lines​between​academic​and​activist,​ inside​and​outside,​oral​and​written​could​be​and​had​been​questioned,​leading​to​a​mutual,​deep​cross-​fertilization​between​theory​and​practice,​analysis​and​experience.​And​all​of​us,​whether​Native​or​non-​Native,​recognized​ a​certain​commonality​in​our​intellectual​work​as​translators,​as​people​who​ inhabit​frontiers​between​worlds,​or​as​bisagras​(hinges)​who​serve​as​connections​between​disparate​knowledges,​cultures,​and​places. ​ Part​ of​ what​ we​ discovered​ was​ sobering,​ for​ the​ challenges​ before​ us​ seemed​ daunting​ and​ at​ times​ overwhelming.​ We​ noted​ deep​ differences​ 4 introDuction

between​North​and​South,​both​in​the​historical​experience​of​indigenous​ peoples​with​colonialism​and​in​the​place​of​indigenous​intellectuals​in​societies​ and​ academies.​ We​ saw​ distinctions​ among​ indigenous​ experiences​ within​ both​ North​ and​ South,​ within​ indigenous​ groups​ themselves,​ and​ between​the​Americas​and​the​Pacific​world.​We​perceived​internal​hierarchies​along​lines​of​race,​region,​language,​and​gender. ​ One​of​the​most​challenging​themes​we​discussed​during​the​conference,​ one​which​emerges​in​this​book​generally,​was​the​relationship​between​academic​and​activist​forms​of​narration​and​collaboration.​This​was​an​especially​ vibrant​ theme​ in​ the​ presentations​ about​ Latin​ America.​ Six​ of​ the​ nine​papers​presented​on​Latin​America​analyzed​experiences​of​collaboration​in​which​scholar-​activists​participated​in​projects​intended​to​put​new​ technologies​and​tools—writing,​social​science​or​linguistic​theory,​video— at​the​service​of​indigenous​peoples​who​wished​to​use​them​for​their​own​ purposes.​In​the​three​essays​about​this​topic​that​are​included​here—those​ on​the​Tzotzil​Maya​of​Chiapas,​the​Nasa​of​Colombia,​and​the​Quechua​of​ Bolivia—non-​Native​collaborators​involved​themselves​in​ongoing​negotiation​with​indigenous​leaders​who​envisioned​the​use​of​these​tools​in​political​and​intellectual​projects​of​their​own​making.​While​these​collaborators​ were​all​educated​in​the​university,​not​all​had​established​themselves​within​ the​academy.​And​the​projects​in​which​they​were​participating​demanded​ that​Native​agendas​be​given​priority​at​all​times. ​ The​ three​ papers​ presented​ at​ the​ conference​ that​ dealt​ with​ Native​ peoples​in​Hawai‘i​and​the​continental​United​States​were​all​by​Native​academics​and,​while​diverse​in​theme​and​scope,​shared​two​goals.​First,​they​ aimed​to​bring​indigenous​political​and​historical​questions​into​the​heart​ of​academic​discussion​and​to​highlight​how​the​presence​of​Native​scholars​ in​the​academy​changed​the​nature​of​intellectual​conversation.​Second,​the​ three​papers​were​interested​in​using​the​tools​of​academic​analysis​to​foster​debate​within​Native​societies​that​would​lead​to​greater​empowerment.​ The​two​that​appear​here,​by​J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui​on​Native​Hawaiian​options​for​autonomy​and​Brian​Klopotek​on​notions​of​race​among​Louisiana​ Choctaws,​are​the​work​of​committed​indigenous​academics​who​wish​to​ use​the​analytical​tools​at​their​disposal​to​move​debates​on​sovereignty​and​ autonomy​forward. ​ While​overall​the​papers​read​at​our​conference​cannot​be​taken​as​representative,​they​do​suggest​distinct​histories​of​articulation​of​academic​and​ intellectual​ knowledge​ to​ indigenous​ activism​ between​ North​ and​ South.​ introDuction 5

In​the​United​States,​indigenous​scholars​and​intellectuals,​facing​immense​ obstacles,​have​been​making​inroads​into​the​academy​and​into​public​debate.​While​such​participation​is​not​a​panacea,​it​does​open​up​new​venues​ of​ academic​ and​ political​ debate​ that​ were​ not​ present​ before.​ In​ Latin​ America,​while​indigenous​political​and​intellectual​revivals​are​also​beginning​to​open​public​space​for​Native​perspectives—for​example,​among​the​ Aymara​in​Bolivia,​the​Mapuche​in​Chile​and​Argentina,​the​Maya​in​Guatemala,​the​Miskito​along​Nicaragua’s​Atlantic​Coast,​and​the​Maya,​Zapotec,​ and​other​groups​in​Mexico—in​general​it​has​been​less​possible​historically​ for​Native​intellectuals​in​the​South​to​claim​real​space​in​the​academy.​In​ providing​examples​of​the​experiences​and​struggles​of​indigenous​peoples​ in​concrete​historical​contexts​and​in​relation​to​particular​constellations​of​ political​and​economic​power,​we​hope​to​deepen​our​comparative​conversations​in​ways​that​will​be​useful​to​indigenous​peoples​and​their​movements. ​ Perhaps​the​most​important​unifying​theme​of​the​conference,​and​thus​ of​the​book,​was​the​need​to​collaborate​in​the​process​of​decolonization​or,​ as​Roberta​Hill​put​it​during​her​conference​comments,​to​“get​colonialism​ off​our​backs.”​All​the​chapters​address​the​issue​of​decolonizing​methodologies​in​one​way​or​another,​and​the​theme​of​decolonization​serves​as​a​ kind​of​backbone​of​the​book.3​As​Klopotek​explains​in​his​essay,​the​double​ meaning​of​the​phrase​is​productive,​in​the​sense​that​we​aim​both​to​decolonize​the​methodologies​used​in​research​and​writing​and​to​elaborate​ methodologies​ that​ decolonize​ the​ relationship​ between​ researchers​ and​ subjects.​At​the​same​time,​however,​the​authors​represented​in​the​book​develop​varying​takes​on​what​this​means. ​ In​the​first​part​of​the​book,​the​essays​by​J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui​and​Riet​ Delsing​(whose​essay​is​the​only​one​in​the​book​that​did​not​originate​in​ a​conference​presentation)​solidify​the​dialogue​between​the​Americas​and​ the​Pacific​that​is​an​important​part​of​our​project.​Although​the​historical​ differences​between​the​two​cases​are​quite​large,​we​find​surprising​similarities​and​parallels.​One​of​these​is​the​timing​of​the​forced​incorporation​ of​the​territories​into​distant​nation-​states,​separated​by​only​a​decade​(1888​ for​Rapa​Nui​or​Easter​Island’s​annexation​to​Chile,​1898​for​Hawai‘i’s​annexation​to​the​United​States).​This​is​not​surprising,​since​the​last​decades​ of​the​nineteenth​century​were,​across​the​world,​a​time​of​intensification​of​ colonialism​and​of​global​relations​of​trade,​two​reasons​the​Pacific​islands​ were​attractive​to​economically​and​militarily​expansive​nation-​states.​In​this​ regard​it​is​equally​telling​that,​at​the​respective​moments​of​forcible​annexa6 introDuction

tion,​both​Chile​and​the​United​States​had​just​emerged​victorious​from​expansionist​wars​and​territorial​conquest,​Chile​from​the​War​of​the​Pacific​ (1879–84)​and​the​conquest​of​Mapuche​autonomous​territory​in​1883,​the​ United​States​from​the​Spanish-​American​War​(1898). ​ Despite​the​vast​geographical​distance​separating​Rapa​Nui​from​Hawai‘i,​ taken​together​they​remind​us​that​the​process​of​colonialism​is​at​the​very​ heart​of​the​history​of​indigenous​peoples.​One​example​of​that​centrality​ is​how​territory,​including​both​land​and​other​resources,​is​expropriated​ through​illegal​means.​In​both​Rapa​Nui​and​Hawai‘i,​as​Delsing​and​Kauanui​make​clear,​concessions​that​were​understood​by​Native​peoples​to​involve​use​rights​were​fraudulently​and​forcibly​transformed​into​property​ rights.​Even​though​the​political​status​of​the​two​regions​differed​greatly— Rapa​Nui​was​a​rural,​kinship-​based​society​at​the​time​of​annexation,​while​ Hawai‘i​was​an​independent​kingdom​and​had​been​recognized​as​such​by​ European​powers​and​the​United​States​for​nearly​a​century—colonial​violence​can​prove​to​be​a​strong​leveling​force.​At​the​same​time,​the​distinct​ historical​ experiences​ of​ Rapa​ Nui​ and​ Hawai‘i​ dramatically​ differentiate​ their​present-​day​options​from​those​of​other​indigenous​peoples​who​inhabit​the​continental​United​States​and​mainland​Chile. ​ Through​a​detailed​analysis​of​Hawai‘i’s​sovereign​history​in​conversation​with​present-​day​international​debates​about​the​status​of​indigenous​ peoples,​Kauanui​changes​the​terms​of​the​discussion​about​indigenous​autonomy.​ Given​ the​ earlier​ history​ of​ the​ Kingdom​ of​ Hawai‘i,​ there​ is,​ in​ international​law,​a​historical​basis​for​making​a​claim​to​independent​status.​ A​part​of​the​movement​for​autonomy​in​Hawai‘i​thus​supports​the​notion​ of​total​independence​based​on​international​law.​There​is,​however,​a​sizable​ sector​in​Hawai‘i​whose​vision​for​self-​determination​would​pass​through​ U.S.​law;​this​group​prefers​to​make​claims​within​the​U.S.​system​of​federal​recognition​that​has​evolved​in​relation​to​the​indigenous​nations​on​ continental​soil.​Kauanui​makes​clear​that​achieving​federal​recognition​for​ Native​Hawaiians​would​indeed​foreclose​both​the​decolonization​and​the​ deoccupation​models​for​achieving​autonomy,​since​it​would​define​Kanaka​ Maoli,​or​indigenous​Hawaiians,​as​a​“domestic​dependent”​nation​with​no​ recourse​to​independent​status. ​ Delsing​ demonstrates​ in​ her​ discussion​ of​ struggles​ over​ sovereignty​ in​Rapa​Nui​that​the​perspectives​of​the​Rapanui​and​the​history​of​their​ struggle​cannot​be​folded​neatly​either​into​Chilean​history​or​into​the​indigenous​histories​connected​to​the​Chilean​mainland.​Originally​a​PolyintroDuction 7

nesian​people,​the​Rapanui​continue​to​be​linked​to​the​Pacific​region.​And​ while​today​the​Rapanui​are​internally​divided​over​the​most​appropriate​ strategies​to​follow​in​their​ongoing​confrontation​with​Chilean​assimilationist​policies,​a​significant​minority​movement​has​formed​around​the​idea​ of​pursuing​political​independence​in​dialogue​with​other​Pacific​peoples. ​ Part​2​of​the​book​discusses​the​interrelated​themes​of​cross-​cultural​collaboration,​translation,​and​writing.​Joanne​Rappaport​and​Abelardo​Ramos​ Pacho,​who​have​formed​part​of​a​collaborative​research​team​led​by​Nasa​ intellectuals​in​Colombia​for​many​years,​address​the​question​of​collaboration​most​systematically.​Ramos​conceptualizes​intellectual​and​theoretical​ collaboration​ as​ a​ minga,​ a​ project​ of​ collective​ work​ for​ collective​ benefit,​which​provides​us​with​the​opportunity​to​think​through​the​connections​between​physical​and​intellectual​labor​and​the​tensions​between​academic​analysis​and​political​usefulness.​Inevitably,​he​writes,​collaboration​ produces​tensions;​but​these​become​productive​through​work.​For​Rappaport,​this​work​involves​a​dialogue​among​ways​of​knowing—a​diálogo de saberes—in​ which​ indigenous​ epistemology​ is​ primary​ but​ not​ exclusive.​ Interculturalism,​she​suggests,​must​be​a​grass-​roots​practice​that​goes​far​ beyond​multiculturalism​as​an​encounter​within​a​context​already​hegemonized​ from​ one​ side.​ Building​ such​ horizontal​ relationships​ is​ a​ work​ in​ progress,​and​its​success​will​be​found​in​the​political​articulation​of​indigenous​and​nonindigenous​cultural​registers. ​ Rappaport​and​Ramos​also​explore​the​concept​of​translation​and​its​relationship​to​writing​or​inscription.​Translation,​in​this​context,​is​inseparable​ from​ indigenous​ theorizing,​ for​ it​ is​ a​ project​ of​ appropriation,​ rethinking,​ and​ reconfiguration​ of​ language​ and​ concepts​ from​ indigenous​ perspectives.​This​means​the​improvement​and​transformation​of​reality,​not​ only​its​analysis​or​representation​in​a​different​language.​Cultural​as​well​as​ linguistic​translation,​therefore,​opens​up​new​potentials​and​possibilities​ and​gives​access​to​an​intercultural​space​where​new​strategies​of​negotiation​ and​new​ways​of​living​can​potentially​be​suggested.​Ramos​concludes,​along​ these​lines,​by​suggesting​that​one​goal​may​be​an​indigenously​grounded​ objectivity​in​which​the​line​between​academic​rigor​and​political​necessities​ and​desires​can​be​more​effectively​troubled. ​ Jan​Rus​and​Diane​L.​Rus​discuss​how​they​built​on​their​long-​term​presence​in​the​highlands​of​Chiapas​among​the​Chamulas​to​contribute​to​the​ Taller​Tzotzil,​an​already​existing​Tzotzil-​language​publishing​project,​beginning​in​the​1980s.​The​Ruses’​legitimacy​within​the​Tzotzil​community— 8 introDuction

they​had​been​given​Tzotzil​names,​which​appear​at​the​back​of​the​volumes​ produced​by​the​Taller—served​as​a​crucial​entry​point​into​the​project​of​ translation​and​inscription​in​which​they​collaborated.​Their​long​presence​ in​the​region​also​helped​them​understand​more​fully​issues​of​alphabet​and​ orthography,​which​called​to​mind​the​presence​of​Bible​translators​as​well​ as​Protestant​missionaries​and​questions​of​dialect​and​the​diversity​of​voices​ present​within​the​narratives.​Indeed,​the​Ruses’​project​revealed​how​deep​ the​negotiations​and​knowledges​involved​in​a​successful​project​of​translation​and​inscription​are,​a​matter​discussed​by​other​authors​and​summarized​by​one​of​our​panel​commentators,​Frank​Salomon,​when​he​suggested​ that​indigenous​language​accounts​become​text​through​a​collaboration​that​ involves​decontextualization​and​then​recontextualization​and​hence​multiple​translations. ​ But​ even​ more​ important,​ the​ Ruses’​ work​ on​ the​ Tzotzil​ publishing​ project​is​an​especially​dramatic​example​of​an​option​taken​by​many​principled​ intellectuals​ and​ professionals​ in​ Latin​ America​ in​ the​ 1960s​ and​ 1970s—that​ of​ the​ committed,​ engagé​ collaborator.​ Rappaport,​ who​ has​ nearly​three​decades​of​experience​with​the​Nasa​and​Cumbal​peoples​of​ Colombia,​is​another​example​of​someone​who​took​this​option,​though​in​ her​case​she​has​claimed​a​place​within​the​academy​in​the​United​States,​ something​ the​ Ruses​ have​ eschewed.​ In​ part​ activist​ anthropology​ in​ the​ mold​of​Alcida​Rita​Ramos​and​Terrence​Turner,​who​also​presented​papers​ at​our​conference,​this​practice​of​engagé​collaboration​had​its​origins​in​the​ radical​mobilizations​of​the​1960s​and,​by​the​early​1970s,​was​inspired​as​ well​by​liberation​theology​and​the​radical​pedagogy​of​Paulo​Freire,​mentioned​by​the​Ruses. ​ These​forms​of​activist​collaboration,​which​existed​in​many​parts​of​the​ so-​called​Third​World​in​the​1970s​and​1980s,​took​on​a​particularly​intense​ quality​in​Latin​America.​Part​of​the​reason​for​this​had​to​do​with​the​specific​ history​ of​ revolutionary​ movements​ in​ the​ region,​ movements​ that​ often​placed​at​their​very​center​the​collaboration​between​urban​intellectuals​on​the​Left​and​the​rural​poor,​a​significant​proportion​of​whom​were​of​ indigenous​descent.​At​the​same​time,​the​very​nature​of​Latin​America’s​political​and​economic​crises​ate​away​at​earlier​coalitions​between​indigenous​ people​and​the​Left,​so​that​in​a​number​of​areas​relationships​of​collaboration​that​had​rested​on​these​earlier​coalitions​either​fell​apart​entirely​or​had​ to​be​renegotiated.​This​has​been​the​case​with​the​Chilean​Mapuche,​whose​ intellectuals​have​increasingly​taken​center​stage​in​defining​research​and​ introDuction 9

activist​agendas,​and​it​has​also​happened​in​other​areas​of​Latin​America,​ such​as​Guatemala​and​Nicaragua’s​Atlantic​coast. ​ As​Ramos​and​Rappaport​and​the​Ruses​demonstrate,​collaborative​relationships​tend​to​endure​when​they​involve​ongoing​negotiations.​In​reflecting​on​their​long-​standing​collaboration​through​the​Consejo​Regional​ Indígena​ del​ Cauca​ (cric),​ Ramos​ and​ Rappaport​ demonstrate​ that​ it​ is​ precisely​the​moment​of​friction,​of​discomfort,​in​collaboration​that​is​the​ most​productive.​Ramos​suggests​that​it​becomes​so​through​work:​in​other​ words,​through​concrete​tasks​and​discussions​that​help​deepen​a​common​ commitment​to​a​joint​project.​The​Ruses,​for​their​part,​built​on​their​long-​ lasting​ relationship​ with​ Tzotzil​ Maya​ communities​ in​ the​ Chiapas​ highlands,​ especially​ in​ Chamula,​ to​ configure​ a​ unique​ indigenous​ language​ publishing​project​that​has​spanned​two​decades,​adapting​its​goals​according​to​the​changing​nature​of​conditions​in​the​region​as​well​as​in​response​ to​feedback​from​the​participants​themselves.​If​their​project​began​with​the​ purpose​of​recovering​pieces​of​community​indigenous​history​and​making​ them​more​broadly​available​across​the​Chiapas​region,​it​was​transformed​ in​the​1990s​and​beyond,​not​only​by​the​Zapatista​uprising​of​1994,​but​also​ by​the​deepening​economic​crisis​that​reconstructed​the​spatial​locations​of​ Tzotzil​Maya​people,​forcing​many​to​migrate​to​the​local​capital​city​of​San​ Cristóbal​de​las​Casas​and​then​increasingly​across​the​U.S.-​Mexican​border​ into​southern​California. ​ Similar​ multifaceted​ moves​ are​ at​ the​ center​ of​ the​ project​ described​ by​Fernando​Garcés​V.​in​his​essay.​As​a​nonindigenous​linguist​originally​ from​Ecuador​who​has​been​working​on​a​Quechua-​language​newspaper​in​ Bolivia,​Garcés​considers​his​positioning​to​be​a​crucial​part​of​his​project.​ A​political​process​at​its​very​core,​the​production​of​the​newspaper,​Conosur Ñawpagman,​combines​its​distribution​at​political​events​and​peasant​ gatherings​in​Cochabamba​with​the​recording​of​new​interviews​and​testimonials​ for​ the​ next​ round​ of​ articles.​ At​ the​ heart​ of​ the​ newspaper’s​ project,​Garcés​argues,​is​what​he​calls​the​intertextual​play​between​orality​ and​writing.​Inscribing​orality​in​text​is​not​only​the​reproduction​of​speech​ in​writing,​but​a​new​act​of​communication​that​involves​political​mediation.​ Intertextuality,​in​such​a​context,​includes​orality​in​a​process​in​which​both​ the​reception​and​construction​of​texts​are​crucial.​Moving​beyond​a​purist​ or​academically​grounded​notion​of​the​preservation​of​classical​Quechua​ in​text,​Garcés​argues​for​the​interaction​between​Quechua​and​the​Spanish​ written​word​in​order​to​create​new​usages​and​to​strengthen​the​Quechua​ 10 introDuction

language.​As​he​suggested​in​his​oral​remarks​at​the​conference,​the​point​is​ not​to​preserve​Quechua​either​by​limiting​it​to​academic​use​or​putting​it​in​ a​museum​(museoficar),​but​to​revitalize​the​social​strength​of​the​language​ by​supporting​its​life-​giving​and​lively​usages​in​daily​practice. ​ Garcés’s​ participation​ in​ the​ publication​ of​ a​ Quechua​ newspaper​ has​ been​ framed,​ as​ in​ the​ case​ of​ Rappaport​ and​ Ramos​ and​ of​ the​ Ruses,​ within​a​broader​history​of​collaboration​with​indigenous​peasant​organizations.​For​him,​therefore,​intellectual​goals​must​of​necessity​be​interlaced​ with​issues​of​empowerment​and​social​justice.​While​his​knowledge​as​a​linguist​helps​him​conceptualize​the​value​of​a​grass-​roots​newspaper​in​terms​ of​the​larger​project​of​Quechua​language​revitalization,​his​experience​as​an​ activist​provides​him​with​the​tools​through​which​he​can​value​a​real-​life​ process​of​language​recuperation​in​which​everyday​usage,​when​inscribed​ in​text,​allows​for​new​practices​that​creatively​extend​the​relevance​of​the​ language. ​ The​emphasis​on​the​revitalization​of​indigenous​languages​through​dynamic​ and​ creative​ forms​ of​ translation​ and​ inscription​ and​ through​ the​ honoring​of​indigenous​practices​and​epistemologies​that​includes​all​levels​ of​society​is​a​powerful​theme​in​the​chapters​by​Garcés,​Ramos​and​Rappaport,​and​the​Ruses.​These​notions​reverberate​strongly​with​the​call​made​ by​Edgar​Esquit​to​extend​and​deepen​our​understanding​of​the​multiplicity​ of​Maya​histories​and​knowledges.​Among​some​educated​pan-​Maya​intellectuals​in​Guatemala,​he​suggests,​the​uncovering​of​a​unified​Maya​history​can​present​a​past​heretofore​hidden​by​official​Guatemalan​versions​ of​history.​While​this​is​an​important​task,​when​the​members​of​a​particular​professional​sector​among​the​Maya​elaborate​it,​in​dialogue​with​other​ knowledges​outside​of​and​unknown​to​Maya​oral​traditions,​they​can​create​ their​own​official​history​that​positions​them​as​“civilized”​in​relation​to​their​ Maya​brothers​and​sisters. ​ It​is​precisely​these​kinds​of​internal​tensions​and​divisions,​and​how​they​ might​unexpectedly​help​to​reproduce​existing​relationships​of​discrimination​and​inequality,​that​form​the​core​of​Klopotek’s​and​Esquit’s​explorations​in​part​3.​In​his​work​with​the​Louisiana​Choctaws,​Klopotek​examines​the​ways​in​which​racial​classification​systems​specific​to​the​U.S.​South,​ themselves​the​result​of​colonial​relationships​of​racial​power,​are​reflected​in​ the​definitions​of​indigeneity​used​by​southern​Indian​communities.​He​suggests​that​a​fuller​critique​of​the​racial​hierarchies​embedded​in​the​general​ system​of​white​privilege,​of​how​the​“one-​drop​rule”​as​applied​to​people​of​ introDuction 11

African​descent​has​led​to​anti-​Black​sensibilities​among​Native​Americans​ as​a​mechanism​of​self-​defense,​might​in​the​long​run​be​a​positive​move​for​ indigenous​people. ​ Esquit,​for​his​part,​questions​current​uses​of​the​notion​of​internal​colonialism​ by​ pan-​Maya​ intellectuals.4​ When​ the​ concept​ is​ used​ to​ explain​ political​relations​between​Maya​and​ladinos​as​separate​yet​homogeneous​ groups,​he​suggests,​it​may​hide​as​much​as​it​reveals.5​To​what​extent,​he​ asks,​might​such​a​usage​result​in​an​understanding​of​a​people’s​rights​and​ culture​ as​ separate​ from​ economics?​ Would​ it​ not​ be​ more​ productive​ to​ think​of​political​relations​as​organized,​in​a​more​complex​way,​along​many​ lines​of​difference​and​hierarchy​that​exist​between​and​inside​both​Maya​and​ ladino​groups?​In​this​context​Esquit​suggests​that​we​consider​instead​the​ colonial​shape​of​power​relations,​which​allows​us​to​connect​class​to​notions​ of​race​and​ethnicity,​thus​opening​the​way​for​a​deeper​recognition​of​the​ multiplicity​of​experiences,​perspectives,​and​history​among​the​Maya.6 ​ Both​Klopotek​and​Esquit,​as​young​indigenous​intellectuals,​are​raising​ questions​about​the​political​and​intellectual​practices​of​a​previous​generation​of​leaders.​Their​locations​within​very​different​societies—Klopotek​is​ a​Choctaw​academic​in​the​United​States,​Esquit​a​Maya​anthropologist​in​ Guatemala—configure​their​options​as​they​negotiate​between​activism​and​ intellectual​work.​Yet​at​the​same​time,​they​share​a​desire​to​expand​definitions​of​indigenous​identity​and​belonging​so​that​broader​coalitions​of​ people​who​identify​as​indigenous,​including​those​traditionally​excluded​ from​leadership,​can​work​more​effectively​to​define​common​goals. ​ The​ desire​ to​ open​ up​ indigenous​ politics​ to​ wider​ coalitions​ involves​ as​well​the​question​of​gender,​as​Esquit​explains​in​his​paper​and​as​also​ emerges​in​the​Tzotzil​publishing​project.​As​the​Ruses​explain,​Diane​Rus’s​ collaboration​with​Maruch​Komes​on​Komes’s​life​history​initiated​a​broader​ discussion​of​a​Maya​women’s​weaving​and​embroidering​cooperative​as​an​ economic​response​to​crisis.​Yet​even​as​this​generated​new​resources​for​the​ cooperative​it​created​deep​debates​about​women’s​economic​autonomy.​Internal​tensions​over​gendered​power​relations​have​also​emerged​in​other​ contexts​of​indigenous​mobilization,​as​is​divulged​in​the​recent​autobiography​by​the​feminist​Mapuche​leader​Isolde​Reuque,​who​was​present​at​the​ conference.7 ​ Taken​together,​then,​the​presentations​at​the​conference​and​the​essays​ in​this​book​explore​a​myriad​of​themes​relating​to​the​challenges​of​decolonization—intellectual,​ academic,​ and​ political.​ Noenoe​ Silva​ and​ Stéfano​ 12 introDuction

Varese,​given​the​perhaps​impossible​task​of​summing​up​the​papers​and​ our​discussions​as​a​prelude​to​a​last​general​plenary​session,​represented​in​ their​comments​some​of​this​complexity​of​solidarity​and​difference.​Silva,​ a​Native​Hawaiian​political​scientist​whose​work​has​demonstrated​how​the​ recovery​of​Hawaiian​language​sources​changes​the​history​of​U.S.​annexation​and​our​understanding​of​Hawaiian​intellectual​life​(Silva​2004,​2007),​ emphasized​the​importance​of​stories​and​language​to​the​empowerment​of​ peoples,​illustrating​her​points​throughout​with​narratives​from​her​own​experiences​and​those​of​her​people.​She​also​spoke​of​the​importance​and​the​ difficulty​of​fostering​Native​scholars.​She​underlined​both​the​possibilities​ and​the​dangers​connected​to​this​task,​but​in​the​end​she​suggested​that​only​ by​having​Native​voices​and​presence​in​the​academy​can​we​aspire​to​a​truly​ intercultural​education​in​which​indigenous​epistemologies​and​languages​ have​a​powerful​voice​and​standing​for​all. ​ Stéfano​Varese,​on​the​other​hand,​an​activist​anthropologist​educated​in​ Peru​but​who​has​worked​on​indigenous​activism​and​sovereignty​throughout​the​Americas,​focused​on​the​power​of​political​mobilization.​He​stressed​ the​danger​inherent​in​the​academy’s​absorption​of​projects​aimed​at​sovereignty,​ the​ recuperation​ of​ language​ and​ territory,​ and​ the​ rewriting​ of​ history,​suggesting​that​indigenous​intellectuals​need​to​be​organic​in​the​ Gramscian​sense.​He​emphasized​the​political​dimensions​of​the​projects​of​ recovery​and​reclaiming,​whether​these​involved​language​or​landscape,​history,​memory,​or​sovereignty.​Ultimately,​he​warned​against​overly​academic​ projects​that,​even​in​the​hands​of​indigenous​intellectuals,​might​recolonize​indigenous​knowledge.​The​differences​of​emphasis​and​vision​in​the​ general​comments​of​Silva​and​Varese​can​help​frame​a​last​set​of​reflections​ that​emerged​from​and​were​prompted​by​our​discussions​at​the​conference.​ As​the​subsequent​conversations,​both​formally​at​the​plenary​and​along​the​ edges​in​more​informal​one-​on-​one​exchanges,​made​clear,​these​differences​ arose​precisely​from​the​diversity​of​experience​and​historical​context​that​ exists​today​among​indigenous​peoples​in​the​Americas​and​the​Pacific.​But​ they​can​also​be​seen​in​the​context​of​our​common​project​of​decolonization,​which​must​involve​an​understanding​of​how​a​respect​for​and​understanding​of​variation​can​lead​to​new​forms​of​creativity. ​ In​her​discussion​of​the​power​of​language​and​stories,​Silva​was​drawing​on​a​deep​tradition​of​struggle​to​honor​the​truths​and​epistemological​ perspectives​contained​in​Native​oral​traditions.​As​several​of​the​essays​in​ this​book​argue,​the​development​of​more​horizontal​and​respectful​forms​of​ introDuction 13

research​and​analysis​must​necessarily​pass​through​a​rethinking​of​and​reencounter​with​the​forms​of​knowledge​contained​in​and​passed​on​through​ oral​tradition.​At​the​confluence​of​several​intellectual​debates,​discussions​ about​oral​history​and​alternative​forms​of​knowledge​and​narrative​have​become​increasingly​wide​ranging​in​recent​years.​Whether​in​the​form​of​testimonio,​oral​history,​or​subaltern​studies,​these​conversations​and​confrontations​have​spanned​the​globe.​While​not​all​the​discussions​have​concerned​ indigenous​issues,​many​of​them​have,​and​Native​and​non-​Native​scholars​ of​indigenous​cultures​have​played​prominent​roles​in​them.​While​even​a​ representative​sample​of​these​conversations​is​too​large​to​cite​here,​often​ the​main​issues​at​stake​concern​the​assessment​of​claims​to​truth​according​ to​established​rules​of​evidence.8​Given​the​distinct​nature​of​oral​tradition​ and​oral​history​as​a​performative​medium​based​on​imparting​knowledge​ and​wisdom​gained​through​direct​personal​experience​or​connection,​the​ rules​of​evidence​associated​with​the​scientific​method​are​less​relevant​or​ applicable.​For​some,​this​makes​oral​tradition​a​lesser​form​of​evidence,​precisely​because​it​is​not​verifiable.9 ​ Two​ complementary​ answers​ to​ this​ challenge​ have​ taken​ shape.​ One​ takes​on​the​academic​project​of​verifiable​research​results​and​demonstrates​ how​alternative​forms​of​knowledge​production​and​transmission,​especially​ oral​tradition,​contribute​new,​important,​and​distinct​perspectives​to​our​ quest​for​knowledge.​They​do​so​precisely​because​they​are​not​data​but​systems​ of​ thought​ that​ provide,​ as​ Julie​ Cruikshank​ writes​ in​ her​ work​ on​ Yukon​communities,​“a​window​on​the​ways​the​past​is​culturally​constituted​ and​discussed.​In​other​words,”​she​continues,​“stories​were​not​merely​about​ the​past,​they​also​provided​guidelines​for​understanding​change”​(Cruikshank​2002,​13).​Similar​claims​are​made​in​a​very​different​context​by​the​ oral​historian​Alessandro​Portelli,​who​argues​that​the​performative​and​apparently​subjective​form​of​oral​history​is​its​greatest​strength,​precisely​because​it​allows​us​to​dig​beyond​fact​to​meaning​(Portelli​1991,​1997).​And​ it​is​precisely​in​this​access​to​meaning​and​interpretation​that​we​can​find​ a​practical​answer​to​the​challenge​set​forth​by​Chakrabarty​(2000)​when​ he​calls​on​us​to​resist​the​positivist​closure​of​narrative​that​keeps​us​from​ understanding​alternative​versions​of​history​that​do​not​start​from​and​end​ in​Europe.10​A​second​way​to​confront​the​objectivist​critique​has​been​to​ question​the​assumption​of​superiority​on​which​it​is​based.​Some​scholars,​including​Linda​Tuhiwai​Smith​(1999),​have​used​postcolonial​and​other​ forms​of​critical​theory​in​dialogue​with​indigenous​knowledge​ to​evalu14 introDuction

ate​the​intellectual​basis​upon​which​dominant​theories​and​methodologies​ have​been​built.​Others,​such​as​Devon​Mihesuah​and​Angela​Cavender​Wilson​(1998,​2004),​have​addressed​specific​historiographies​and​their​minimization​or​erasure​of​Native​sources. ​ It​ was​ precisely​ this​ rich​ tradition​ that​ Silva​ referred​ to​ when​ she​ discussed​the​power​of​stories.​She​also​was​making​reference​to​her​own​work​ on​Hawaiian​language​sources,​and​how​the​highlighting​of​new​versions,​ whether​ oral​ or​ written,​ can​ and​ should​ turn​ our​ interpretations​ of​ both​ the​past​and​the​present​on​their​heads.​And​for​Silva,​doing​so​within​the​ academy,​through​the​increasing​presence​of​Native​scholars​within​its​gates,​ is​an​absolutely​crucial​priority.​This​is​also​the​most​important​point​put​forward​in​the​recent​anthology​Indigenizing the Academy​(Mihesuah​and​Wilson,​2004),​not​in​the​sense​merely​of​inclusion​but​also​of​transformation.​ As​Silva​noted​in​her​comments,​several​of​the​authors​represented​in​that​ book,​including​Mihesuah​and​Taiaiake​Alfred,​demonstrate​that​bringing​ indigenous​perspectives​into​the​academy​makes​sense​if​and​when​a​critical​ mass​of​indigenous​scholars​can​begin​to​change​the​way​in​which​academic​ knowledge​itself​is​organized,​produced,​and​taught.11​This​means​not​only​ claiming​a​space​within​academic​circles​for​indigenous​points​of​view,​but​ envisioning​a​time​when​indigenous​languages,​histories,​and​epistemologies​ are​part​of​the​knowledge​that​everyone​seeks​out. ​ On​this​point,​Silva​and​Varese​brought​the​most​distinct​perspectives​ to​the​table.​Historical​differences​between​North​and​South—how​Native–​ state​relations​have​been​negotiated,​the​role​of​academic​learning​in​society,​ the​nature​of​indigenous​social​and​political​movements​and​their​relationship​to​other​forms​of​resistance—help​explain​in​part​the​diverse​visions​ of​indigenous​participation​in​the​academy.​If​today​a​second​generation​of​ indigenous​scholars,​on​the​basis​of​much​struggle​and​sacrifice,​is​establishing​a​beachhead​in​university​systems​in​the​United​States,​Canada,​and​New​ Zealand,​such​is​not​yet​the​case,​with​few​exceptions,​in​Latin​America.12​The​ always-​present​ danger​ of​ the​ academy​ colonizing​ the​ indigenous​ scholar,​ rather​than​the​other​way​around,​is​a​serious​threat​in​the​South.​But​perhaps​even​more​stark​is​the​variation​in​the​depth​and​degree​of​participation​ by​indigenous​activists​in​class-​based​movements​for​social​change. ​ Indeed,​as​Armando​Muyolema​argued​in​his​presentation​at​the​conference,​one​of​the​central​distinguishing​characteristics​of​indigenous​movements​ in​ Latin​ America​ historically​ has​ been​ their​ close​ interaction​ and​ interrelation​with​popular​class-​based​movements.​In​Latin​America​the​lack​ introDuction 15

of​treaty​or​nation-​to-​nation​negotiations​led​to​an​early​fragmentation​of​ Native​territories​into​small​communities​and​to​direct​negotiation​between​ national​states​and​these​small,​land-​based​political​units.​As​a​result,​the​indigenous​question​was​deeply​embedded​in​the​broader​land​question,​and​ in​the​majority​of​cases​the​most​promising​line​of​struggle​lay​in​a​class​alliance​with​other​landless​or​rural​poor.​This​alliance​was​buttressed​by​the​ generally​dependent​status​of​Latin​American​countries,​which​increased​the​ pressure​for​a​common​coalition​in​favor​of​national​development,​especially​ in​the​heady​years​of​reform​between​the​Second​World​War​and​the​end​of​ the​Vietnam​War. ​ During​these​three​decades​national-​popular​states​based​on​coalitions​of​ leftist​intellectuals​and​political​parties,​trade-​union​organizations,​and​some​ peasant​groups​held​out​promises​of​egalitarian​reform​as​they​confronted​ entrenched​oligarchies​and​landowning​elites,​while​at​the​same​time​promoting​relations​of​so-​called​internal​colonialism​in​which​some​of​the​poor​ ended​up​being​more​deserving​than​others.​Still,​at​a​moment​in​history​ when​change​seemed​possible,​many​found​it​more​important​to​maintain​ the​unity​of​all​popular​forces​than​to​take​exception​to​the​ongoing​forms​of​ inequality​within​the​reformist​alliance.​The​greater​strength​of​class-​based​ social​and​political​movements​in​Latin​America,​moreover,​increased​the​ attraction,​among​laboring​indigenous​peoples​in​city​and​countryside,​of​ a​class-​based​coalition.​One​major​exception​to​these​tendencies​could​be​ found​among​lowland​indigenous​peoples,​particularly​in​the​Amazonian​ regions​of​Venezuela,​Colombia,​Peru,​Bolivia,​and​especially​Brazil,​where​ Native​peoples​had​little​permanent​interaction​with​emerging​nation-​states​ except​through​violent​extractive​industries​and​the​spread​of​epidemic​diseases​(Ramos​1995,​1998;​Turner​1995,​2002;​Varese​1970). ​ It​was​only​with​the​generalized​failure​of​national-​democratic​and​socialist​attempts​at​reform​and​national​liberation,​therefore—most​notably​in​ the​1970s​and​early​1980s—that​the​class-​alliance​strategy​was​finally​brought​ to​crisis​for​many​indigenous​peoples​in​Latin​America.​Yet,​as​Charles​R.​ Hale​and​Rosamel​Millamán​have​recently​argued​(2006),​the​evolution​of​ culture-​based​demands​for​indigenous​peoples​has​led​to​a​new​kind​of​trap​ for​activists​interested​in​autonomy,​since​neoliberal​states​in​process​of​transition​toward​democratic​rule​have​articulated​a​rights-​based​discourse​that​ provides​limited​new​privileges​for​indigenous​peoples​within​the​context​of​ the​new​political​order.​This​has​given​rise,​in​their​estimation,​to​the​emer-

16 introDuction

gence​of​(borrowing​a​term​from​the​Aymara​historian​and​activist​Silvia​ Rivera​Cusicanqui)​the​indio permitido,​or​“permissible​Indian,”​a​new​figure​ who,​in​return​for​limited​new​cultural​and​political​rights,​is​colonized​into​ the​existing​system.​So​in​the​end,​it​seems​that​for​a​host​of​historical​reasons​ many​ Native​ intellectuals​ in​ the​ South​ have​ perhaps​ a​ deeper,​ more​ enduring​suspicion​of​and​hostility​toward​institutions,​both​political​and​ academic.​This​was,​in​part,​the​perspective​reflected​in​Varese’s​concluding​ comments. ​ And​yet​we​must​not​overdraw​the​contrasts​between​North​and​South​ but​use​them—as​we​use​other​differences​and​tensions—as​entry​points​ for​deeper​reflection.​In​our​final​plenary​session,​Leilani​Basham,​a​Native​ Hawaiian​ scholar,​ addressed​ the​ nonindigenous​ people​ in​ our​ midst,​ reminding​us​that​respect​for​difference​and​for​the​integrity​of​cultures​must​ lie​at​the​heart​of​all​forms​of​collaboration.​The​minute​we​start​to​feel​proprietary,​she​implied,​it’s​time​to​let​go,​to​establish​a​respectful​distance.​ Jennifer​Denetdale​added​to​this​observation​that,​as​Wilson​has​noted,​not​ only​colonialism​but​decolonization​as​well​engenders​violence.​“When​we​ speak​and​we​speak​honestly​and​we​speak​across​cultures,”​Denetdale​said,​ “one​of​the​things​that​will​happen​is​that​there​will​be​tension,​it​will​be​ uncomfortable.​Don’t​be​afraid,​stay​there,​see​what​it​feels​like,​see​what​it​ tastes​like.”13​Denetdale’s​comments​echoed​Ramos’s​earlier​suggestion​that​ collaboration​inevitably​leads​to​tension,​but​that​tension​and​contradiction​ can​be​productive​through​work.​They​also​raised,​once​again,​the​painful​ or​uncomfortable​quality​of​the​frontier,​that​place​where,​as​Gloria​Anzaldúa​wrote,​“the​Third​World​grates​against​the​first​and​bleeds”​(Anzaldúa​ 1987,​3). ​ As​intellectuals,​scholars,​researchers,​and​writers​who​inhabit​a​variety​of​ frontiers,​we​face​these​contradictions​daily.​Attempting​to​build​nonviolent​ knowledge​must,​perhaps,​inevitably​be​done​along​the​frontier—between​ worlds,​between​cultures​and​languages,​between​histories​and​territories.​ What​tools​do​we​have?​Many,​including​the​law,​history,​the​archive,​the​ academy,​ and​ writing​ itself,​ have​ also​ been​ the​ tools​ of​ colonialism.​ And​ given​the​history​of​our​world,​could​it​be​any​other​way?​To​build​nonviolent​knowledge​with​tools​steeped​in​violence​may​be​the​core​of​our​project.​ And​we​need​to​build​such​knowledge​globally,​since​the​forces​that​oppose​ it​are​global,​too.​As​Ramos​suggested​during​the​discussions,​it​is​indeed​a​ challenge​to​use​the​same​tools​the​colonizers​have​used.​But,​he​insisted,​it​

introDuction 17

is​a​challenge​we​can​take​on​creatively​and​ambitiously,​with​the​purpose​of​ transforming​both​their​use​and​their​meaning.​We​offer​this​book​in​that​ spirit.

Notes ​ 1.​ Colleagues​ at​ Wisconsin​ who​ participated​ in​ the​ early​ intellectual​ planning​ stages​for​the​conference​are​Ned​Blackhawk,​Ada​Deer,​Roberta​Hill,​Patricia​Loew,​ Larry​Nesper,​Frank​Salomon,​and​Theresa​Schenck.​Ned​Blackhawk​in​particular​ was​most​helpful​in​identifying​potential​participants​working​on​Hawai‘i,​the​United​ States,​and​Canada.​Our​conference​was​held​in​conjunction​with​the​graduate​student​conference​of​the​ cic ​American​Indian​Studies​Consortium,​organized​that​ year​in​Madison​by​Ned​Blackhawk.​Some​of​the​participants​made​important​contributions​ to​ our​ plenary​ discussions.​ For​ logistical​ and​ organizational​ support,​ I​ owe​thanks​to​the​Institute​for​Research​in​the​Humanities​and​especially​to​Loretta​ Freiling;​and​to​the​American​Indian​Studies​Program,​especially​to​Denise​Wyaka.​ Financial​support​for​the​conference​was​provided​by​the​Burdick​Vary​Fund​of​the​ Institute​for​Research​in​the​Humanities;​the​Anonymous​Fund​and​the​University​ Lectures​Committee​of​the​University​of​Wisconsin;​and​the​naVe ​Fund​of​the​Latin​ American,​Caribbean,​and​Iberian​Studies​Program.​The​following​programs,​offices,​ and​divisions​of​the​University​of​Wisconsin​contributed​to​the​purchase,​housing,​ and​maintenance​of​the​simultaneous​interpretation​equipment​used​at​the​conference,​which​is​now​available​on​campus​for​use​by​other​interpreters:​the​Language​ Institute;​the​Global​Studies​Program;​the​Office​of​Human​Resource​Development;​ the​Division​of​International​Studies;​the​Department​of​History;​the​Office​of​Facilities,​Planning​and​Management;​the​Division​of​University​Housing;​the​Medical​ School;​the​Wisconsin​Union;​and​Learning​and​Support​Services.​Simultaneous​interpretation​was​provided​by​Gladys​McCormick,​Adan​Palau,​Yesenia​Pumarada​ Cruz,​and​Donna​Vukelich.​I’m​grateful​to​Roberto​Galo​Arroyo​for​permission​to​ use​his​art​on​the​cover​of​the​paperback​book.​At​Duke​University​Press​I’m​grateful,​ as​always,​to​Valerie​Millholland,​Mark​Mastromarino,​and​Miriam​Angress.​Carol​ Roberts​did​her​usual​excellent​work​on​the​index. ​ 2.​The​literature​on​these​issues​is​too​extensive​to​cite​here.​Among​the​pioneers​ in​the​application​of​colonial​and​postcolonial​theory​to​a​study​of​indigenous​issues​ is​Linda​Tuhiwai​Smith​(1999).​Other​starting​points​for​postcolonial​theory​might​ include​Said​1978;​Chatterjee​1986;​Guha​and​Spivak​1988;​Prakash​1995;​Dirlik,​Bahl,​ and​Gran​2000;​Loomba,​Kaul,​Bunzl,​Burton,​and​Esty​2005. ​ 3.​The​phrase​“decolonizing​methodologies”​comes​from​the​title​of​Smith​1999. ​ 4.​Originally​formulated​as​a​concept​ by​Pablo​González​ Casanova​(1965)​and​ Rodolfo​Stavenhagen​(1965),​“internal​colonialism”​has​been​taken​up,​and​its​mean-

18 introDuction

ing​ transformed,​ by​ indigenous​ intellectuals​ in​ Guatemala​ and​ Bolivia.​ See​ Cojtí​ Cuxil​1996;​Rivera​Cusicanqui​and​Barragán​1997;​Qayum​2002. ​ 5.​In​modern​Guatemala,​the​word​ladino​is​used​to​designate​a​Hispanicized​person,​usually​of​mixed​European​and​indigenous​descent;​in​many​other​parts​of​Latin​ America​that​person​would​be​termed​mestizo. ​ 6.​This​call​for​more​consciously​inclusive​forms​of​indigenous​politics​is​echoed​ as​well​by​Víctor​Montejo​(2005). ​ 7.​Indigenous​women,​Reuque​suggested​at​the​conference,​can​be​doubly​marginalized​or​doubly​invisible;​and​yet,​as​her​experience​with​her​book​has​demonstrated,​indigenous​women​are​also​a​source​of​great​cultural​and​political​dynamism.​ See​Reuque​Paillalef​2002a,​b. ​ 8.​Some​examples​are​Cruikshank​2002;​Howe​2002;​James​2000;​Mallon​2001,​ 2002,​2005;​Montejo​1987,​1999;​Portelli​1991,​1997;​Wilson​1998. ​ 9.​An​example​of​these​debates​can​be​found​in​Hispanic American Historical Review​(1999). ​ 10.​I​engage​in​a​dialogue​with​Chakrabarty​on​these​issues​in​Mallon​2005. ​ 11.​See​especially​Mihesuah’s​essay​“American​Indian​History​as​a​Field​of​Study”​ and​Alfred’s​essay​“Warrior​Scholarship,”​both​in​Mihesuah​and​Wilson​2004. ​ 12.​ One​ might​ argue​ that​ within​ Latin​ America​ indigenous​ intellectuals​ have​ made​limited​progress​in​entering​academic​circles​in​Bolivia,​Guatemala,​Colombia,​Chile,​and​on​Nicaragua’s​Atlantic​coast,​but​all​gains​are​partial​and​very​hard​ to​maintain,​given​the​financial​difficulties​of​universities​in​general.​The​tendency​is​ for​indigenous​intellectuals​to​develop​their​own​institutions,​which​are​financially​ fragile​as​well.​An​especially​trenchant​example​of​these​problems​is​represented​in​ Chile​by​the​publication​of​Marimán,​Caniuqueo,​Millalén,​and​Levil​2006,​a​book​ of​essays​by​four​young​Mapuche​historians,​of​whom​only​one,​Marimán,​has​so​far​ had​access​to​a​Ph.D.​program. ​ 13.​Jennifer​Denetdale,​General​Comment,​Plenary​Session,​Conference​on​Narrating​Native​Histories,​University​of​Wisconsin,​Madison,​10​April​2005,​transcription​from​recording​of​the​session.

introDuction 19

since tHe 1970 s​the​internationalization​of​indigenous​mobilization​and​the​

formation​of​globalized​coalitions​of​Native​peoples​have​changed​the​face​ of​indigenous​cultural​politics​and​of​indigenous​claims​to​autonomy.​One​ of​the​venues​through​which​Native​activism​has​been​most​dramatically​felt​ has​been​the​United​Nations,​where​indigenous​peoples​have​successfully​ pressured​for​the​passage​of​broad-​ranging​resolutions​supporting​Native​ rights​to​self-​determination,​autonomy,​and​territorial​and​cultural​integrity.​ Both​the​International​Labor​Organization’s​(ilo)​Convention​169,​adopted​ in​June​1989​and​put​in​force​in​September​1991,​and​the​United​Nations​ Declaration​on​the​Rights​of​Indigenous​Peoples,​ratified​in​September​2007,​ have​broken​new​ground​in​the​area​of​international​recognition​of​indigenous​rights. ​ During​the​1990s,​as​Native​peoples​pressured​existing​nation-​states​to​ ratify​and​observe​the​principles​of​ ilo ​Convention​169​in​their​dealings​ with​indigenous​peoples​within​their​borders,​it​became​clear​that​un ​resolutions​can​serve​as​powerful​weapons​for​mobilization.​Additionally,​the​ intensification​and​deepening​of​international​debate​on​indigenous​issues,​ buttressed​by​back-​to-​back​Decades​of​Indigenous​Peoples​declared​by​the​ United​Nations​(1990–2000,​2000–2010),​have​increased​consciousness​on​ the​ question​ of​ Native​ peoples​ and​ their​ rights,​ not​ only​ among​ political​ elites​ but​ also​ in​ intellectual​ and​ academic​ communities​ worldwide.​ And​ this​new​awareness​has​doubled​back​into​Native​societies,​encouraging​new​ forms​of​activism. ​ The​two​essays​in​part​1​situate​the​struggles​of​two​indigenous​peoples,​ the​ Kanaka​ Maoli​ of​ Hawai‘i​ and​ the​ Rapanui​ of​ Rapa​ Nui,​ or​ so-​called​ Easter​ Island,​ squarely​ within​ this​ evolving​ story​ of​ international​ indigenous​mobilization.​Informed​by​literatures​in​international​politics,​international​human​rights,​and​debates​over​indigenous​self-​determination,​these​ essays​take​a​broad​view​of​the​interactions​between​indigenous​peoples​and​ the​states​that​colonized​them.​The​focus​is​not​on​local​forms​of​cultural​ practice​or​historical​memory,​but​on​the​historically​changing​alternatives​ available​to​indigenous​peoples​as​a​whole​in​their​struggle​to​retain​land,​ culture,​and​resources​and​to​achieve​sovereignty​and​self-​determination. ​ Kehaulani​Kauanui​places​the​historical​struggle​of​Kanaka​Maoli​both​ in​the​context​of​U.S.​federal​government​debates​and​within​discussions​in​

international​law.​As​she​makes​clear,​the​case​of​Hawai‘i​is​in​some​ways​ unique​because,​during​the​nineteenth​century,​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i​received​ international​ treaty​ recognition​ as​ a​ sovereign​ state.​ Subsequently,​ however,​the​U.S.-​backed​overthrow​of​the​kingdom​in​1893,​the​illegal​annexation​of​Hawai‘i​as​a​U.S.​territory​in​1898,​and​the​irregular​vote​that​led​ to​statehood​in​1959​have​all​added​layers​of​complexity​and​colonialism,​ making​ questions​ of​ national​ sovereignty,​ deoccupation,​ and​ indigenous​ rights​deeply​conflictual​among​the​islands’​inhabitants.​Indeed,​as​Kauanui​ explores​in​her​essay,​none​of​the​alternatives​existing​today—whether​indigenous​self-​determination​under​U.S.​federal​law​or​under​international​ law,​decolonization​under​international​law,​or​deoccupation​based​on​the​ kingdom’s​ previous​ existence​ as​ an​ independent​ state—attend​ simultaneously​and​effectively​to​the​needs​of​all​those​involved. ​ Consciously​developing​a​different​kind​of​anthropological​perspective,​ Riet​ Delsing​ traces​ the​ revitalization​ and​ recovery​ of​ identity​ and​ memory​in​Rapa​Nui​both​as​a​story​embedded​in​the​narrative​of​the​Chilean​ nation-​state​and​as​an​international​practice​framed​by​the​last​generation​ of​ globalized​ indigenous​ mobilization.​ Delsing​ shows​ how​ the​ history​ of​ Chilean​expropriation​and​colonization​of​the​Rapanui​is​both​embedded​ in​the​evolution​of​the​Chilean​nation-​state​and​is​a​chapter​in​the​broader​ story​of​Chilean​Pacific​imperialism​and​territorial​expansion.​At​the​same​ time,​she​traces​the​links​between​the​evolution​of​a​new​Rapanui​consciousness​and​the​development​of​a​Pacific-​based​indigenous​consciousness.​In​ the​end,​she​suggests​that​the​recent​turn​to​militancy​by​a​sector​of​Rapanui​ activists​is​articulated​to​the​expansion​of​international​indigenous​activism​ and​to​the​Rapanui’s​recognition​of​themselves​as​a​Polynesian,​rather​than​ an​American,​people. ​ Taken​together,​the​two​essays​assume​three​important​tasks​of​the​collection​as​a​whole.​First,​they​show​how,​in​two​specific​historical​cases,​the​ international​indigenous​movement​and​ un ​debates​on​indigenous​rights​ have​changed​the​struggles​for​autonomy​and​self-​determination​over​the​ last​two​generations.​The​richness​of​historical​context​provided​is​extremely​ important,​because​some​analysts​have​tended​to​assume​that,​rather​than​ coming​to​fruition​in​the​context​of​the​ un ​debates,​indigenous​struggles​ actually​originated​in​them.​These​essays​demonstrate,​to​the​contrary,​that​ the​changing​international​context​has​afforded​new​venues​and​languages​ within​which​to​place​already​existing​and​ongoing​struggles​over​cultural​ recognition,​resources,​and​self-​determination. Sovereignty and Self-Determination 23

Louisiana

Chiapas

Hawaii

Chimaltenango Cauca Valley

PAC I F I C O C E A N Cochabamba Valley

Rapa Nui

Map​of​regions​discussed​in​the​book. Credit:​Cartographic​Laboratory,​University​of​Wisconsin,​Madison. Mallon 5 x 4 in

​ 08.09.10 The​second​task​the​essays​take​on​is​to​decenter​the​focus​of​the​volume​from​the​Americas.​By​concentrating​on​the​Pacific​region,​and​specifically​on​two​Polynesian​peoples,​the​authors​remind​us​to​look​outside​ our​national,​or​even​continental,​boundaries​in​considering​the​relationship​ between​indigenous​peoples​and​colonialism.​Despite​the​dramatic​differences​in​the​history​of​Hawai‘i​and​Rapa​Nui,​certain​similarities​in​historical​periodization​and​even​in​linguistic​terminology​(for​example,​the​use​of​ the​word​canaca​in​Rapa​Nui​and​kanaka​in​Hawai‘i​to​denote​indigenous​ people)​stand​out.​This​process​of​decentering​can​perhaps​be​best​appreciated​visually​by​looking​at​the​accompanying​map.​As​the​reader​will​see,​in​ order​to​show​Hawai‘i​it​was​necessary​to​cut​off​a​portion​of​eastern​South​ America,​giving​the​image​a​certain​counterintuitive​feel. ​ The​third​task​these​essays​perform​is​to​raise​the​question​of​methodology​in​the​writing​of​indigenous​history​and​Native​narrative.​We​tend​to​ assume​that​Native​history,​because​it​is​about​indigenous​communities,​is​ best​written​from​an​ethnographic​perspective​that​seeks​to​get​inside​the​ cultures​about​which​we​write.​Certainly​a​close​understanding​of​cultural​ 24 part​one

categories​and​practices,​of​people’s​narratives​and​memories,​must​stand​ at​the​center​of​how​Native​history​is​rendered.​Yet​at​the​same​time,​as​we​ reflect​in​this​book​on​notions​of​decolonization,​we​must​also​take​to​heart​ the​ fact​ that​ broad​ national​ and​ international​ narratives​ and​ analysis​ are​ equally​important​as​Native​peoples​continue​to​engage​nation-​states,​intellectuals,​political​organizations,​and​academic​practitioners.​Perhaps,​in​this​ sense,​decolonization​can​also​begin​at​home,​as​we​think​through​the​multiple​ways​and​registers​in​which​to​render​indigenous​narratives,​history,​ and​experience​in​the​ever​more​globalized​world.

Sovereignty and Self-Determination 25

J. keHaulani kauanui

Hawaiian​Nationhood,​Self-​Determination,​​ and​International​Law

This​measure​does​not​preclude​Native​Hawaiians​from​seeking​alternatives​in​the​international​arena.​This​measure​focuses​solely​on​self-​determination​within​the​framework​of​ federal​law​and​seeks​to​establish​equality​in​the​federal​policies​extended​towards​American​Indians,​Alaska​Natives​and​Native​Hawaiians. —U.S.​Senator​Daniel​Kahikina​Akaka​(2001a) Let​me​be​clear—It​is​not​my​intention,​nor​the​intention​of​the​delegation,​to​preclude​ efforts​of​Native​Hawaiians​at​the​international​level.​The​scope​of​this​bill​is​limited​to​ federal​law. —U.S.​Senator​Daniel​Kahikina​Akaka​(2001b)

U.S.​Senator​Daniel​Kahikina​Akaka’s​assurances,​made​in​2001,​were​in​regard​to​a​legislative​initiative​to​recognize​a​Native​Hawaiian​nation​within​ the​confines​of​U.S.​federal​policy​on​Tribal​Nations​that​still​remains​before​ the​U.S.​Congress.​Beginning​in​the​106th​U.S.​Congress​in​2000​and​continuing​at​least​through​the​111th​Congress​in​2011,​Akaka,​a​Native​Hawaiian​Democrat​from​the​State​of​Hawai‘i,​introduced​this​federal​legislation​in​ order​to​secure​the​recognition​of​Native​Hawaiians​as​an​indigenous​people​ who​have​a​“special​relationship”​with​the​United​States​and​thus​a​right​to​ internal​self-​determination.​Passage​of​the​bill​would​lay​the​foundation​for​a​ nation-​within-​a-​nation​model​of​self-​governance​defined​by​U.S.​federal​law​ as​“domestic​dependent​nations”​to​exercise​the​right​to​self-​government.​ The​U.S.​government​has​included​Kanaka​Maoli​(indigenous​Hawaiians)​in​ over​160​legislative​acts​relating​to​Native​Americans.1​However,​it​has​not​included​Kanaka​Maoli​in​its​policy​on​Native​self-​determination.​Akaka’s​assertions​that​passage​of​the​bill​would​not​preclude​Kanaka​Maoli​from​seek-

ing​“alternatives​in​the​international​arena”​have​been​his​standard​response​ to​ challenges​ posed​ to​ him​ by​ individuals​ and​ organizations​ opposed​ to​ the​legislation​because​they​favor​Hawaiian​independence​from​the​United​ States—that​is,​the​restoration​of​a​Hawaiian​state​under​international​law.​ These​groups​include​Hui​Pu​as​well​as​those​who​are​part​of​the​Hawaiian​ Independence​Action​Alliance:​the​Pro-​Kanaka​Maoli​Independence​Working​Group,​Ka​Pakaukau,​Komike​Tribunal,​ honi ​(Hui​o​Na​Ike),​Ka​Lei​ Maile​Ali‘i​Hawaiian​Civic​Club,​Koani​Foundation,​‘Ohana​Koa,​ nFip — Hawai‘i,​Spiritual​Nation​of​Kū—Hui​Ea​Council​of​Sovereigns,​Living​Nation,​Settlers​for​Hawaiian​Independence,​Mana ​(Movement​for​Aloha​No​ Ka​‘Aina),​as​well​as​the​Hawai‘i​Institute​for​Human​Rights. ​ Akaka’s​response,​however,​echoed​repeatedly​by​Hawai‘i’s​state​and​federal​officials​over​the​past​decade,​speaks​only​to​the​rights​of​indigenous​ peoples​under​international​law​(Namuo​2004).​But​because​his​mention​ of​“alternatives​in​the​international​arena”​here​and​elsewhere​is​ill-​defined,​ he​has​led​many​to​infer​that​Kanaka​Maoli​could​pursue​full​independence​ in​a​postfederal​recognition​political​scenario,​if​they​so​desire.​What​proponents​of​the​Akaka​bill​refuse​to​acknowledge​is​that​this​strategy​differs​ from​the​prevalent​Hawaiian​independence​position​from​the​outset.​While​ many​proponents​of​U.S.​federal​recognition​presume​that​activists​in​the​ Kanaka​Maoli​independence​movement​merely​want​continued​access​to​the​ United​Nations​as​indigenous​peoples,​the​vast​majority​of​proindependence​ Kanaka​Maoli​support​two​entirely​different​legal​strategies​under​international​law,​decolonization​and​deoccupation,​neither​of​which​is​based​on​ indigeneity.​ Decolonization​ is​ specific​ to​ colonized​ peoples​ in​ non-​self-​ governing​territories,​while​deoccupation​pertains​to​occupied​states. ​ The​history​of​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i,​which​was​recognized​as​a​state​ by​ all​ major​ global​ powers​ throughout​ the​ nineteenth​ century,​ provides​ Kanaka​Maoli​and​others​with​a​rare​legal​claim​that​shows​the​current​state-​ driven​push​for​federal​recognition​to​be​problematic​for​outstanding​sovereignty​claims.2​This​essay​critically​analyzes​the​limits​of​both​Akaka’s​federal​proposal​for​internal​self-​determination​and​the​rights​of​indigenous​ peoples​under​international​law​to​argue​that​passage​of​the​Native​Hawaiian​Government​Reorganization​Act​would​indeed​threaten​the​independence​claims​of​the​Hawaiian​nation,​which​are​not​necessarily​protected​ by​the​Declaration​on​the​Rights​of​Indigenous​Peoples.​In​other​words,​I​ show​how​the​independence​claim​for​the​sovereignty​of​the​Hawaiian​kingdom​exceeds​the​current​rights​accorded​to​indigenous​peoples​at​the​United​ 28 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

Nations​because​the​monarchy​was​recognized​as​a​state​prior​to​the​U.S.-​ backed​overthrow​in​1893. ​ The​case​of​Hawai‘i​illuminates​the​limitations​of​international​law​as​a​ remedy​ for​ the​ politically​ fraught​ history​ of​ the​ kingdom​ and​ of​ Kanaka​ Maoli​as​an​indigenous​people.​First,​I​offer​some​historical​background​in​ order​to​delineate​the​diplomatic​relations​of​the​Hawaiian​kingdom​and​the​ United​States,​the​U.S.-​backed​overthrow​of​the​kingdom,​and​unilaterally​ imposed​U.S.​annexation​and​contested​statehood​for​Hawai‘i​as​the​fiftieth​ state​of​the​American​Union.​Next,​I​critically​examine​the​prospect​for​internal​self-​determination​under​U.S.​domestic​policy​as​proposed​in​the​Native​Hawaiian​Government​Reorganization​Act​of​2009,​also​known​as​the​ Akaka​bill,​in​order​to​assess​the​limits​of​that​model​of​governance​as​it​is​ detailed​in​the​legislation.​I​also​explore​the​ways​in​which​the​bill,​if​passed,​ could​work​to​preempt​and​preclude​the​Hawaiian​sovereignty​claim​under​ international​law. ​ The​ next​ section​ delineates​ the​ terrain​ of​ indigenous​ peoples’​ rights​ under​international​law​as​distinct​from​the​rights​of​states.​I​suggest​that​ although​indigenous​peoples’​rights​are​expanding,​they​still​pose​limits​for​ the​Hawaiian​sovereignty​claim—given​the​legal​genealogy​of​the​Hawaiian​ kingdom,​an​independent​state—as​it​currently​exists​because​of​the​way​that​ international​law​continues​to​privilege​the​rights​of​states​over​the​rights​of​ peoples.​Independence​proponents​who​advocate​restoration​of​the​kingdom​reject​both​indigenous​self-​determination​under​U.S.​policy​as​well​as​ indigenous​self-​determination​under​international​law​as​legal​strategies​for​ recuperating​Hawaiian​sovereignty.​Most​also​reject​decolonization​under​ the​United​Nations​Charter,​for​reasons​discussed​below,​and​instead​advocate​for​deoccupation.​However,​that​legal​strategy​also​has​shortcomings​ vis-​à-​vis​the​plight​of​Kanaka​Maoli,​which​I​address. ​ The​history​of​occupation​and​colonialism​has​generated​a​variety​of​options,​but​none​of​them​seem​sufficient​in​their​current​scope​since​each​has​ serious​limitations​and​demands​an​alternative​approach​to​begin​to​address​ this​complicated​historical​legacy​in​a​way​that​promotes​restorative​justice.

From Kingdom to U.S.-Occupied Colony Official​diplomatic​relations​between​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i​and​the​United​ States​transpired​over​five​decades.​The​treaties​negotiated​between​the​two​ were​made​after​the​U.S.​government​and​other​nations​had​already​recogHawaiian Nationhood 29

nized​the​kingdom​as​an​independent​state.​In​1842​King​Kamehameha​III​ dispatched​a​delegation​to​the​United​States​and​later​to​Europe​that​was​endowed​with​the​power​to​secure​the​recognition​of​Hawaiian​independence​ by​the​major​world​powers​of​the​time.​On​19​December​1842​the​delegation​ secured​the​assurance​of​President​John​Tyler​of​the​United​States​of​American​recognition​of​the​independence​of​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i,​and​subsequently​it​secured​formal​recognition​by​Great​Britain​and​France. ​ The​treaties​between​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i​and​the​United​States​were​ not​concerned​with​land​or​governance;​they​specified​only​relations​of​peace​ and​friendship,​commerce,​and​navigation.​The​first,​signed​at​Washington​ on​20​December​1849,​delineated​protocols​for​perpetual​peace​and​amity​ between​the​countries.​It​provided​for​reciprocal​commerce​and​navigation,​ including​the​regulation​of​duties​and​imports​at​favored​foreign​nation​rates​ and​permission​for​U.S.​whaling​ships​to​dock​at​selected​Hawaiian​ports.​ The​second​treaty​was​negotiated​in​1870​and​concerned​an​arrangement​ between​the​postal​services​of​the​kingdom​and​the​United​States.​The​third​ treaty,​known​as​the​Reciprocity​Treaty,​was​signed​in​1875.​This​agreement​ for​commercial​reciprocity​meant​no​export​duty​was​imposed​on​Hawai‘i​ or​the​United​States​and​allowed​for​tax-​free​goods​exchanged​between​the​ two​nations​to​enter​and​leave​Hawaiian​and​U.S.​ports.​In​1884​the​two​nations​negotiated​a​convention​to​renew​and​supplement​the​treaty​of​1875.​ This​allowed​the​United​States​privileged​access,​over​other​nations,​to​use​ Pearl​Harbor.​The​convention​specified​that​the​U.S.​government​had​exclusive​right​to​enter​the​harbor​and​to​establish​and​maintain​there​a​coaling​ and​repair​station​for​the​use​of​U.S.​vessels.​Contrary​to​popular​opinion,​ this​supplement​to​the​treaty​ceded​nothing​to​the​United​States​in​the​way​ of​territory.​Last,​in​1882​the​two​nations​negotiated​a​convention​between​ the​Post​Office​Department​of​the​United​States​and​the​Post​Office​Department​of​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i​concerning​the​exchange​of​money​orders. ​ Although​ neither​ lands​ nor​ sovereignty​ were​ ceded​ in​ any​ of​ these​ treaties​by​either​party,​the​number​of​elite​foreigners​residing​in​Hawai‘i​ eventually​ grew​ to​ the​ point​ where​ they​ threatened​ the​ autonomy​ of​ the​ kingdom.​White​Americans​had​migrated​to​the​Hawaiian​Islands​from​the​ time​of​the​first​Christian​mission​in​1820​sponsored​by​the​American​Board​ of​Commission​for​Foreign​Missions.​As​Lilikala​Kame‘eleihiwa​(1992)​has​ documented,​white​Americans​and​European​merchants​constituted​the​foreign​population​in​Hawai‘i​by​the​1840s,​when​the​missionaries’​descendants​ pressured​King​Kamehameha​III​to​privatize​communal​landholdings.​The​ 30 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

Mahele​land​division​of​1848​increased​the​wealth​of​these​foreigners,​who​ managed​to​secure​vast​extensions​of​land​(Kame‘eleihiwa​1992).​In​turn,​ white​settlers’​presence​and​power​increased​on​the​islands​throughout​the​ nineteenth​century​(Silva​2004;​Osorio​2002;​Kame‘eleihiwa​1992).​Anglo-​ American​legal​impositions​transformed​Hawaiian​society​throughout​that​ period​and​made​for​a​distinct​form​of​colonialism​accompanied​by​global​ movements​of​capitalism​and​Christianity​that​affected​the​everyday​lives​of​ Hawaiians​with​regard​to​work,​family,​marriage,​and​even​sexuality​(Merry​ 2000). ​ Eventually,​ the​ foreign​ elites​ formed​ their​ own​ militia,​ the​ Honolulu​ Rifles,​ associated​ with​ the​ U.S.​ military​ (Silva​ 2004,​ 122;​ Osorio​ 2002,​ 239–40).​In​1887​the​Honolulu​Rifles​seized​strategic​points​in​the​city,​and​ mounted​armed​patrols​forced​the​ruling​monarch,​King​Kalakaua,​to​sign​ what​became​known​as​the​Bayonet​Constitution,​a​document​that​stripped​ him​of​his​most​important​ executive​powers​and​diminished​ the​Kanaka​ Maoli​voice​in​government.​The​king​was​no​longer​able​to​appoint​members​ to​the​House​of​Nobles.​The​Bayonet​Constitution​created​an​oligarchy​of​the​ haole​planters​and​businessmen​by​primarily​empowering​white​Americans​ and​Europeans.​The​new​constitution​gave​U.S.​citizens​the​right​to​vote​in​ Hawaiian​elections,​while​a​large​sector​of​the​Kanaka​Maoli​electorate​was​ excluded​through​rigorous​property​qualifications​and​Asians​were​entirely​ disenfranchised​as​aliens​(Osorio​2002,​243–45,​251–54;​Kent​1993,​55).​Every​ decision​would​have​to​have​the​approval​of​the​cabinet,​now​made​up​of​ foreigners.​In​addition,​the​new​order​prevented​the​king​from​dismissing​ the​cabinet​himself​since​the​power​was​given​to​the​legislature,​which​could​ dismiss​any​cabinet​with​a​simple​majority​vote​(Silva​2004,​122–26;​Osorio​ 2002,​194–97). ​ Although​the​House​of​Nobles​never​properly​ratified​the​Bayonet​Constitution,​Queen​Lili‘uokalani’s​attempt​to​promulgate​a​new​constitution​to​ replace​ it​ (once​ she​ succeeded​ to​ the​ throne​ after​ her​ brother​ Kalakaua’s​ death)​prompted​the​unlawful​overthrow​of​the​kingdom.​In​1893​U.S.​Minister​of​Foreign​Affairs​John​L.​Stevens,​with​the​support​of​a​dozen​white​ settlers,​organized​to​overthrow​Queen​Lili‘uokalani.​The​queen​yielded​her​ authority​under​protest​because​she​was​confident​that​President​Benjamin​ Harrison​would​endeavor​to​undo​the​actions​led​by​one​of​his​ministers.​ However,​this​was​not​the​case,​and​those​who​overthrew​the​kingdom​established​the​provisional​government.​Eventually,​after​sending​an​investigator​on​the​matter,​the​next​president,​Grover​Cleveland,​declared​the​action​ Hawaiian Nationhood 31

under​ Stevens​ an​ act​ of​ war​ and​ acknowledged​ that​ the​ coup,​ backed​ by​ U.S.​Marines,​was​unlawful​(Cleveland​1893).​But​he​never​moved​to​restore​ formal​recognition​to​the​queen. ​ As​ this​ struggle​ for​ control​ was​ taking​ place,​ the​ provisional​ government​established​the​Republic​of​Hawai‘i​on​4​July​1894,​with​Sanford​Ballard​Dole​as​president​(Trask​1993;​Silva​2004).​Besides​asserting​jurisdiction​ over​the​entire​island​archipelago,​this​group​seized​roughly​1.8​million​acres​ of​land—Kingdom​Government​and​Crown​Lands—and​declared​them​free​ and​clear​of​any​trust​or​claim.​This​de​facto​government​ceded​these​same​ lands​to​the​United​States​when​it​illegally​annexed​Hawai‘i​in​1898.​This​is​ the​land​base​at​stake​in​the​political​struggle​today,​one​sorely​contested​ through​contemporary​legal​challenges. ​ The​United​States​did​not​annex​the​Hawaiian​Islands​by​treaty.​Rather,​it​ purportedly​annexed​the​archipelago​through​its​own​internal​domestic​law,​ the​Newlands​Resolution.​This​legislation​passed​in​1898​despite​massive​indigenous​opposition,​as​documented​by​Noenoe​Silva​(1998,​2004).​Kanaka​ Maoli​organized​into​two​key​nationalist​groups,​Hui​Aloha​‘Aina​and​Hui​ Kalai​‘Aina,​each​of​which​submitted​petitions​representing​the​vast​majority​ of​the​indigenous​people;​the​combined​signatures​amounted​to​over​thirty-​ eight​thousand.​Because​only​one​of​the​two​petitions​has​been​recovered,​it​ is​unclear​how​many​individuals​signed​both​petitions.​However,​only​forty​ thousand​Kanaka​Maoli​resided​in​Hawai‘i​at​the​time​(Silva​1998,​2004).​In​ the​two​petitions,​Kanaka​Maoli​clearly​stated​their​opposition​to​becoming​ part​of​the​United​States​“in​any​shape​or​form.” ​ In​1897​the​U.S.​Senate​accepted​these​petitions,​and​in​the​face​of​such​ resistance​found​it​impossible​to​secure​the​two-​thirds​majority​vote​needed​ for​a​treaty.​Regardless,​under​President​William​McKinley,​proannexationists​proposed​a​joint-​senate​resolution,​even​though​admitting​Hawai‘i​in​ this​way,​that​is,​as​a​new​territory​and​not​a​state,​violated​the​U.S.​Constitution.​A​joint-​senate​resolution​could​pass​with​only​a​simple​majority​in​ both​ houses​ of​ Congress.​ The​ Newlands​ Resolution​ passed​ in​ 1898​ when​ the​U.S.​government​“annexed”​Hawai‘i.​The​resolution​also​mandated​that​ the​republic​cede​absolute​title​to​the​public​lands​formerly​belonging​to​the​ Hawaiian​Kingdom​and​Crown.​The​U.S.​government​incorporated​Hawai‘i​ as​a​colonial​territory​through​the​Organic​Act​of​1900,​which​created​specific​laws​to​administer​the​allegedly​public​lands.​These​laws​again​stated​ that​the​lands​were​part​of​a​special​trust​under​the​federal​government’s​ oversight​(Resolution​No.​55,​2nd​Session,​55th​Congress,​July​7,​1898;​30​Sta.​ 32 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

at​L.​750;​2​Supp.​R.​S.​895).​These​lands​remain​the​centerpiece​in​the​struggle​ to​restore​Hawaiian​independence​because​even​though​they​amount​to​only​ slightly​ less​ than​ one-​third​ of​ the​ lands​ throughout​ the​ archipelago,​ they​ have​never​fallen​into​private​hands.

From Non-Self-Governing Territory to Fiftieth State of the United States of America In​ 1946​ the​ United​ Nations​ compiled​ a​ list​ of​ non-​self-​governing​ territories​ on​ which​ the​ U.S.​ government​ included​ Hawai‘i​ (Trask​ 1994).​ Although​ Hawai‘i​ was​ on​ the​ list​ and​ was​ therefore​ entitled​ to​a​ process​ of​ self-​determination​to​decolonize,​the​U.S.​government​predetermined​statehood​as​the​status​for​Hawai‘i​by​treating​its​political​status​as​an​internal​ domestic​issue.​The​ballot​used​in​1959​when​the​people​of​Hawai‘i​voted​to​ become​a​state​of​the​Union​included​only​two​options:​integration​and​remaining​a​U.S.​colonial​territory​(Trask​1994,​68–87).​Among​those​allowed​ to​take​part​in​the​vote,​settlers​as​well​as​military​personnel​outnumbered​ Hawaiians.​ Citing​ the​ internal​ territorial​ vote,​ the​ U.S.​ State​ Department​ then​misinformed​the​United​Nations,​which​in​turn​considered​the​people​ of​Hawai‘i​to​have​freely​exercised​their​self-​determination​and​chosen​to​incorporate​themselves​as​part​of​the​United​States​(Trask​1994).3 ​ By​un ​criteria​established​in​1960,​but​already​in​debate​the​previous​year​ and​thus​known​to​the​United​States​at​the​time​of​the​earlier​vote,​the​ballot​should​have​included​independence​and​free​association​as​choices.​On​ 14​December​1960,​the​United​Nations​General​Assembly​issued​a​Declaration​on​the​Granting​of​Independence​to​Colonial​Countries​and​Peoples— Resolution​1514​(XV).4​Also​in​1960,​the​assembly​approved​Resolution​1541​ (XV),​which​defined​free​association​with​an​independent​state,​integration​ into​an​independent​state,​or​independence​as​the​three​legitimate​options​ of​full​self-​government.5​United​Nations​General​Assembly​Resolution​1541​ refers​to​territories​that​are​“geographically​separate​and​distinct​ethnically​ and/or​culturally”​without​specifying​what​“geographically​separate”​must​ entail​(Barsh​1986,​373).​Nonetheless,​this​chapter​of​the​resolution​has​been​ accepted​as​applicable​mainly​to​overseas​colonization,​while​relegating​indigenous​peoples​to​a​condition​of​“internal​colonization”​(Barsh​1986,​373).​ At​stake​is​prohibiting​the​indigenous​claim​to​the​same​self-​determination​ granted​to​“blue​water”​colonies​by​Resolution​1514,​“which​can​logically​lead​ to​ independence”​ (Griswold​ 1996,​ 101n14).​ Hence​ the​ phrase​ “all​ peoples​ Hawaiian Nationhood 33

have​the​right​of​self-​determination”​has​been​mainly​applied​to​inhabitants​ of​territories​destined​for​decolonization​rather​than​to​indigenous​peoples​ (Griswold​1996,​93). ​ Since​1960​only​peoples​recognized​as​colonized​have​had​the​right​to​ freely​determine​their​political​status.​For​example,​in​the​case​of​East​Timor​ in​1999,​the​East​Timorese​finally​had​the​opportunity​to​vote​on​their​political​status​through​a​un -​sponsored​plebiscite,​and​they​voted​to​fully​decolonize​from​Indonesia.​Although​the​East​Timorese​are​an​indigenous​people,​ it​was​the​status​of​East​Timor​as​a​colony​of​Indonesia​since​1975​(and​before​that​of​Portugal​since​the​mid-​sixteenth​century)​that​qualified​them​for​ the​right​to​full​self-​determination,​not​their​status​as​an​indigenous​people​ per​se.​It​seems​reasonable​to​infer​that​the​right​of​the​East​Timorese​to​ full​self-​determination​is​due​to​the​blue​water​doctrine​under​international​ law,​which​defines​colonial​territories​plainly​as​those​far​from​the​colonial​ metropoles​asserting​rule​over​them. ​ At​the​same​time,​the​United​Nations​recognized​Hawai‘i​as​a​non-​self-​ governing​territory​from​1946​to​1959,​during​which​time​Kanaka​Maoli​and​ others​were​eligible​for​full​decolonization.​Some​argue,​therefore,​that​the​ most​straightforward​legal​argument​in​support​of​independence​is​the​decolonization​model.​The​Pro–Kanaka​Maoli​Independence​Working​Group,​ Ka​Pakaukau,​and​the​Komike​Tribunal​have​consistently​worked​to​educate​ the​Hawaiian​community​about​the​aborted​option​under​the​decolonization​ model​ and​ have​ advocated​ that​ contemporary​ Kanaka​ Maoli​ should​ be​entitled​to​a​plebiscite​to​exercise​their​right​to​self-​determination​and​ determine​ what​ model​ of​ governance​ they​ prefer.​ However,​ many​ sovereignty​ activists​ who​ advocate​ for​ kingdom​ restoration​ reject​ this​ strategy​ of​reinscription​on​the​list​of​non-​self-​governing​territories.​They​make​a​ distinction​ between​ a​ colonial​ territory​ (e.g.,​ Guam,​ a​ U.S.​ territory)​ and​ an​occupied​state​such​as​the​Hawaiian​kingdom.​As​an​alternative,​those​ organized​to​restore​the​Hawaiian​kingdom​government​advocate​for​deoccupation​rather​than​decolonization​and​rely​on​the​international​laws​of​ occupation​by​drawing​on​regulations​created​during​The​Hague​Convention​IV​of​1907,​specifically​Article​43​(Sai​2001).6​Accordingly,​those​who​ identify​as​subjects​of​the​kingdom​are​demanding​that​the​recovery​process​as​well​as​all​charges​against​the​United​States,​be​guided​by​The​Hague​ Regulations,​not​by​the​ un ​Charter​providing​for​self-​determination​ (Sai​ 2001).​In​other​words,​they​avoid​an​analysis​of​colonialism​because​they​ assume​that​to​talk​about​colonialism​in​Hawai‘i​is​to​legitimate​Hawai‘i​as​a​ 34 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

former​U.S.​colony​rather​than​an​occupied​state.​Because​the​kingdom​had​ already​secured​recognition​of​its​independence​in​1842,​deoccupation​supporters​declare​their​status​as​kingdom​nationals​of​a​nation​that​has​already​ achieved​self-​determination.​Since​the​U.S.​Congress​unilaterally​annexed​ Hawai‘i​ through​ its​ own​ domestic​ law,​ supporters​ of​ deoccupation​ argue​ that​the​kingdom​was​never​really​annexed​and​therefore​its​territory​continues​to​be​merely​occupied​by​the​United​States.​Unfortunately,​this​political​discourse​of​achievement​has​been​framed​in​a​way​that​is​demeaning​to​ indigenous​peoples​who​have​not​formed​states​and​reveals​a​reluctance​to​ emphasize​oppression​specific​to​Kanaka​Maoli​living​under​U.S.​domination.​Many​proponents​of​kingdom​restoration,​much​like​the​neoconservatives​opposed​to​the​Akaka​bill,​have​dismissed​indigenous​self-​government​ as​race-​based​government,​and​they​have​done​so​by​casting​the​kingdom​ as​a​“colorblind”​government​because​non–Kanaka​Maoli​were​included​as​ kingdom​subjects.7 ​ To​complicate​matters​further,​there​is​no​acknowledgment​that​American​colonialism​arguably​began​long​before​the​formal​takeover​of​Hawai‘i​ by​the​United​States,​let​alone​that​the​assimilationist​policies​imposed​on​ Kanaka​Maoli​throughout​the​twentieth​century​are​colonial​in​nature.​Any​ discussions​ of​ decolonization—including​ those​ in​ the​ cultural​ arena​ not​ dependent​on​ un ​protocols,​such​as​indigenous​language​revitalization​in​ response​to​years​of​indigenous​language​suppression,​to​cite​just​one​example—are​too​quickly​dismissed​in​legal​terms.​The​problem​then​takes​ the​form​of​a​battle​over​international​law​rather​than​focusing​on​the​white​ supremacist​practices​and​policies​that​are​part​and​parcel​of​the​colonial​ subordination​ of​ Kanaka​ Maoli,​ whether​ one​ considers​ Hawai‘i​ a​ former​ U.S.​colony​or​not.​The​myriad​of​oppressions​faced​by​the​vast​majority​of​ Kanaka​Maoli​include​high​infant​mortality​and​low​life​expectancy;​disproportionate​rates​of​diabetes,​hypertension,​heart​disease,​cancer,​depression,​ and​suicide;​intergenerational​trauma;​criminalization​and​high​rates​of​incarceration;​as​well​as​other​social​ills​linked​to​indigenous​land​dispossession​and​poverty​induced​by​colonial​status. ​ The​formation​of​Hawai‘i​as​the​fiftieth​state​of​the​Union​has​been​used​ to​silence​the​possibility​of​decolonization​from​the​United​States.​Here,​it​ seems​that​the​blue​water​doctrine​holds​no​effective​meaning,​even​though​ Hawai‘i​is​over​two​thousand​miles​from​California​and​nearly​five​thousand​ miles​from​Washington,​D.C.​Therein​lies​the​paradox.​While​Hawai‘i​was​a​ distant​U.S.​colony​during​the​first​half​of​the​twentieth​century,​it​was​an​ Hawaiian Nationhood 35

independent​state​before​the​U.S.​takeover,​which​complicates​conventional​ and​legal​notions​of​self-​determination​in​discussions​of​most​indigenous​ peoples.​And​yet,​it​is​clear​that​Kanaka​Maoli​are​also​an​indigenous​people.

Internal Self-Determination: The Akaka Bill Proposal One​of​the​main​rationales​offered​by​Akaka​for​his​legislative​proposal​for​ federally​organizing​a​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​is​the​U.S.​congressional​Apology​Resolution​of​1993​(Public​Law​103–150),​in​which​the​U.S.​ government​apologized​to​the​Hawaiian​people​for​the​U.S.​military’s​role​in​ the​overthrow.​This​joint-​senate​resolution,​signed​by​President​William​J.​ Clinton​ came​ about​ as​ a​ result​ of​ efforts​ by​ Akaka,​ who​ worked​ to​ have​ the​resolution​passed​during​the​one-​hundred-​year​anniversary​of​the​overthrow.​Although​the​apology​includes​a​disclaimer​at​the​end,​stating​that​ nothing​it​contains​can​be​used​to​settle​a​case​against​the​United​States,​it​ still​is​a​finding​of​fact.​The​apology​maintains​that​“the​indigenous​Hawaiian​ people​never​directly​relinquished​their​claims​to​their​inherent​sovereignty​ as​a​people​or​over​their​national​lands​to​the​United​States,​either​through​ their​monarchy​or​through​a​plebiscite​or​referendum”​(U.S.​Public​Law​103– 150,​ 103d​ Congress​ Joint​ Resolution​ 19).8​ The​ apology​ also​ calls​ for​ some​ form​of​reconciliation​and​self-​governance​for​Native​Hawaiians.​It​specifically​ states​ that​ Congress​ “expresses​ its​ commitment​ to​ acknowledge​ the​ ramifications​of​the​overthrow​of​the​Kingdom​of​Hawaii,​in​order​to​provide​a​proper​foundation​for​reconciliation​between​the​United​States​and​ the​Native​Hawaiian​people;​and​.​.​.​urges​the​President​of​the​United​States​ to​also​acknowledge​the​ramifications​of​the​overthrow​of​the​Kingdom​of​ Hawaii​and​to​support​reconciliation​efforts​between​the​United​States​and​ the​Native​Hawaiian​people”​(U.S.​Public​Law​103–150,​103d​Congress​Joint​ Resolution​19).​Akaka​has​framed​his​legislative​proposal,​the​Native​Hawaiian​Government​Reorganization​Act​of​2009,​as​the​step​toward​reconciliation​supported​in​the​Apology​Resolution.​But​it​was​also​prompted​by​the​ case​of​Rice v. Cayetano,​in​which​the​U.S.​Supreme​Court​ruled​Hawaiian-​ only​voting​conducted​by​the​state​Office​of​Hawaiian​Affairs​for​trustee​elections​unconstitutional.9​Shortly​after​the​ruling,​Akaka​set​up​a​Task​Force​on​ Native​Hawaiian​Issues​and​then​proposed​legislation​to​federally​recognize​ a​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​as​a​domestic​dependent​nation​with​ the​aim​of​creating​an​internal​government​that​would​be​immune​to​legal​ challenges​to​the​14th​and​15th​constitutional​amendments.​As​a​result,​many​ 36 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

Native​Hawaiians​staffing​state​agencies​such​as​the​Office​of​Hawaiian​Affairs​and​the​Department​of​Hawaiian​Home​Lands,​which​are​dependent​on​ state​and​federal​funding​for​specifically​indigenous​projects​like​Papa​Ola​ Lokahi​(Native​Hawaiian​Healthcare)​and​Nā​Pua​No’eau​(Center​for​Gifted​ and​Talented​Native​Hawaiian​Children),​and​the​vast​majority​of​Hawaiian​ civic​clubs​support​the​legislation. ​ The​Akaka​bill​sets​up​the​process​for​the​formation​of​a​governing​entity​ to​be​approved​by​the​U.S.​government.​The​entity​would​be​formed​by​a​ commission​ of​ nine​ members​ appointed​ by​ the​ secretary​ of​ the​ interior,​ whose​duty​first​and​foremost​would​be​to​report​to​the​secretary.10​The​legislation​allows​for​the​recognition​only​of​a​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​ and​not​of​the​rights​of​that​entity,​which​would​be​subject​to​later​negotiation​between​the​U.S.​federal​government,​the​Native​Hawaiian​entity,​and​ the​Hawai‘i​state​government. ​ The​bill​was​first​introduced​in​2000​in​the​106th​Congress,​where​it​did​ not​survive​committee,​and​during​each​subsequent​Congress​it​has​been​ defeated​by​Republican​opposition​(Kauanui​2005b).​Conservatives’​refusal​ to​support​the​measure​became​more​pronounced​when​the​administration​ of​George​W.​Bush​took​a​position​against​the​legislation,​opposition​which​ lasted​throughout​that​administration.​Although​throughout​that​period​the​ legislation​gained​committee​approval​in​both​the​House​and​the​Senate,​it​ remained​stalled​when​it​came​to​a​floor​debate.​Despite​multiple​revisions​ and​reintroductions​of​new​drafts​aimed​at​satisfying​the​concerns​of​the​ Department​ of​ the​ Interior​ and​ appeasing​ Republican​ critics,​ who​ called​ the​proposal​a​plan​for​“race-​based​government,”​the​legislation​never​progressed​to​a​vote.11 ​ Under​the​new​leadership​of​President​Barack​Obama​there​is​widespread​ support​for​the​bill.​Since​the​start​of​the​111th​Congress​on​3​January​2009​ three​sets​of​proposals​have​been​made,​all​titled​the​Native​Hawaiian​Government​Reorganization​Act​of​2009:​S.​381​and​H.R.​862,​introduced​on​ 4​February​2009;​S.​708​and​H.R.​1711,​introduced​on​25​March​2009;​and​ S.​1011​and​H.R.​2314,​introduced​on​7​May​2009.​S.​1011​was​given​a​hearing​ before​the​U.S.​Senate​Committee​on​Indian​Affairs​on​6​August​2009​and​ H.R.​2314​was​given​a​hearing​before​the​U.S.​House​Committee​on​Natural​ Resources.​At​the​time​of​this​writing​both​await​a​floor​debate​and​vote.12 ​ Those​who​support​independence​oppose​federal​recognition​because​at​ the​very​most​it​would​allow​for​no​more​than​a​domestic​dependent​entity​ under​the​full​and​exclusive​plenary​power​of​Congress.​Most​immediately,​ Hawaiian Nationhood 37

federal​recognition​would​set​up​a​process​for​extinguishing​most​claims​to​ land​title—except​for​whatever​the​state​of​Hawai‘i​and​the​federal​government​may​be​willing​to​relinquish​in​exchange​for​that​recognition—and​ even​then​the​U.S.​federal​government​would​hold​it​in​trust.​What​is​at​stake​ here​is​the​1.8​million​acres​of​former​Kingdom​Crown​and​Government​ Lands​and​the​obliteration​of​the​Hawaiian​nation’s​title​to​them.​As​the​U.S.​ Supreme​Court​case​of​2009​regarding​these​lands​shows,​there​is​absolutely​ no​guarantee​that​any​future​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​would​hold​ any​of​these​lands.13 ​ Counter​to​Akaka’s​assurances,​there​is​also​the​likelihood​that​passage​ of​the​bill​could​foreclose​the​sovereignty​claim​for​Hawaiian​independence​ under​international​law.​The​legislation​appears​to​be​a​preemptive​attempt​ to​ squash​ outstanding​ sovereignty​ claims​ unsuccessfully​ extinguished​ by​ Hawai‘i’s​being​admitted​as​the​fiftieth​state​of​the​American​Union.​If​the​ bill​passes,​the​will​of​the​people​will​seem​to​have​been​expressed—as​a​ form​of​self-​determination​in​support​of​federal​recognition—in​a​way​that​ would​ make​ international​ intervention​ much​ more​ far-​fetched,​ given​ the​ likelihood​that​the​world​community​would​see​the​Hawaiian​question​as​ even​more​of​a​U.S.​domestic​issue​than​it​does​today.​In​any​case,​it​would​ certainly​entrench​the​Hawaiian​sovereignty​claim​further​within​the​U.S.​ government​since​the​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity,​as​proposed​in​the​ Akaka​bill,​would​be​subordinate​to​both​the​Hawai‘i​state​government​and​ the​U.S.​federal​government. ​ Alternatively,​supporters​of​federal​recognition​insist​that​nothing​in​the​ Akaka​bill​would​compromise​Hawai‘i’s​national​claims​under​international​ law.​But​they​do​not​attend​to​the​ways​in​which​the​United​States​asserts​its​ plenary​power​to​keep​indigenous​sovereigns​both​domestic​and​dependent.​ In​this​context​it​is​important​that​a​provision​included​in​S.​708​was​swiftly​ removed​from​the​later​version,​S.​1011.​Section​11​of​S.​708.​was​titled​“Disclaimer”​and​stated,​“Nothing​in​this​Act​is​intended​to​serve​as​a​settlement​ of​any​claims​against​the​United​States,​or​to​affect​the​rights​of​the​Native​ Hawaiian​people​under​international​law.”​Despite​this​change,​neoconservative​ opponents​ to​ the​ bill​ have​ sought​ to​ spread​ misinformation​ about​ the​legislation.​This​had​led​Akaka​to​provide​further​assurances​in​direct​ contradiction​to​those​he​once​provided​to​supporters​of​Hawaiian​independence.​In​a​hearing​before​the​U.S.​Senate​Committee​on​Indian​Affairs,​ he​repeatedly​asserted​that​the​bill​does​not​allow​Hawai‘i​to​secede​from​the​ United​States​(Akaka​2009). 38 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

​ This​legislation​limits​Hawaiian​self-​determination​because​of​its​fundamental​legal​distinction​between​Indian​tribes​and​foreign​nations​under​the​ U.S.​Constitution​and​federal​law​with​specific​regard​to​the​unextinguished​ sovereignty​of​the​Hawaiian​kingdom.​The​name​alone​represents​what​is​ problematic​for​Hawaiian​sovereignty​and​nationhood​under​international​ law.​Embedded​in​its​title,​the​“Native​Hawaiian​Government​Reorganization​Act​of​2009,”​is​a​fundamental​historical​lie:​there​can​be​no​attempt​to​ reorganize​a​Native​Hawaiian​government​because​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i​ was​an​internationally​recognized​state​that​in​the​nineteenth​century​afforded​citizenship​status​to​more​than​just​indigenous​Hawaiian​people.​This​ name​misconstrues​the​nature​of​the​government-​to-​government​relationship​the​United​States​had​with​the​kingdom.​The​bill​should​be​named​more​ accurately​as​the​“Native​Hawaiian​Government​Organization​Act.” ​ The​bill​asserts​that​“the​Constitution​vests​Congress​with​the​authority​ to​ address​ the​ conditions​ of​ the​ indigenous,​ native​ people​ of​ the​ United​ States,”​drawing​on​Article​I,​Section​8,​Clause​3​of​the​U.S.​Constitution,​ which​reads​as​follows:​“The​Congress​shall​have​power​.​.​.​to​regulate​commerce​ with​ foreign​ nations,​ and​ among​ the​ several​ states,​ and​ with​ the​ Indian​tribes.”​The​U.S.​Supreme​Court​has​ruled​time​and​time​again​that​ this​clause,​known​as​the​Commerce​Clause,​means​the​U.S.​federal​government​has​total​and​complete​power​over​tribal​nations​(Wilkins​1997).​Section​(3)​of​the​bill​also​states​that​“the​United​States​has​a​special​political​and​ legal​relationship​to​promote​the​welfare​of​the​native​people​of​the​United​ States,​including​Native​Hawaiians.”​In​other​words,​the​U.S.​government​ calls​it​“special”​because​it​regards​tribal​nations​as​internal​nations​that​are​ both​domestic​and​dependent​because​they​are​forced​to​exist​within​the​ broader​legal​boundary​asserted​by​the​U.S.​government.​Yet​the​U.S.​government​never​legally​regarded​the​Hawaiian​kingdom​as​domestic​or​dependent.​Under​the​U.S.​Constitution,​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i​was​regarded​as​ a​foreign​nation,​an​independent​sovereign​state. ​ The​U.S.​Congress​has​repeatedly​delegated​its​authority​to​the​executive​ branch​of​the​U.S.​government.​With​regard​to​Indian​tribes,​it​delegates​its​ authority​specifically​to​the​U.S.​Department​of​the​Interior.​This​matters​for​ the​purposes​of​the​bill​since​the​legislation​proposes​to​create​and​empower​ the​U.S.​Office​for​Native​Hawaiian​Relations,​within​the​U.S.​Department​ of​the​Interior,​to​coordinate​the​“special​political​and​legal​relationship​between​the​United​States​and​that​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity.”​Foreign​ nations​do​not​have​any​relationship​to​the​U.S.​Department​of​the​Interior​ Hawaiian Nationhood 39

precisely​because​that​department​is​concerned​with​areas​considered​by​the​ U.S.​government​to​be​internal​to​the​United​States,​areas​such​as​Indians​ tribes,​U.S.​Island​Territories,​and​National​Parks.​Foreign​nations​relate​to​ the​U.S.​Department​of​State. ​ Section​4,​which​details​the​purpose​of​the​bill,​claims​that​it​will​“provide​a​process​for​the​reorganization​of​the​single​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​and​the​reaffirmation​of​the​special​political​and​legal​relationship​between​the​United​States​and​that​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​ for​purposes​of​continuing​a​government-​to-​government​relationship.”​At​ the​same​time,​it​makes​it​clear​how​the​legislation​limits​the​scope​of​self-​ determination:​“Native​Hawaiians​have—(A)​an​inherent​right​to​autonomy​ in​their​internal​affairs;​(B)​an​inherent​right​of​self-​determination​and​self-​ governance;​(C)​the​right​to​reorganize​a​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity;​ and​(D)​the​right​to​become​economically​self-​sufficient”​(Section​4,​part​5). ​ Sections​5​and​6​of​the​bill​give​the​U.S.​Department​of​Defense​free​rein.​ Whereas​Section​5​requires​the​proposed​U.S.​Office​of​Native​Hawaiian​Relations​to​consult​with​the​Native​Hawaiian​Governing​Entity​“before​taking​ any​actions​that​may​have​the​potential​to​significantly​affect​Native​Hawaiian​resources,​rights,​or​lands,”​it​makes​an​exception​for​anything​having​ to​do​with​the​needs,​wants,​and​desires​of​the​U.S.​Department​of​Defense:​ “This​section​shall​have​no​applicability​to​the​Department​of​Defense​or​ to​ any​ agency​ or​ component​ of​ the​ Department​ of​ Defense.”​ This​ means​ that​U.S.​militarism​in​and​from​Hawaiian​waters​and​lands​can​continue​ without​end​and​that​neither​the​Office​nor​the​Native​Hawaiian​Governing​ Entity​could​do​anything​to​stop​it​according​to​U.S.​law.​Similarly,​Section​6,​ after​outlining​the​composition​and​duties​of​the​Interagency​Coordinating​ Group​set​up​to​coordinate​federal​programs​that​address​the​conditions​of​ Native​Hawaiians​and​are​administered​by​federal​agencies​other​than​the​ Department​of​the​Interior,​reiterates​that​“this​section​shall​have​no​applicability​to​the​Department​of​Defense​or​to​any​agency​or​component​of​the​ Department​of​Defense.” ​ Section​8​reaffirms​the​delegation​of​U.S.​government​authority​to​the​ State​of​Hawai‘i​in​order​to​address​the​condition​of​Native​Hawaiians​under​ the​Hawai‘i​state​admissions​act.​With​regard​to​negotiations,​this​section​ specifies​that​after​the​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​is​created,​both​the​ United​States​and​the​State​of​Hawai‘i​may​enter​into​negotiations​with​the​ Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity.​This​sets​the​bill​apart​from​other​forms​ of​federal​recognition​of​Native​nations,​which​do​not​typically​give​state​ 40 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

governments​any​part​in​the​negotiations,​with​the​exception​of​matters​related​to​Indian​gaming.​This​bill​allows​the​State​of​Hawai‘i​to​sit​at​the​table​ to​negotiate​matters​including​the​transfer​of​lands,​natural​resources,​and​ other​assets​and​the​protection​of​existing​rights​related​to​such​lands​or​resources;​the​exercise​of​governmental​authority​over​any​transferred​lands,​ natural​resources,​and​other​assets,​including​land​use;​the​exercise​of​civil​ and​criminal​jurisdiction;​the​delegation​of​governmental​powers​and​authorities​to​the​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​by​the​United​States​and​ the​State​of​Hawai‘i;​any​residual​responsibilities​of​the​United​States​and​the​ State​of​Hawai‘i;​and​grievances​regarding​assertions​of​historical​wrongs​ committed​against​Native​Hawaiians​by​the​United​States​or​by​the​State​of​ Hawai‘i.​None​of​these​things​are​guaranteed​in​the​bill—not​land,​not​jurisdiction,​not​assets,​not​governmental​power.​They​are​all​open​to​negotiation​ once​representatives​of​a​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​sit​down​with​ federal​and​state​agents.​There​is​no​equal​footing​here;​all​negotiations​must​ take​place​within​the​framework​of​U.S.​federal​law​and​policy​with​regard​ to​Indian​tribes​and​under​U.S.​plenary​power,​where​the​U.S.​government​ asserts​total​and​complete​power,​and​in​this​case​the​State​of​Hawai‘i​will​ have​an​equal​role.14 ​ Notably,​Section​(e)​of​the​bill​states,​“Nothing​in​this​Act​alters​the​civil​ or​criminal​jurisdiction​of​the​United​States​or​the​State​of​Hawai‘i​over​lands​ and​persons​within​the​State​of​Hawai‘i.”​It​further​states,​“The​status​quo​of​ Federal​and​State​jurisdiction​can​change​only​as​a​result​of​further​legislation,​if​any,​enacted​after​the​conclusion,​in​relevant​part,​of​the​negotiation​ process​established​in​section​8(b).”​In​other​words,​when​the​representatives​of​the​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​sit​at​the​table​to​negotiate​with​ federal​and​state​agents,​they​cannot​negotiate​for​civil​or​criminal​jurisdiction​over​any​land.​In​order​for​them​to​do​so,​more​legislation​would​need​ to​be​passed. ​ This​section​of​the​bill​also​includes​a​disclaimer:​nothing​in​the​act​can​ create​a​cause​of​action​against​the​United​States​or​any​other​entity​or​person,​or​alter​“existing​law,​including​existing​case​law,​regarding​obligations​ on​the​part​of​the​United​States​or​the​State​of​Hawai‘i​with​regard​to​Native​ Hawaiians​or​any​Native​Hawaiian​entity.”​It​further​states​that​nothing​in​ the​bill​can​create​any​new​obligation​to​Native​Hawaiians​under​federal​law,​ and​it​specifically​outlines​and​protects​the​federal​government​through​sovereign​immunity​against​lawsuits​for​breach​of​trust,​land​claims,​resource-​ protection​ or​ resource-​management​ claims,​ or​ similar​ types​ of​ claims​ Hawaiian Nationhood 41

brought​by​or​on​behalf​of​Native​Hawaiians​or​the​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity.​And​it​asserts​that​the​State​of​Hawai‘i​“retains​its​sovereign​ immunity,​unless​waived​in​accord​with​State​law,​to​any​claim,​established​ under​any​source​of​law,​regarding​Native​Hawaiians,​that​existed​prior​to​ the​enactment​of​this​Act.” ​ This​last​section,​among​others,​especially​raised​concerns​within​the​Native​Hawaiian​Bar​Association​(nhba).​On​11​June​2009,​the​nhba ​submitted​testimony​to​the​House​Committee​on​Natural​Resources​regarding​the​ House​version​of​the​Akaka​bill​(H.R.​2314).​Although​the​nhba ​expressed​ its​support​for​the​bill,​its​testimony​outlined​some​major​concerns.​The​first​ is​the​role​of​the​U.S.​Department​of​Defense​as​it​relates​to​the​Office​of​Native​Hawaiian​Relations​and​the​Native​Hawaiian​Interagency.​The​second​is​ the​role​of​the​U.S.​Department​of​Justice​(DoJ)​because,​unlike​earlier​versions​of​the​bill,​the​current​legislation​does​not​include​a​provision​authorizing​the​designation​of​a​ DoJ ​representative​to​assist​in​the​implementation​ and​ protection​ of​ the​ rights​ of​ Native​ Hawaiians​ and​ their​ political,​ legal,​and​trust​relationship​with​the​United​States.​The​third​concern​was​the​ section​of​the​bill​relating​to​“claims​and​sovereignty​immunity.”​The​nhba​ notes, We​ believe​ it​ is​ unnecessary​ and​ premature​ to​ include​ provisions​ on​ claims​and​sovereign​immunity​prior​to​federal​recognition​of​a​Native​ Hawaiian​Government​and​recommend​that​these​provisions​under​section​8(c)​be​taken​out​of​the​bill.​Such​provisions​could​be​contemplated​ during​implementation​legislation​after​federal​recognition​is​conferred​ and​negotiations​between​the​Native​Hawaiian​Governing​Entity​and​the​ State​of​Hawai‘i​and​Federal​Government​are​completed.​The​bill’s​provisions​on​claims​and​federal​sovereign​immunity​appear​to​be​overly​broad​ and​may​prohibit​lawsuits​by​individual​Native​Hawaiians​for​claims​that​ could​be​pursued​by​any​other​member​of​the​general​population. In​response,​Rep.​Neil​Abercrombie​of​Hawai‘i​suggested​the​legislation​be​ revisited​to​assess​whether​another​revision​was​needed.15 ​ Although​the​U.S.​Senate​Committee​on​Indian​Affairs​proceeded​to​hold​ a​hearing​for​the​companion​bill​to​H.R.​2314,​S.​1011,​the​intervention​by​the​ nhba ​may​serve​to​slow​down​the​process​to​allow​more​critical​analysis​of​ the​proposal​overall,​at​least​among​those​in​the​Kanaka​Maoli​communities​ both​within​the​islands​and​throughout​the​U.S.​continent.​However,​should​ the​Akaka​bill​pass,​Kanaka​Maoli​would​be​shut​out​of​the​decolonization​ 42 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

model,​ which​ would​ technically​ leave​ open​ the​ venue​ for​ redress​ offered​ by​ the​ United​ Nations​ Declaration​ on​ the​ Rights​ of​ Indigenous​ Peoples.​ But,​as​we​shall​see​below,​for​a​variety​of​reasons​this​is​an​unsatisfactory​ ​alternative.

Self-Determination and the Rights of Indigenous Peoples On​13​September​2007,​the​United​Nations​General​Assembly​adopted​the​ Declaration​on​the​Rights​of​Indigenous​Peoples.​The​result​of​nearly​three​ decades​of​activism,​it​is​the​most​comprehensive​international​human​rights​ document​addressing​the​rights​of​indigenous​peoples​all​over​the​world.​Indigenous​peoples​worldwide​have​worked​for​decades​to​ensure​that​their​ preexisting​human​rights​are​recognized​and​upheld​by​global​nation-​states,​ especially​since​the​domestic​laws​in​most​settler​states​have​not​protected​ their​ability​to​assert​their​self-​determination.​Key​issues​of​struggle​include​ the​ right​ of​ ownership​ and​ control​ of​ territory​ and​ resources,​ protection​ of​sacred​sites​and​lands,​self-​governance,​and​decision-​making​authority​ vis-​à-​vis​ the​ dominant​ population.​ Central​ to​ all​ of​ these​ is​ the​ question​ of​indigenous​peoples’​right​to​self-​determination​under​international​law.​ Because​the​basic​criteria​defining​colonies​under​international​law​include​ foreign​domination​and​geographical​separation​from​the​colonizer,​indigenous​peoples​up​until​now​have​been​at​a​disadvantage​in​terms​of​the​application​of​decolonization​protocols,​an​issue​heatedly​debated​throughout​ the​world​community​because​indigenous​peoples​are​often​considered​to​be​ subject​to​internal​colonization. ​ This​ limitation​ reflects​ the​ long-​term​ battle​ over​ whether​ indigenous​ peoples​should​be​considered​peoples​in​the​context​of​Chapter​XI​of​the​ United​Nations​Charter​of​1945,​which​includes​the​Declaration​Regarding​ Non-​Self-​Governing​Peoples​in​Article​73​and​within​United​Nations​General​Assembly​Resolution​1514,​which​reads,​“All​peoples​have​the​right​to​ self-​determination;​by​virtue​of​that​right,​they​freely​determine​their​political​ status​ and​ freely​ pursue​ their​ economic,​ social,​ and​ cultural​ development.”16​ Regarding​ the​ question​ of​ self-​determination​ for​ indigenous​ peoples,​the​still-​cited​report​by​José​Martinez​Cobo,​commissioned​by​the​ United​Nations,​states,​“Self-​determination​constitutes​the​exercise​of​free​ choice​by​indigenous​peoples,​who​must,​to​a​large​extent,​create​the​specific​content​of​this​principle,​in​both​its​internal​and​external​expressions,​ which​do​not​necessarily​include​the​right​to​secede​from​the​State​in​which​ Hawaiian Nationhood 43

they​may​live​and​to​set​themselves​up​as​sovereign​entities.​This right may in fact be expressed in various forms of autonomy within the State”​(emphasis​ added). ​ There​is​no​consensus​on​whether​indigenous​peoples​have​the​right​to​ full​ self-​determination—an​ option​ that​ would​ allow​ for​ the​ development​ of​ nation-​states​ that​ are​ independent​ of​ their​ former​ colonizers,​ like​ the​ postcolonial​Third​World—or​whether​that​right​is​limited​to​internal​self-​ determination​within​the​existing​nation-​states​in​which​they​are​included.​ The​use​of​the​term​peoples,​which​signifies​legal​rights​under​international​ law​over​and​above​the​term​people,​has​been​the​most​contentious​part​of​ this​debate.​This​form​of​discrimination​can​be​traced​to​the​Law​of​Nations,​ which​institutionalized​the​international​legal​discrimination​against​indigenous​peoples​(Newcomb​2008). ​ The​establishment​in​1982​of​the​Working​Group​on​Indigenous​Populations​(Wgip),​under​the​United​Nations​Economic​and​Social​Council,​led​ the​effort​to​draft​a​specific​instrument​under​international​law​that​would​ protect​ indigenous​ peoples​ worldwide.​ The​ Wgip ​ was​ informed​ by​ early​ organizations,​such​as​the​International​Indian​Treaty​Council,​formed​in​ 1977,​which​was​the​first​organization​of​indigenous​peoples​to​be​reorganized​as​a​Non-​Governmental​Organization​(ngo)​with​Consultative​Status​ to​the​United​Nations​Economic​and​Social​Council.​Another​example​is​the​ American​Indian​Law​Alliance,​founded​in​1989,​which​also​has​special​consultative​status​with​the​Economic​and​Social​Council​of​the​United​Nations. ​ Initially,​the​ Wgip ​submitted​a​first​draft​of​a​declaration​on​the​rights​ of​indigenous​peoples​to​the​Sub-​Commission​ on​the​Prevention​of​Discrimination​and​Protection​of​Minorities,​which​was​eventually​approved​ in​1994.17​The​draft​was​sent​to​the​United​Nations​Commission​on​Human​ Rights​ for​ further​ discussion.​ The​ declaration​ was​ stalled​ for​ many​ years​ because​ of​concerns​ by​ states​ with​ regard​ to​ some​ of​its​ core​ statements,​ namely,​the​right​to​self-​determination​of​indigenous​peoples​and​the​control​over​natural​resources​existing​on​indigenous​peoples’​traditional​lands.​ By​1995​an​open-​ended​intersessional​working​group​was​formed​with​the​ understanding​that​some​version​of​the​declaration​would​be​adopted​by​ the​General​Assembly​within​the​International​Decade​of​the​World’s​Indigenous​Peoples​(1995–2004).​The​United​Nations​Commission​on​Human​ Rights​ extended​ the​ mandate​ of​ the​ Wgip ​ into​ the​ Second​ International​ Decade​of​the​World’s​Indigenous​Peoples​(2005–2015)​and​also​urged​it​to​

44 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

present​for​un ​adoption​a​final​draft​declaration​on​the​rights​of​indigenous​ people. ​ The​Human​Rights​Council​of​the​United​Nations​was​the​first​to​adopt​ the​ Declaration​ on​ the​ Rights​ of​ Indigenous​ Peoples,​ in​ June​ 2006,​ and​ offered​a​recommendation​that​it​be​adopted​by​the​General​Assembly.18​In​ the​vote​of​the​General​Assembly,​the​declaration​was​passed​with​a​vote​of​ 143​in​favor,​4​against,​and​11​abstentions.​Notably,​the​4​votes​against​the​ adoption​came​from​white​settler​states,​all​with​a​strong​indigenous​presence​in​terms​of​political​resistance​to​First​World​domination:​Australia,​ Canada,​New​Zealand,​and​the​United​States.​Many​attribute​the​opposition​ of​these​states​to​governmental​fears​that​indigenous​peoples​would​secede​ and​seek​independence,​acts​which​potentially​threaten​to​disrupt​the​contiguous​land​mass​of​the​settler​nation-​states​that​encompass​them. ​ Regarding​the​issue​of​self-​determination,​however,​the​newly​adopted​ Declaration​ on​ the​ Rights​ of​ Indigenous​ Peoples​ is​ ambiguous.​ On​ the​ one​ hand,​ Article​ 3​ states,​ “Indigenous​ peoples​ have​ the​ right​ of​ self-​ determination.​By​virtue​of​that​right​they​freely​determine​their​political​ status​and​freely​pursue​their​economic,​social,​and​cultural​development.”​ But​on​the​other​hand,​the​last​article,​Article​46,​states,​“Nothing​in​this​ Declaration​may​be​.​.​.​construed​as​authorizing​or​encouraging​any​action​ which​would​dismember​or​impair,​totally​or​in​part,​the​territorial​integrity​or​political​unity​of​sovereign​and​independent​States.”​For​example,​the​ U.S.​government​would​surely​be​threatened​if​the​Navajo​Nation​were​to​ seek​independence,​given​that​the​asserted​boundaries​of​the​states​of​New​ Mexico,​Colorado,​Utah,​and​Arizona​fall​within​the​Diné’s​traditional​territory.​Given​these​two​seemingly​contradictory​articles,​how​are​we​to​understand​what​the​right​to​self-​determination​means​and​to​what​extent​that​ right​can​be​realized​by​indigenous​peoples? ​ Article​26​states​the​following​with​regard​to​traditional​lands: ​ 1.​ Indigenous​ peoples​ have​ the​ right​ to​ the​ lands,​ territories​ and​ resources​which​they​have​traditionally​owned,​occupied​or​otherwise​ used​or​acquired. ​ 2.​ Indigenous​peoples​have​the​right​to​own,​use,​develop​and​control​ the​lands,​territories​and​resources​that​they​possess​by​reason​of​traditional​ownership​or​other​traditional​occupation​or​use,​as​well​as​ those​which​they​have​otherwise​acquired. ​ 3.​ States​shall​give​legal​recognition​and​protection​to​these​lands,​terHawaiian Nationhood 45

ritories​and​resources.​Such​recognition​shall​be​conducted​with​due​ respect​to​the​customs,​traditions​and​land​tenure​systems​of​the​indigenous​peoples​concerned. Parts​1​and​2​here​are​explicit​in​terms​of​the​right​to​land.​They​could​certainly​ be​ cited​ in​ support​ of​ the​ Hawaiian​ sovereignty​ proponents​ in​ the​ reclamation​of​the​Hawaiian​Kingdom​Crown​and​Government​Lands​controlled​by​the​state​government​of​Hawai‘i​under​the​United​States,​as​well​ as​other​lands​in​the​archipelago​heretofore​unalienated​under​the​kingdom​ during​the​Mahele​land​division​of​1848,​which​privatized​traditional​communal​lands.​The​question​remains​how​the​claim​to​traditional​lands​by​indigenous​peoples​can​be​asserted​in​light​of​the​article​meant​to​protect​the​ territorial​integrity​of​states. ​ Since​Kanaka​Maoli​(among​the​vast​majority​of​kingdom​heirs)​live​in​ a​ historically​ occupied​ state,​ the​ question​ of​ territorial​ integrity​ could​ be​ evoked​by​those​supporting​an​independent​Hawaiian​state,​not​simply​the​ settler​ state​ of​ the​ United​ States.19​ The​ principle​ of​ territorial​ integrity​ is​ usually​operative​vis-​à-​vis​other​states:​that​is,​one​state​is​prohibited​from​ invading​and​accessing​another​state’s​territory,​although​this​happens​nonetheless.​Article​46​can​be​used​as​political​leverage​to​advocate​for​the​territorial​integrity​of​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i​as​a​state.​The​U.S.​government​ violated​the​Hawaiian​state’s​territorial​integrity​when​it​supported​an​illegal​ overthrow​and​unilaterally​annexed​Hawai‘i​in​contravention​to​U.S.​federal​ law,​its​treaties​with​the​kingdom,​and​international​law​operative​at​the​time.​ Hence,​ deoccupation​ supporters​ demand​ that​ the​ U.S.​ government​ withdraw​from​Hawai‘i.​Still,​the​U.S.​government​casts​independence​claims​as​ attempts​at​secession,​a​complete​misnomer. ​ Prior​to​the​passage​of​the​declaration​many​governmental​officials​assumed​that​the​right​of​indigenous​groups​to​self-​determination​would​lead​ to​secession,​and​this​assumption​was​used​to​deny​indigenous​peoples​this​ right​(Lâm​1992).​Even​members​of​the​Wgip ​and​the​un ​special​rapporteurs​ have​shared​this​assumption​of​states​(Lâm​1992).​Maivân​Clech​Lâm​suggests​that​it​is​possible​for​indigenous​peoples​to​exercise​self-​determination​ without​threatening​the​territorial​integrity​and​sovereignty​of​the​surrounding​state,​especially​since​most​have​visions​of​becoming​autonomous​without​becoming​nation-​states.​In​fact,​most​seek​mutually​negotiated​free​association​(Lâm​1992;​Griswold​1996,​98).​Situations​differ​depending​on​the​ state​in​question​and​its​location.​For​example,​most​indigenous​movements​ 46 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

throughout​North​and​South​America​continue​to​fight​for​an​expansion​of​ cultural,​political,​and​territorial​autonomy​within​the​respective​settler​states​ that​encompass​them.​Within​these​debates​is​the​continuous​contestation​ over​the​concepts​of​sovereignty,​self-​determination,​self-​government,​and​ autonomy,​which​differ​in​meaning​and​intention​within​different​​contexts. ​ In​the​context​of​the​United​States,​even​if​indigenous​peoples​have​no​ vision​of​becoming​nation-​states,​the​most​basic​components​of​fuller​autonomy​would​likely​disrupt​the​territorial​integrity​of​the​surrounding​state.​ For​example,​if​the​U.S.​government​were​to​honor​and​abide​by​all​of​the​ treaties​it​signed​with​indigenous​nations;​return​most​of​the​National​Parks​ to​the​indigenous​peoples​from​whom​they​were​taken;​federally​recognize​ all​tribal​nations​and​entities​who​seek​this​U.S.​domestic​model​of​acknowledgment​ (which​ includes​ over​ two​ hundred​ tribal​ entities​ that​ have​ submitted​their​petitions​and​remain​on​the​Bureau​of​Indian​Affairs’​waiting​ list);​and​restore​all​previously​terminated​tribes​with​federal​acknowledgment,​one​can​certainly​imagine​a​major​reordering​of​society​in​a​way​that​ would​affect​the​existing​state​and​the​territory​the​U.S.​government​currently​claims​as​its​own.​None​of​these​four​actions​need​be​tied​to​the​goal​ of​indigenous​nations​becoming​nation-​states;​however,​the​likelihood​that​ the​federal​government​would​act​on​any​of​these​matters​at​this​moment​in​ time​seems​quite​far-​fetched.​Indeed,​indigenous​possession​is​a​contradiction​inherent​in​the​U.S.​nation-​state​and​its​very​foundations. ​ Today,​international​lawyers​who​favor​nation-​states​argue​that​indigenous​peoples​do​not​have​an​unqualified​right​to​self-​determination​under​ international​law,​while​those​who​favor​indigenous​peoples​argue​that​they​ do​(Lâm​1992).​There​is​no​consensus​regarding​this​model,​which​is​why​so​ many​indigenous​activists​have​devoted​much​time​and​effort​to​advocating​that​the​United​Nations​and​the​Organization​of​American​States​(oas)​ adopt​the​Declaration​on​the​Rights​of​Indigenous​Peoples​affirming​that​indigenous​peoples​have​an​unqualified​right​to​self-​determination. ​ The​ Indigenous​ Caucus​ at​ both​ the​ United​ Nations​ and​ the​ oas ​ had​ consistently​taken​the​position​that​indigenous​peoples​are​colonized​and​ therefore​fall​under​the​decolonization​model.​un ​documents​and​international​practice​demonstrate​that​self-​determination​is​a​right​available​to​all​ peoples.​But​there​was​widespread​controversy​over​when​a​group​of​persons​ constitute​ a​ people​ who​ are​ entitled​ to​ self-​determination​ under​ international​law.​When​the​U.S.​National​Security​Council​took​a​position​on​indigenous​peoples​before​the​United​Nations​Commission​on​Human​Rights​ Hawaiian Nationhood 47

and​its​Working​Group​on​the​Draft​Declaration​on​Indigenous​Rights,​along​ with​a​similar​oas ​draft​declaration,​the​council​stated​that​the​United​States​ urged​the​use​of​the​term​internal self-determination​for​indigenous​peoples.​ In​other​words,​the​U.S.​position​was​that​using​the​term​self-determination​ was​advisable​only​if​it​was​defined​in​a​way​that​meant​that​the​right​to​self-​ determination​signified​indigenous​peoples’​right​to​negotiate​their​respective​political​statuses​within​the​framework​of​the​existing​nation-​state.​The​ debate​over​indigenous​peoples’​demand​for​the​use​of​the​term​peoples​was​ crucial​to​activist​demands​under​international​law.​The​U.S.​government​has​ continuously​opposed​the​use​of​the​term​peoples,​which​marks​distinction​ to​peoplehood​and​attendant​collective​rights​to​sovereignty.​However,​with​ the​adoption​by​the​United​Nations​of​the​Declaration​on​the​Rights​of​Indigenous​Peoples,​such​opposition​may​potentially​change—especially​if​the​ declaration​becomes​a​convention​with​the​full​force​of​international​law.

Conclusions The​complex​history​of​Hawai‘i​and​its​multiple​transitions​from​sovereign​ kingdom​to​occupied​colonial​territory​to​fiftieth​U.S.​state​presents​a​unique​ challenge​as​we​think​through​the​options​for​decolonization​that​are​available​to​Kanaka​Maoli​and​other​heirs​of​the​kingdom.​Given​the​layers​of​ history​and​foreign​intervention,​there​is​no​clear​or​easy​way​to​resolve​this​ problem,​especially​so​long​as​the​U.S.​government​continues​to​dominate​ nations​across​the​globe​with​its​political​and​military​power.​The​history​of​ both​American​colonialism​and​U.S.​occupation​has​generated​a​variety​of​ options—but​none​of​them​seem​sufficient​in​their​current​scope​since​each​ has​serious​limitations. ​ As​we​saw​in​the​discussion​of​the​Akaka​bill,​the​status​of​domestic​dependent​nation​that​would​be​granted​Native​Hawaiians​through​a​process​ of​federal​recognition​neither​recognizes​the​kingdom’s​history​of​sovereign​ existence​ nor​ takes​ into​ account​ the​ unjust​ occupation​ and​ overthrow​ of​ the​monarch​by​the​U.S.​government.​At​the​same​time,​relying​on​presently​ existing​international​law​regarding​indigenous​peoples​also​has​the​limitation​that,​in​its​present​state,​it​still​gives​priority​to​existing​nation-​states​ and​puts​the​preexisting​rights​of​indigenous​peoples​as​nations​on​the​back​ burner.​ While​ this​ may​ change,​ for​ the​ moment​ neither​ of​ these​ options​ gives​Kanaka​Maoli​or​other​heirs​of​the​kingdom​the​satisfaction​of​recognizing​their​previously​independent​status. 48 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

​ Yet,​as​we​also​saw​briefly,​the​deoccupation​model,​while​taking​account​ of​such​independent​status,​also​denies​the​internal​colonialism​in​terms​of​ culture,​language,​and​territory​to​which​the​Kanaka​Maoli​have​been​specifically​subjected.​It​seems​as​though​recognition​of​the​previous​sovereignty​of​ the​kingdom​currently​rests​on​the​denial​of​internal​forms​of​domination.​ In​the​end,​therefore,​there​does​not​seem​to​be​one​alternative​that​both​ recognizes​the​kingdom’s​history​of​sovereignty​and​provides​Kanaka​Maoli​ with​the​cultural​and​territorial​ restitution​ to​which​they​aspire.​Furthermore,​although​Kanaka​Maoli​constituted​the​majority​of​the​kingdom’s​subjects​prior​to​the​overthrow​in​1893,​Kanaka​Maoli​and​other​heirs​of​the​ kingdom​together​are​a​demographic​minority​in​Hawai‘i’s​current​population.​This​begs​the​question​as​to​how​the​kingdom​government​would​be​ restored​if​independence​became​a​feasible​political​goal,​since​within​the​ contemporary​world​community​minority-​led​governments​are​viewed​as​ unacceptable.​In​response​to​this​problematic,​the​normative​solution​under​ international​law​that​would​have​all​citizens​equally​enfranchised​without​ any​differential​status​for​Kanaka​Maoli​and​other​heirs​raises​the​possibility​ that​Kanaka​Maoli​would​once​again​be​a​vulnerable​indigenous​minority​ under​an​independent​Hawaiian​government​and​thus​have​to​rely​on​the​ indigenous​rights​provided​under​current​international​law,​as​it​is​now​in​ any​case. ​ In​an​“Urgent​Open​Letter​to​U.S.​President​Barack​Obama”​dated​13​April​ 2009,​a​self-​selected​group​of​Kanaka​Maoli,​kupuna​(elders),​kumu​(educators),​and​representatives​wrote​on​behalf​of​the​Kanaka​Maoli​people​as​ well​as​of​other​heirs​of​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i.​Signatories​also​included​ a​number​of​our​kako‘o​(supporters)​who​were​invited​to​add​their​names.20​ The​letter’s​primary​purpose​was​to​inform​the​president​of​the​signatories’​ categorical​opposition​to​the​proposed​legislation.​It​also​proposed​an​alternative​bilateral​approach​to​begin​to​address​the​complex​legacy​detailed​in​ this​essay​in​a​way​that​promotes​restorative​justice.​The​letter​read​in​part​as​ follows: The​ Bill​ arrogantly​ attempts​ to​ unilaterally​ characterize​ the​ historical​ transgressions​ of​ the​ United​ States​ against​ our​ people​ and​ kingdom,​ and​to​unilaterally​specify​their​remedy.​We​insist​otherwise.​U.S.​crimes​ against​our​Kanaka​Maoli​people​and​other​Kingdom​heirs​from​1893​on​ require,​for​their​redress,​that​a​mechanism​composed​of​U.S.​agents​and​ wholly​independent​representatives​of​Kanaka​Maoli​and​Kingdom​heirs​ Hawaiian Nationhood 49

be​bilaterally​set​up​by​your​Administration​and​us​to​make​findings​of​ fact​and​conclusions​of​international​law​that​could​serve​as​a​road-​map​ for​the​resolution​of​the​political​and​legal​issues​now​outstanding​between​our​two​parties. As​this​essay​has​made​clear,​the​complex​histories​of​colonialism,​occupation,​and​discrimination​to​which​Native​peoples​have​been​subject​across​ the​globe​have​no​single​solution,​precisely​because​each​case​has​its​own​ particular​characteristics.​Given​the​especially​fraught​history​of​the​Hawaiian​case,​the​combination​of​international​law​and​honest​bilateral​dialogue​ might​ be​ the​ only​ venue​ open​ for​ redress.​ But​ it​ is​ also​ my​ hope​ that,​ if​ brought​to​fruition,​such​dialogue​might​provide​an​example​of​what​could​ be​possible​for​indigenous​nations​in​other​parts​of​the​world.

Notes This​essay​began​as​a​presentation​delivered​at​the​Native​American​Studies​Symposium​“Narrating​Native​American​History​in​the​Americas,”​University​of​Wisconsin,​Madison,​7–10​April​2005.​I​would​like​to​thank​Florencia​Mallon​and​Ned​ Blackhawk​for​inviting​me​to​present​my​work​there,​as​well​as​the​following​individuals​and​institutions​that​created​opportunities​for​me​to​present​various​working​ versions​ of​ this​ piece:​ Jessica​ Cattelino​ and​ Miranda​ Johnson​ for​ inviting​ me​ to​present​at​the​Comparative​Colonialisms​workshop​hosted​by​the​Anthropology​ Department​of​the​University​of​Chicago;​Aileen​Moreton-​Robinson​for​inviting​me​ to​present​an​earlier​version​for​the​inaugural​lecture​for​the​Indigenous​Studies​Research​Network,​Queensland​University​of​Technology​in​Brisbane,​Australia;​and​ Alyssa​Mt.​Pleasant​for​inviting​me​to​present​at​the​American​Studies​colloquium​ at​Yale​University. ​ 1.​ Congress​ has​ enacted​ numerous​ special​ provisions​ of​ law​ for​ the​ benefit​ of​ Native​Hawaiians​in​the​areas​of​health,​education,​labor,​and​housing.​Along​with​ American​Indians​and​Alaska​Natives,​Native​Hawaiians​have​been​included​in​over​ 160​federal​acts​for​Native​Americans​since​1903.​To​some​degree,​then,​the​U.S.​Congress​has​recognized​that​a​special​relationship​exists​between​the​United​States​and​ the​Native​Hawaiian​people​when​it​extended​some​of​the​same​rights​and​privileges​ accorded​to​American​Indian,​Alaska​Native,​Inuit,​and​Aleut​communities.​Relevant​ legislation​includes​the​Native​American​Programs​Act​of​1974​(42​usc ​2991​et​seq.),​ the​American​Indian​Religious​Freedom​Act​(42​ usc ​1996),​the​National​Museum​ of​the​American​Indian​Act​(20​usc ​80q​et​seq.),​the​Native​American​Graves​Protection​and​Repatriation​Act​(25​ usc ​3001​et​seq.),​the​National​Historic​Preservation​Act​(16​usc ​470​et​seq.),​and​the​Native​American​Languages​Act​(25​usc ​2901​ 50 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

et​seq.).​Also,​under​Title​VIII​of​the​Native​American​Programs​Act​of​1975,​Native​ Pacific​Islanders​are​defined​as​Native​Americans.​There​are​also​several​Hawaiian-​ specific​federal​acts,​comparable​to​those​providing​for​American​Indians​and​Alaskan​Natives,​such​as​the​Native​Hawaiian​Health​Care​Act​and​the​Native​Hawaiian​ Education​Act.​In​all​of​these​acts​Hawaiians​are​defined​by​the​most​inclusive​definition:​“Any​individual​who​is​a​descendent​of​the​aboriginal​people​who,​prior​to​ 1778,​occupied​and​exercised​sovereignty​in​the​area​that​now​constitutes​the​State​of​ Hawaii.” ​ 2.​The​United​States​and​members​of​the​international​community​also​recognized​ the​ Kingdom​ of​ Hawai‘i’s​ independence​ through​ treaty​ relations​ with​ the​ major​powers​of​the​world,​including​not​only​the​United​States​(1849,​1870,​1875,​ 1883,​and​1884),​but​also​Austria-​Hungary​(1875),​Belgium​(1862),​Denmark​(1846),​ France​(1846​and​1857),​Germany​(1879),​Great​Britain​(1836,​1846,​and​1851),​Italy​ (1863),​Japan​(1871​and​1886),​the​Netherlands​(1862),​Portugal​(1882),​Russia​(1869),​ Samoa​(1887),​Spain​(1863),​the​Swiss​Confederation​(1864),​and​Sweden​and​Norway​ (1852). ​ 3.​The​fiftieth​anniversary​of​U.S.​statehood​for​Hawai‘i,​in​2009,​marked​an​opportunity​ for​ scholars​ to​ investigate​ the​ details​ of​ the​ vote​ issued​ by​ the​ colonial​ administration​in​the​Hawaiian​Islands​at​the​time.​Some​of​the​issues​that​need​research​attention​include​the​executive​decisions​that​allowed​both​U.S.​military​and​ other​non-​Hawaiian​residents​to​vote​(regardless​of​whether​or​not​they​were​descendants​of​the​Kanaka​Maoli​and​non-​Hawaiians​residing​in​the​Islands​prior​to​ the​unlawful​U.S.​annexation),​and​a​careful​study​of​the​reports​issued​by​the​U.S.​ representative​to​the​United​Nations,​who​reported​that​Hawaiians​had​already​exercised​self-​determination​in​the​vote​of​1959​and​therefore​should​be​removed​from​ the​un ​list​of​non-​self-​governing​territories. ​ 4.​See​www.un.org/Depts./dpi/decolonization/declaration.htm. ​ 5.​ In​ 1962​ the​ General​ Assembly​ established​ a​ special​ committee,​ now​ known​ as​the​Special​Committee​of​24​on​Decolonization,​to​examine​the​application​of​ the​declaration​and​to​make​recommendations​on​its​implementation.​http://www​ .un.org/Depts/dpi/decolonization/declaration.htm. ​ 6.​See​also​http://www.hawaiiankingdom.org/. ​ 7.​Here,​too,​the​proponents​of​kingdom​restoration​engaging​in​this​problematic​ critique​do​not​acknowledge​that​indigenous​governing​systems​by​and​large​have​ always​managed​to​incorporate​outsiders​too,​even​if​they​do​not​do​so​under​the​ auspices​of​a​state​government.​Moreover,​there​seems​to​be​little​understanding​that​ contemporary​tribes​that​have​been​granted​U.S.​federal​recognition,​for​example,​ may​limit​their​citizenry​to​those​of​who​are​their​specific​indigeneity,​but​this​may​ also​be​because​the​U.S.​government​maintains​that​its​trust​obligation​is​limited​to​ those​who​have​ancestry​from​any​given​Native​Nation​and​not​non-​Natives. ​ 8.​Unfortunately,​as​discussed​below,​in​the​U.S.​Supreme​Court​ruling​in​State Hawaiian Nationhood 51

of Hawaii v. Office of Hawaiian Affairs, et al.,​the​court​ruled​that​the​apology​was​ merely​symbolic​and​had​no​legal​effect​when​it​comes​to​the​question​of​land​title. ​ 9.​For​a​critical​account​of​this​legal​case,​see​Kauanui​(2002). ​ 10.​This​process​of​appointments​already​set​the​proposal​apart​from​the​Indian​ Reorganization​Act​of​1934. ​ 11.​For​a​critical​analysis​of​the​neoconservative​forces​on​the​Islands​that​organized​against​the​legislation​because​they​regarded​it​as​a​proposal​for​race-​based​ government,​see​Kauanui​(2008). ​ 12.​For​information​on​S.​1011​and​H.R.​2314​and​their​predecessors,​see​http:// thomas.loc.gov/cgi-​bin​(accessed​11​August​2009). ​ 13.​On​31​March​2009​the​U.S.​Supreme​Court​issued​its​ruling​in​State of Hawaii v. Office of Hawaiian Affairs, et al.​The​State​of​Hawai‘i​asked​the​high​court​whether​or​ not​the​state​has​the​authority​to​sell,​exchange,​or​transfer​1.2​million​acres​of​land​ formerly​held​by​the​Hawaiian​monarchy​as​Crown​and​Government​Lands.​Prior​ to​the​state’s​appeal​to​the​U.S.​Supreme​Court,​the​Hawai‘i​Supreme​Court​unanimously​ruled​that​the​state​should​keep​the​land​trust​intact​until​Kanaka​Maoli’s​ claims​to​these​lands​are​settled​and​prohibited​the​state​from​selling​or​otherwise​ disposing​of​the​properties​to​private​parties;​it​did​so​based​on​an​Apology​Resolution​of​1993​issued​by​Congress​to​the​Hawaiian​people.​The​U.S.​Supreme​Court​ reversed​the​judgment​of​the​Hawai‘i​Supreme​Court​and​remanded​the​case​for​further​proceedings​with​the​stipulation​that​the​outcome​not​be​inconsistent​with​the​ U.S.​Supreme​Court’s​opinion.​The​contested​land​base​constitutes​29​percent​of​the​ total​land​area​of​what​is​now​known​as​the​State​of​Hawai‘i​and​almost​all​the​land​ claimed​by​the​state​as​public​lands.​These​lands​were​unilaterally​claimed​by​the​U.S.​ federal​ government​ when​ it​ unilaterally​ annexed​ the​ Hawaiian​ Islands​ through​ a​ joint​resolution​by​the​U.S.​Congress​in​1898,​after​they​had​been​“ceded”​by​the​Republic​of​Hawai‘i,​which​had​established​itself​a​year​after​the​armed​and​unlawful​ overthrow​of​the​Hawaiian​monarchy​under​Queen​Lili‘uokalani​in​1893.​The​Court​ insists​that​the​apology​does​not​change​the​legal​landscape​or​restructure​the​rights​ and​obligations​of​the​state.​The​ruling​states​that​the​apology​would​“raise​grave​constitutional​concerns​if​it​purported​to​‘cloud’​Hawai‘i’s​title​to​its​sovereign​lands​more​ than​three​decades​after​the​State’s​admission​to​the​union.”​The​Court​further​opined​ that​“Congress​cannot,​after​statehood,​reserve​or​convey​submerged​lands​that​have​ already​been​bestowed​upon​a​State.”​But​if​the​Apology​Resolution​has​no​teeth​in​ the​court​of​the​conqueror,​how​is​it​that​the​Newlands​Resolution​that​unilaterally​ annexed​Hawai‘i​does? ​ 14.​This​part​of​the​legislation​should​worry​Native​Nations​across​Indian​Country​ since​it​gives​state​governments​a​central​role​alongside​the​Native​governing​entity​ and​the​federal​government.​Although​Akaka,​ever​since​his​proposal​was​first​introduced​in​2000,​has​continuously​asserted​that​his​measure​seeks​to​establish​equality​ in​the​federal​policies​extended​toward​American​Indians,​Alaska​Natives,​and​Native​ 52 J.​Kehaulani​Kauanui

Hawaiians,​the​most​recent​version​of​the​legislation​makes​it​clear​that​that​is​not​at​ all​the​case.​Section​9,​titled​“Applicability​of​Certain​Federal​Laws,”​actually​spells​ out​the​inapplicability​of​certain​federal​laws—those​pertaining​to​federally​recognized​Indian​tribes​that​would​not​apply​to​the​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity.​All​ of​these​laws​that​exclude​the​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​happen​to​be​laws​ that​greatly​benefit​tribal​nations.​The​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​would​not​be​ allowed​to​claim​rights​under​the​Indian​Gaming​Regulatory​Act.​The​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​would​not​be​allowed​to​have​the​secretary​of​the​interior​take​ land​into​trust​on​behalf​of​the​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity.​This​is​important​ because​only​land​held​in​trust​by​the​federal​government​on​behalf​of​Native​Nations​ is​allowed​to​be​used​by​Indian​tribes​as​part​of​their​sovereign​land​base​where​they​ can​assert​jurisdiction.​The​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​would​not​be​allowed​ to​rely​on​the​Indian​Trade​and​Intercourse​Act​to​challenge​how​the​State​of​Hawai‘i​ acquired​the​Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i​Crown​and​Government​Lands.​No​other​Native​ Hawaiian​group​would​be​eligible​for​recognition​under​the​Federal​Acknowledgment​Process.​The​Native​Hawaiian​governing​entity​would​not​be​eligible​for​Indian​ Programs​and​Services. ​ 15.​Some​within​the​Native​Hawaiian​community​in​Hawai‘i​have​speculated​that​ Abercrombie’s​responsiveness​to​the​ nhba ’s​concerns​may​be​appropriately​linked​ to​his​campaign​for​election​as​Hawai‘i’s​state​governor​in​2010. ​ 16.​www.un.org/aboutun/charter. ​ 17.​www.un.org/esa. ​ 18.​www.ohchr.org. ​ 19.​ Thanks​ to​ Andrea​ Carmen,​ executive​ director​ of​ the​ International​ Indian​ Treaty​Council​(the​first​organization​of​indigenous​peoples​to​be​reorganized​as​a​ nongovernmental​organization),​who,​in​an​interview​for​my​radio​show,​“Indigenous​ Politics:​ From​ Native​ New​ Eng​land​ and​ Beyond,”​ explained​ that​ Article​ 46​ can​be​interpreted​for​the​benefit​of​Hawaiian​independence​from​the​United​States.​ Carmen​also​noted​that​the​article​became​a​catchall​for​states​and​that​it​was​inserted​after​2004​when​countries​that​supported​the​declaration,​including​Mexico,​ Guatemala,​Peru,​and​others,​prompted​such​a​move.​It​was​adopted​by​the​Human​ Rights​Council​in​2006.​For​more​information,​listen​to​the​interview,​which​aired​ on​13​January​2009​and​is​archived​online:​http://indigenouspolitics.mypodcast.com. ​ Also​featured​on​a​different​program​of​my​show​was​Tonya​Gonnella​Frichner,​ founder​and​president​of​the​American​Indian​Law​Alliance.​This​program​includes​ a​comprehensive​account​of​the​activist​history​that​led​to​the​passage​of​the​declaration​as​well​as​a​critical​analysis​of​the​politics​of​careful​negotiations​that​led​to​the​ compromises​over​these​seemingly​contradictory​articles​of​the​declaration. ​ See​http://indigenouspolitics.mypodcast.com. ​ 20.​ For​ a​ list​ of​ the​ signatories,​ see​ the​ letter​ as​ it​ appeared​ in​ Counterpunch:​ http://www.counterpunch.org/blaisde1104152009.html. Hawaiian Nationhood 53

riet Delsing

Issues​of​Land​and​Sovereignty The Uneasy Relationship between Chile and Rapa Nui

On​ New​ Year’s​ Eve​ 1999​ a​ large​ crowd​ gathered​ at​ the​ ceremonial​ site​ of​ Tahai​on​Rapa​Nui​to​celebrate​the​advent​of​the​new​millennium.1​Rapa​ Nui,​the​small​island​in​the​South​Pacific​also​known​as​Easter​Island,​was​ annexed​ by​ Chile​ in​ 1888.​ That​ same​ morning​ some​ Rapanui​ youths​ had​ damaged​the​Chilean​National​Television​(tVn)​equipment​set​up​on​the​ site​to​cover​the​celebrations.​They​were​protesting​against​the​violation​of​a​ sacred,​ceremonial​place​and​also​demanding​access​to​the​considerable​sum​ paid​by​tVn ​to​the​municipality​of​Rapa​Nui​for​the​rights​to​film​the​event,​ which​was​to​be​broadcast​live,​worldwide,​via​the​ bbc ​network.​Minutes​ before​midnight​the​best-​known​Chilean​television​hosts,​flown​in​from​the​ mainland​for​the​occasion,​distributed​flower​garlands​among​the​islanders​ and​the​tourists​participating​in​the​event,​so​that​the​world​could​enjoy​the​ exotic​character​of​this​most​unique​millennium​celebration. ​ When​fireworks​lit​up​the​spectacular​site,​with​its​famous​stone​statues​ (moai),​and​the​crowd​was​cheering,​some​of​us​noticed​that​this​was​not​the​ only​manifestation​of​“Rapanuiness.”​A​few​steps​away,​in​the​dark​night,​a​ small​group​of​Rapanui​wearing​traditional​mahute​(bark​cloth)​capes​and​ carrying​torches​stood​silently​against​the​starred​sky,​next​to​a​lonely​moai​ and​a​Chilean​flag​which​was​blowing​in​the​stiff​breeze.​The​flag​was​purposely​put​beneath​a​Rapanui​flag​as​a​challenge​to​Chilean​sovereignty​over​ the​island.​This​incident​illustrates​some​of​the​political​and​cultural​tensions​in​Rapa​Nui.​The​events​surrounding​the​millennium​celebration​show​ not​only​the​Rapanui’s​insistence​on​asserting​their​collective​cultural​identity,​but​also​their​entanglement​with​the​Chilean​nation-​state​and​tourism.​ Since​the​1990s​there​had​been​a​growing​awareness​among​Rapanui​of​their​

specific​cultural​identity,​expressed​in​practices​and​discourses​around​the​ issues​of​land,​language,​and​cultural​performances,​along​with​a​striking​increase​in​cultural​exchanges​with​other​Polynesians. ​ More​than​a​century​has​passed​since​the​annexation,​and​the​Chilean​ nation-​state​ has​ created​ not​ an​ environment​ leading​ to​ cooperation​ with​ the​Rapanui​people​but​one​of​resistance.​In​this​essay​I​explore​some​of​the​ issues​at​stake​in​this​enduring​conflict.​After​a​review​of​the​early​years​of​ Chilean​colonization​I​show​how​successive​Chilean​laws​have​attempted​to​ integrate​Rapa​Nui​into​the​nation-​state,​and​how​they​are​an​obstacle​to​traditional​Rapanui​relations​with​their​land​and​territory.​I​conclude​with​an​ examination​of​the​changing​forms​of​political​relationship​between​Chile​ and​Rapa​Nui. ​ My​work​is​based​on​several​years​of​anthropological​research​and​life​ experience​in​Rapa​Nui.​Starting​in​1996​I​have​conducted​fieldwork​on​the​ island​on​various​occasions​ranging​from​a​couple​of​weeks​to​ten​months.​ Since​then,​my​life​has​become​intertwined​with​the​people​of​Rapa​Nui,​with​ their​joys​and​their​struggles.​Over​the​past​decade​I​have​explored​Rapanui​gender​relations,​issues​of​globalization,​and,​in​the​context​of​my​dissertation​research,​cultural​politics,​Rapanui​relationships​with​the​Chilean​ nation-​state,​and​their​thrust​toward​self-​determination.​In​these​inquiries​I​ have​adopted​a​multisited​approach​(Marcus​1995;​Marcus​and​Fischer​1986)​ since​my​main​premise​is​that​the​movement​of​people,​ideas,​institutions,​ communication​systems,​and​capital​across​the​Pacific​Ocean​is​central​to​ the​articulation​of​a​modern​Rapanui​cultural​identity.​My​voice​is​that​of​an​ anthropologist,​inquisitive​and​curious​about​cultural​processes—the​subject​of​our​trade—but​also​that​of​somebody​with​a​personal​investment​in​ social​and​political​change​in​Rapa​Nui​and​elsewhere.

A Brief History The​annexation​of​Rapa​Nui​did​not​take​place​in​a​historical​vacuum.​It​was​ the​result​of​the​Chilean​Republic’s​imperialist​aspirations​in​the​late​nineteenth​century.​After​gaining​independence​from​Spain​in​1818,​Chile​was​ still​consolidating​its​territory​in​the​1880s​when​it​made​two​major​conquests​that​increased​its​territory​by​a​third.​To​the​south,​it​militarily​defeated​the​Mapuche​people,​who​had​struggled​for​three​hundred​years,​first,​ against​Spanish​and,​later,​Chilean​colonizers.​To​the​north,​Chile​defeated​ Bolivia​ and​ Peru​ in​ the​ War​ of​ the​ Pacific​ (1879–83),​ and​ Chile​ annexed​ Chile and Rapa Nui 55

substantial​parts​of​their​territories​that​were​inhabited​by​the​indigenous​ Aymara,​Quechua,​and​Colla​peoples.​The​major​objective​of​this​war​was​ to​gain​control​of​the​mineral​riches,​nitrate​in​particular,​of​the​Atacama​ desert,​part​of​which​was​located​in​Bolivian​and​Peruvian​territories​(Silva​ Galdames​1995). ​ But​Chile’s​expansionist​drive​did​not​limit​itself​to​the​American​continent.​A​growing​number​of​foreign​merchants,​mainly​British,​used​the​ Chilean​port​of​Valparaíso​as​a​way​station​for​trade​with​the​Pacific​coast​ before​the​opening​of​the​Panama​Canal​in​1914.​Valparaíso​became​the​most​ important​port​on​that​coast,​which​allowed​Chilean​merchants​to​create​ their​own​trade​routes​across​the​Pacific,​in​India​and​East​Asia,​in​search​of​ new​markets​for​Chile’s​copper​and​nitrates​(Bushnell​and​Macaulay​1988,​ 109).​ Before​ the​ end​ of​ the​ century​ Chilean​ consulates​ had​ been​ opened​ in​Shanghai,​Canton,​Manila,​Calcutta,​Sydney,​and​Brunei.​Chilean​sailors​ and​merchants​became​familiar​with​Polynesian​geography,​and​this​led​to​ dreams​ of​ western​ expansion​ into​ the​ Pacific​ (Porteous​ 1981).​ In​ the​ late​ 1800s​several​European​and​American​nations​annexed​islands​and​archipelagos​in​the​Pacific.​In​this​context​of​imperialist​fervor​Chile​annexed​ Rapa​Nui. ​ A​captain​of​the​Chilean​navy​by​the​name​of​Policarpo​Toro​Hurtado​ visited​Rapa​Nui​in​1875​and​again​in​1886.​After​his​second​visit​he​submitted​a​proposal​for​annexation​to​his​superiors​in​the​navy.​President​José​ Manuel​Balmaceda​of​Chile​approved​of​the​idea,​and​Toro​went​to​Tahiti​ in​1887​with​the​intention​of​buying​the​Rapanui’s​lands​and​animals,​which​ had​been​seized​by​European–Tahitian​businessmen​and​the​Tahitian​Catholic​Church​(Revista de Marina​1983,​316,​317).​Toro​then​annexed​the​island​in​ September​1888​by​signing​the​“Agreement​of​Wills”​(Acuerdo de Voluntades)​ with​the​Rapanui​chiefs. ​ The​official​Spanish​text​of​the​agreement​consists​of​two​parts:​the​“Cession,”​in​which​the​chiefs​grant​sovereignty​to​Chile,​and​the​“Proclamation,”​ in​which​Toro​accepts​the​cession​of​sovereignty​in​the​name​of​the​Republic​of​Chile​(Vergara​1939,​appendices​XII​and​XIII).​In​2001​the​Rapanui-​ language​version​of​these​documents​started​to​circulate​on​the​island.​A​ translation​of​this​version​back​into​Spanish​reveals​that​the​Rapanui​did​not​ hand​over​sovereignty​to​the​Chileans​in​the​sense​in​which​the​concept​is​ understood​in​current​international​law.2​This​disparity​coincides​with​oral​ tradition,​according​to​which​ariki​Atamu​Tekena​gave​a​bunch​of​grass​to​ Toro​but​put​a​handful​of​soil​in​his​own​pocket,​a​gesture​meant​to​express​ 56 riet​Delsing

that​he​was​allowing​the​Chileans​to​make​use​of​land​and​crops​but​that​ he​was​not​handing​over​Rapanui​territory.3​This​enactment​is​performed​ for​me​over​and​over​again​whenever​I​ask​Rapanui​about​their​political​relationship​with​Chile.

The Early Years of Chilean Colonization Misunderstandings​about​the​separateness​of​land​and​territory​were​present​ from​the​very​beginning​of​Chilean​colonization.​After​the​annexation​in​ 1888,​Toro’s​brother,​Pedro​Pablo,​stayed​in​Rapa​Nui​for​four​years​as​an​ “agent​of​colonization”​(Toro​1892)​and​wrote​an​interesting​report​about​his​ experiences.​Besides​his​observations​about​Chilean​versus​Rapanui​political​authority,​Chilean​“civilization”​versus​Rapanui​Polynesian​culture,​and​ the​Chilean​legal​system​versus​Rapanui​customary​law,​he​made​the​first​assessment​of​Rapanui​landownership​seen​through​the​eyes​of​a​Chilean​who​ had​firsthand​knowledge​of​the​situation.​“Private​and​permanent​ownership​ does​not​really​exist​in​the​countryside,”​he​said.​“Each​individual​cultivates​ and​sows​a​plot​of​land,​which​he​abandons​after​the​harvest​to​take​another​ one​later​on”​(Toro​1892,​205).​Toro​had​no​understanding​of​the​Polynesian​ system​of​land​tenure,​which​allowed​for​collective​use​of​clan​lands,​and​he​ may​not​have​been​aware​of​the​existing​clan​system. ​ Most​interesting​are​his​recommendations​to​the​Chilean​government,​ which​give​a​striking​vision​of​how​the​island​and​its​people​should​become​ integrated​into​the​Chilean​nation-​state.​His​suggestions​are​a​stunning​example​of​capitalist​discourse​on​the​advantages​of​private​property.​First,​he​ suggested​that​the​island​be​submitted​to​Chilean​jurisdiction​by​creating​a​ subdelegation​annexed​to​the​Department​of​Valparaíso.​Second,​he​proposed​to​constitute​indigenous​private​property​rights​by​equally​dividing​ the​land​in​plots,​“sufficient​to​satisfy​the​necessities​of​each​family”​to​maintain​itself​independently.​The​canacas​(natives)​should​be​obliged​to​fence​off​ their​respective​properties.​The​creation​of​private​property​would​stimulate​ work,​production,​and​exchange.​It​would​create​healthy​competition​since​ each​indígena​(indigenous​person)​would​see​himself​as​exclusive​owner​of​ his​property​and​“more​or​less​rich,”​according​to​his​own​efforts,​economic​ ability,​ and​ dedication.​ Toro​ supposed​ that​ in​ the​ beginning​ the​ canacas​ would​resist​these​innovations​concerning​the​private​property​of​land,​but​ that​such​resistance​would​never​be​serious,​and​the​canacas​would​slowly​ but​ surely​ become​ convinced​ of​ the​ advantages​ of​ the​ new​ system​ (Toro​ Chile and Rapa Nui 57

1892,​212).​Toro​also​thought​it​would​not​be​difficult​to​substitute​the​legal​ authority​of​the​whites​for​the​traditional​authority​of​the​indigenous​chiefs,​ among​whom​the​subdelegate​could​assign​his​subordinates.​It​is​remarkable​ how​prescient​Toro’s​vision​would​prove​to​be,​as​today​the​Western​concept​ of​individual​private​property​has​invaded,​slowly​but​surely,​Rapanui​customary​forms​of​communal​land​tenure​and​the​notion​of​kainga,4​or​ancestral​lands,​is​losing​ground​among​many​Rapanui. ​ After​the​initial​years​of​colonization​Chile​lost​interest​in​the​island,​possibly​because​of​the​country’s​bloody​civil​war​in​1891​and​the​realization​ that​it​was​not​the​tropical​paradise​Toro​had​imagined​it​to​be.5​The​Chilean​ government​ first​ rented​ out​ the​ island​ to​ a​ French–Chilean​ businessman​ based​in​Valparaíso​who​in​1903​passed​on​the​lease​to​Williamson​Balfour​ and​Company,​a​Scottish​trading​company​with​headquarters​for​South​and​ North​America​in​Valparaíso.​The​Compañía​(as​it​is​still​referred​to​today)​ converted​most​of​the​island​into​a​sheep​farm​for​the​export​of​wool,​and​ its​representatives​became​the​virtual​rulers​of​the​island​for​the​next​fifty​ years,​until​1953.​The​Chilean​government​was​present​in​the​form​of​its​navy,​ which​sent​a​ship​once​yearly​and​stayed​in​contact​with​the​representative​ of​the​Compañía.​However,​during​this​long​period​the​Rapanui​were​not​ treated​as​Chilean​citizens.​Chile’s​legal​system​was​put​into​practice​by​the​ navy​only​in​the​most​rudimentary​way,​while​its​administrative​and​institutional​structures​were​virtually​absent. ​ At​the​end​of​the​nineteenth​century​some​Rapanui​were​beginning​to​ lose​their​intimate​contact​with​and​deep​connection​to​the​kainga,​where​ they​had​been​living​according​to​tribal​affiliations​and​customary​practices​ in​which​the​land​was​intrinsically​inalienable.​Legend​says​that​the​island​ was​partitioned​into​two​territorial​confederacies,​the​Ko Tu’u Aro Kote Mata Nui,​the​major​clans​which​occupied​the​northern​and​western​part​of​the​ island,​and​the​Ko Tu’u Hotu Iti Mata Iti,​the​minor​clans​which​lived​in​the​ southeastern​part​(Routledge​1919;​Métraux​1940;​McCall​1976).​Each​confederation​was​divided​into​patrilineal​clans,​or​mata.​The​six​western​mata​ wielded​religious​and​political​power​and​emphasized​fishing,​while​the​four​ eastern​mata​were​mainly​agriculturalists.​These​specific​economic​activities​ made​them​dependent​on​one​another. ​ At​least​two​factors​were​involved​in​the​process​of​alienation​that​took​ place​in​the​late​nineteenth​century.​Owing​to​slave​raids​and​the​introduction​of​previously​unknown​diseases​only​slightly​more​than​one​hundred​ Rapanui​had​survived​by​the​time​of​the​Chilean​takeover,​out​of​a​popu58 riet​Delsing

lation​ of​ two​ thousand​ in​ the​ early​ 1860s.​ This​ suggests​ that​ some​ of​ the​ original​clan​lands​must​already​have​been​depopulated​toward​the​end​of​ the​century.​A​second​factor​is​that​the​Church​and​the​early​Chilean​colonizers​gathered​the​Rapanui​in​a​single​settlement,​Hanga​Roa,​for​purposes​ of​evangelization​and​colonial​control.​The​early​colonizers​also​prohibited​ the​islanders​from​using​their​original​clan​lands​for​planting​and​raising​ ​animals. ​ Early​documents​presented​by​Rapanui​to​the​Chilean​government​show​ that​several​islanders​complained​about​the​fact​that​their​lands​and​animals​were​taken​away.​These​lists​of​protests​started​the​process​of​alienation​from​tribal​lands.​The​very​act​of​listing​in​itself​brought​about​a​distancing​from​earlier​ways​of​relating​to​the​land​as​name,​age,​and​property​ were​recorded.6​Certain​lands​were​claimed​by​several​individuals,​sometimes​people​with​different​surnames,​suggesting​that​the​land​had​belonged​ to​specific​clans.​In​those​years​this​new​way​of​asserting​a​relationship​with​ the​land​may​have​gone​unnoticed,​but​in​hindsight​the​individualization​on​ paper​seems​to​be​a​first​step​toward​privatization.​Although​the​listing​of​ land​and​animals​shows​Rapanui​resistance​against​abuses​of​the​Compañía,​ it​also​introduced​the​idea​of​individual​property. The Chilean Republic Consolidates Its Hold on the Island ​ A​few​years​after​the​annexation​it​became​standard​practice​that​island​ disputes​were​arbitrated​by​naval​officers​during​their​yearly​visits​(Porteous​ 1981,​50).​While​the​Compañía​was​mainly​interested​in​the​profits​of​the​ wool​business,​the​navy’s​objective​was​to​carry​out​the​project​of​the​Chilean​ nation-​state.​Territorial​rights​and​landownership​remained​the​major​issues.​ Beginning​in​1917​the​navy​started​to​distribute​plots​to​be​used​for​agricultural​purposes​(Vergara​1939,​81).​The​Rapanui​had​to​convince​navy​personnel​that​they​needed​land​for​specific​purposes.​In​a​publication​of​1926​ entitled​Memorias, Balances, Inventarios y Registro de Propiedades,​the​navy​ lists​all​the​plots​assigned​to​Rapanui​up​to​that​year.​Afterward​it​became​ standard​practice​to​give​five​hectares​to​young​married​couples.​These​cessions​would​be​confirmed​by​the​commanders​of​the​navy​ships​during​their​ visits​to​the​island.​Each​land​title​was​accompanied​by​a​drawing​indicating​ the​size​and​location​of​the​plot.​The​navy​compiled​another​document​in​ 1962,​the​Libro de registros de propiedades llevado por la Armada de Chile, Isla de Pascua.​Like​all​navy​records,​these​publications​are​no​longer​available​ on​the​island​but​copies​were​made,​and​recently​the​Ministerio​de​Bienes​ Chile and Rapa Nui 59

Nacionales​got​hold​of​one.7​If​it​had​not​been​for​copies​made​by​individuals,​this​historical​information​would​be​lost,​as​was​the​case​with​the​treaty​ documents.​The​tone​and​content​of​the​land​titles​indicate​that​the​navy​ acted​as​a​colonial​agent,​applying​strict​military​rules​that​had​to​be​observed​by​the​islanders.​The​reiteration​of​the​navy’s​deeds​in​successive​registers​shows​that​it​was​quite​keen​on​keeping​things​in​order.​By​the​1960s,​ 525​provisional​land​titles​had​been​extended​(Andueza​Guzmán​2005),​and​ the​area​of​Hanga​Roa,​where​the​Rapanui​live​in​family​groups​according​ to​traditional​clan​distributions,​grew​over​the​years​from​one​thousand​to​ three​thousand​hectares. ​ The​Chilean​government’s​position​was​that​these​provisional​titles​allowed​the​beneficiaries​to​use​the​plots​of​land​for​agricultural​purposes,​but​ the​Chilean​state​reserved​ownership​to​the​land.​This​is​ironic,​to​say​the​ least,​if​one​considers​that​this​interpretation​is​a​reversal​of​what​the​Rapanui​offered​to​Chile​at​the​moment​of​annexation.​At​that​time​ariki​Atamu​ Tekena​assigned​the​usufruct​of​Rapanui​lands​to​the​Chilean​state​but​by​ putting​a​handful​of​soil​in​his​pocket​explicitly​expressed​the​wish​to​remain​ in​charge​of​the​kainga.​Interestingly,​the​Rapanui​considered​the​provisional​ titles​as​property​titles,​an​interpretation​the​state​did​not​object​to​in​future​ legal​determinations​about​land​use​in​Rapa​Nui.8​This​is​an​excellent​example​of​how​the​Rapanui​have​been​able​to​circumvent​Chilean​legal​decisions​and​interpret​them​according​to​their​cultural​needs. The Inscription of 1933 ​ In​the​1930s​Rapa​Nui​was​still​a​British​sheep​farm,​run​as​if​it​were​a​ship​ by​its​administrators​and​the​Chilean​navy​authorities.​By​then​the​foreign​ authorities​had​replaced​Rapanui​traditional​leaders,​stripped​them​of​their​ lands,​and​turned​them​into​farmhands.9​However,​an​important​change​was​ made​in​1933.​Tired​of​the​cat-​and-​mouse​game​being​played​over​Rapanui​ lands​by​the​Compañía​and​the​Chilean​state,​the​government​took​action.​ A​ high-​level​ government​ commission​ headed​ by​ a​ Chilean​ bishop​ determined​that​private​landownership​did​not​exist​on​the​island​according​to​ Chilean​ law,​ and​ in​ November​ 1933​ the​ government​ registered​ the​ entire​ island​as​Chilean​public​land​(tierra fiscal).​It​declared​itself​“owner​of​Easter​ Island,​also​called​Rapa​Nui,”​with​an​area​of​15,796​hectares.​The​document​ says​that​Chile​acquired​the​island​through​occupation​by​virtue​of​article​ 590​of​the​Civil​Code​(Vergara​1939,​appendix​XLI).​This​article​states​that​ “all​the​land​situated​within​the​territorial​limits​that​lacks​another​owner​is​ 60 riet​Delsing

state​property”​(Vergara​1939,​appendix​XLIV).​The​commission’s​arguments​ were​correct​in​that​the​early​transactions​and​sales​to​the​Compañía​had​not​ been​registered​in​the​proper​government​office​(Rochna-​Ramírez​1996,​40),​ and​when​the​government​renewed​the​lease​with​the​Compañía​for​another​ twenty​years​in​1936,​it​referred​to​the​whole​island​except​for​the​land​occupied​by​“the​natives,​the​lepers​and​the​naval​authority.”10 ​ In​the​inscription​of​1933​the​Chilean​state​ignored​once​again​the​very​ existence​of​the​Rapanui​as​a​people​with​ancestral​rights​to​their​land​and​ territory.​This​time​Chile​stated​that​it​had​acquired​the​island​through​occupation,​not,​as​it​had​asserted​in​1888,​through​cession.​This​claim​was​not​ mentioned​again​in​later​discussions​about​the​Chilean​state’s​political​relationship​with​the​island,​possibly​because​it​would​have​put​Chile​in​a​bad​ light​on​the​international​legal​stage.11​The​Rapanui​were​not​informed​about​ the​inscription​of​their​entire​territory​as​public​land​and​became​aware​of​ this​act​more​than​thirty​years​later.12 ​ In​hindsight,​the​inscription​has​benefited​the​Rapanui​because​neither​ foreigners​nor​non-​Rapanui​Chileans​are​allowed​to​own​land​on​the​island.​ This​unintended​consequence​has​become​a​major​tool​in​the​hands​of​contemporary​ Rapanui​ to​ make​ a​ case​ for​ collective​ private​ landownership.​ Contrary​to​what​has​happened​in​other​Polynesian​island​states,​such​as​ Hawai‘i,​where​non–Hawaiian​Americans​and​foreigners​can​own​land,​the​ blunder​by​the​Chilean​state​in​1933​allowed​Rapanui​to​secure​their​lands,​ albeit​under​the​tutelage​of​that​very​state.

Chilean Integrationist Policies and the Privatization of Rapanui Lands The Easter Law (Ley Pascua) and the Pinochet Law (Ley Pinochet) ​ Several​ decades​ passed​ before​ two​ Chilean​ laws​ dealing​ with​ Rapanui​ landholding​ were​ enacted.​ In​ Law​ number​ 16.441,​ the​ so-​called​ Ley​ Pascua​of​1966,​the​Rapanui​were​recognized​for​the​first​time​as​full-​fledged​ Chilean​citizens.​It​authorized​the​president​of​the​Republic​to​grant​individual​property​titles​(títulos de dominio)​to​Chilean​nationals​in​urban​territories​ belonging​ to​ the​ state​ (territorios fiscales urbanos),​ and​ stipulated​ that​most​rural​lands​belonging​to​the​state​(tierras fiscales rurales)​could​be​ given​in​concession​to​Chilean​government​institutions.​The​Ley​Pascua​is​ significant​in​that​it​represents​the​first​time​private​landownership​in​Rapa​ Chile and Rapa Nui 61

Nui​was​introduced​through​a​Chilean​law.​In​the​name​of​equality,​this​right​ was​extended​not​only​to​Rapanui,​but​also​to​non-​Rapanui​Chilean​citizens.​ However,​these​dispositions​did​not​have​a​major​effect​on​the​island.​The​ titles​to​individual​ownership​referred​only​to​the​urban​area​of​Hanga​Roa,​ where​virtually​all​Rapanui​lived.​The​vast​majority​did​not​bother​to​get​land​ titles​for​places​where​they​and​their​families​had​been​living​for​several​decades.​No​titles​were​given​to​Chileans​living​on​the​island​on​the​basis​of​ the​Ley​Pascua​(Barrientos​1998,​6).​For​several​years​to​come,​remarkably,​ Rapanui​ islanders​ continued​ living​ their​ lives​ in​ their​ Hanga​ Roa​ homesteads​without​significant​changes​as​far​as​land​tenure​was​concerned. ​ A​much​bigger​step​toward​individual​private​landownership​was​taken​ in​1979,​when​the​Chilean​military​dictator​Augusto​Pinochet​issued​a​decree​ with​the​force​of​law​(DL-​2885)​that​became​known​as​the​Ley​Pinochet.13​ General​Pinochet​showed​a​special​interest​in​Rapa​Nui,​in​accordance​with​ his​ geopolitical​ views​ and​ nationalist​ goals​ for​ Chile,​ which​ included​ the​ homogenization​and​integration​of​the​Chilean​population​into​the​nation-​ state.​Consequently,​the​Rapanui​were​not​referred​to​as​a​people.​The​decree​gave​the​president​the​authority​to​extend​free​titles​in​urban​and​rural​ public​areas​(terrenos fiscales)​to​Chileans​born​on​the​island​whose​father​or​ mother​also​had​been​born​there.​These​titles​could​also​be​given​to​Chileans​not​born​on​the​island​if​one​of​their​parents​had​been​born​there,​had​ lived​there​for​at​least​five​years,​and​exercised​a​profession​or​permanent​activity​on​the​island.​In​practice​this​meant​that​Pinochet​was​giving​land​titles​ to​Rapanui,​although​in​theory​non-​Rapanui​who​were​born​on​the​island​ could​own​Rapanui​land.​Once​again,​no​reference​was​made​to​the​fact​that​ the​law​was​applicable​only​to​the​roughly​three​thousand​hectares​(out​of​a​ total​of​sixteen​thousand)​comprising​Hanga​Roa​and​its​vicinities,​to​which​ the​Rapanui​had​been​reduced​in​the​late​1800s.​This​law​decree​had​a​much​ more​invasive​effect​than​the​Ley​Pascua​since​its​intention​was​to​oblige​the​ Rapanui​to​take​land​titles.​The​law​was​reinforced​by​an​offer​of​subsidized​ government​housing,​which​could​be​obtained​only​if​land​titles​were​accepted​and​inscribed. ​ The​Ley​Pinochet​met​with​massive​resistance​from​the​Rapanui,​who​ felt​that​individual​land​distribution​was​being​forced​upon​them.​Their​reaction​was​to​form,​in​1980,​a​Consejo​de​Ancianos​(Council​of​Elders).14​ The​council’s​opposition​to​the​Ley​Pinochet​was​based​mainly​on​the​argument​that​the​Chilean​state​did​not​have​the​authority​to​give​titles​to​Rapanui​land.​As​one​Rapanui​clearly​put​it,​“Why​do​we​have​to​accept​a​title​of​ 62 riet​Delsing

something​that​is​already​mine?​It​is​as​if​somebody​wants​to​give​me​the​ shirt​I​am​wearing”​(Revista Análisis,​February​1988).​Nevertheless,​Rapanui​ started​to​inscribe​their​properties​and​acquire​private​property​titles​during​ the​1980s;​by​1990​the​number​who​had​done​so​totaled​359​(Gómez​2004).​ The​law​decree​stipulated​that​if​people​could​prove​they​had​been​living​on​ or​using​a​piece​of​land​for​more​than​ten​years,​they​would​have​the​right​ to​a​land​title.​The​validation​of​land​occupancy​(poseedor regular)​became​ a​very​popular​way​for​the​Rapanui​to​accept​land​titles.​The​recognition​of​ a​relationship​between​land​and​people​appealed​to​Rapanui​cultural​idiosyncrasy​(see​Andueza​2005).​Living​on​or​using​a​plot​of​land​for​agricultural​purposes​(or​both)​for​a​considerable​amount​of​time​reinforced​these​ connections.​Thus​some​Rapanui​responded​to​Chilean​laws,​although​not​ altogether​for​the​reasons​intended​by​the​legislator,​whose​purpose​was​to​ instill​the​concept​of​individual​private​property​in​Rapanui​cultural​practice​ and​turn​them​into​regular​Chileans​for​whom​private​ownership​is​a​basic​ cultural​paradigm. The Indigenous Law (Ley Indígena) ​ The​situation​changed​again​after​Chile’s​return​to​democracy​in​1990.​The​ indigenous​cause​was​high​on​the​agenda​of​Patricio​Aylwin,​the​first​democratically​elected​president​after​the​dictatorship.​In​1993​a​special​law​was​ issued,​the​so-​called​Ley​Indígena​(No.​19,253),​which​established​norms​of​ protection,​promotion,​and​development​of​Chile’s​indigenous​population.​ In​contrast​to​the​Ley​Pinochet,​which​aimed​at​absorbing​indigenous​people​ into​the​Chilean​population,​this​law​recognized​the​existence​of​indigenous​ people​and​their​differences.​The​Ley​Indígena​recognized​that​land​was​the​ lifeblood​of​indigenous​cultures.​Some​Rapanui​suggested​that​rather​than​ include​Rapa​Nui​in​the​Ley​Indígena,​the​Ley​Pascua​of​1966,​which​was​ specific​to​the​Rapanui,​be​amended​to​reflect​the​new​situation,​but​this​ initiative​went​nowhere.​These​Rapanui​argued​that​the​differences​between​ Rapa​Nui’s​Polynesian​population​and​American​indigenous​peoples​on​the​ mainland​are​too​great​to​include​them​both​in​a​single​law.15​The​Ley​Indígena,​like​previous​laws,​maintained​the​concept​of​individual​private​property,​although​it​states​explicitly​for​the​first​time​that​only​people​of​Rapanui​ descent​can​own​land​in​Rapa​Nui​and​that​the​land​cannot​be​transferred​ to​ non-​Rapanui.​ The​ National​ Corporation​ for​ Indigenous​ Development​ (conaDi)​was​formed​to​implement​the​Ley​Indígena​in​each​of​the​places​ where​indigenous​people​live. Chile and Rapa Nui 63

​ In​hindsight,​it​can​be​suggested​that​the​Ley​Indígena,​although​designed​ to​benefit​the​Rapanui​as​a​people,​has​had​several​negative​consequences​ in​Rapa​Nui.​First,​it​divided​the​Rapanui​community,​a​division​that​still​ exists​today.​The​Council​of​Elders​split​on​the​issue​of​land​distribution.​ The​council’s​leader​and​some​other​council​members​who​had​been​fervently​opposed​ to​the​Ley​Pinochet​ became​ strong​ supporters​ of​the​Ley​ Indígena.​Members​of​the​dissident​group,​who​opposed​private​land​titles,​ maintained​that​it​was​not​the​right​of​the​Chilean​government​to​impose​ land​distribution​in​Rapa​Nui. ​ This​situation​was​mainly​caused​by​a​complicated​interaction​between​ Rapanui​leaders​and​Chilean​party​politics.​In​general,​Rapanui​identify​with​ neither​Chilean​party​politics​nor​the​political​and​ideological​paradigms​on​ which​they​are​based,​since​they​have​no​historical​and​cultural​relevance​in​ Rapa​Nui.​Nevertheless,​leaders​of​the​Council​of​Elders​had​strongly​supported​Aylwin,​the​candidate​of​the​Center-​Left​government​coalition,​and​ felt​committed​to​the​Ley​Indígena.​The​result​was​that​the​dissident​group​ of​the​council​lined​up​with​the​opposition​to​the​newly​elected​Democratic​ government,​which​consists​of​an​ideological,​extreme​Right—erstwhile​defenders​of​the​dictatorship—and​a​more​moderate​neoliberal,​big​business– oriented​central​Right. ​ The​Ley​Indígena​also​created,​solely​for​Rapa​Nui,​a​Development​Commission​(coDeipa),​whose​membership​would​be​made​up​partly​of​Rapanui​and​partly​of​mainlanders.​It​consists​of​the​Rapanui​governor,​the​Rapanui​mayor,​the​head​of​the​Council​of​Elders,​five​members​elected​by​the​ Rapanui​community,​and​six​representatives​of​various​Chilean​ministries​ that​operate​on​the​island,​five​of​whom​are​continental​Chileans.​This​composition​ guarantees​ a​ Rapanui​ majority​ in​ the​ coDeipa .​ It​ was​ to​ be​ in​ charge​of,​among​other​things,​land​distribution​through​one​of​the​Chilean​ ministries​ (Bienes​ Nacionales).​The​split​in​the​Council​of​Elders​ created​ a​problem​because​the​ultimate​leader​of​the​council​would​be​one​of​the​ commission’s​ members.​ With​ two​ individuals​ claiming​ the​ leadership​ of​ the​Council​of​Elders,​the​Development​Commission​could​not​be​put​into​ operation​until​1998,​when​elections​were​held​in​the​Council​and​the​original​leader​won​by​a​narrow​margin.16 ​ An​even​more​serious​effect​of​the​Ley​Indígena​was​the​distribution​of​ fifteen​hundred​hectares​of​government-​owned​land​to​the​Rapanui.17​The​ ministry​in​charge​assigned​these​lands​in​plots​of​five​hectares​rather​haphazardly,​often​not​respecting​the​tribal​affiliations​of​the​applicants,​which​ 64 riet​Delsing

created​ problems​ between​ and​ discontent​ among​ Rapanui.​ Two​ hundred​ fifty-​nine​individual​land​titles​were​handed​out​in​2001.​Today,​some​twelve​ hundred​Rapanui​are​waiting​for​a​second​redistribution.​Many​who​earlier​ resisted​land​titles​have​now​registered.​Although​most​Rapanui​still​do​not​ agree​with​the​system​in​their​discourse,​they​submit​to​it​in​practice.​However,​the​government​is​in​the​process​of​adjusting​the​criteria​for​distribution,​as​there​is​not​enough​land​available,​so​the​plots​will​be​smaller​this​ time​around.​The​process​has​been​delayed,​and​in​2006​the​ coDeipa ​was​ still​revising​the​records​of​each​applicant,​which​has​created​a​lot​of​discontent​and​mistrust​in​the​community.18​Also,​a​new​relationship​with​the​ Chilean​government​is​in​the​making​(see​below),​and​this​may​reverse​the​ landholding​situation​altogether. ​ Another​negative​effect​of​the​land​delivery​is​that​Rapanui​have​started​ to​trade​their​plots​of​land​for​motorcycles,​used​cars,​and​other​material​ goods​of​their​liking,​which​has​allowed​some​Rapanui​to​accumulate​land.​ This​has​stimulated​the​development​of​a​real​estate​market,​albeit​between​ Rapanui,​in​the​past​couple​of​years,​unheard​of​before.​This​circumstance​ implies​ a​ further​ erosion​ of​ the​ concept​ of​ kainga,​ since​ it​ separates​ the​ Rapanui​further​from​their​traditional​clan​lands​and​disintegrates​their​traditional​social​organization.​The​Ley​Indígena​allows​for​individual​private​ property​but​to​the​detriment​of​collective​private​property. ​ Loopholes​in​the​law​have​also​permitted​outsiders​to​invest​in​the​island,​ a​phenomenon​that​requires​close​supervision​on​part​of​the​Rapanui.​An​ emblematic​case,​the​first​of​its​kind,​was​the​construction​and​inauguration​ in​early​2008​of​a​five-​star​hotel​by​the​exclusive​Chilean​hotel​chain​Explora.​ The​Explora​hotels​belong​to​the​Chilean​Pedro​Ibañez,​a​wealthy​businessman​and​entrepreneur.​After​consulting​for​several​years​with​various​Rapanui​families,​Explora​officials​convinced​a​successful​Rapanui​businessman,​ Mike​Rapu,​to​acquire​land​from​his​family​and​obtain​a​second​plot​from​ another​Rapanui—a​total​of​9.6​hectares—to​execute​this​project.​With​the​ help​of​various​lawyers​the​Ley​Indígena​was​bypassed.​When​I​asked​Rapu​ why​ he​ went​ ahead​ with​ this​ project,​ he​ repeatedly​ stressed​ the​ trust​ the​ owner​of​the​Explora​hotels​had​put​in​him​and​the​mistrust​other​Rapanui​ had​inspired​(interview​Mike​Rapu​Pate,​2006).​It​is​interesting​that​personal​ relations​seem​to​have​played​a​major​factor​in​such​a​significant​financial​ operation.​Explora​has​set​a​precedent​and​opened​the​door​to​future​foreign​ investments. ​ On​the​other​hand,​thanks​ to​the​Ley​Indígena,​ permission​ to​build​ a​ Chile and Rapa Nui 65

casino​in​Rapa​Nui​was​denied​on​legal​grounds​in​September​2006,​namely,​ because​that​the​Chilean​casino​law​and​the​Ley​Indígena​are​mutually​incompatible​(El Mercurio,​9​September​2006).​This​decision​put​an​end​to​a​ heated​yearlong​debate​in​Rapa​Nui​and​on​the​mainland​about​the​advantages​and​disadvantages​of​having​a​casino​on​the​island.​The​casino​law​requires​a​fifteen-​year​permit​to​operate,​while​according​to​the​Ley​Indígena​ indigenous​lands​can​be​rented​out​for​a​maximum​period​of​only​five​years.​ Even​though​these​five-​year​periods​are​renewable​in​the​Ley​Indígena,​the​ casino​law​does​not​allow​for​this​figure.​Both​conaDi ​and​coDeipa ​were​ against​ the​ casino,​ as​ was​ a​ large​ part​ of​ the​ Rapanui​ community.​ Rapanui​ University​ students​ residing​ on​ the​ mainland​ organized​ various​ protests​during​2006​in​Santiago​and​Valparaíso,​protests​in​which​I​participated.​The​Council​of​Elders​and​the​mayor​of​Rapa​Nui​were​in​favor​of​the​ casino.​Their​argument​was​that​the​project​would​bring​cash​to​the​island.​ The​casino​project,​which​involved​an​investment​of​fourteen​million​dollars,​was​a​joint​venture​of​a​Chilean​investor​and​a​Rapanui​businessman. ​ The​Ley​Indígena​has​thus​been​manipulated​and​has​had​unpredictable​ consequences​for​the​Rapanui​community​and​Chilean​lawmakers​alike.​The​ Rapanui​have​certainly​not​benefited​from​the​rules​and​regulations​imposed​ by​ a​ nation-​state​ that​ insists​ on​ sovereignty​ over​ a​ territory​ which​ it​ has​ abused​historically.

From Colonialism to Self-Determination? These​ discrepancies​ in​ the​ interpretation​ and​ use​ of​ existing​ law​ and​ the​ interplay​between​the​Chilean​state’s​intentions​and​Rapanui​discourse​and​ practice​can​also​be​seen​in​the​various​stages​of​political​status​the​Chilean​ state​has​imposed​on​the​Rapanui​people​and​their​territory. ​ Three​distinct​moments​can​be​distinguished​in​Chile’s​political​relationship​with​Rapa​Nui.​The​first​is​the​Annexation​of​1888,​when​Chile​asserted​ sovereignty​over​the​island.​As​discussed​earlier,​the​Republic​of​Chile​then​ quickly​lost​interest​in​its​insular​possession,​and​the​island​was​turned​into​ a​sheep​farm.​Arguably,​during​those​first​years​of​colonization​the​Rapanui​ were​barely​aware​of​the​presence​of​a​nation-​state​exercising​sovereignty​ over​the​island.​Chile’s​judicial​and​administrative​systems​were​imposed​in​ the​most​rudimentary​way.​The​situation​changed​somewhat​in​1917,​when​ Chile​declared​Rapa​Nui​to​be​a​subdelegation​(Subdelegación​Marítima)​of​

66 riet​Delsing

the​Naval​Department​(Gobernación​Marítima)​of​the​port​of​Valparaíso.​ Navy​officials​were​then​officially​named​as​representatives​of​the​Chilean​ government​in​Rapa​Nui,​and​the​connection​with​the​central​government​ was​channeled​through​its​Ministry​of​Defense.​This​situation​lasted​for​five​ decades.​During​those​years​the​Rapanui​endured​physical​and​psychological​abuses​by​representatives​of​the​Compañía​and​navy​officials​and​had​no​ constitutional​rights​whatsoever.​Nevertheless,​their​cultural​practices,​especially​their​language​and​social​organization,​remained​largely​intact. La Ley Pascua ​ This​state​of​affairs​changed​drastically​in​1966​with​the​passage​of​the​Ley​ Pascua.​A​young​Rapanui​schoolteacher,​one​of​the​first​Rapanui​educated​ on​the​mainland,​staged​a​rebellion​in​1964.19​Partly​as​a​result​of​this​revolt​ the​Ley​Pascua​was​approved​by​the​National​Congress​in​1966.​The​law​put​ an​end​to​navy​rule​and​created​the​Department​of​Easter​Island​as​part​of​ the​province​of​Valparaíso,​with​its​own​municipality​and​public​services​ (Makihara​1999,​101).​The​most​important​consequence​of​the​Ley​Pascua​is​ that​the​Rapanui​were​finally​recognized​as​Chilean​citizens​and​were​given​ the​right​to​vote. ​ After​ the​ law​ was​ passed,​ three​ hundred​ newcomers,​ mostly​ Chilean​ functionaries​and​their​families,​arrived​on​the​island​to​set​up​the​new​administrative​system​in​representation​of​Chilean​ministries​and​other​institutions.​Chilean​workers​were​brought​in​from​the​continent​for​the​construction​of​the​airport,​as​well​as​some​60​American​army​personnel​who​ came​to​set​up​a​base​for​surveillance​of​artificial​earth​satellites​in​compliance​with​an​agreement​between​the​Chilean​and​U.S.​Air​Force.​By​1968​ the​outsiders​added​up​to​a​total​of​665​people,​as​compared​with​a​Rapanui​ population​of​1,200,​with​the​result​that​there​were​more​foreign​and​continental​adults​than​Rapanui​adults​on​the​island​(Cristino​et​al.,​1984).​One​ can​only​imagine​the​impact​this​arrival​of​nonislanders​had​on​Rapanui’s​ lifestyle​and​world.​Besides​the​influx​of​people,​there​was​an​influx​of​goods​ and​services.​Electricity​and​piped​water​lines​were​installed,​and​roads​were​ built.​Trucks​and​jeeps​were​imported.​The​improvement​in​communications​ realized​by​the​building​of​the​airport​and​the​subsequent​air​traffic​opened​ the​island​up​to​the​world​in​an​unprecedented​way.​The​concentration​of​ services​and​government​buildings​in​Hanga​Roa​made​it​the​only​inhabited​center​on​the​island,​a​fact​which​loosened​the​ties​between​the​Rapanui​

Chile and Rapa Nui 67

and​their​ancestral​lands​even​more.​None​of​this​was​adequately​planned​ nor​anticipated​in​the​Ley​Pascua.​The​Chilean​legislators​failed​to​comprehend​and​predict​the​impact​Chilean​laws​and​institutions​would​have​on​the​ daily​life​of​the​Rapanui.​On​the​other​hand,​the​Chileans​who​were​assigned​ to​the​island​did​not​have​enough​cultural​sensitivity​to​perceive​these​possible​alterations​of​Rapanui​culture​and​social​organization.​The​Ley​Pascua​ fomented​westernization​in​a​way​the​Rapanui​are​still​coping​with​today,​ and​it​did​not​provide​tools​to​safeguard​cultural​difference​and​enhance​self-​ determination. La Comisión de Verdad Histórica y Nuevo Trato para los Pueblos Indígenas (Commission on Historic Truth and New Relationship with Indigenous Peoples) ​ Today,​almost​fifty​years​after​passage​of​the​Ley​Pascua,​another​change​ in​political​status​for​Rapa​Nui​is​in​the​making.​The​protests​by​Rapanui​ in​ the​ 1980s​ over​ land​ and​ territory​ strengthened​ their​ awareness​ of​ cultural​difference,​while​in​Chile​in​those​same​years​the​first​protests​against​ the​military​regime​led​to​the​recovery​of​democracy​in​1990,​after​seventeen​years​of​dictatorship.​Indigenous​rights​and​demands​appeared​on​the​ national​ agenda​ through​ the​ creation​ of​ the​ Ley​ Indígena​ in​ 1993,​ which​ informed​Chilean​civil​society​about​indigenous​issues​and​demands.​This​ process​culminated​in​2001​in​the​creation​of​a​government​entity​known​as​ the​Commission​on​Historic​Truth​and​New​Relationship​with​Indigenous​ Peoples​(La​Comisión​de​Verdad​Histórica​y​Nuevo​Trato​para​los​Pueblos​ Indígenas).​Then-​president​of​Chile​Ricardo​Lagos​charged​the​commission​ with​studying​the​historic​relationship​between​Chile’s​indigenous​peoples​ and​the​Chilean​state​and​suggesting​recommendations​for​new​state​policies​(una política de estado). ​ The​truth​commission​put​out​its​final​report​in​2003,​and​its​recommendations​for​Rapa​Nui​included​the​ratification​of​the​“Agreement​of​Wills”​ of​1888​by​the​National​Congress,​the​creation​of​a​statute​of​autonomy,​the​ recognition​of​the​exclusive​right​of​the​Rapanui​to​landownership​on​the​ island,​and​the​promotion​and​financing​of​development​programs​in​Rapa​ Nui​(Informe de la Comisión).​These​recommendations​were​formulated​by​ the​Rapanui​authorities​who​were​recognized​as​such​by​the​Chilean​government:​the​mayor,​the​head​of​the​Council​of​Elders,​and​the​governor,​in​his​ capacity​as​head​of​the​Rapanui​Development​Commission.

68 riet​Delsing

​ Another​set​of​recommendations​had​been​formulated​in​workshops​that​ took​ place​ on​ the​ island​ in​ 2002.​ The​ organizers​ of​ these​ workshops​ had​ been​elected​and​appointed​in​a​meeting​with​representatives​of​the​Chilean​ government​who​visited​the​island​in​February​2002​to​create​the​Rapanui​ chapter​of​the​truth​commission.​These​organizers​were​later​reconfirmed​in​ a​meeting​with​the​Rapanui​community.​Nevertheless,​their​final​report​was​ not​taken​into​consideration​and​was​replaced​by​a​text​presented​by​the​authorities​recognized​by​the​Chilean​government. El Parlamento Rapanui ​ Meanwhile,​ in​ 2001​ a​ group​ of​ Rapanui​ created​ the​ Rapanui​ Parliament,​several​of​whose​members​formerly​belonged​to​the​second​Council​ of​Elders,​which​virtually​dissolved​after​it​lost​the​elections​of​1998.​Their​ main​demand​was​that​the​Chilean​state​return​Rapanui​territory​and​that​ land​distribution​should​be​based​on​ancestral​principles.​They​also​declared​ autonomy​in​their​act​of​constitution​and​demanded​a​government​of​their​ own​ (Constitución Parlamentaria,​ 2001).​ The​ document​ does​ not​ specify​ what​exactly​is​meant​by​autonomy,​but​this​was​the​first​time​a​Rapanui​ organization​had​made​claims​to​self-government​during​the​Chilean​epoch. ​ Although​the​group​is​not​considered​to​be​a​serious​interlocutor​by​the​ Chilean​government​and​represents​only​a​minority​of​the​Rapanui​community,​it​has​earned​recognition​abroad​by​networking​informally​in​Polynesia​ and​the​Pacific.​Lately​they​have​also​represented​Rapa​Nui​in​international​ organizations​ in​ New​ York​ and​ Geneva,​ such​ as​ the​ United​ Nations​ Permanent​Forum​on​Indigenous​Issues,​the​United​Nations​Working​Group​ for​ Indigenous​ Populations,​ and​ the​ Indigenous​ Peoples​ Pacific​ Caucus,​ where​it​has​revealed​its​complaints​and​demands​to​the​Chilean​state.​In​ June​2006​some​members​of​the​Rapanui​Parliament​traveled​from​Rapa​ Nui​to​join​other​Rapanui​living​in​Europe​and​the​United​States​to​participate​in​a​meeting​of​the​nongovernmental​International​Forum​of​Indigenous​Peoples​(Fipau),​held​in​Pau,​France.​From​there​they​went​to​Geneva​ to​participate​in​ un ​meetings​held​parallel​to​and​in​conjunction​with​the​ important​meeting​of​the​recently​created​United​Nations​Human​Rights​ Council​in​July​2006.​In​both​instances​Rapanui​were​participating​in​international​arenas​as​indigenous​people​with​specific​rights​to​land,​territory,​ and​self​government,​thus​circumventing​a​nation-​state​they​consider​to​be​ in​violation​of​their​rights​as​a​people.

Chile and Rapa Nui 69

Special Status for Rapa Nui: A Special Territory with a Special Statute ​ For​several​years​Rapanui​authorities,​the​mayor​in​particular,​insisted​ on​the​need​for​a​política de estado​of​the​Chilean​government​toward​Rapa​ Nui.20​At​the​same​time​the​work​of​the​truth​commission​was​proceeding,​ Rapanui​authorities,​together​with​Chilean​public​personalities,​including​ ex-​president​Aylwin,​started​to​elaborate​a​proposal​for​a​Special​Statute​for​ the​Administration​of​Easter​Island.​It​took​almost​three​years​to​formulate​ and​was​completed​in​August​2005.​The​proposal​includes​a​reform​of​the​ Chilean​Constitution​in​order​to​create​Special​Territories​in​Easter​Island​ and​the​Archipelago​of​Juan​Fernández.​These​territories​would​have​a​certain​degree​of​administrative​autonomy​but​would​depend​directly​on​the​ central​government​(Propuesta​2005,​5–6). ​ In​the​meantime,​the​government​solicited​suggestions​from​the​Rapanui​community​as​to​what​should​be​included​in​the​proposal,​which​led​to​ passionate​discussions​on​the​island.​In​May​2006,​a​year​before​the​final​approval​of​the​special​territory​status,​the​local​office​of​conaDi ​organized​a​ seminar​that​lasted​several​days​and​gathered​some​seven​hundred​Rapanui​ to​discuss​a​government​proposal​similar​to​the​one​developed​by​the​public​ personalities​that​basically​maintains​the​existing​administrative​structure.​ The​difference​between​the​two​proposals​was​that​the​governor​of​Rapa​Nui​ would​no​longer​depend​on​the​Fifth​Region​(Valparaíso)​but​directly​on​the​ central​government​through​its​Ministry​of​the​Interior. ​ From​the​seminar​held​in​Rapa​Nui​several​discussion​groups​resulted,​ and​two​main​Rapanui​proposals​emerged​by​September​2006.​One​was​very​ similar​to​the​government’s​proposal​and​was​intended​to​increase​the​possibilities​of​being​taken​into​account​by​the​Chilean​government.​Nonetheless,​ this​group​of​Rapanui​insisted​that​there​should​be​a​local​government​at​ the​top​consisting​of​six​elected​Rapa​Nui​members,​alongside​the​governor​ (or​high​commissioner),​appointed​by​the​Chilean​president,​and​a​representative​of​the​Council​of​Elders.​The​other,​more​radical​proposal​insisted​ on​the​reinstallation​of​the​Kingdom​of​Rapa​Nui,​headed​by​an​ariki​and​ administered​by​a​Council​of​Elders​chosen​by​the​Rapanui​families,​with​ the​participation​of​one​representative​of​the​Chilean​government.​In​the​ discussions​of​these​two​proposals​the​importance​of​the​traditional​Rapanui​social​organization​based​on​the​thirty-​six​families​was​central,​as​was​ the​issue​of​land​and​territory​(kainga).​Even​the​more​moderate​proposal​ recommended​that​new​property​titles​not​be​extended​until​the​previously​ 70 riet​Delsing

completed​distribution​of​fifteen​hundred​hectares​had​been​properly​analyzed.​Both​proposals​also​insisted​that​any​future​land​distribution​should​ be​carried​out​according​to​the​territorial​divisions​of​each​clan.21 ​ To​assist​the​Rapanui​in​these​discussions​and​in​their​request,​the​Chilean​ government​appointed​an​international​consultant,​who​visited​the​island​in​ December​2006​and​made​recommendations​for​the​content​of​the​special​ statute.​He​emphasized​in​his​resulting​report​that​Chile’s​political​Constitution​determines​that​the​heads​of​regions​and​provincial​governors​have​the​ exclusive​trust​of​the​president​of​the​Republic​and​thus​cannot​be​elected​by​ popular​vote​(Gómez​2006).22​Unless​structural​changes​occur​in​the​highly​ centralized​model​of​the​Chilean​state,​it​will​be​difficult​for​the​Rapanui​to​ get​political​autonomy.​From​the​perspective​of​the​state,​the​only​thing​they​ can​aspire​to,​for​the​time​being,​is​administrative​autonomy. ​ Rapanui​have​complained​about​the​fact​that​they​do​not​have​the​appropriate​analytical​tools​to​discuss​the​Chilean​proposal​for​the​special​statute​ and​that​the​appointment​of​a​consultant​came​very​late​in​the​process.​The​ discussion​groups​worked​for​several​months​in​2006​on​a​daily​basis​without​fully​grasping​the​true​significance​of​the​centralized​character​of​the​ Chilean​state.​They​also​grappled​with​the​difficult​legal​language​in​which​ the​proposal​is​couched​and​would​sometimes​switch​from​Spanish​to​Rapanui​in​order​to​better​understand​the​meaning​of​specific​parts​of​the​proposal. ​ Toward​the​end​of​2006,​the​Chilean​government​organized​some​workshops​on​the​special​statute.​They​did​so​with​public​functionaries​on​the​ island​as​well​as​with​Rapanui​students​on​the​mainland.​On​both​occasions​ no​copies​of​the​government’s​document​were​made​available​to​the​participants​beforehand.​When​a​student​in​Santiago​asked​why​the​group​had​not​ received​this​relevant​documentation​so​they​could​have​studied​it​before​ the​meeting,​the​Rapanui​governor,​Carolina​Hotus,​who​was​present​at​the​ workshop,​answered​that​she​did​not​want​to​confuse​them​(personal​information).​This​lack​of​proper​orientation​seems​indicative​of​the​relations​the​ Chilean​government​maintains​with​the​Rapanui. ​ During​a​visit​by​President​Michelle​Bachelet​of​Chile​to​the​island​in​ November​ 2006,​ on​ her​ way​ back​ home​ from​ the​ yearly​ meeting​ of​ the​ Asia-​Pacific​Economic​Cooperation​held​in​Vietnam,​she​promised​more​ autonomy​for​Rapa​Nui,​but​she​did​not​differentiate​between​administrative​and​political​autonomy​and​thus​concealed​the​important​difference​between​the​two.​These​are​just​a​few​examples​of​how​the​Chilean​government​ Chile and Rapa Nui 71

is​still​not​sending​clear​signals​to​the​Rapanui​people​concerning​issues​of​ such​vital​importance​for​their​political​future.​There​may​be​more​than​one​ reason​for​this,​but​I​suggest​that​mistrust​of​the​Rapanui​people’s​capacity​ to​understand​Western​ways​of​thinking​is​one​of​them.​By​the​same​token,​ however,​Chileans​still​have​to​acquire​a​real​understanding​of​Rapanui​cultural​ways. ​ In​ January​ 2007​ a​ second​ seminar​ between​ the​ Rapanui​ discussion​ groups​and​Chilean​government​officials​from​the​Ministry​of​the​Interior​ took​place.​It​resulted​in​a​proposal​that​most​Rapanui​present​at​the​meeting​agreed​upon​(Propuesta unificada de Estatuto Especial de Administración de Rapa Nui).​The​main​points​of​this​proposal​are​the​following:​the​governor​of​Rapa​Nui,​appointed​by​the​Chilean​president,​would​form​part​of​ a​Council​(Koro Nui)​consisting​of​six​elected​members;​as​far​as​landholding​ goes,​ individual​ private​ landownership​ would​ be​ recognized​ only​ for​ those​individuals​who​already​have​secured​property​titles​to​date.​In​the​ rest​of​the​island​collective​landownership​would​be​applied​according​to​ “the​traditional​use​and​customs​that​existed​on​the​island​before​9​September​of​1888”;​all​public​land​being​used​for​government​purposes​would​be​ handed​over​to​a​Rapanui​corporation.23​The​proposal​about​collective​landownership​is​an​implicit​critique​of​all​Chilean​legislation​to​date​and​a​major​ manifestation​of​Rapanui​cultural​resilience​against​all​odds. ​ After​a​yearlong​process​of​discussions,​one​might​think​that​this​would​ have​been​the​final​consensus​proposal​on​the​part​of​the​Rapanui.​But​it​was​ not.​Mayor​Petero​Edmunds​blocked​the​proposal​by​sending​a​letter​to​the​ Ministry​of​the​Interior​in​February​2007​in​which​he​argued​that​the​signers​ of​the​draft​proposal​were​not​representative​of​the​Rapanui​people​and​as​a​ matter​of​fact​were​opposing​the​government​of​La Concertación—the​ruling​ government​coalition—and​that​he​and​the​head​of​the​Council​of​Elders,​ the​Rapanui’s​legitimate​representatives,​had​not​been​invited​to​participate​ in​the​discussions.24​He​also​stated​that​the​proposal​contradicts​the​Chilean​ Constitution​ and​ the​ principle​ of​ a​ unitarian​ state.​ Further,​ he​ expressed​ opposition​to​the​proposed​expropriation​of​the​land​for​the​Hotel​Hanga​ Roa,​defended​the​rights​of​Chilean​inhabitants​on​the​island,​and​stated​ that​the​majority​of​Rapanui​do​not​wish​to​be​separated​from​Chile.​He​also​ emphasized​that​all​the​preparatory​work​for​the​special​statute​had​already​ been​done​by​the​Grupo​de​Personalidades,​of​which​he​himself​formed​part. ​ In​July​2007,​Law​no.​20.193​reformed​the​political​Constitution​of​Chile,​

72 riet​Delsing

allowing​the​category​of​Special​Territory​to​Rapa​Nui​and​the​Archipelago​ Juan​ Fernández,​ whose​ government​ and​ administration​ has​ to​ be​ determined​by​a​special​statute​established​by​a​Ley orgánica constitucional​(constitutional​ organic​ law).​ Not​ until​ May​ of​ 2008​ was​ a​ new​ proposal​ for​ a​ special​statute​finally​presented​to​Congress,​without​any​further​input​or​ approval​from​the​Rapanui​community​in​open​meetings.​The​newly​elected​ representative​ of​ conaDi ,​ Rafael​ (Rinko)​ Tuki,​ who​ participated​ in​ the​ workshops​on​the​topic​in​2006​and​whose​signature​appears​on​the​draft​ proposal​of​January​2007,​does​not​agree​with​the​content​(personal​information). ​ One​can​distinguish​at​least​three​points​of​view​in​present-​day​Rapanui​ politics​ in​ the​ context​ of​ the​ discussions​ around​ Special​ Territory​ Status.​ One​group​of​Rapanui​proposes​to​try​to​convince​the​Chilean​state​to​incorporate​Rapanui​wishes​for​self-​government,​especially​in​relation​to​collective​landownership,​but​is​willing​to​compromise​as​to​the​ultimate​political​ authority​over​the​island.​Implicitly,​these​Rapanui​accept​de​facto​Chilean​ sovereignty​over​Rapanui​territory.​A​small​group,​mainly​belonging​to​the​ Rapanui​Parliament,​insists​that​the​Agreement​of​Wills​of​1888​was​illegal​ and​wants​to​proceed​from​that​point,​in​the​full​knowledge​that​the​Chilean​ state​will​not​respond​to​this​request.​It​is​not​quite​clear​what​the​political​ agenda​of​the​current​official​leaders​of​Rapa​Nui​is.​Although​they​have​ waged​a​historical​struggle​for​Rapanui​rights,​they​now​insist​on​the​rights​ of​the​Chilean​nation-​state​over​Rapa​Nui.

Conclusion I​ have​ shown​ here​ that​ the​ relationship​ between​ Chile​ and​ Rapa​ Nui​ is​ marked​by​Chile’s​insistent​claim​of​sovereignty​over​Rapanui​territory.​Successive​laws​and​decrees​have​put​a​strong​emphasis​on​the​privatization​of​ land,​in​order​to​replace​ideas​of​collective​private​landownership.​The​separation​of​the​Rapanui​from​their​ancestral​lands​(kainga)​and​the​relentless​ insistence​on​the​benefits​of​small-​scale​private​landownership​have​eroded​ Rapanui​customary​law,​as​was​predicted​by​Pedro​Pablo​Toro​more​than​a​ century​ago. ​ Chile’s​actions​on​the​island​are​determined​by​the​shifting​concerns​of​ successive​governments​and​by​the​persisting​concept​of​a​unitarian​state.​ Since​the​late​1960s—coinciding​with​the​integration​of​Rapa​Nui​into​the​

Chile and Rapa Nui 73

national​ administrative​ system—Chile​ has​ gone​ through​ various​ political​ stages,​ including​ the​ first​ freely​ elected​ Socialist​ government​ in​ Latin​ America​and​a​brutal​dictatorship.​Such​laws​as​the​Easter​Law​of​1966,​the​ Pinochet​Law​Decree​of​1979,​and​the​Indigenous​Law​of​1993​clearly​reflect​ the​ political​ philosophy​ of​ these​ respective​ governments.​ Nevertheless,​ Chilean​legislators​of​all​political​colors​have​insisted​on​the​importance​of​ individual​private​landownership,​the​trademark​of​Western​civilization. ​ These​legal​interventions,​based​on​a​political​system​alien​to​the​Rapanui​worldview,​have​caused​cultural​misunderstandings​that​are​little​understood​and​need​to​be​clarified​by​both​Rapanui​and​Chileans.​I​argue​that​ during​the​twentieth​century​Chilean​lawmakers​failed​to​conceptualize​the​ important​differences​between​individual​and​collective​private​landownership,​while​only​the​latter​makes​cultural​sense​for​many​Rapanui.​I​also​contend​that​over​the​past​several​years​Chilean​politicians​have​been​covering​ up​the​important​difference​between​administrative​and​political​autonomy,​ under​the​circumstance​that​self-​determination​is​so​important​if​the​Rapanui​are​to​achieve​their​cultural​goals. ​ It​can​also​be​suggested​that​the​Chilean​state’s​interventions​in​Rapa​Nui​ have​created​divisions​between​Rapanui​during​the​period​under​consideration​ in​ this​ essay.​ Because​ of​ Rapa​ Nui’s​ colonial​ dependence​ on​ Chile,​ Rapanui​leaders​are​virtually​obliged​to​work​within​both​systems​and​participate​in​the​intricate​institutional​and​political​structure​that​Chile​has​ imposed​on​Rapa​Nui.​Although​they​are​considered​by​Chilean​politicians​ as​ their​ main​ liaison​ with​ Rapa​ Nui,​ these​ leaders​ are​ often​ out​ of​ touch​ with​their​people.​The​consequence​has​been​a​lack​of​strong​leadership​over​ the​past​several​years,​causing​disinterest​in​common​cultural​goals​among​ a​considerable​part​of​the​Rapanui​community.​It​has​also​caused​internal​ power​struggles​between​Rapanui​that​are​difficult​to​assess​and​overcome.​ Cooptation​of​indigenous​leaders​is​a​well-​known​colonial​strategy,​and​one​ can​see​it​at​work​in​Rapa​Nui. ​ Chilean​ legislation​ has​ met​ with​ Rapanui​ resistance​ over​ the​ past​ decades,​as​we​saw​in​the​general​rejection​of​the​different​laws,​all​aimed​at​the​ privatization​of​Rapanui​land.​Several​Rapanui​now​insist​on​reviving​this​ connection​with​the​land​and​their​traditional​social​organization,​which​ are​so​intimately​connected.​At​the​same​time,​some​Rapanui​have​started​ to​ articulate​ their​ cultural​ difference​ as​ a​ Polynesian​ people​ and​ to​ organize​accordingly.​These​Rapanui​are​pointing​out​the​cultural​blunders​committed​in​every​single​piece​of​Chilean​legislation​and​are​asking​for​political​ 74 riet​Delsing

self-​determination,​even​if​within​the​Chilean​nation-​state.​Only​a​profound​ change​of​the​Chilean​Constitution​would​allow​this​to​happen. ​ Whatever​the​decisions​made​by​Chilean​governments,​the​Rapanui​will​ continue​on​the​path​toward​self-​determination,​supported​by​other​Pacific​ peoples​and​the​international​community.​At​the​same​time,​Chilean​civil​ society​will,​one​hopes,​guide​its​political​leaders​in​the​direction​of​a​participatory​democracy,​in​which​cultural​difference​becomes​an​asset​instead​ of​a​threat​to​sovereignty.​These​two​processes​of​social​and​political​change,​ in​Rapa​Nui​as​well​as​in​Chile,​have​a​certain​degree​of​urgency.

Notes ​ 1.​In​accordance​with​common​practice​in​the​literature​I​use​the​terms​Rapa Nui​ when​referring​to​the​island​and​Rapanui​when​referring​to​the​people,​the​language,​ etc. ​ 2.​This​translation​problem​can​be​compared​with​a​similar​one​surrounding​the​ Treaty​of​Waitangi,​accorded​between​the​Maori​of​Aotearoa/New​Zealand​and​the​ British​Crown​(see​Fenton​and​Moon​2002). ​ 3.​In​the​early​days​the​ariki-mau​was​the​head​of​the​Miru​clan,​the​paramount​ chief​and​undisputed​leader​of​the​island.​In​the​later​period​the​island​was​no​longer​ united,​and​the​leaders​of​the​clans​challenged​each​other​in​a​yearly​contest.​After​the​ dissemination​of​the​Rapanui​population​at​the​end​of​the​nineteenth​century​and​ the​breakdown​of​the​clan​system,​there​was​only​one​ariki,​whom​the​Rapanui​called​ kin,​after​the​Eng​lish​term​king.​I​have​heard​contemporary​Rapanui​argue​that​it​is​ not​clear​if​the​term​ariki​means​“chief ”​or​“king.” ​ 4.​The​concept​of​kainga​has​more​than​one​meaning.​I​use​it​here​as​a​territorial​ unit,​constituting​the​estate​of​a​clan​or​descent​group​(see​Métraux​1971;​Kirch​2000,​ 272) ​ 5.​President​José​Manuel​Balmaceda​(1886–91)​committed​suicide​in​1891,​at​the​ end​of​the​civil​war,​which​lasted​for​seven​months​and​caused​between​five​and​ten​ thousand​Chilean​deaths​(Loveman​2001,​159;​Subercaseaux,​1997,​16).​The​Chilean​ cultural​historian​Bernardo​Subercaseaux​argues​that​the​war​took​place​at​the​crossroads​of​Chile’s​passage​to​a​“social,​economic​and​political​modernity”​and​that​the​ year​1891​“has​been​conceived​as​a​kind​of​metaphor​of​the​modern​country”​(1997,​ 34–36).​Chile,​says​Subercaseaux,​forged​itself​as​a​modern​nation-​state​in​the​reconstruction​period​after​the​war,​in​which​a​new​political​and​ideological​landscape​ formed​and​new​social,​cultural,​and​political​actors​appeared.​This​difficult​process​ of​striving​for​internal​national​cohesion​may​have​distracted​attention​from​Chile’s​ adventure​in​the​Pacific. ​ 6.​E.g.,​Daniel​María​Teave,​thirty-​six​years​of​age,​owner​of​the​lands​between​ Chile and Rapa Nui 75

Hotu​’Iti​and​Hanga​Te’e;​Timoteo​Pate,​thirty-​six​years​of​age,​owner​of​part​of​Poike;​ Simeon​Riroroko,​twenty-​one​years​of​age,​owner​of​Anakena,​etc.​(El Consejo​1988,​ 297). ​ 7.​ This​ information​ comes​ from​ an​ interview​ I​ conducted​ in​ 2002​ with​ Naval​ Governor​Patricio​Carrasco,​who​told​me​that​no​navy​records​on​the​island​exist​ before​1990. ​ 8.​On​several​occasions​Chilean​governments​have​preferred​not​to​officially​intervene​in​Rapanui​concepts​of​land​tenure,​presumably​because​these​did​not​interfere​ in​Chilean​mainland​politics.​On​the​other​hand,​most​Rapanui​do​not​readily​make​ the​connection​between​sovereignty​and​territory.​Only​very​recently​have​some​Rapanui​started​to​openly​question​the​Chilean​claim​that​the​island​is​Chilean​territory. ​ 9.​Since​the​annexation​the​Rapanui​had​elected​ariki​in​place​who​were​in​constant​disagreement​with​the​Chilean​sheep​farmers.​The​situation​had​become​unsustainable​by​1902,​when​the​commander​of​the​yearly​navy​ship​General Baquedano​ named​Juan​Tepano,​a​Rapanui,​as​“chief​or​cacique​with​the​task​of​vigilance​and​representative​of​the​islanders​for​the​subdelegado marítimo​[port​captain]”​(Document​ of​the​Ministry​of​National​Defense).​This​was​a​strategic​colonial​decision,​since​ the​navy​needed​a​buffer​between​the​company​and​the​Rapanui.​As​a​youth​Tepano​ had​served​in​the​Chilean​army​during​the​War​of​the​Pacific​and​had​been​acculturated,​so​to​speak.​It​was​the​first​time​the​Chileans​intervened​in​Rapanui​leadership​ decisions.​The​commander​also​ordained​that​Tepano​was​to​be​subordinate​to​the​ company​representative​and​subdelegado,​and​he​took​five​of​the​resistance​leaders​to​ Chile​(Ministerio de Marina. Oficios de la Dirección General de la Armada,​1902). ​ 10.​This​information​is​extracted​from​a​document​of​1936​of​the​Chilean​Ministry​ of​Defense.​It​refers​to​“13.747​hectares”​out​of​15.796. ​ 11.​ Contemporary​ international​ law​ distinguishes​ four​ ways​ of​ exercising​ sovereignty​over​territories,​namely,​by​occupation,​prescription,​conquest,​or​cession​ (Wallace​1997,​92–100).​Occupation​refers​to​the​situation​in​which​a​state​establishes​ title​to​a​territory​which​is​terra nullius,​this​is,​owned​by​no​one​or​inhabited​by​savages.​The​argument​for​occupation​is​difficult​to​sustain​in​Rapa​Nui​because​it​was​a​ stratified​and​organized​Polynesian​society​at​the​time​of​the​Chilean​takeover.​After​ all,​it​was​the​ariki​who​signed​the​treaty​with​the​Chileans.​Prescription​refers​to​ the​situation​in​which​sovereignty​can​be​invoked​by​claimants​who​discovered​and​ occupied​a​territory​and​who​want​to​consolidate​their​claim.​A​state​can​validate​an​ initially​doubtful​title,​provided​that​the​display​of​authority​is​public,​peaceful,​and​ continuous.​Prescription​thus​involves​a​de​facto​exercise​of​sovereignty​(Wallace​ 1997,​ 97).​ This​ situation​ is​ also​ referred​ to​ as​ occupation​ cum animo domini.​ The​ Chilean​state​argues​that​it​exercised​public,​peaceful,​and​continuous​authority​over​ the​island.​However,​contemporary​international​law​establishes​that​“another​claimant​or​a​dispossessed​sovereign​can​bar​the​establishment​of​title​by​prescription”​ (Wallace​ 1997,​ 97).​ This​ is​ a​ possibility​ to​ be​ explored​ by​ contemporary​ Rapanui.​ 76 riet​Delsing

Sovereignty​through​conquest​refers​to​the​acquisition​of​enemy​territory​by​military​ force​in​wartime.​This​is​clearly​not​the​case​for​Rapa​Nui.​Cession​is​the​transfer​of​ sovereignty​by​one​sovereign​to​another.​This​is​the​argument​for​Chilean​sovereignty​ over​Rapa​Nui​most​frequently​used​today,​by​Chileans​and​Rapanui​alike.​However,​the​recent​translation​of​the​Rapanui​version​of​the​cession​and​proclamation​ documents​unsettles​this​argument,​as​it​shows​that,​according​to​this​translation​of​ the​Rapanui​version​of​the​treaty,​the​Rapanui​chiefs​did​not​cede​their​territory​to​ the​Chilean​state.​I​argue​that​the​only​way​for​Chile​to​claim​sovereignty​today​is​ through​prescription,​but​that​the​Rapanui​can​object​to​this​by​means​of​diplomatic​ protests​in​the​appropriate​international​forums​(Wallace​1997,​97). ​ 12.​Another​act,​carried​out​without​the​consultation​of​the​Rapanui,​was​the​creation​of​the​Rapanui​National​Park​and​its​nomination​as​a​National​Historic​Monument​in​1935​(Makihara​1999,​86). ​ 13.​This​decree​corresponded​to​a​more​general​policy​of​privatization​of​agricultural​lands,​mostly​belonging​to​indigenous​people​on​the​mainland,​mainly​the​ Mapuche.​In​1979​Pinochet​issued​a​decree​(DL​2.536)​that​did​away​with​Mapuche​ communal​ landownership.​ This​ was​ followed​ by​ another​ one​ in​ 1980​ (DL​ 3.516)​ allowing​for​the​division​of​land​into​small​plots​of​half​a​hectare,​thereby​violating​ Mapuche​cultural​principles.​These​decrees​formed​part​of​a​profound​legal​transformation​carried​out​between​1978​and​1981​that​reformulated​all​former​dispositions​ about​property​rights​over​natural​resources.​The​purpose​of​these​reforms​was​the​ implementation​of​an​economic​model​focused​on​exportation​(Toledo​2005,​5). ​ 14.​This​council​was​still​headed​by​its​first​leader,​Alberto​Hotus,​in​2007​and​still​ exists​today.​It​is​composed​of​representatives​of​the​thirty-​six​Rapanui​families​that​ trace​their​ancestry​to​the​original​tribes.​Its​purpose​is​to​defend​both​the​Rapanui’s​ right​to​their​land,​territory,​and​culture​and​other​Rapanui​interests​(see​El Consejo de Jefes de Rapa Nui . . . ,​1988). ​ 15.​Personal​communication,​Alfonso​Rapu. ​ 16.​ The​ head​ of​ the​ council​ has​ created​ a​ system​ of​ patronage​ over​ the​ years.​ Alongside​his​central​role​in​the​council,​he​has​held​several​important​government​ posts​and​has​built​a​power​base​on​the​island​and​on​the​mainland​that​is​hard​to​ match​and​difficult​to​contest.​His​consistent​support​on​the​mainland​can​be​explained​by​the​fact​that​he​has​been​loyal​to​the​Center-​Left​government​coalition​in​ power​since​the​return​to​democracy​in​1990.​Especially​through​his​role​as​national​ advisor​of​ conaDi ,​he​has​been​able​to​influence​the​intricate​Rapanui​family​network​by​handing​out​favors​in​exchange​for​votes. ​ 17.​This​gesture​corresponded​again​partly​to​a​Chilean​election​campaign. ​ 18.​ This​ information​ comes​ from​ interviews​ I​ conducted​ in​ 2001​ with​ Alvaro​ Durán​ (lawyer​ for​ conaDi )​ and​ Alvaro​ Lafuente​ and​ Rodrigo​ Sepúlveda​ (functionaries​of​the​Ministerio​de​Bienes​Nacionales),​and,​in​2006,​with​Luis​Guillermo​ Alvarez​(also​a​functionary​in​Bienes​Nacionales). Chile and Rapa Nui 77

​ 19.​A​Chilean​association​by​the​name​of​Friends​of​Easter​Island​had​arranged​ through​the​Ministry​of​Education​for​eleven​scholarships​to​be​awarded​to​students​ to​study​on​the​mainland,​since​no​secondary​education​existed​on​the​island.​One​ of​the​students,​Alfonso​Rapu​Haoa,​was​only​thirteen,​the​youngest​of​the​group.​He​ returned​to​the​island​eight​years​later​with​a​teaching​degree​in​hand.​He​says​that​ in​Santiago​he​was​“always​very​concerned​about​the​great​poverty​and​abandonment​ that​my​people​suffered,​my​family,​my​brothers​and​sisters,​and​I​started​to​think​ about​how​to​take​them​out​of​that​world,​get​them​out​of​the​darkness​and​put​them​ in​the​light,​so​they​would​be​able​to​walk”​(interview,​17​May​2002). ​ 20.​The​concept​of​política de estado​became​part​of​the​Chilean​political​vocabulary​at​the​beginning​of​the​2000s.​The​mayor​probably​adopted​the​term​from​Chile. ​ 21.​This​information​was​gathered​during​my​visit​to​the​island​in​August–December​2006,​during​which​I​participated​regularly​in​the​meetings​of​one​of​the​discussion​groups. ​ 22.​In​meetings​between​Gómez​and​Rapanui​that​participated​in​the​discussion​ groups,​he​said​that​nation-​states​have​made​indigenous​peoples​invisible,​that​there​ is​no​mutual​understanding​between​the​Chilean​state​and​Rapanui​as​yet,​and​that​ it​is​important​to​pay​attention​to​the​kind​of​language​employed​in​conversations​ between​the​two​parties.​He​also​emphasized​the​power​of​organizing. ​ 23.​The​proposal​also​contains​recommendations​for​a​special​budget,​the​creation​ of​a​special​body​for​the​defense​and​protection​of​Rapanui​culture​and​cultural​patrimony,​and,​crucially,​for​the​regulation​of​immigration​to​the​island.​Uncontrolled​ immigration​is​one​of​the​main​complaints​the​Rapanui​have.​Although​I​firmly​agree​ with​the​importance​of​this​issue,​I​do​not​address​it​in​this​essay. ​ 24.​By​not​participating​in​any​of​the​workshops​or​other,​more​general​meetings​organized​with​the​Rapanui​community​in​2006,​the​mayor​and​the​head​of​the​ Council​of​Elders,​Alberto​Hotus,​marginalized​themselves.

78 riet​Delsing

in​part​2,​bounded​on​both​sides​by​sections​that​establish​a​dialogue​between​North​and​South,​are​about​Latin​America.​Taken​ together,​they​tell​a​particularly​Latin​American​story​of​more​than​a​generation​of​activism​and​cross-​cultural​collaboration​between​Native​communities​and​their​intellectuals​on​one​side​and​non-​Native​radical​intellectuals​on​the​other.​While​the​three​essays​are​quite​different,​a​fact​I​explore​ below,​the​similarities​among​them​help​us​understand​an​especially​salient​ moment​in​the​history​of​continental​indigenous​peoples​across​the​Latin​ American​region. ​ In​ contrast​ to​ Native​ peoples​ based​ in​ the​ continental​ United​ States,​ whose​struggles​have​often​revolved​around​the​recognition​of​treaty-​based​ rights​and​the​achievement​of​federal​recognition—something​that​Kauanui’s​essay​on​Hawai‘i​in​part​1​helps​us​put​in​a​more​complex​context— indigenous​peoples​in​Latin​America​have​historically​struggled​mainly​at​ the​ individual​ community​ level.​ This​ is​ because​ the​ process​ of​ colonization​in​most​cases​reorganized​indigenous​society​from​the​start,​breaking​ down​regional​or​imperial​coalitions​and​rearticulating​local​societies​and​ their​leaders​to​an​emerging​colonial​state.​By​the​beginning​of​the​twentieth​century,​this​history​had​generated​two​interrelated,​though​sometimes​ contradictory,​ trends​ in​ the​ relationship​ between​ Native​ peoples​ and​ national​states.​While​Native​struggles​for​cultural​preservation​and​economic​ viability​were​usually​organized​around​the​protection​of​communal​political​autonomy,​often​the​only​way​to​protect​local​lands​was​by​demanding​ that​the​national​state​intervene​against​rapacious​regional​landowners.​As​ a​result,​indigenous​peoples​in​twentieth-​century​Latin​America​were​often​ caught​between​ethnocultural​imperatives​on​one​side​and​the​need​to​form​ part​of​broader​popular,​class-​based​coalitions​on​the​other. ​ These​ competing​ alliances​ and​ loyalties​ were​ made​ even​ more​ complicated​ by​ the​ emergence​ of​national-​popular​ states.​ Beginning​ with​ the​ Mexican​Revolution​of​1910​and​spreading​through​the​region​in​the​wake​ of​the​Great​Depression​of​the​1930s,​coalitions​of​middle-​class​politicians​ and​popular​sectors​instituted​welfare-​oriented​states.​While​in​some​cases,​ such​as​Mexico​and​Bolivia,​the​measures​instituted​by​these​states​included​ agrarian​reform,​everywhere​they​also​aimed​to​integrate​indigenous​peoples​ into​the​nation​through​education.​As​Native​peoples​confronted​the​promtHe tHree essays

ise​ of​ resources​ in​ conjunction​ with​ the​ requirement​ of​ integration,​ the​ emergence​of​indigenous​political​identities​occurred​both​from​within​and​ against​the​legacy​of​the​national-​popular​state.​And​given​the​two-​pronged​ nature​of​indigenous​political​mobilization,​non-​Native​collaborators​have​ been​an​important​presence​throughout​the​twentieth​century. ​ The​three​regions​treated​in​part​2​exhibit​some​important​contrasts​in​ this​general​history.​In​the​state​of​Chiapas,​in​southeastern​Mexico,​political​ and​economic​reform​has​been​postponed​through​much​of​Mexico’s​modern​history.​The​Mexican​Revolution​came​late​to​Chiapas​and​mainly​from​ outside,​ and​ when​ the​ indigenous​ communities​ were​ integrated​ into​ the​ emerging​postrevolutionary​state​in​the​1930s​it​was​at​the​cost​of​accepting​ the​emergence​of​a​new​local​elite​under​the​hegemony​of​the​official​revolutionary​party.​In​the​Cauca​Valley​in​Colombia,​where​the​indigenous​groups​ that​form​part​of​the​ cric ​are​located,​the​Nasa​and​Guambiano​peoples​ have​experienced​a​parallel​history​of​marginalization​and​postponement.​ At​the​same​time,​given​the​Colombian​state’s​ongoing​difficulties​with​effective​national​integration,​they​were​sometimes​able​to​transform​their​marginalization​into​a​form​of​cultural​preservation.​Still,​in​both​the​Mexican​ and​Colombian​cases,​the​indigenous​peoples​featured​here​have​lived​on​ the​margins​of​emerging​national​states.​The​Quechua​communities​of​the​ Cochabamba​Valley​in​Bolivia,​on​the​other​hand,​have​often​been​considered​the​showcase​of​the​agrarian​reform​realized​by​the​Bolivian​Revolution​ of​1952​and​have​historically​had​a​reputation​as​combative​and​central​to​the​ populist​politics​of​the​Bolivian​state.​The​importance​of​the​valley’s​peasant​ unions​and​the​close​relationship​they​have​with​Quechua​communal​organizations​emerge​in​large​part​from​this​history. ​ The​three​essays​presented​here​discuss​the​past​twenty​to​thirty​years,​ when​the​role​of​the​nonindigenous​collaborator​has​been​transformed​as​ the​viability​of​the​national-​popular​state​has​unraveled.​The​three​essays​explore​the​implications​of​this​transformation,​in​distinct​contexts​and​with​ different​results.​Not​only​are​the​rules​and​parameters​of​the​collaborations​ different,​but​so​is​the​nature​of​the​indigenous​society​and​of​the​political​ activity​to​which​the​collaborators​are​connected.​Equally​important,​the​collaborators​themselves​occupy​diverse​positions​within​their​own​societies. ​ As​ a​ nonindigenous​ Ecuadorian​ linguist​ specializing​ in​ Quichua,​ Fernando​ Garcés​ V.​ has​ chosen​ to​ collaborate​ with​ Conosur Ñawpagman,​ a​ Quechua-​language​newspaper​produced​and​circulated​in​the​southern​corner​of​the​Cochabamba​Valley.​In​this​politically​militant​region,​which​gave​ Indigenous Writing and Collaboration 81

birth​to​now-​president​Evo​Morales’s​Movimiento​Al​Socialismo,​the​newspaper​has​evolved​into​an​instrument​at​the​service​of​the​peasant​union​that​ connects​different​Quechua​communities​in​their​ongoing​struggle​to​preserve​their​land,​culture,​language,​and​local​knowledge.​Under​these​conditions,​ Garcés​ considers​ that​ the​ editorial​ team​ of​ the​ newspaper​ serves​ as​a​bridge​between​the​rich​metaphorical​lexicon​of​oral​Quechua​and​the​ conventions​of​the​written​word​and​can​be​a​powerful​example​of​more​ effective​ways​to​standardize​written​Quechua​on​the​basis​of​contemporary​ practice.​At​the​same​time,​the​language​itself​must​be​defended​through​ writing​and​through​the​creative​inscription​of​orality​in​written​form,​but​ with​the​specific​purpose​of​defending​the​culture​and​communal​resources​ from​colonial​appropriation.​As​a​result,​then,​the​newspaper​collaborates​ with​Quechua​peasant​organizations​in​a​sort​of​“globalization​from​below.” ​ The​dialogue​and​collaboration​featured​in​the​essay​by​Joanne​Rappaport​ and​Abelardo​Ramos​Pacho,​as​they​point​out,​has​been​ongoing​for​three​ decades,​although​the​specific​project​discussed​here​is​a​history​of​an​intercultural​ and​ bilingual​ education​ project​ formulated​ by​ Consejo​ Regional​ Indígena​del​Cauca​(cric).​Articulated​with​and​by​the​ cric ,​this​historical​research​project​was​successful,​the​authors​explain,​precisely​because​it​ articulated​different​cultural​registers​and,​through​their​mutual​interrogation,​reimagined​them​all.​The​intermediate​bridge​position​also​discussed​ by​Garcés​is​here​inhabited​by​both​Native​and​non-​Native​intellectuals​and​ researchers,​who​together​struggle​to​harness​their​research​agenda​to​the​ priorities​of​the​cric ,​which​are​themselves​the​collective​product​of​a​conversation​ among​ traditional​ communal​ authorities,​ shamanic​ specialists,​ local​teachers,​and​non-​Native​collaborators.​As​Ramos​explains,​one​can​ see​research​as​a​minga—collective​work​by​and​for​the​benefit​of​the​community.​This​is​an​example​of​indigenous​theorizing,​which​takes​shape​in​a​ multiethnic​and​intercultural​environment​in​which​translation​entails​the​ improvement​as​well​as​the​reinterpretation​of​ideas​and​concepts. ​ The​essay​by​Jan​Rus​and​Diane​Rus​takes,​in​their​own​words,​the​form​of​ a​diary​that​traces​the​emergence​of​the​Taller​Tzotzil,​an​indigenous​publishing​project,​in​the​context​of​a​dramatically​changing​world​among​Tzotzil​ Maya​communities​in​Chiapas​between​the​1970s​and​the​present.​In​contrast​to​the​other​essays,​which​strive​to​theorize​about​indigenous​knowledge​and​literacy​and​to​decolonize​existing​intellectual​categories​and​practices​from​the​perspective​of​indigenous​epistemologies,​the​Ruses’​narrative​ traces​ the​ economic,​ political,​ and​ cultural​ changes​ on​ the​ ground,​ so​ to​ 82 part​tWo

speak,​as​Tzotzil​Maya​communities​struggle​with​the​consequences​brought​ on​by​the​insertion​of​their​region​into​the​international​globalized​economy.​In​a​detailed​yet​ultimately​understated​way​the​Ruses​take​the​reader​ through​their​transformation​from​locally​committed​ethnographers​who​ were​deeply​connected​in​Chamula​in​the​1970s​to​scribe-​collaborators​who​ helped​bring​into​public​view​histories​and​narratives​that​had​previously​ been​considered​secret.​The​process​through​which​this​occurred,​and​the​ internal​as​well​as​broader​tensions​and​conflicts​that​accompanied​it,​unfold​ organically​through​an​account​of​how​the​Tzotzil​publishing​house​originated,​evolved,​and​changed​over​several​decades.​Among​the​larger​events​ woven​into​this​account​are​the​increasing​migration​of​community​members​to​the​United​States​and​the​Zapatista​uprising​of​1994. ​ As​is​clear​in​all​three​essays​in​part​2,​Native​knowledge,​education,​and​ literacy​are​deeply​embedded​in​indigenous​histories,​political​struggle,​and​ local​community​life.​Non-​Native​collaborators​work​within​these​specific​ contexts​and​establish​dialogues​and,​as​Ramos​would​put​it,​mingas​that​ are​appropriate​to​each​case.​At​the​same​time,​the​personal​and​intellectual​ trajectories​of​the​collaborators​themselves​play​a​role​in​the​relationships​ established.​As​a​practicing​member​of​the​U.S.​academy,​Joanne​Rappaport​ uses​her​experience​as​a​collaborator​to​rethink​and​retheorize​the​nature​of​ research​and​the​ways​in​which​intercultural​work​can​change​the​perspectives​we​bring​and​the​questions​we​ask.​Garcés​uses​the​experience​of​the​ newspaper​to​question​the​separation​between​orality​and​writing​and​the​ nature​of​intertextuality,​while​at​the​same​time​counterposing​the​forms​ of​local​knowledge​contained​in​Quechua​peasant​yachay​to​the​supposed​ universality​of​Western​categories.​And​Jan​Rus​and​Diane​Rus,​by​choice​ activist​anthropologists​who​have​eschewed​full​participation​in​the​U.S.​academic​mainstream,​strengthen​their​position​as​narrators​who​accompany​ Tzotzil​Maya​communities​as​they​make​sense​of​a​rapidly​changing​world. ​ In​the​final​analysis,​these​essays​help​us​trace​the​multiple​ways​in​which​ indigenous​narratives,​histories,​and​political​action​in​Latin​America​have​ not​only​participated​in​and​benefited​from​intercultural​collaboration,​but​ also​contributed​in​powerful​ways​to​the​development​of​grass-​roots​mobilization​more​broadly.​In​Colombia,​the​Constitution​of​1991,​written​in​ dialogue​with​indigenous​ organizations​ and​political​ activists,​ has​helped​ frame​in​new​ways​the​possibilities​of​multiethnic​nationhood.​In​Bolivia,​ the​indigenous​peasant​movement​that​generated​Morales’s​Movimiento​Al​ Socialismo​has​made​clear​that​effective​globalization​must​respect​and​colIndigenous Writing and Collaboration 83

laborate​with​local​needs​and​forms​of​knowledge,​and​it​has​helped​elect​ Morales,​Bolivia’s​first​indigenous​president.​And​in​Chiapas,​the​Maya​communities​that​helped​generate​the​Ejército​Zapatista​de​Liberación​Nacional​ continue​to​challenge​political​transitions​that​serve​only​the​interests​of​the​ political​and​economic​center​of​the​country.​These​large​transformations,​ too,​are​part​of​indigenous​history​and​must​be​interpreted​as​such.

84 part​tWo

FernanDo garcés v.

Quechua​Knowledge,​Orality,​and​Writings The Newspaper Conosur​Ñawpagman

In​this​essay​I​reflect​on​some​aspects​of​Quechua​knowledge,​orality,​and​ writing​found​within​a​concrete​case​inscribed​in​writing:​the​Conosur Ñawpagman​newspaper.1​To​this​end,​I​offer​reflections​on​this​means​of​communication,​focusing​on​its​objectives​as​well​as​its​linguistic​and​epistemic​ usage​practices.​I​concentrate​especially​on​the​inscription​of​oral​discourse​ and​ thereby​offer​ a​ pragmatic​ and​ epistemic​ defense​ of​ Quechua​ peasant​ yachay.2​I​begin​by​offering​three​clarifications​by​way​of​introduction:​how​ and​why​I​use​the​term​peasant;​what,​more​concretely,​I​mean​by​Quechua​ yachay;​and​a​short​reflection​on​my​authority,​as​an​outsider,​to​represent​ Quechua​voices. ​ In​contemporary​social​science​discourse,​scholars​are​working​to​move​ beyond​a​classist-​Marxist​vision​so​as​to​rightly​recognize​other​forms​of​exclusion.​Among​those​forms​of​exclusion,​ethnic​identity​occupies​a​privileged​ place.​ Events​ of​the​ past​ decades​ have​ contributed​ to​ the​ centrality​ of​ interest​ in​ culture​ and​ identity​ within​ social​ and​ political​ analyses​ of​ different​ national​ and​ multinational​ spaces​ (Garcés​ 2006).​ Several​ scholars​have​linked​this​newfound​attention​to​other​forms​of​exclusion​to​the​ changes​ contemporary​ global​ capitalism​ has​ suffered​ over​ the​ past​ thirty​ years​(Castro-​Gómez​2003;​Jameson​1984;​Žižek​1993).​In​the​case​of​Abya​ Yala,​scholars​have​increasingly​emphasized​that​the​colonial​restructuring​ of​local​societies​involved​systems​of​inequality,​based​on​social​class,​and​of​ exclusion,​based​on​categories​like​race​and​gender​(Quijano​2000;​Santos​ 2003).3​Under​such​conditions,​my​use​of​the​term​peasant​necessarily​calls​ for​a​rethinking​of​the​imaginary​of​class,​enriching​it​with​a​concern​for​the​ processes​by​which​contemporary​identities​are​politicized​(Regalsky,​2003).

​ A​second​reason​for​my​using​the​term​peasant​involves​the​term’s​historical​baggage​in​the​Bolivian​context.​What​can​be​called​the​indigenous​vein​ in​Bolivia​has​combined​the​experiences​of​organizations​with​so-​called​traditional​indigenous​structures​and​those​of​others​whose​historical​experiences​have​prompted​them​to​organize​their​interests​as​Andean​communities​through​the​structure​of​the​rural​union.​An​important​example​of​this​ is​the​Tiawuanaku​manifesto,​which​Sarela​Paz​describes​as​a​key​milestone​ in​the​maturation​of​the​notion​of​indigenous​peoples​in​the​Andean​world.​ Via​that​manifesto,​urban​and​rural​Aymara​sectors​converged​with​diverse​ peasant​sectors​around​Katarismo,​expressing​“the​culture’s​historical​horizons​and​ideological​themes.”​For​this​author,​“The​Manifesto​gathers​peasant​ Quechua/Aymara​ voices​ that​ revindicate​ their​ autochthonous​ culture​ and​the​origin​of​double​oppression:​economic​in​terms​of​peasants​and​cultural​in​terms​of​excluded​peoples”​(Paz​2005,​2). ​ Here​we​see​that​the​term​peasant​retains​a​presence​as​a​category​of​self-​ denomination​among​rural​Bolivians​and​within​Bolivian​social​movements,​ even​ as​ in​ the​ new​ context​ of​ struggle​ they​ have​ also​ reformulated​ their​ identities​as​aboriginal​or​indigenous.4​In​the​Department​of​Cochabamba,​ where​the​bilingual​newspaper​treated​in​this​essay​primarily​circulates,​it​is​ the​form​most​frequently​found.​None​of​the​above​denies​the​validity​of​discourses​and​practices​that​revindicate​the​aboriginal​and​indigenous​character​of​many​communities​and​collectivities​in​Bolivia.​I​think​that​in​this​ case​we​can​gain​more​from​a​comprehensive,​capacious​vision​than​from​a​ restrictive,​exclusive​one.

As​part​of​this​more​capacious​vision,​it​is​important​to​reflect​systematically​ on​the​term​Quechua yachay,​by​which​I​mean​the​collective​knowledge​produced​and​reproduced​orally​by​Quechua-​speaking​communities.​While​I​do​ not​believe​there​is​a​direct​and​exclusive​association​between​a​language,​a​ type​of​knowledge,​and​a​single,​distinct​nation​or​people,​I​nonetheless​prefer​the​term​Quechua yachay​to​other,​more​general​and​less​precise​ones.​ Andean knowledge,​for​example,​at​least​in​the​Bolivian​case,​includes​as​well​ Aymara​communities,​while​indigenous knowledge​refers​as​well​to​the​lowland​indigenous​peoples.​Thus,​Quechua yachay​has​a​certain​practical​use. ​ To​think​of​Quechua​knowledge​as​oral​also​forces​us​to​recognize​the​ geopolitics​ of​ knowledge​ that​ has​ colonially​ subalter[n]ized​ certain​ languages,​ among​ them​ Quechua​ (Garcés​ 2005a).​ My​ understanding​ of​ 86 FernanDo​garcés​V.

Quechua​ yachay​ as​ being​ fundamentally​ oral​ might​ seem​ to​ rearticulate​ the​colonial​imaginary​within​which​indigenous​languages​were​classified​ as​“lower”​because​they​did​not​express​modern,​abstract,​or​spiritual​ideas​ (Mannheim​1991,​61–79;​Mignolo​1999).​On​the​contrary,​I​want​to​emphasize​that​colonial​differentiation​has​also​provided​subalter[n]ized​languages​ with​a​certain​epistemological​power​reproduced​at​the​margins​or​in​the​ interstices​of​colonial​power​(Rivera​1987;​Mignolo​2002).​While​there​has​ been​a​history​of​permanent​contacts​between​orality​and​the​world​of​written​communication,​from​colonial​times​and​in​a​much​more​intense​way​in​ the​contemporary​period,​the​vast​majority​of​the​Andean​world​continues​ to​privilege​oral​knowledge​in​everyday​communicational​spaces.​As​I​will​ show,​this​is​because​Quechua​yachay​and​its​oral​production​and​reproduction​are​counterhegemonic​responses​to​a​global​colonial​epistemology.

My​final​clarification​has​to​do​with​the​pacha​from​where​I​think​and​articulate​my​own​intellectual​and​political​practice​with​regard​to​Quechua.5​ My​connection​with​the​Quichua​and​Quechua​languages​is​rooted​in​my​involvement​with​diverse​bilingual​education​programs,​my​support​for​local​ research​projects,​and​my​relationships​with​the​newspaper’s​editorial​team.​ Through​these​experiences​I​have​found​myself​in​a​growing​struggle​with​ my​own​personal​history​of​colonization,​aware​that​my​ability​to​partake​of​ this​process​of​reflection​and​intervention​places​me​in​a​position​of​power.​ I​thus​develop​my​ideas​about​Quechua​and​Quechua​yachay​in​a​highly​ charged​context​of​struggles​over​representation​in​which​I​myself​am​a​participant​(Castro-​Gómez​2000). ​ In​this​text,​as​I​attempt​to​map​politically​the​environments​in​which​ the​power​of​knowledge​and​languages​moves,​I​necessarily​involve​myself​ in​struggles​over​power​and​over​different​positions​concerning​Quechua​ and​its​yachay.​I​speak,​then,​from​a​location​marked​by​my​own​subjectivity​ and​history:​as​a​white​intellectual,​male,​native​Spanish​speaker,​and​as​full​ of​contradictions.​At​the​same​time,​I​constantly​labor​to​insert​myself​into​ a​learning​process​marked​by​crisis​and​rupture,​a​process​that​is​the​product​of​interaction​with​other​women​and​men​also​displaced​in​the​act​of​ speaking​and​knowing.​This​essay​emerges​from​a​kind​of​frontier,​a​position​where​I​know​myself​to​be​part​of​the​system​of​power​yet​am​also​in​ constant​conversation​with​other​forms​of​knowing,​thinking,​speaking,​and​ silencing. Quechua Knowledge and Writings 87

Background on the Conosur Ñawpagman The​Conosur Ñawpagman​newspaper​was​created​in​1983​in​association​with​ the​Portales​Center​of​the​Simón​Patiño​Foundation.6​Financed​with​Swiss​ aid,​the​newspaper​served​to​promote​reading​in​Mizque,​a​province​of​the​ Department​of​Cochabamba.​The​newspaper​was​created​through​an​agreement​ with​ the​ San​ José​ de​ Mizque​ Cooperative,​ under​ the​ name​ El Mizqueño.​Initially,​the​paper​was​geared​to​the​people​of​the​Mizque​community​and​supported​the​work​of​the​popular​libraries​that​the​Portales​Center​ had​created​in​different​provinces​of​the​department. ​ The​ year​ the​ Conosur​ was​ born​ was​ one​ of​ significant​ drought​ in​ the​ valleys​of​Cochabamba​and​marked​the​arrival​of​many​nongovernmental​ organizations​(ngo s)​that​brought​with​them​large​quantities​of​money​for​ peasant​communities.​The​Conosur​began​publication​in​an​attempt​to​analyze​the​impact​of​development​projects​in​the​communities.​The​first​issues​ of​the​newspaper​addressed​the​supposed​benefits​that​development​institutions​brought​to​the​countryside​and​the​opinions​of​peasants​who​opposed​ the​institutions’​overwhelming​presence.​The​following​year,​in​an​agreement​ with​the​Moyopampa​Agricultural​Union​(Totora,​Carrasco​province),​El Totoreño​emerged​and​essentially​reproduced​El Mizqueño’s​content​but​with​ different​headlines.​El Totoreño​sought​to​be​a​more​direct​nexus​with​the​ communities​and​separate​itself​from​the​small-​town​sector​to​which​it​was​ initially​linked. ​ The​Conosur​newspaper​explored​the​issue​of​appropriate​technologies​ and​began​to​conduct​research​in​different​communities​to​test​the​hypothesis​ that​ the​ introduction​ of​ modern​ technology,​ instead​ of​ benefiting​ the​ communities,​actually​accelerated​the​erosion​of​peasant​knowledge,​just​as​ it​eroded​the​soil​(Gonzalo​Vargas,​interview,​09/10/01).​In​Raqaypampa,​for​ example,​research​demonstrated​that​peasants​developed​their​own​strategies,​ in​ which​ families​ and​ local​ grass-​roots​ organizations​ acted​ together​ to​ counter​ the​ effects​ of​ introduced​ technologies​ and​ the​ constant,​ overwhelming​assault​of​the​market.​It​was​possible​to​observe​the​cultivation​of​ crops​linked​to​each​other,​the​use​of​diverse​ecological​niches,​highly​precise​ weather​forecasting,​seed​varieties,​and​so​forth. ​ At​a​meeting​in​1986​of​the​trade​union​centrals​of​the​three​southernmost​provinces​of​the​Department​ of​Cochabamba​ (Totora,​Mizque,​and​ Carrasco),​the​participants​asked​that​each​province​have​its​own​newspaper.​

88 FernanDo​garcés​V.

Taking​stock​of​limited​institutional​capacity,​the​participants​decided​to​create​one​newspaper​linked​to​peasant​organizations,​especially​the​Mizque​ Provincial​ Trade​ Union,​ the​ Moyapampa​ Union,​ and​ the​ Departmental​ Peasant​Federation​itself.7​At​the​same​meeting,​the​newspaper​was​given​ the​name​Conosur Ñawpagman​because​it​dealt​with​the​provinces​in​the​ department’s​southern​cone. ​ In​1988​the​Andean​Communication​and​Development​Center​(cenDa)​ considered​the​possibility​of​focusing​on​radio​communications.​As​a​result,​ the​Conosur’s​publication​was​suspended​for​almost​a​year,​and​the​newspaper​underwent​an​evaluation.​Pressure​from​organizations​and​the​political​ climate​ created​ by​ the​ upcoming​ general​ elections​ drove​ the​ editorial​ team​to​resume​publication​of​Conosur​and​to​define​the​newspaper’s​political​ stance.​ The​ paper’s​ initial​ regional​ focus​ thus​ became​ connected​ with​ national​concerns.​The​newspaper​resumed​publication​in​1989,​the​same​ year​the​Unified​Confederation​of​Bolivian​Workers​and​Peasants​(csutcb)​ was​ born​ at​ the​ Tarija​ Congress.​ At​ the​ congress,​ the​ delegates​ also​ discussed​the​possibility​of​creating​a​political​mechanism​to​support​peasant​ ​organizations. ​ The​ PCÑ ​has​gone​through​a​gradual​process​of​self-​definition​that​affected​its​stated​objectives.​By​1992​there​was​increasing​discussion​about​ the​issue​of​a​political​mechanism,​and​a​proposal​was​made​to​render​the​ union​organization​independent​of​traditional​political​parties.​The​Conosur​also​made​explicit​its​objective​and​defined​itself​as​a​tool​of​the​peasant​ movement’s​critical​intellectuals,​not​of​the​movement’s​leadership.​Starting​ with​the​promotion​of​Quechua​reading​and​writing​and​its​transcription​ of​speakers’​testimonies,​the​newspaper​began​to​define​itself​as​part​of​a​ greater​political​objective.​This​objective,​as​stated​earlier,​was​to​be​a​tool​for​ discussion​among​critical​thinkers​in​the​department’s​peasant​movement.​ The​ editorial​ team’s​ question​ was:​ Where​ is​ that​ sector​ of​ critical​ thinkers?​From​what​it​understood,​the​sector​never​took​shape,​not​even​after​ the​Movement​toward​Socialism​(Mas)​was​formed​as​the​desired​political​ mechanism.8 ​ The​role​the​newspaper​played​within​the​Quechua​peasant​movement​ was​therefore​not​as​an​immediate​means​of​communication,​but​as​a​space​ for​reflection​that​linked​the​ PCÑ ​to​the​particular​conjuncture​of​peasant​ mobilization.​The​sale​and​distribution​of​the​paper​became​massive​at​times​ of​social​mobilization​in​general​and​of​peasant​mobilization​in​particular.​It​

Quechua Knowledge and Writings 89

was​at​these​times​that​the​Conosur​responded​most​closely​to​its​objectives,​ serving​as​the​repository​of​memory​and​as​an​instrument​of​reflection​for​ the​peasant​political​movement. ​ Initially,​the​paper​was​aimed​at​the​leadership​sector.​Starting​in​1989,​ as​part​of​its​institutional​evaluation​and​renovation,​it​sought​closer​ties​to​ the​grass-​roots​among​the​department’s​peasants,​in​search​of​the​aforementioned​critical​sector.​That​sector,​in​general,​was​composed​of​people​with​ low​levels​of​education​in​reading​and​writing.​This,​however,​did​not​deny​ the​presence​of​the​leaders’​voices,​and​rural​teachers,​merchants,​truckers,​ and​ even​ semiurban​ neighborhood​ organizations​ requested​ copies​ of​the​ newspaper. ​ The​ PCÑ ​ is​ distributed​ in​ what​ can​ be​ called​ a​ personal​ manner,​ with​ representatives​visiting​the​department’s​important​fairs​and​attending​the​ various​events​held​by​the​department’s​peasant​organizations.​The​moment​ of​the​newspaper’s​distribution​is​at​the​same​time​the​moment​of​research​ through​specific​interviews​and​the​recording​of​speeches​at​the​events.​The​ resulting​articles​are​largely​testimonials,​recordings,​and​interviews.​Rather​ than​more​usual​forms​of​writing,​they​are​constructed​texts.9 ​ The​newspaper​is​published​bimonthly​(it​might​even​be​called​a​magazine),​ and​ it​ deals​ with​ such​ subjects​ as​ the​ Andean​ productive​ system;​ weather​prediction;​community​history;​education;​events​and​resolutions​ sponsored​by​peasant​and​indigenous​organizations​at​the​local,​regional,​ and​national​levels;​community​events;​national​and​international​news;​and​ the​ever-​present​personal​story.​Currently,​its​printing​varies​from​thirty-​five​ hundred​to​four​thousand​copies.​About​twenty-​five​hundred​to​three​thousand​copies​of​each​edition​are​commonly​sold,​although​at​times​of​mobilization​the​issue​sells​out.​An​important​fact​is​that​approximately​40​percent​of​the​issues​are​sold​in​Chapare,​a​zone​of​permanent​tension​because​ of​government​and​U.S.​efforts​to​forcibly​eradicate​coca.​While​the​newspaper​has​a​token​price​(3​bolivianos​in​the​city​and​1​or​1.50​in​rural​areas),​ it​is​never​given​away.​Significantly,​some​readers,​especially​children,​barter​ community​products​(grains,​potatoes,​and​so​on)​for​the​Conosur.

The Politics of Written Orality in the pcÑ One​of​the​ PCÑ ’s​characteristics​is​to​work​with​Quechua​writing​based​on​ the​orality​of​the​speakers.​This​involves​the​politics​of​inscribing​oral​discourse​(Marcone​1997)​that​is​not​limited​to​the​simple​reproduction​of​an​ 90 FernanDo​garcés​V.

act​of​speech​but​instead​creates​a​new​form​of​communication.​To​inscribe​ orality​becomes​a​political​act​that​involves​a​textual​selection​based​on​the​ editor’s​or​inscriber’s​needs​and​interests.​One​example​of​this​in​the​Conosur​involves​an​expanded​notion​of​intertextuality. ​ Literary​and​textual​linguistic​studies​frequently​use​the​concept​of​intertextuality​to​mean​the​construction​of​a​text​from​a​mosaic​of​references​as​ well​as​the​absorption​and​transformation​of​another​text​(Kristeva​1982).​ In​this​sense,​intertextuality​creates​new​texts​through​the​re-​elaboration​of​ existing​ones.​For​me,​intertextuality​has​a​different​meaning​with​regard​to​ the​Conosur’s​practice​of​inscription.​I​understand​intertextuality​not​only​ as​a​textual​interrelation​fashioned​on​paper,​but​also​as​the​construction​of​ a​series​of​plots​that​are​textual​(in​the​broadest​sense​of​the​word),​where​ diverse​visual,​textual​(in​the​sense​of​written),​and​oral​codes​are​in​figurative​battle.​Intertextuality​is​a​conflictual​process​whereby​diverse​actors​ construct​texts​as​they​move​in​different​cultural​imaginaries.​Intertextuality​ also​considers​the​diverse​contexts​of​textual​production​and​conflictive​and​ diverse​reception. ​ Intertextuality​can​be​exemplified​in​the​newspaper’s​inscribed​written​ (and​ visual)​practice.​The​ PCÑ ​publishes​ news​and​produces​ information​ in​Quechua​and​in​Spanish.​On​the​one​hand,​the​editors’​explicit​principal​ criterion​is​that​events​occurring​in​one​language​be​described​in​that​same​ language,​be​it​Quechua​or​Spanish.​On​the​other​hand,​anything​that​has​ to​do​with​the​world​outside​the​communities​and​the​organizations​(for​example,​national​and​international​news​or​agricultural​technical​subjects)​is​ written​in​Spanish,​while​matters​involving​internal​interests​(community​ history,​weather​forecasting,​evaluation​of​the​agricultural​cycle,​stories,​and​ so​forth)​are​written​in​Quechua.​This​is​the​general​tendency​that​emerges​ from​the​Bolivian​diglottic​framework​in​which​the​newspaper​exists.10 ​ One​could​also​describe​the​ PCÑ ’s​textual-​linguistic​economy​from​the​ perspective​of​the​confrontation​between​official​and​unofficial​discourses.​ From​ this​ perspective,​ official​ and​ legal​ discourse​ and​ the​ expressions​ or​ relations​of​the​discursive​and​hegemonic​state​environment​are​published​ in​Spanish.​For​example,​even​if​the​agenda​for​discussion​at​an​organization’s​local​meeting​is​written​in​Quechua,​its​resolutions​generally​appear​in​ Spanish.​This​occurs​because​said​resolutions​politically​position​the​organizations​and​communities​in​relation​to​the​mechanisms​of​state​domination.​In​this​way,​the​construction​of​news​not​mediated​by​orality​also​appears​in​Spanish.​That​which​forms​part​of​the​organizational​and​communal​ Quechua Knowledge and Writings 91

(not​necessarily​local)​discursive​environment​is​treated​in​Quechua.​Here,​ stories​and​weather​forecasting​are​as​much​a​part​of​the​discussion​as​local​ peasant​events​and​national​and​international​news​(Constitutive​Assemblies,​the​Free​Trade​Agreement​of​the​Americas​(Ftaa),​the​North​Atlantic​ Free​Trade​Agreement​(naFta),​World​Bank​policies​about​agriculture,​and​ so​on). ​ Nevertheless,​this​spatial-​textual​distribution​is​not​that​simple,​for​there​ are​also​frequent​intertextual​games.​For​example,​in​a​given​news​piece​the​ title​may​be​in​Spanish​and​most​of​the​information​in​Quechua​(or​vice​ versa).​Within​a​given​article,​there​may​be​changes​or​jumps​back​and​forth​ between​Quechua​and​Spanish. ​ According​to​the​rules​of​inscription,​there​are​three​criteria​to​follow​in​ the​face​of​the​Spanish​written​word:​to​the​extent​possible,​recover​endangered​Quechua​vocabulary;​create​neologisms​for​those​terms​that​are​not​ historically​found​in​the​language​and​that​current​communication​demands;​ and,​when​necessary,​incorporate​a​Spanish​term​by​either​keeping​the​original​spelling​in​Spanish​or​providing​a​phonetic​rendition​in​Quechua​(Plaza​ 1995,​58).​Under​these​criteria,​resorting​to​Spanish​is​a​last​resort,​reflecting​ an​explicit​policy​of​recovering​and​strengthening​Quechua.​The​presence​ of​Spanish​terms​is​considered​a​lesser​evil.​I​will​later​touch​on​the​topic​of​ the​PCÑ ’s​periodic​effort​to​recover​the​ancient​Quechua​vocabulary,​but​for​ now​I​will​focus​on​some​examples​of​the​newspaper’s​norm​for​dealing​with​ Spanish​terms. ​ The​ PCÑ ​does​not​have​an​explicit​policy​for​the​creation​of​neologisms​ in​the​sense​that​it​is​the​editorial​team​that​proposes​new​Quechua​terms.​ Nevertheless,​and​as​a​result​of​the​collection​of​oral​information,​I​can​offer​ a​few​examples​that​prove​speakers’​creativity.​In​some​cases,​that​creativity​ involves​the​description​of​characteristics,​while​in​others​it​involves​the​appropriation​and​conceptual​reformulation​of​the​original​Spanish​term.​We​ thus​have​a​physical​place​where​a​radio​functions,​wayra wasi​(54:12)​(lit.​ ‘wind​house’);11​for​airplane,​lata p’isqu​(63:4)​(lit.​‘iron​bird’);​for​handkerchief,​qhuña pichana​(61:11)​(lit.​‘snot​cleaner’);​for​members​of​the​Mobile​ Unit​for​Rural​Patrolling,​a​repressive​force​charged​with​the​aggressive​eradication​of​the​coca​leaf,​p’alta uma​(46:3)​(lit.​‘flat​head’);​to​refer​to​gringos​or​ foreigners​in​general,​jawa puka kunka​(50:4)​(lit.​‘red​neck​from​abroad’). ​ Beyond​ the​ effort​ of​ lexical​ recreation​ through​ neologisms,​ it​ is​ common​practice​in​the​PCÑ ​to​use​Spanish​terms,​written​according​to​Spanish​ grammar.​This​is​observed​at​different​levels,​such​as​the​following: 92 FernanDo​garcés​V.

a.​In​entire​phrases: [.​.​.]​lluksinankupaq​representantes​

For​them​to​become​genuine

genuinos de las provincias​

representatives of the provinces,

compañeros (39:3).​

comrades.

b.​In​the​lexical-​morphological​combination​of​Spanish​and​Quechua: Munayku​Escuela Fiscal​kananta,​

We​want​that​the​school be public,

mana privatizakunanta​campesinos​

that​it​be​not​privatized;​we​the

manachay escuelas privadasman​

peasants​would​not​be​able​to​pay

pagayta atiykumanchurayku​(44:19).​

for​these​private schools.

c.​In​the​consignation​of​different​types​of​acronyms​and​the​institution’s​

full​name: CSUTCB ​uchhika q’ayma kachkan,​ imata nisun?​Central Obrera​ Boliviana q’aymallataq, uraman​ yaykuyta munachkan​(79:6).​ ​ ​

The​CSUTCB ​is​a​little​bit​unenthusiastic​(lit.​‘insipid’),​what​would​we say?​The​Central Obrera Boliviana (Bolivian Workers’ Union)​is​also unenthusiastic​and​it​is​becoming down.12

Quechua in the pcÑ Few​studies​deal​with​the​presence​of​indigenous​languages​in​the​media​ (Albó​1998),​even​though​there​is​a​relatively​strong​presence​of​Aymara​and​ Quechua​on​urban​radio​stations​in​La​Paz​and​Cochabamba,​respectively.13​ In​the​written​press,​the​daily​Presencia​published​one​page​in​Quechua​and​ another​in​Aymara​every​day​for​a​year.​Unfortunately,​this​experiment​in​ the​media​ended​because​the​newspaper​closed.​Albó​and​Anaya​(2003)​describe​the​experience​of​the​newspaper​Jaima.​It​initially​published​texts​in​ Aymara,​and​now​it​also​does​so​in​Quechua​and​Guaraní​as​a​weekly​under​ the​new​name​of​Kimsa Pacha Ara Mboapi,​which​is​distributed​together​ with​the​daily​La Prensa.​The​Conosur​is​thus​one​of​very​few​means​of​diffusion​outside​of​the​academy​that​generates​information​in​an​indigenous​ language​in​Bolivia.14 ​ The​first​issues​of​newspapers​like​El Mizqueño​and​El Totoreño​distinguished​themselves​by​their​limited​use​of​Quechua.​Nevertheless,​with​the​ New Era​of​the​Conosur​(starting​in​1989)​the​revaluation​of​Quechua​beQuechua Knowledge and Writings 93

came​a​priority.​A​new​era​of​debate​over​standardization​begins,​which​can​ be​summarized​as​“do​we​completely​normalize​Quechua​or​respect​the​testimony?”​(Julia​Román,​interview,​05/10/01).​Asked​in​a​more​conciliatory​ way:​how​to​achieve​equilibrium​between​the​norm​and​an​inscribed​written​variety​that​readers​could​understand​even​without​a​high​level​of​standardization?​ In​ the​ PCÑ ,​ the​ basic​ criterion​ was​ to​ use​ a​ comprehensible​ Quechua​even​though​it​did​not​entirely​conform​to​the​current​exigencies​ of​standardization.​This​practice​began​from​thinking​through​the​writing​ from​the​actual​words​of​the​speakers.​However,​there​was​a​moment​(PCÑ​ numbers​44​to​55)​when​the​newspaper​explicitly​intervened​idiomatically​to​ purge​the​newspaper’s​Quechua​speech​of​excessive​use​of​Spanish​vocabulary.15 ​ The​ PCÑ ’s​thematic​sections​move,​disappear,​or​reappear​from​issue​to​ issue.​There​is,​however,​an​inalterable​section​that​is​not​subject​to​the​political​articulation​of​the​moment:​the​story.​In​each​issue​the​story​appearing​ on​the​last​page​is​unchanged​not​only​in​its​appearance,​but​also​in​the​linguistic​code​it​represents.​In​the​story,​we​find​Quechua​in​its​purest​form,​ as​if​it​managed​to​condense​forms​impervious​to​modern​communication​ requirements. ​ I​ have​ carefully​ studied​ the​ PCÑ ’s​ greater​ or​ lesser​ observation​ of​ the​ norms​of​written​Quechua​(Garcés​2005b).16​Overall,​and​in​spite​of​the​editorial​team’s​effort​during​a​specific​period​of​time,​I​could​generally​not​find​ orthographic​consistency.​The​newspaper’s​editors​have​a​basic​knowledge​of​ grammatical​norms​and​rules,​since​they​occasionally​attend​training​seminars​or​courses​on​the​normalization​of​Quechua,​but​they​do​not​necessarily​ apply​them​directly.​This​is​because​the​paper’s​unique​strength​is​dealing​ with​Quechua​writing​based​on​its​informants’​orality—the​voice​of​those​ who​offer​their​testimonies​and​speak.17

Traces of Orality in the pcÑ Conosur​is​a​space​of​textual​production,​starting​from​the​inscription​of​ oral​ discourse.​ In​ the​ hands​ of​ the​ newspaper’s​ editors,​ this​ is​ a​ political​ practice​that​implies​a​process​of​textual​selection​and​reconstruction.​In​ my​view,​this​practice​responds​to​three​main​issues​in​the​extensive​literature​about​the​relations​between​orality​and​writing.​First,​it​contradicts​the​ idea​that​orality​is​less​valuable​than​writing,​largely​because​it​contributes​ little​or​nothing​to​the​configuration​of​abstract​thought​and​the​develop94 FernanDo​garcés​V.

ment​of​intellect​(Goody​1968;​Olson​1994;​and​Ong​1982,​1992).​Second,​it​ problematizes​the​notion​that​there​is​rupture​rather​than​continuity​in​the​ relationship​of​orality​to​writing,​what​Street​(1984)​and​others​have​called​ the​“great​divide.”​And​third,​it​provides​an​alternative​to​the​quandary​we​ face​ when​ elaborating​ written​ forms​ of​ subordinated​ languages​ from​ the​ model​of​the​dominant​languages,​thus​producing​a​functional​and​political​ copy​that​also​reproduces​the​linguistic​colonialism​present​in​our​societies​ (Garcés​2005a,​2005b).​Indeed,​through​these​interventions​Conosur​serves​ as​an​example​of​the​political​uses​of​subaltern​sectors’​writing,​which​some​ authors​have​noted​can​impart​a​sense​of​history​to​local​struggles​(Portelli​ 1989)​or​counter-​hegemonize​or​negotiate​with​the​written​inscribed​officiality​(Rappaport​1990).18​With​the​aim​of​contributing​to​the​debates​about​ linguistic​politics​and​the​practice​of​written​interventions​in​Quechua​and​ Aymara,​I​offer​examples​of​the​most​frequent​and​important​cases​of​the​ oral​presence​that​I​found​in​Conosur’s​writing. ​ One​example​of​the​oral​presence​in​Conosur​is​the​appearance​of​conversational​ties,​including​í,​which​in​Bolivian​Quechua​allows​the​speaker​ to​express​uncertainty​and​doubt,​while​also​asking​the​interlocutor​to​voice​ their​own​opinion​on​the​topic​in​question​(Herrero​and​Sánchez​de​Lozada​ 1979).​In​PCÑ ​68:14,​we​find​the​following:​Nuqaykup lugarniykumanta papa muju​í, Laqmu tarpuyku​(“It​is​a​potato​seed​from​our​place,​you see;​we​sow​ laqmu​.​.​.”).​The​presence​of​í​would​be​normal​in​an​oral​interaction,​where​ one​of​the​speakers​demands​the​participation​of​the​other​speaker. ​ Another​way​in​which​the​PCÑ ​reproduces​the​context​of​oral​conversation​in​the​written​text​is​by​trying​to​reproduce​the​performative​aspects​ of​the​linguistic​event.​Issue​84:11,​for​example,​details​the​experience​of​a​ Workshop​for​the​Handling​of​Potato​and​Corn​Varieties​organized​by​the​ Women’s​Organization​of​Kuyupaya.​The​expert​in​distinct​varieties​of​potatoes​ and​ corn​ seeds​ carried​ out​ a​ demonstration​ for​ the​ attendees​ at​ the​ workshop.​The​newspaper​covered​this​presentation​in​the​same​way​the​linguistic​event​unfolded: Ñuqa apamurkani saritasta, papitasta​

I​had​brought​some​corn​(maize)​and

riqsichinaykupaq. Riqsichisaykichiq:​

potatoes​for​display.​I​will​show​them

Yuraq sara waltaku, ranqhanapaq,​

to​you:​the​Waltaku​white​corn,​is​for

sara lluch’usqapipis walliqllataq;​

selling;​it​is​also​good​for​being

Guinda sara nisqa jank’apaq;​kaytaq​

peeled;​the​purple​corn​(is​good​for)

Q’illu sara Lurivayu, lawapaq,​

being​toasted;​and​this​one​the​yellow Quechua Knowledge and Writings 95

jank’apaqpis, jak’upis sumaq,​

corn​(called)​Lurivayu,​for​soup,​for

bajiyupi puqun, patapipis kallantaq.​

being​toasted,​it​is​also​good​for

Kaytaq​Uchpa sarita jank’apaq,​

flour;​it​grows​in​the​lowlands​and

ranqhanapaq;​kay​Yuraq sara rosada​

also​in​the​highlands.​And​this​one​is

jina, tukuy imapaq; Phasanqalla sara,​

the​Ashes​corn,​good​for​being​toasted

muchhaspa jank’anchiq.​Kaytaq​

and​for​selling;​this​white,​pinkish

Yuraq sara, puka q’uruntañataq​

one,​is​good​for​everything;​this​is

lluch’usqapaq, ranqhanapaq, tukuy​

popcorn​corn,​it​is​toasted​getting​the

imapaq​.​.​.​(84:11).​

grains​out​from​the​cob.​And​this​one



is​the​White​corn,​it​has​a​red​corn-



cob,​it​is​good​for​being​peeled,​for



selling,​for​everything​.​.​.

The​text​is​accompanied​by​a​photo​of​a​lady​presenting​different​corn​varieties.​In​this​way,​the​newspaper​attempts​to​insert​the​reader​into​the​interactional​context​and​moment​of​speaking.​By​reproducing​the​environment​ in​which​text​is​produced,​this​type​of​textual​construction​distances​itself​ from​the​rules​of​objectivity​that​should​mark​a​formal​written​text​and​that​ give​writing​its​character​as​a​technology​of​abstract​intellectual​development.19 ​ Another​important​presence​of​orality​in​the​newspaper​occurs​in​its​quotation​system.​In​the​following​example​we​see​reproduced​the​most​common​Quechua​quotation​practice: gobiernopunicha kachamun “runasta​

It​is​most​possible​that​it​was​the

maqamuychis”​nispa​fruta sach’asta​

government​itself​that​sent​them,

aqnata machitiyamuychis​nispa​

“go​ahead,​go​to​beat​the​peasants,”

(72:15).​

saying,​“go​and​cut​them​down​with



machetes​as​if​they​were​fruit​bearing



trees,”​saying.

​ In​addition​to​the​classic​system​of​quotation​unique​to​Quechua’s​discursive​structure,​in​its​testimonies​the​ PCÑ ​often​relies​on​a​generalizing​ anonymity​through​constructions​like​“it​was​said,”​“a​leader​said,”​and​“the​ peasant​delegates​said.”​On​other​occasions​the​testimony​directly​attributes​ the​words​to​their​speaker: Compañera cocata puquchik​

The​coca​producer​comrade​Eugenia

Eugenia Blanco​jaqay Central​

Blanco​from​the​Copacabana​Union

96 FernanDo​garcés​V.

Copacabanamanta kay jinata​

has told us this:​“That’s​the​way​they

willariwayku: “Kay jinata cocaykuta​

ripped​off​our​coca​plants,​they​left​us

t’irapuwayku, mana cocayuqta​

without​any​coca,​now​how​are​we

saqirpawayku, kunan imawantaq​

going​to​feed​(raise)​our​children.​If

wawasniykuta uywasqayku. Coca​

there​is​no​coca​how​are​we​going

mana kaptin imawan kawsasqayku,​

to​live,​I​only​get​money​from​(selling)

cocallamanta qullqi jap’ikuq kani, ​

coca,​nothing​else​grows​here.”

mana ni ima puqunchu kaypi”​(85:​11).

But​in​a​third​example,​in​PCÑ ​41:​B6–B8,​after​a​page​and​half​of​discussion​ on​Ch’iñi laqatu​(Andean​weevil)​in​a​clearly​journalistic​style,​the​article​ suddenly​ poses​ the​ following​ question:​ Imata ruwaq kanku ñawpa runas chay khuruta pisiyachinankupaq mana anchá jatarinanpaq?​ (“What​ did​ people​used​to​do​to​control​the​bugs,​so​that​they​do​not​proliferate?”).​An​ unidentified​interviewee​directly​responds:​Bueno, yachasqayman jina​.​.​.​ (“Well,​according​to​what​I​know​.​.​.”).​As​of​this​moment,​since​the​text​contains​no​quotes​or​any​other​sign​that​divulges​its​production​or​authorship,​ we​do​not​know​with​certainty​what​belongs​to​the​newspaper’s​editors​and​ what​belongs​to​the​interviewee. ​ A​dramatic​instance​of​orality’s​presence​in​the​newspaper​is​the​use​of​ oral​formulas.​As​mentioned​earlier,​one​of​the​enduring​features​in​the​PCÑ​ is​the​concluding​story.​With​an​exception​here​and​there,​all​of​the​newspaper’s​stories​conclude​with​the​explicit​formula​of​oral​narration.​For​example,​ PCÑ ​46:19–20​states,​Kunan kuti chayllapi tukukun kay kwintituqa. Waq kutikama​(“On​this​occasion​this​little​tale​ends​just​there.​See​you.”);​ or​also​Kaypi tukukun kay willanita​(“This​little​tale​ends​here.”)​(49:16).​In​ addition,​attempts​to​reproduce​oral​onomatopoeic​or​interjective​forms​appear​as​often​in​the​stories​as​in​other​testimonial​texts:​yuthuqa,​churrrrrr​ nichkaqta pawarikapusqa​(77–78:16)​(“The​partridge​flew​away​‘churrrrr’​ saying”);​Chaymantaqa compadren nisqa: —Ayyy​kumpa, mana ajinatachu luz k’anchaytaqa wañuchina, kay botonllata ñit’ina, chaywan wañun​(91:12)​ (“Then​his​compadre​said:​—hey​buddy,​that​is​not​the​way​to​turn​off​the​ light,​you​just​have​to​press​this​button,​that​turns​it​off ”);​or​the​important​ case​of​the​cover​of​ PCÑ ​45:​Kunan uqharikuna . . . a.a.a . . . !​(“Now​let​us​ riseeee​.​.​.​!).”20

Quechua Knowledge and Writings 97

Everyday Metaphors and Similes in the pcÑ “Our​ordinary​conceptual​system,​in​terms​of​what​we​think​and​act,​is​fundamentally​of​a​metaphoric​nature,”​write​Lakoff​and​Johnson​(1980,​39).​ They​show​how​the​metaphor​impregnates​language,​thought,​and​action.​ Metaphors​are​constructed​and​circulated​in​an​everyday​linguistic​market.​ They​are​not​the​fruit​of​specialists,​as​the​Western​literary​intellectual​class​ would​prefer.​Indeed,​we​find​in​metaphors​the​key​to​understanding​relations​between​language,​culture,​and​the​comprehension​of​reality. ​ In​such​a​context,​the​fact​that​the​ PCÑ ’s​metaphoric​world​is​especially​ evident​in​sociopolitical​discourse​demands​attention.​In​reference​to​the​ Law​of​Popular​Participation,​for​example,​whose​negative​implications​for​ peasant​movements​could​not​be​clearly​understood,​the​newspaper​stated,​ Imaynatacha​ katarita ch’uskirinchik, kikinta kay kamachiyta ch’uskikurqa​ (“Just​as​we​peel​off​a​snake,​likewise​we​peeled​off​this​law”)​(62:3).​On​other​ occasions,​we​see​a​much​more​visual​comparison​than​traditional​political​ parties​are​able​to​conjure: Eleccionespiqa​imaynatachus​ch’uspi​

In​the​elections​just​as​the​flies​fall

leche mankaman urmaykun ajinata​

into​the​milk​pot,​they​fall​into​the

wakin partidos tradicionalespaq​

rear​of​some​traditional​political

qhipanman urmaykunku, paykunapaq​

parties,​the​votes​for​them​appear.

votos rikhurin (84:5).

And​ throughout​ different​ Quechua​ texts​ of​ the​ PCÑ ,​ we​ see​ the​ popular​ comparison​of​different​organizational​situations​of​the​peasant​movement​ with​the​movement​of​ants​(see,​for​example,​50:3​and​50:4): Sik’imira​jina, ch’inllamanta tukuy​

As​ants,​quietly​all​the​women,

warmikuna, wawa uqharisqa, uk runa​

holding​our​babies,​just​as​one​single

jinalla, auto yankuna wisq’asunchis​

person,​will​close​down​the​roads

(69:5).​

(will​block​the​roads).

​ Perhaps​one​of​the​richest​sets​of​metaphoric​uses​from​Quechua​involves​ elements​of​human​corporeity:​uma​(head),​sunqu​(heart),​maki​(hand),​and​ llawar​(blood).​Uma​means,​among​other​things,​the​center​of​desires​and​ intentions​as​well​as​of​ways​in​which​ideas​are​received: Kunitan​gobiernop umanpiqa​

Right​now​in​the​mind​of​the​govern-

campesinosta wich’uy munachkan jaqay​

ment​they​are​thinking​of​driving​the

98 FernanDo​garcés​V.

Parque Isiboro Sécuremanta, chayman​

peasants​from​the​Isiboro​Sécure​Park,

gringosta sat’inankupaq​(64:​5).​

to​place​the​gringos​there.

Participación Popular, mana​

The​Grass​Roots​participation​(idea)

umaykuman yaykunchu​(57:13).​

does​not​enter​in​our​minds.

Starting​ with​ these​ first​ examples,​ we​ can​ better​ understand​ the​ fact​ that​ uma​is​in​permanent​relation​with​intentions,​deceit,​or​confusion: [. . .] uk yana uwija warmikunaq​

A​black​sheep​had​appeared​inside​the

qutuchakuynin ukhupi rikhurisqa,​

women’s​organization,​swirling​their

umaninkuta muyuchiyta​munaspa,​

minds,​thereby​feeding​the​women​to

jinamanta atuqman qarananpaq​

the​fox.

warmi masisninta​(46:17).

Uma​also​metaphorically​designates​the​leaders​and​important​posts​of​peasant​organizations: Kunanqa musuq​umallichik​kayku,​

Nowadays​we​are​the​new​leaders,​this

chaytaq jatun thaskiriy, Federacionqa​

is​a​great​step​(for​us),​(for)​the​Union

manamin pukllakuyku​(51:​3).​

is​not​a​game.

This​is​precisely​why​uma​also​refers​to​the​lack​of​leadership​of​a​determined​ social​entity.​We​see​this,​for​example,​in​critiques​of​the​government​for​incompetent​social​leadership:​Kay gobiernoqta​mana tiyanchu uman, qhasimanakaq​(88:3)​(“This​government​has​no​head,​it​is​there​in​vain”). ​ The​other​organ​of​the​body​that​is​a​key​starting​point​for​the​formulation​ of​ Quechua​ metaphors​ is​ the​ heart.​ Sunqu​ is​ a​ very​ versatile​ word​ because​of​its​many​metaphoric​connections​to​multiple​realities,​states​of​ being,​and​situations.​Through​sunqu,​it​is​possible​to​speak​truthfully​and​ not​just​with​words: Dirigentesta qullqiwan umata muyu-​

The​leaders​are​swirling​the​minds

chichkanku, chayrayku dirigentes​

with​money,​that​is​why​the​leaders

kanku cuchillo de ambos filos, qull-​

are​double​edged​knives,​for​the

qirayku mayladomanpis kutirillanku,​

money​they​will​go​in​any​direction,

simillawan k’achituta parlanku,​mana​

they​speak​beautifully​with​their

sunqunkuwanchu​(94:8).​

mouths,​not​with​their​hearts.

But​sunqu​also​refers​to​the​center​of​a​given​reality,​in​its​conception​of​the​ “middle,”​“importance,”​and​“clandestine”​character.​For​example,​with​respect​to​the​night,​we​find​these​types​of​sentences: Quechua Knowledge and Writings 99

Chawpi​tutaq sunqunpi​sublevacionta​

We​had​made​a​rebellion​in​the

ruwarqayku​(suplem.​77–78:1).​

middle​of​the​night.

In​terms​of​the​earth: Chayniqta Reservas Fiscales, Parques​

That​is​why​they​are​delivering​the

nispa jallp’akunata Instituciones-​

state​reservations,​the​parks,​the

Empresaspaq makinman jaywarapu-​

lands​to​the​hands​of​the​(private)

sanku. Imapaq? Astawan Pachamama​

enterprises.​What​for?​For​them​to

jallp’aq sunqunta​waqcha runakunaq​

squeeze​the​heart​of​Mother​Earth

pulmonisninta ch’irwanankupaq​

and​the​lungs​of​the​poor​people.

(70–71:2).

​ A​group​of​important​associations​with​the​term​sunqu​relate​to​the​fact​ this​is​an​organ​thought​to​be​the​seat​of​satisfaction,​conformity,​rest,​and​ rejoicing.​In​contrast,​to​say​that​you​are​not​with​junt’a sunqu​indicates​you​ are​disquieted,​dissatisfied,​and​anguished: Mana sunquy junt’achu​Instrumento​

My​heart​is​not​happy​due​to​the​fact

Politicota vendesqankumanta​

that​they​have​sold​out​the​Political

(73–74:3).​

Instrument​(of​the​people).

In​terms​of​calmness,​tranquility,​serenity,​the​effect​is​achieved​through​the​ formula​sunqu tiyaykuy: Sindicatos p’utusqanmantapacha​

Since​the​birth​of​the​unions​our

sunquyku tiyaykun​(suplem.​77–78:1).​

hearts​are​in​peace.

The​pain​of​the​heart​vivifies​situations​of​suffering,​at​the​same​time​its​absence​indicates​insensitivity: Gobiernuqta​mana sunqun nananchu​

The​heart​of​the​government​does​not

waqcha runakunamanta, payta nanan​

ache​for​the​poor​people,​it​aches​for

chay qhapaq runamasinmanta​(92:7).​

the​rich​people.

​ The​topic​of​social​and​political​control​is​expressed​by​resorting​to​the​ metaphoric​construction​of​“being​in​the​hands​of.​.​.​.”​In​this​sense,​the​ formula​maki​+​(nominal​suffix​of​a​person)​+–pi ~–man​is​used​to​express​ the​idea​of​having​someone​subjected​to​the​power,​control,​and​authority​of​ another​person: Tawa diputados indígenas​basespaq​

The​four​indigenous​deputies​are​in

makinpi​(75:1).​

the​hands​of​the​grass​roots.

100 FernanDo​garcés​V.

Estados Unidospaq​makinpi​

They​make​us​dance​in​the​hands​of

tusuchiwachkanchik​(67:​3).​

the​USA.

Additionally,​adding​the​root​tusu​in​this​last​example​demonstrates​that​this​ control​is​manipulative,​managing​others​as​if​they​were​puppets​that​could​ be​made​to​dance​on​demand. ​ Another​element​of​human​corporality​frequently​used​as​a​metaphoric​ base​is​llawar.​“I​do​not​have​blood”​indicates​insensitivity,​not​feeling​in​the​ presence​of​the​other: Gobiernoqa k’ullu, uk rumi churakun​

The​government​does​not​listen​to

mana llawarniyuq​gobierno​(67:4).​

(the​people),​making​themselves​hard



as​a​rock,​it​does​not​have​blood.

In​contrast,​to​do​something​“with​blood”​indicates​effort,​suffering: Federacionqa manamin pukllakuyku,​

The​Union​is​not​a​game,​but​we

manataq uk institucion jina qhawa-​

cannot​consider​it​just​as​any​other

sunmanchu, ni Prefecturawan, ni​

institution,​neither​as​the​Prefecture,

Alcaldiawan, ni Policiatawan, chay-​

nor​the​municipality,​nor​the​police,

kunaqa qullquiwan ruwasqa kanku,​

those​are​made​with​money,​but​our

Federacionninchiktaq​llawarwan​

Union​is​made​out​of​blood.

ruwasqa kachkan​(51:3).

​ A​special​type​of​metaphor​found​in​the​newspaper​refers​to​the​personification​of​nature.​Quechua​testimonials​in​the​ PCÑ ​refer​to​nature​or​its​ elements​as​entities​that​get​tired,​walk,​know,​predict,​get​angry.21​Here​are​ some​examples: Pitaq juchayuq kay​pacha sayk’usqa​

Whose​fault​it​is​that​nature​is​tired?

kananpaq?​(46:1). Sach’akuna​waliq wata waqyamuch-​

The​trees​are​predicting​a​good​year

kawanchik​(53:8).​

for​us​[lit.​‘calling​for’].

wakin​yakusqa phiñas chullchuya-​

Some​waters​are​mean,​they​might

chiwasunman​(35:7).​

make​us​sick.

​ In​ the​ same​ way,​ peasant​ knowledge​ is​ anthropomorphized​ because​ it​ exists,​it​grows,​and​it​stays​with​the​Quechua​speaker: Yachayniykuqa​nuqaykuwan kashan.​

Our​knowledge​is​with​us.​This

Wawita kasqaykumanta pacha kay​

knowledge​of​ours​has​to​grow​(multi-

yachayniykuqa​miranan tiyan​

ply)​ever​since​we​were​children​and Quechua Knowledge and Writings 101

wiñaypaq wiñayninpaq, kay yachayqa​

forever​and​ever,​this​knowledge

ni jaykaq tukukunanchu tiyan​

cannot​ever​end.

(Seminario​sobre​Escuela​Campesina de​Raqaypampa,​in​44:​6). Kawsayniyku,​yachayniykuqa,​

Our​life,​our​knowledge​live​with​us

unaymantapachapuni nuqaykuwan​

from​time​immemorial.

kawsan (Pedro​Olivera,​in​79:13).

​ Overall,​the​newspaper’s​metaphoric​world​offers​many​possibilities​for​ idiomatic​development.​The​role​of​bridge​that​the​PCÑ ’s​editorial​team​plays​ is​significant​given​that​its​members​are​also​Quechua​speakers​who​move​ between​the​world​of​oral​informants​and​that​of​the​writing​skills​required​ for​the​newspaper’s​journalistic​function.​On​the​one​hand,​they​intuitively​ use​the​Quechua​metaphors​mobilized​by​villagers​and​leaders​and,​on​the​ other​hand,​they​permanently​struggle​to​render​writing​that​is​comprehensible​to​readers​because​it​follows​certain​norms.

Yachayniyku, or the Politics of Quechua Knowledge In​the​past,​the​knowledge​produced​by​subaltern​groups​was​used​to​think​ about​ them​ and​ formulate​ policies​ for​ them.​ Today​ we​ seek​ the​ revaluation​ of​ local​ knowledge​ and​ the​ active​ participation​ of​ the​ actors​ themselves​in​policymaking.​Three​factors​have​influenced​these​changes.​First,​ the​ transformation​ of​ global​ capitalism​ requires​ the​ further​ expansion​ of​ transnational​ markets​ and​ access​ to​ new,​ often​ scarce,​ resources​ (Lander​ 2002a,​2002b).​Second,​postmodern​discourses​have​highlighted​the​essentialist​and​binary​character​of​modern​knowledge,​making​its​positivisms​ and​absolutisms​more​flexible​(Coronil​2004).​Third,​and​in​contrast,​many​ counterhegemonic​groups​have​made​the​defense​of​place​a​theoretical,​political,​and​ecological​project​(Escobar​1999,​2000). ​ At​the​same​time,​we​continue​to​exist​within​a​framework​that​Mignolo​ calls​the​geopolitics​of​knowledge​(2000,​2001).​Eurocentrism​(in​its​historical​form)​and​North-​centrism​(in​its​current​form),​both​characteristic​of​ contemporary​global​coloniality,​have​canonized​and​validated​one​knowledge​as​legitimate​and​considered​it​universal.​Local​knowledge,​that​of​the​ colonial​and​global​peripheries,​is​dismissed​as​local,​aboriginal,​indigenous,​ or​“ethnic”​knowledge.​It​is​useful​but​not​legitimate—a​knowledge​that​can​ be​studied​and​learned​but​that​is​not​worthy​of​incorporation​into​the​para102 FernanDo​garcés​V.

digmatic​knowledge​of​thinking​and​living​(Garcés​2005a).​What​is​forgotten​ in​this​context​is​that​so-​called​universal​knowledge​is​also​a​local​knowledge,​ but​ one​ that​ managed​ to​ impose​ itself​ onto​ the​ emerging​ capitalist​ world-​system.​As​a​result,​this​knowledge​defined​itself​as​universal​and​led​ others​to​recognize​it​as​such​(Santos​2003). ​ In​the​Conosur​newspaper,​we​see​a​space​for​the​communication​of​a​ wide​gamut​of​topics​related​with​the​yachay—local​knowledge,​in​the​deepest​sense—in​Quechua​communities.​Some​are​technical​or​agricultural​in​ nature:​types​of​soils;​elements​of​Andean​technology,​including​the​construction​of​ditches​and​furrows;​control​of​plagues​such​as​the​saq’u​and​the​ ch’iñi laqatu;​weather​forecasting;​native​seeds;​water​source​management;​ forest​management.​Others​involve​the​communal​management​of​health,​ including​ traditional​ medicine,​ medicinal​ plants,​ and​ animal​ sanitation.​ And​still​others​deal​with​sociopolitical​or​symbolic​aspects:​reciprocity​institutions​like​the​ayni;​community​history;​the​mapping​of​Andean​territory;​rituals​associated​with​productive​and​spatial​control​like​the​q’uwa,​ the​ch’alla,​and​the​pijchu;​local​educational​institutions;​and​narrative​traditions​like​riddles​and​stories.​Throughout​the​Conosur,​four​major​themes​ emerge​ in​ relation​ to​ Quechua​ yachay:​ its​ value;​ its​ location​ in​ different​ physical​ spaces;​ its​ relationship​ to​ language;​ and​ its​ roots​ in​ community​ production​and​cultural​practices.​I​will​provide​some​concrete​examples​ of​each. ​ A​basic​affirmation​in​the​Conosur​is​that​Quechua​peasant​knowledge​is​ better​than​Western​or​urban​knowledge,​that​it​is​professional​and​should​ not​be​lost.​These​beliefs​can​be​seen,​for​example,​in​references​to​knowledge​ about​weather​forecasting​and​tending​the​land: Chay campesinoq yachaynin aswan​

The​knowledge​of​the​peasant​is

sumaq kasan. Nuqaykutaq taripayku​

better.​We​realized​that,​long​before,

ñawpaqpi kanan chay campesinoqta​

peasants​had​knowledge.​They​know

yachaynin. Pay yachan tiempota qha-​

how​to​observe​the​weather​for​the

wayta uj wata tarpuypaq. Imaynachus​

yearly​planting.​They​recognize​the

jamuq wata kananpaq señasta riq-​

signs​for​the​coming​year.​Or​else,

sillantaq. Mana chayqa, imaynatachus​

(they​know)​how​their​ancestors

jallp’ata waqaychaq kanku achachis-​

knew​how​to​take​care​of​the​land.

ninku​(37:7). Profesionales kanchiq yachayninchiq-​

We​are​professionals​in​our​knowl-

manta (Clemente​Salazar,​in​46:4).

edge. Quechua Knowledge and Writings 103

Nuqanchis unaymanta pachapuni​

We​knew​from​times​past​how​to​take

montesninchikta jallch’ayta yachaq​

care​of​our​forests.

kanchiq”​(Zacarías​Ortiz​76:4). Nuqaykuqa mana munaykuchu ya-​

We​do​not​desire​that​our​knowledge

chayniyku wiqch’usqa kananta (54:14).​

be​put​aside.

Nevertheless,​even​though​this​expert​knowledge​has​responded​to​the​environment​better​than​Western​capitalist​knowledge,​it​is​met​with​disrespect​ and​scorn: “Tecnología científicamanta” técnicos,​

The​technicians,​institutions,​govern-

instituciones, gobiernos, Estado ima​

ments,​even​the​State​continue

ch’ipakullankupuni, comunidadpata​

swarming​around​“scientific​tech-

yachayninta manaraqpuni wali-​

nology,”​(and)​they​do​not​value​the

chinkuchu. Ch’irwarkullaytapuni ​

knowledge​of​the​community.​They

munawayku​(63:14).​​

still​want​to​squeeze​us.

There​is​a​contempt​for​peasant​goods​and​labor​which​rests​on​a​type​of​ racism​that​values​production​and​knowledge​from​a​colonial​point​of​view: Campesinospata productonchis mana​

Our​crops​are​not​appreciated,​our

valenchu, trabajonchis mana valenchu;​

work​is​not​appreciated;​not​happy

todavía chaywan mana contentaku-​

with​that​(work),​the​town​people,

wanchiqchu kay pueblopi kaqkuna kay​

the​rich,​are​getting​disgusted​by​us,—

khapaq runas, paykuna noqanchista​

what​does​an​ignorant​Indian​know—

millachikusawanchis, imatá yachan

saying,​comrades.

kay indio bruturi nispa compañeros (Valeriano​Romero,​34:6).

As​a​result,​peasant​production​and​knowledge​are​degraded​as​a​result​of​ changes​introduced​by​modern​technology​and​its​ideology.​Peasant​yachay​ is​subordinated​to​urban​and​scientific​knowledge​at​the​service​of​dominant​sectors: [. . .] ñawpataqa allinta puquykunata​

In​the​past​we​knew​how​to​handle

apayqachasarqayku, jallp’apis sumaq​

the​crops​well,​the​soil​was​also​very

kallpayuq kachkarqa mana kunan​

fertile,​not​as​it​is​today.​The​chemicals

jinachu, chayman chayanapaqqa karqa​

that​appeared​led​us​to​this​situation,

rikhurimusqan chay kimiku, maychus​

the​so-​called​modern​technology,​the

jamun tecnología moderna nisqawan,​

town​people​resort​to​this​discourse.

104 FernanDo​garcés​V.

llaqtarunakuna kay parlayta apayqa-​

Nowadays​the​soil​has​become​hard.

chanku. Kunanqa jallp’akunaqa chuqru-​

Our​fellow​countrymen​have​seen

man tukun, compañeros rikunku kay​

that​these​chemicals​are​a​poison​for

kimiku jallp’apaq uk veneno kasqanta.​

the​soil.

Chaywanpis, llaqtarunaqa Universidad​

In​spite​of​that,​the​ones​who​have

yachay wasipi yachaqkunaqa mana​

studied​at​the​universities​do​not

campesinota valechinkuchu, ninku:​

value​the​peasant’s​knowledge.​They

–imata campo runa yachanri nuqayku​

said–what​does​the​peasant​know?​We

Universidadpi yachayku, yachaykutaq​

studied​at​the​university,​and​we​know

kimiku venenochus manachus–,​

whether​the​chemical​(fertilizer)​is

ajinata paykunapis parlanku, jinapis​

poisonous​or​not.​That​is​the​way​they

compañeros, yachanchik imaptinchus​

speak,​comrades.​Thus​comrades,​we

parlanku chayta, mana kimikusta​

know​why​they​speak​like​that.​If​we

rantisunman chayqa, mana qulqi

did​not​buy​those​chemicals,​there

yaykunmanchu qhapaqkunapaq,​

would​be​no​income​for​the​rich.

chayta yachaspa paykunaqa, chay​

Because​they​know​that,​the​techni-

tecnicosqa, comunidadespi yachachispa​

cians​are​teaching​in​the​communities

kanku qhapaq runaq kawsayninman​

the​ways​of​the​rich,​they​defend​the

jina, paykunaqa qhapaq runaq​

way​of​life​of​the​rich.

kawsayninta jark’akunku​(Florencio Alarcón,​in​60:​4).

​ The​second​major​theme​in​the​Conosur​is​that​Quechua​yachay​is​expressed​and​socialized​in​many​places,​but​here​I​will​limit​myself​to​showing​ the​tension​of​two​locations:​the​school​and​the​community.​At​its​most​fundamental​level,​education​takes​place​within​the​community​and​the​organization: Sapa comuna ukhupi nuqayku pura​

Inside​every​community,​we​teach

yachachinakuyku​(Fructuoso​Vallejos,​

each​other.

in​64:10). Jatuchik tantakuykunaqa​

The​large​meetings​[congresses​and

chaqrarunakunapaqqa uk yachay​

union​leaders​meetings]​are​like

wasipis kanman jina​(67:6).​

schools​for​us​the​peasants.

Likewise,​there​is​a​clear​awareness​that​the​family​provides​a​better​education​than​schools​and​that​schools​must​respond​to​the​community’s​way​of​ life​and​productive​system:

Quechua Knowledge and Writings 105

Yachayqa mana yachay wasi​

Knowledge​is​not​found​only​in​the

ukhullapichu (64:10).​

schools.

Aswan allin wasipi mama tataq​

The​teachings​of​our​parents​at​home

yachachisqan, mana ni qhillqayta,​

were​better,​(even)​without​knowing

nitaq ñawiyta yachan​(64:11).​

how​to​read​or​write.

Educación nuqanchikpaq kawsaynin-​

Let​education​for​us​be​according​to

chikman jina, nuqanchikpaq​

our​culture,​according​to​our​work.

llank’ayninchikman jina kachun​(57:14).

​ A​specific​historical​case​that​illustrates​the​tension​between​family​and​ community​on​one​side​and​the​school​on​the​other​occurred​in​1986​in​Raqaypampa,​in​the​Mizque​highlands.​The​community​criticized​the​teachers​ for​being​arrogant​with​parents​and​community​leaders;​for​impeding​the​ children’s​ learning​ by​ teaching​ in​ Spanish​ instead​ of​ Quechua;​ and,​ perhaps​ most​ important,​ for​ not​ respecting​ the​ community’s​ work​ calendar.​ In​response,​the​parents​took​their​children​out​of​the​school.​The​following​ year​the​community​named​“peasant​teachers”​to​manage​the​school​in​the​ neighboring​community​of​Rumi​Muqu.​In​an​experiment​under​the​name​ Ayni​School​(Garcés​and​Guzmán​2006),​the​community​paid​these​teachers​with​products​and​labor​in​their​fields,​and,​in​turn,​the​teachers​taught​ in​Quechua​and​worked​from​June​24​to​September​24. ​ The​ conflict,​ which​ persisted​ until​ 1992,​ revolved​ around​ two​ central​points:​the​school​calendar​and​who​had​jurisdictional​authority.​On​ the​first​point,​community​members​argued​that​if​their​children​were​in​ school​when​they​were​needed​for​agricultural​work,​they​missed​the​opportunity​to​be​educated​by​their​parents​(Arratia​2001;​Garcés​and​Guzmán​2006).​On​the​second​point,​the​community​felt​that​the​school,​being​ practically​the​only​state​representative​in​the​community,​had​to​submit​ to​communal​authority​(Garcés​and​Guzmán​2006;​Regalsky​2003).​The​ Conosur​articles​from​those​years,​therefore,​emphasized​that​the​schools​ responded​to​the​interests​of​the​rich,​not​to​the​desires​and​needs​of​the​ peasant: yachanchik jina kunankamaqa educa-​

As​we​know,​up​to​this​date​(formal)

ción qhapaqkuna yachakunankupaq​

education​has​been​for​the​rich;​it​has

jina, mana nuqanchikpaq munaynin-​

not​been​(designed)​according​to​our

chikman jinachu (Florencio​Alarcón,

needs.

in​56:6). 106 FernanDo​garcés​V.

​ Building​from​this​experience,​people​emphasize​that​Educacionqa kawsayninchikmanta kawsayninchikpaq kanan tiyan​(“Education​has​to​be​[designed,​implemented]​from​our​life​and​for​our​life”)​(Garcés​and​Guzmán​ 2003).​On​the​basis​of​this​principle,​the​Educación​Intercultural​Bilingüe​ project​(Intercultural​Bilingual​Education,​or​eib )​is​criticized​as​being​imposed​ from​ outside​ and​ as​ being​ unsuitable​ to​ peasant​ life​ because,​ even​ though​ the​ project​ is​ bilingual,​ it​ does​ not​ respect​ the​ community’s​ time​ and​rhythms.​In​that​context,​the​experience​of​Rumi​Muqu​serves​as​a​valid​ counterproposal. Nuqa uchhikitanta niyta munani chay​

I​would​like​to​say​a​little​about​that

iskay qallupi yachanakuymanta (Edu-​

education​in​two​tongues​(Intercul-

cación Intercultural Bilingüe), nuqan-​

tural​Bilingual​Education),​we​are

chik chaqra llank’aypi tarikunchik​

peasants​but​those​teachings​(of

manataq kay yachakuykunamanta​

formal​education)​are​not​for​us,​are

mana nuqanchikpaq mana kawsaynin-​

not​designed​according​to​our​way​of

chikman jinachu. Chaytataq nuqa kay-​

life.​I​would​like​to​request​to​our

patamanta autoridadesninchikmanta​

authorities​up​here,​that​the​school​

mañakuni, nuqanchikpaq kawsaynin-

calendar​be​designed​according​to​our

chikman jina, calendario escolar ruwa​

life.​For​a​few​years,​we​have​placed​a

kunanta. Ñawpaq watamanta pachaña​

peasant​teacher​in​ayni​(reciprocity

nuqanchik aynipi uk campesino yacha-​

system),​and​he​is​teaching​according

chik churakuspa llank’aynin chikman​

to​our​work.​I​wish​they​work​in​just

jina risan, kikillantapuni llank’ananta​

that​manner,​as​in​the​Rumi​Muqu

yachay wasin Rumi Muqupi munani,​

school;​we​are​used​to​that.

chaywan nuqanchik yachasqa kachkanchik​(Nicolas​Pardo​in​52:4).

​ The​central​criterion​is​that​the​indigenous​organization​must​control​any​ educational​proposal.​School​calendars,​teachers,​and​curriculum​must​all​ respect​community​values.​On​the​question​of​calendars,​if​the​school​functions​during​the​seasonal​peak​of​agricultural​labor,​it​breaks​the​community’s​educational​time: Nuqaykupaq chay tiempo escuela kanan​

For​us,​for​all​the​peasants​the​school

mana waliq kasqanta k’ala entero​

time​is​not​good.​I​had​thought​that

agricultorespaq. Nuqa qhawarqani​

the​time​we​relax​in​our​farming,

mayk’aqchus ima tiempochus nuqayku​

that’s​when​the​schools​for​the​chil-

llank’ayniykumanta llawqiyaykuman​

dren​should​start.​The​fact​is​that​our Quechua Knowledge and Writings 107

chaymanta qallarinman escuelas​

life​is​of​one​kind,​and​the​life​of​the

wawaspaq . . . Nuqaykuqta kawsayniy-

cities​is​of​another​type.

kuqawaqjinataq, llaqtaq kawsaynin waqjinataq (Luis​Albarracín,​in​38:13).

On​the​question​of​teachers​and​curriculum,​for​the​school​truly​to​belong​to​ the​community,​it​must​have​its​own​peasant​teacher​so​that​Quechua​children​can​study​according​to​their​own​knowledge​and​language​and​at​the​ same​time​benefit​from​the​knowledge​of​their​elders: Waturirqayku, imaraykutaq mana​

We​asked​why​are​there​not​teachers

kanchu maestros campesinos wawa-​

to​teach​the​peasants’​children?​It

kunata yachachinapaq? Waliq kanman​

would​be​good​that​the​children​at

wawakuna escuelapi yachakunanku​

school​learn​about​what​we​have​on​

imataq jallp’a patapi kapuwasqan-​

the​soil,​about​our​knowledge,​our

chikmanta, yachayninchikmanta,​

organization​as​unions,​and​all​of

organización sindicalmanta, kay​

this​in​our​Quechua​tongue.​We

tukuytaqa qhichwa qallunchikpi.​

could​also​make​an​exchange​of​the

Atillasunmantaq intercambio de​

so-​called​knowledges,​resorting​to​the

conocimientos nisqata ruwayta, kuraq​

knowledge​of​our​elders,​so​we​could

tatakunaq yachayninta uqharispa, ​

walk​according​to​that​(knowledge).

chayman jina purinapaq (Un comunario​de​Tacachi,​in​83:7).

​ The​third​major​theme​in​the​Conosur​on​the​subject​of​Quechua​peasant​ yachay​is​its​close​linkage​to​the​language​in​which​it​is​expressed​(Garcés​ 2005a).​From​the​perspective​of​the​geopolitics​of​knowledge,​indigenous​ languages​have​been​subalter(n)ized,​or​constructed​as​inferior,​in​the​process​of​colonial​differentiation.​The​knowledge​expressed​in​indigenous​languages​has​been​dismissed​as​a​knowledge​that,​in​the​best​of​cases,​expresses​ the​emotive​environment​of​these​communities​of​speakers​(Ong​1982).​eib​ programs,​on​the​other​hand,​have​attempted​to​normalize​and​standardize​ indigenous​languages,​to​give​them​an​inscribed​written​form,​and​to​revalorize​indigenous​knowledge.​Among​the​psycholinguistic​justifications​for​ eib ​programs​has​ been​the​promise​ of​better​cognitive​ development​ and​ scholarly​results​through​learning​in​the​mother​tongue​(López​and​Küper​ 2000). ​ What​we​find​in​Conosur,​however,​is​that​the​Quechua​language​cannot​ be​studied​in​isolation​from​the​power​relations​in​which​it​is​embedded.​The​ 108 FernanDo​garcés​V.

discrimination​experienced​by​the​Quechua​peasant​is​seen​as​similar​to​the​ discrimination​Quechua​suffers​as​a​language: Qhishwa parlayninchista k’alata​

They​are​allowing​our​Quechua

kunankamaqa saruchisanku kastillanu​

language​to​be​completely​stepped

rimaywan​(33:12).​

upon​by​the​Spanish​language.

Because​of​this,​Quechua​positions​itself​conflictively​and​in​opposition​to​ Spanish;​to​compete​with​Spanish​means​to​defend,​value,​and​develop​one’s​ own​culture: Qhishwata pataman tanqananchik​

We​have​to​push​Quechua​upward

tiyan maqanachinapaq waq qalluwan.​

so​that​it​can​compete​with​another

Chantapis kulturanchikta astawan​

tongue.​Also​to​raise​our​culture

pataman uqharinapaq​(Pablo​Vargas,​

higher.

in​59:10).

The​study​of​Quechua​is​never​an​end​in​itself.​In​order​to​serve​as​a​tool​of​ liberation,​it​must​operate​in​tandem​with​other​strategies,​such​as​its​written​inscription​according​to​its​oral​use​and​not​according​to​what​a​group​ of​planners​says: Tukuy campesinos qhishwa parlay-​

All​the​peasants​who​are​speaking​in

ninchispi rimaspa qhilqasunchis.​

our​language​will​also​write.​From

Kunan manta ñawpaqmanjinamanta​

now​on,​in​this​way​we​shall​raise​our

par layninchista uqharisunchis, kay​ KULLASUYU llaqtanchispi imaray-​ kuchus kay phisqapachaq wataña​ qhishwa parlaq runaqa engañasqa​ rikukuyku tukuy imapi. Chaymanta​ qhishwa rimayninchispi qhilqasunchis​ chayqa librostapis ruwasunchis parlay-​ ninchisman jina (Santos​Albarracín, in​39:16).

language.​Because​in​the​Qulla​Suyu, we​the​Quechua-​speaking​people​have found​ourselves​deceived​in​every thing​for​five​hundred​years.​That’s why,​if​we​write​in​our​Quechua language,​we​will​make​the​books according​to​our​own​speech.

​ In​this​sense,​Quechua​can​be​an​instrument​of​liberation​or​oppression,​ as​happened​in​the​colonial​period.​It​would​seem​that​the​key​matter​is​not​ only​to​develop,​inscribe​in​writing,​or​intellectualize​the​language,​but​to​ determine​what​practical​purposes​and​sociopolitical​practices​the​language​ can​serve.​In​this​sense,​the​language—like​communal​institutions​themselves—can​be​put​in​the​service​of​systems​of​state​control: Quechua Knowledge and Writings 109

Gobierno qallunchikpi apay munach-​

The​government​is​trying​to​lead​us​to

kawanchik paykunaq yuyayninllanku-​

their​thinking​in​our​own​tongue.

manta​(Félix​Santos,​in​57:14).

​ This​brings​me​to​the​fourth​and​final​theme​in​the​Conosur​dealing​with​ Quechua​yachay,​which​is​that​Quechua​peasant​knowledge​has​two​closely​ related​roots​that​feed​it:​the​peasant​system​of​production​and​reproduction​and​the​indigenous​peasant​community.​In​relation​to​the​first​root,​the​ Conosur​collects​Quechua​knowledge​on​such​topics​as​how​granaries​are​ built,​which​varieties​of​corn​seed​are​known,​and​what​medicinal​plants​ are​present​in​a​particular​area​and​how​should​they​be​used.​It​also​uses​research​ cenDa ​has​conducted​in​Raqaypampa​over​many​years​to​demonstrate​the​benefits​of​the​Quechua​productive​system. ​ Perhaps​one​of​the​most​important​topics​is​weather​prediction,​and​the​ Conosur​has​dedicated​abundant​space​to​it.​As​a​front-​page​headline​in​PCÑ​ 32​proclaimed,​“Predicting​the​weather​is​peasant​wisdom.”​Later​on​in​the​ same​issue​(8–9),​several​community​members’​testimonies​on​the​topic​are​ presented​in​a​section​entitled,​“The​principal​peasant​art​is​weather​forecasting.”​The​section​then​concludes​in​Spanish:​“The​principal​art​of​peasants​continues​to​be​predicting​the​exact​behavior​of​the​rains​and,​accordingly,​to​organize​the​planting​of​different​crops​in​the​best​places​and​on​the​ best​soils​to​ensure​the​rains’​maximum​advantage”​(32:20).​This​continuous​ concern​is​perhaps​best​represented​in​the​annual​Weather​Prediction​Contest.​In​64:8,​we​find​an​annual​announcement: Kay wata 1995–1996 qallarikullanña-​

This​year​1995–1996​has​already

taq, imaynataq kay wata kanqa,​

begun,​how​is​this​year​going​to​be?

watuna kachkan, amañana siñakuna​

We​have​to​ask,​we​need​to​predict

qhawayta: sach’akuna, wayra, chiri,​

how​it​will​be,​accustomed​as​we​are

uywakuna, phuyukuna, waqkuna ima​

to​reading​the​signs:​the​trees,​the

chayllamanta astawan waliq kanan​

wind,​the​domestic​animals,​the

tarpuyninchik. Kay watapaq para​

clouds​and​other​things;​for​making

imaynataq kanqa, mayqin makistataq​

our​farm​fields​better.​How​will​the

para yanapanqa, manachayqa luku​

rain​for​this​year​be,​who​will​the​rain

parachu kanqa, imaynataq?​

help,​or​will​the​rain​be​a​downpour,



how​will​it​be?

The​newspaper​interviews​participating​elders​and​publishes​the​different​ versions​of​their​forecasts​for​the​upcoming​agricultural​year.​At​the​end​of​ 110 FernanDo​garcés​V.

each​cycle,​the​newspaper​evaluates​the​cycle​in​relation​to​the​readers’​testimonies​and​selects​the​elder​with​the​closest​prediction.​By​means​of​this​ contest​the​newspaper​seeks​to​preserve​and​stimulate​the​circulation​of​the​ Quechua​yachay​about​weather​prediction​and​hopes​that​writing​will​safeguard​this​yachay​given​that​global​climate​change​is​endangering​weather​ prediction: Ñawpa kuraqkuna astawan yachaq​

The​elders​are​the​ones​who​know

kanku kay tiempo qhawaymantaqa.​

more​about​these​weather​predictions.

Kay tiempo runasqa mana anchata​

The​people​of​today​do​not​know

yachankuñachu. Yachaymanchus​

very​much.​If​I​knew​how​to​read

ñawiyta, qhilqayta imaqa, tukuy​

and​write,​I​would​write​down​all​my

qhawasqayta sapa wata qhilqiyman​

predictions​for​the​year​on​paper​so

papelpi mana qunqanapaq. Ikillapis​

that​they​are​not​forgotten.​Probably,

tukuy yachankuman tiempoman​

all​would​already​know​about​the

jinañachu. Chaytaq qhasiman rin​

weather​in​that​way​(written​down

llank’anku​(Fermín​Vallejos,​in​39:8).​

on​paper).​But​they​work​in​vain



(if​they​do​not​observe​the​signs).

​ The​newspaper​works​as​well​to​preserve​knowledges​that​serve​to​control​ plagues​like​the​ch’iñi laqatu​(weevils​of​the​Andes)​and​degenerative​diseases​like​the​saq’u.​As​the​newspaper​affirms,​Yachayninchiqwan khurukunamanta jark’akuna​(104:14)​(“With​our​knowledge​let​us​defend​ourselves​ from​the​plagues”).​The​topic​of​traditional​medicine​is​covered​in​articles​ on​the​uses​of​traditional​medicinal​plants​such​as​rosemary​and​horsetail​ (PCÑ ​38:7). ​ The​second​root​that​sustains​peasant​knowledge​is​the​social​organization​of​the​community.​Because​modern​techniques​often​seek​to​destroy​ communal​organizations​by​imposing​a​different​rationality​of​production​ on​them,​one​of​the​principal​topics​of​the​Quechua​yachay​deals​with​the​ subject​and​practices​of​development.​ PCÑ ​32:8​reports​that​state​institutions​as​well​as​agrochemical​companies​and​their​sales​representatives​pressure​peasants​to​“modernize.”​According​to​them,​peasant​agriculture​would​ benefit​ through​ the​introduction​ of​improved​ seeds,​ the​increased​use​ of​ chemical​fertilizers,​pesticides,​herbicides,​and​insecticides,​and​the​introduction​of​mechanization.​Mechanization​is​also​achieved​through​regularizing​the​size​(medianización)​of​the​agricultural​plots.​Afterward,​the​newspaper​cites​cenDa ​experiments​that​show​a​rather​different​reality,​namely,​ that​“the​introduction​of​improved​seeds​or​the​increase​in​fertilizers​and​ Quechua Knowledge and Writings 111

pesticides​are​of​secondary​importance​and​sometimes​detrimental​to​crop​ yields;​while​traditional​peasant​knowledge​about​weather​prediction​(in​relation​to​soils​and​plants)​continues​to​be​what​defines​the​success​or​failure​ of​a​crop.”22 ​ cenDa ,​in​agreement​with​a​local​organization,​carried​out​a​series​of​ tests​on​fifteen​plots​of​land​in​Raqaypampa​community​during​the​1987–88​ agricultural​cycle.​The​results,​presented​in​ PCÑ ​32,​contained​three​main​ points.​First,​the​local​varieties​of​potato​are​more​productive​than​the​newly​ introduced​“improved”​variety,​since​they​have​the​advantage​of​suitability​ to​the​type​of​rain​and​soils​of​the​area.​Second,​fertilization​does​not​ensure​greater​production​because​a​hailstorm​or​lack​of​rain​can​reverse​its​ positive​effects.​And​third,​the​technological​element​of​greatest​importance​ is​ weather​ management,​ which​ implies​ weather​ forecasting​ in​ relation​ to​ suitable​varieties​for​the​types​of​terrain,​the​dates​of​planting​chosen​according​ to​ the​ types​ of​ soil​ and​ varieties,​ and​ the​ management​ of​ family​ members’​labor.​“In​other​words,”​the​article​concludes,​“the​most​important​ techniques​in​the​region’s​agriculture​are​based​entirely​on​peasants’​traditional​knowledge​and,​by​comparison,​‘modern​technology’​can​make​few​ solid​and​effective​contributions.”23 ​ A​series​of​articles​in​the​Conosur​critiques​patents,​the​appropriation​of​ peasant-​indigenous​knowledge​by​transnational​agro-​food​and​pharmaceutical​companies,​and​institutions​that​introduce​into​the​communities​technological​packages​inherited​from​the​green​revolution.​Examples​of​the​first​ case​are​found​in​ PCÑ ​nos.​76​and​77–78,​which​discuss​the​patent​of​quinoa,​the​protest​by​the​National​Association​of​Quinoa​Producers,​and​the​ patent’s​subsequent​annulment.​ PCÑ ​86:8​contains​an​article​denouncing​ Monsanto’s​attempts​to​introduce​transgenetic​seeds​into​the​country. ​ The​link​between​the​yachay​and​communal​organization​is​a​subject​of​ great​importance​to​the​newspaper.​It​could​be​said​that​knowledge​is​valued​ because​of​the​ways​in​which​it​contributes​to​strengthening​communal​organization.​While​individual​knowledge​may​be​more​prestigious​in​a​national​imagined​community,​it​does​not​work​at​the​community​level:24 ñawpata papasusninchik mana qill-​

In​the​past​our​parents​did​not​know

qayta, ñawiyta yacharqankuchu, jinapis​

how​to​read​or​write,​but​in​spite​of

organización sindical sumaq purichik​

this​they​made​the​Union​function

kanku. Nuqanchik ñawpata jina uk​

well.​We​have​to​walk​as​in​the​past,

runa jinalla purinanchik tiyan, sut’inta​

as​one​single​man,​speaking​the​truth;

112 FernanDo​garcés​V.

parlana, nuqanchikqa uk chhika​

knowing​a​little​bit,​we​are​already

yachaytawankama ñapis politikuq

grabbing​the​tails​of​the​politicians,

chupanta jap’itawan purichkanchik,​

sticking​to​one​or​another;​in​that​way

ukman ukman k’askachkanchik,​

we​will​never​overcome​this​life​of

chaywanqa mana ni jayk’aq kay llakiy

misery.

kawsay sarusunchu​(56:6).

​ Modern​knowledge,​therefore,​is​unable​to​offer​organizational​strength,​ and​education​cannot​consist​only​in​knowing​how​to​read​and​write;​rather,​ it​must​involve​knowing​local​Andean​technology​and​communal​organizational​forms: Educacionqa mana ñawiriy-​

Education​is​not​only​reading​and

qillqariyllachu, kawsayniykumanta​

writing.​We​created​the​Communal

‘tecnología andina’ yachayta, sindi-​

Council​of​Education​because​we

calismota yachay wasiman churayta​

wanted​to​introduce​Andean​tech-

munaspa Consejo Comunal de Educa-​

nology​and​unionization​to​the

ciontaqa jatarichirqayku​(Florencio​

school.

Alarcón,​in​64:10).

Quechua​yachay​and​the​social​organization​that​sustains​it​are​intimately​connected:​if​unique​organizational​forms​are​lost,​social​knowledge​is​also​lost.​ Consequently,​it​does​not​make​sense​to​defend​peasant​knowledge​in​and​of​ itself,​but​in​close​connection​with​the​preservation​of​territorial​autonomy: Ñawpataqa yakuyuq jallp’akunapiqa​

Before,​there​was​water​for​irrigation

karqapuni qarpanapaqqa, comunidad​

and​the​community​with​the​union

sindicatowan khuska apaykachaq​

organized​turns​for​everyone.​They

kanku mit’asta, paykuna rak’iq kanku​

would​distribute​the​water.​In​recent

yakutaqa. Kay qhipamanri Instituciones​

times,​however,​development​agencies

de desarrollo q’alata tukuyniqman​

put​us​all​together​and​carried​out

junt’aykamuwanchik, paykunataq ​

public​works​in​the​communities:

comunidadespiqa ruwanku obrasta: ​

irrigation​canals​that​are​paved​and

canales de riego cementowan, jatuchik​

blocked​off.​With​public​works​like

quchas tukuy imata. Kay jina​

these,​the​knowledge​of​the​commu-

obraswanqa comunidadpaq yachay-

nity​disappears,​neither​is​this​in​the

ninqa chinkan, sindicatopis manaña​

hands​of​the​unions;​these​institutions

makinpichu jap’in, chay institucionesqa​

ordered​us​to​create​new​associations

kamachinku jatarinanta Asociaciones​

or​committees​for​irrigation.

manachay Comités de Riego”​(68:11). Quechua Knowledge and Writings 113

​ The​link​of​the​yachay​with​communal​organization​and​territorial​autonomy​is,​however,​located​in​a​broader​context​that​seeks​independence​ from​the​institutions​and​foreign​nations​attempting​to​change​peasant​life​ in​order​to​incorporate​it​into​capitalism: Campesino yachan, tukuy imamanta​

The​peasant​knows.​He​has​experience

experiencia tiyan: tiempota qhawan,​

with​everything:​he​watches​(predicts)

jallp’ata llank’ayta, mujuta churayta,​

the​weather,​works​the​soil,​sows​the

trojaspi mikhunapaq waqaychayta,​

seeds,​knows​what​to​store​for​eating

vendenanpaq ima. Tukuy kayta organi-​

and​what​to​sell.​All​of​this​is​done

zacionninwan mana dependespa ni​

independently,​with​the​organization,

pimanta. Wakin Institucionesqa mana​

without​depending​on​anyone.​Some

qhawankuchu, mana yuyankuchu.​

institutions​do​not​see,​do​not​think.

Mana kay culturasta respetaspalla,​

Without​respecting​the​culture​they

cambio socialta mask’anku nispa ninku. ​ strive​for​social​change.​They​want​us Jawa nacionesmanta dependenanta​

to​depend​on​other​countries,​to

munanku chaywan culturanchista

change​our​culture.

cambiananta (Dirigentes​de​Campero, in​37:11).

The​communal​organization​of​the​Quechua​peasantry,​then,​is​not​simply​ an​administrative​apparatus,​but​also​the​main​line​of​defense​and​control​ of​territory​in​order​to​preserve​political​autonomy​in​the​face​of​attempts​ at​destructuring​by​the​state​and​transnational​capital.​As​the​fundamental​ element​in​the​historical​continuity​of​Quechua​communities,​it​also​oversees​other​entities​present​in​the​community,​such​as​the​school,​and​controls​access​to​resources.​It​is​for​this​reason​that​the​resolutions​of​a​peasant​ congress​in​Campero​province​(PCÑ ​42:5)​prohibit​merchants​from​cutting​ trees​in​the​forest​and​selling​the​wood;​request​that​the​csutcb ​guard​the​ communities’​forests​by,​among​other​measures,​ensuring​that​the​lumber​ companies​do​not​profit​from​the​sale​of​communal​forests;​and​prohibit​ merchants​from​stealing​and​selling​trees​that​belong​to​the​communities.

Conclusions: Rethinking Power, Knowledge, and Linguistic Practice Historically,​ Quechua’s​ process​ of​ inscription​ and​ system​ of​ writing​ have​ been​unable​to​get​beyond​their​use​for​specific​ends,​such​as​religious​conversion​and​training,​education,​and​so​on.​In​general,​linguistic​policy​in​ relation​ to​ minority​ or​ oppressed​ languages​ basically​ exists​ solely​ to​ pro114 FernanDo​garcés​V.

mote​the​written​inscription​of​these​languages.​In​the​Bolivian​case,​over​ the​past​few​years​the​main​effort​has​been​to​develop​a​process​of​the​inscription​of​Quechua​through​two​fundamental​mechanisms:​the​standardization​of​Quechua​writing​through​a​unified​orthographic​normative,​the​ creation​of​neologisms​and​the​establishment​of​a​certain​morpho-​syntactic​ normative;​and​the​diffusion​of​this​generalized​system​through​the​Educational​Reform.25 ​ Bolivian​linguistic​policy​toward​Quechua,​even​if​supposedly​a​policy​ of​recovery,​is​being​formulated​on​the​basis​of​four​arguable​assumptions:​ (1)​that​the​maintenance​and​revitalization​of​Quechua​must​be​built​from​its​ inscription​in​writing​and​through​teaching​it​in​the​schools;​(2)​that​a​pan-​ Andean​unification​of​Quechua​will​promote​the​empowerment​and​the​destigmatization​ of​Quechua​ speakers;​ (3)​ that​ the​written​ form’s​ standardization​is​key​to​the​language’s​development​and​fortification;​and​(4)​that​ historical​criteria​are​the​best​guide​for​developing​a​standard​form​when​ faced​with​existing​dialectical​variation​(Luykx​2001).​As​Luykx​notes,​these​ assumptions​emphasize​a​linguistic​policy​that​(a)​directs​efforts​to​situations​ in​ which​ Quechua​ is​ at​ a​ disadvantage​ with​ Spanish;​ (b)​ prioritizes​ the​preoccupations​of​language​and​educational​planners​above​those​of​the​ Quechua-​speaking​majority;​and​(c)​links​dialectical​variation​to​the​prestige​and​hierarchy​of​one​class,​which​stigmatizes​nonstandardized​varieties. ​ This​policy​starts​from​a​set​of​criteria​developed​with​reference​to​Spanish​ and​ the​ interests​ of​ policymakers,​ including​ criteria​ of​ inscription​ in​ writing,​scholasticization,​pan-​Andean​standardization,​and​historicism.​In​ an​attempt​to​overcome​diglossia,​policymakers​are​elaborating​a​prestige-​ based,​ academicist​ model​ that​ prioritizes​ intellectualization​ and​ writing.​ They​do​not​begin​from​the​linguistic​reality​of​the​majority​of​speakers​or​ from​their​concrete​communicational​interests​and​necessities.​In​the​end,​ they​do​not​pay​attention​to​the​language’s​own​sociocommunicative​capital,​ but​instead​seek​to​impose​its​standardization​through​a​comparison​with​ the​practices​of​the​language​and​the​group​in​power. ​ What​ I​ have​ attempted​ to​ show​ here​ is​ that​ the​ Conosur Ñawpagman​ newspaper​offers​a​way​to​research​writing​as​it​emerges​from​concrete​linguistic​practices.​This​is​especially​interesting​because​it​deals​with​an​extra-​ scholastic​experience​that​seeks​to​inscribe​speakers’​oral​discourse.​I​think​ that​in​this​process​there​is​potential​for​developing​a​written​inscription​that​ has​not​received​much​attention​in​terms​of​linguistic​planning,​one​that​ seeks​to​overcome​normative​and​elitist​visions.​The​very​creation​of​neoloQuechua Knowledge and Writings 115

gisms​ would​ benefit​ from​ the​ incorporation​ of​ speakers’​ everyday​ metaphors,​rather​than​resorting​to​desktop​creations​or​to​the​resurrection​of​ obsolete​historical​forms​which,​even​if​passionately​sought​after​by​the​linguist,​sound​strange​to​contemporary​speakers. ​ As​for​the​topic​of​the​Quechua​yachay,​I​think​it​is​important​to​reflect— even​if​hypothetically—on​the​relations​between​knowledge​and​territoriality.​As​the​topic​of​local,​indigenous,​or​native​knowledge​has​become​central​to​the​academic​agenda​of​many​intellectuals,​whether​indigenous​or​ not,​we​risk​building​a​decontextualized,​abstract​discourse​about​indigenous​knowledge​that​can​be​managed​by​global​capitalism.​If​this​happens,​ indigenous​knowledges​would​be​disqualified​in​the​name​of​science​and​ progress​even​as​global​capitalism​sought,​through​legal​mechanisms,​to​appropriate​and​pillage​those​very​same​knowledges. ​ Within​the​current​system​of​globalization,​the​development​of​biotechnology​ and​ the​ appropriation​ of​ the​ collective​ knowledge​ of​ indigenous-​ peasant​ communities​ could​ constitute​ an​ important​ resource​ for​ capitalism​when​faced​with​crisis.​We​are​on​the​verge​of​a​qualitative​leap​in​how​ knowledge​can​be​linked​to​relations​of​neocolonial​domination​in​the​contemporary​world,​in​the​sense​that​it​can​“immediately​and​directly​create​ new​forms​of​subordination​and​new​relations​of​domination​and​exploitation”​(Lander​2002b,​73). ​ For​those​who​have​created​the​global​order,​Western​knowledge​is​objective​ and​ universal​ and​ therefore​ worthy​ of​ protection​ through​ private​ property​ rights.​ Other​ knowledges​ are​ nonknowledge​ and​ can​ therefore​ be​appropriated​through​pillage​and​piracy.​Scientific​and​entrepreneurial​ knowledge​is​the​knowledge,​meaning​it​has​to​be​protected​by​exacting​payment​for​its​use.​Here​we​have​“one​of​the​most​important​methods​for​the​ concentration​of​power​and​the​increase​in​the​inequalities​that​characterize​ the​current​globalization​process.​For​that​reason,​it​constitutes​one​of​the​ more​significant​dimensions​in​the​geopolitics​of​contemporary​capitalism”​ (Lander​2002b,​74). ​ The​development​of​biotechnology​has​recently​seen​impressive​advances​ with​experiments​in​cloning,​genetically​modified​crops,​and​the​decoding​ of​the​human​genome.​To​realize​such​development,​biotechnology​requires​ legal​ and​ commercial-​economic​ security​ mechanisms,​ designed​ over​ the​ course​of​several​years,​to​allow​it​unfettered​accumulation.​In​recent​international​agreements​and​treaties,​such​as​naFta ,​the​creation​in​1995​of​the​ World​Trade​Organization,​efforts​to​subscribe​to​the​Multilateral​Invest116 FernanDo​garcés​V.

ment​Agenda,​and​now​attempts​to​formalize​even​further​“free​trade”​negotiations​such​as​the​ Ftaa ​and​the​Andean​free​trade​agreement,​the​topics​ related​to​agriculture​and​intellectual​property​rights​receive​a​great​deal​of​ attention. ​ It​was​no​accident​that​in​these​agreements​and​treaties​the​concept​of​ intellectual​ property​ rights​ was​ expanded;​ it​ no​ longer​ is​ limited​ to​ that​ which​is​invented,​but​now​includes​that​which​is​discovered.​As​has​been​ true​for​over​five​hundred​years,​colonial​modernity​continues​discovering​ and​conquering.​Before,​colonial​modernity​discovered​America,​meaning​it​ became​aware​of​that​which​was​previously​unknown​to​it,​and​that​awareness​translated​into​conquest,​domination,​and​accumulation.​Today,​colonial​ modernity​ discovers​ genetic​ diversity​ and​ privatizes​ the​ rights​ to​ access​and​use​of​the​planet’s​genetic-​biological​wealth.​In​both​cases,​previous​ knowledge—collective,​orally​circulated,​and​indigenous—does​not​count​ or​even​exist.​Only​colonial–imperial​jurisprudence​has​the​power​to​create​ and​to​give​the​ability​to be​to​nature,​to​human​beings,​and​to​their​knowledge. ​ A​few​years​ago​during​the​triumphant​green​revolution,​which​promised​to​abolish​world​hunger,​the​knowledge​of​allegedly​ignorant​Indians​ and​peasants​was​denied​in​the​name​of​a​modern​scientific​perspective​that​ boasted​objectivity,​precision,​and​veracity.​Driven​by​this​denial,​missionaries​of​development​poured​into​peasant​and​indigenous​communities​to​ teach​Indians​how​to​sow,​what​seeds​to​use,​and​how​to​increase​production.​Today,​people​continue​to​deny​that​Indian​knowledge​is​knowledge​ (conocimiento)—at​most,​it​gets​to​be​wisdom​(saber)​or​ethnic​wisdom— but​community​knowledge​is​surreptitiously​usurped,​robbed,​plundered.​ The​knowledge​of​Indians​is​not​worthy​of​written​legal​protection,​but​it​is​ very​useful​to​unfettered​capitalist​accumulation. ​ In​ the​ PCÑ ,​ indigenous​ peasant​ knowledge​ and​ Quechua​ yachay​ are​ linked​to​the​political​and​territorial​autonomy​of​communities​and​their​ organizations.​Quechua​yachay​defends​the​indigenous​peasant​way​of​life​ and​is​a​weapon​to​combat​governmental​and​nongovernmental​development​policies.​In​this​sense,​yachayninchik​~​yachayniyku​(“Our​knowledge​ [inclusive]​~​knowledge​ [exclusive​ of​second​person]”)​is​related​to​kawsayninchik​~​kawsayniyku​(“Our​life​~​life”)​as​an​expression​of​a​territorial​presence.​In​the​voices​represented​by​the​newspaper,​almost​everything​ must​be​kawsayninchikman jina​(“According​to​our​life”):​the​organization,​ education,​environmental​management,​health,​and​so​forth. Quechua Knowledge and Writings 117

​ As​such,​it​does​not​make​much​sense​to​speak​of​local​or​indigenous​ knowledge​in​the​abstract.​Defending​it​makes​sense​only​in​the​context​of​ the​struggle​for​the​territorial​revindication​of​Bolivia’s​indigenous​peasant​ movement.​This​knowledge​is​linked​to​the​control​of​territory​understood​ as​ a​ defense​ of​ communal​ jurisdiction​ and​ peasant​ autonomy​ before​ the​ state​and​a​defense​from​the​attacks​of​global​capitalism. ​ This​ struggle​ against​ racism​ is​ expressed​ in​ multiple​ ways​ and​ has​ inspired​don​Roberto​Albarracín​to​say: Maypi yachayninchiq, rimayninchiq,​

Where​have​our​knowledge​and

wich’usqa kasanman karqa. Nuqanchiq​

our​words​been​wasted?​We​were

yachananchiq karqa. Nuqanchiq​

supposed​to​know.​We​are​Quechuas.

qhiswaruna kanchiq. Nuqa chayta​

I​ask​myself​that,​I​would​like​to

tapurikuni, yachayta munayman​

know.

(Roberto​Albarracín,​in​46:1).

The​ideas​presented​in​this​essay​run​parallel​to​the​question​don​Roberto​ asks​from​within​his​community.​Taking​as​a​pre-​text​the​voices​of​the​Conosur Ñawpagman​newspaper,​I​have​attempted​to​understand,​through​continual​discussion​with​community​members​and​leaders​in​Raqaypampa​and​ Ayopaya,​where​and​how​the​knowledge​and​words​that​are​uncomfortable​ for​global​capital​are​being​lost.​I​am​conscious​that,​as​a​q’ara,​and​since​I​ am​known​to​belong​to​this​space​of​academic​power,​I​can​be​a​discursive​ tool​and​act​as​a​jawamanta yachay​(“knowledge​from​abroad”),​enabling​ the​interstitial​resistance​of​Quechua’s​yachay.​In​this​way​I​seek​to​convey​ the​idea​that​don​Roberto’s​question​is​not​final,​that​such​knowledge​and​ such​words​have​not​been​entirely​lost.​They​are​worth​the​impertinence​of​ continuing​to​live,​the​impertinence​of​continuing​to​bloom,​as​Tata​Fermín​ knew​so​well: Kay pata chiri jallp’akuna pampas​

These​high​and​cold​lands​are​ours,

ñuqanchikpata, ñawpa tatakunanchik​

our​old​ancestors’​inheritance,​we​live

saqisqanku, kaypi tiyakunchik. Chay-​

here.​And​that​is​nondisappearing,

taqrimana chinkaq, mana tukukuq,​

never​ending,​we​continue​living​even

kunankamapis kawsachkallanchikpuni,​

to​this​day,​left​(to​live)​here,​to​die​in

kay kikinpi saqisqas, kikinpi wañuq,​

the​same​place,​to​live​in​the​same

kikinpi kawsaq. Mana waq llaqtaman-​

place.​We​have​not​appeared​in

tachu rikhurinchik, kay kikin llaqtayuq​

another​land,​we​belong​to​this​land,

118 FernanDo​garcés​V.

kanchik, qhurajina kanchik mujumanta​

we​are​as​weeds​that​return​from​the

watanpaq watanpaq kutirin mana​

seeds​year​after​year,​never​ending,​we

tukukuq, qhura jina mana tukukuq

are​as​weeds​that​die​out​not.

kanchik​(Fermín​Vallejos​1995:3–4).

Notes I​thank​Florencia​Mallon,​not​only​for​inviting​me​to​the​conference​that​provided​ the​framework​for​this​paper,​but​also​for​her​comments​on​my​work.​I​also​thank​ Pedro​Plaza,​who​helped​me​with​the​translation​of​Quechua​texts​into​Eng​lish,​and​ Soledad​Guzmán,​who​helped​me​shorten​the​presentation.​I​dedicate​this​article​to​ my​brother,​Armando​Muyulema,​who​knows​the​creative​and​transformative​power​ of​language,​both​in​its​oral​and​its​written​forms. ​ 1.​Throughout​this​essay​I​opt​for​using​the​phrase​inscription in writing​and​the​ word​writing​in​place​of​literacidad,​ever​more​common​in​the​existing​bibliography​ as​a​loanword​of​the​Eng​lish​literacy.​In​spite​of​Zavala’s​justification,​I​think​literacidad​evokes​in​Spanish​the​world​of​literature,​marked​by​its​elitist​and​academic​(ilustrado)​character.​I​agree​with​Zavala’s​definition​of​the​term:​“A​social​phenomenon​ that​is​not​restricted​to​technical​learning​in​the​educational​arena”​(Zavala​2002,​15).​ I​will​refer​to​this​publication​as​the​Conosur,​the​PCÑ ,​or​the newspaper​throughout​ the​text.​Ñawpagman​means​“go​forward.” ​ 2.​Yachay​can​be​translated​as​“knowledge.”​However,​it​is​the​basis​of​an​entire​ semantic​field​related​to​knowledge,​learning,​teaching,​and​even​to​a​way​of​life.​For​ an​ethnographic​study​on​this​concept,​see​García​(2005). ​ 3.​The​Cuna​peoples​use​the​term​Abya Yala,​meaning​“mature​and​fertile​earth,”​ to​name​America.​Many​countries’​indigenous​organizations​have​adopted​this​term​ to​refer​to​a​geographical​space.​If​to​name​is​to​struggle,​as​Muyulema​states​(2001,​ 328),​and​if​America​and​Latin​America​result​from​naming​policies​that​partially​ implanted​ the​ conquistadors​ in​ this​ communication,​ then​ I​ insert​ myself​ in​ that​ struggle.​I​thus​opt​to​use​Abya Yala​to​refer​to​what​has​usually​been​constructed​as​ America​or​Latin​America. ​ 4.​In​two​of​the​regions​that​witnessed​recovery​of​territory​in​Cochabamba​Department,​peasant​ organizations​ stated​ their​organizational​ position​in​their​legal​ documents​ as​ “Unified​ Regional​ Trade​ Union​ of​ Indigenous​ Peasants​ of​ Raqaypampa”​and​“Unified​Regional​Trade​Union​of​Indigenous​Peasant​Workers​of​Ayopaya.” ​ 5.​The​term​pacha​is​one​of​the​richest,​most​complex​terms​in​Quechua’s​semantic​universe.​It​refers​to​the​entire​and​very​ample​spectrum​of​space​and​time​in​ which​we​are​located. ​ 6.​This​section​is​a​synthesis​of​a​previous​discussion​(Garcés​2005b,​82–104). Quechua Knowledge and Writings 119

​ 7.​The​same​group​that​started​the​newspaper​had​created​cenDa ,​a​nongovernmental​organization,​the​previous​year.​At​first,​cenDa ​worked​on​the​issue​of​introduced​technologies​and​their​effects​on​peasant​communities,​primarily​the​community​of​Raqaypampa. ​ 8.​Evo​Morales,​leader​of​the​Peasant​Federations​from​Cochabamba’s​Tropical​ Region,​founded​the​Mas ​political​party.​In​June​2002​Mas ​participated​in​national​ elections​and​won​20​percent​of​the​votes​(1​percent​less​than​the​Movimiento​Nacionalista​Revolucionario,​Gonzalo​Sánchez​de​Lozada’s​party)​and​thirty-​five​parliamentary​seats​in​the​Congress​(Postero,​2005). ​ 9.​At​one​point​the​newspaper​carried​out​an​experiment​in​which​the​readers​ themselves​wrote​the​articles.​The​experiment​did​not​work​because,​among​other​ things,​leaders​critiqued​it​for​wanting​to​create​a​select​group​of​writers. ​ 10.​Diglottic​is​a​sociolinguistic​term​referring​to​the​conflictive​coexistence​within​ a​territory​of​two​or​more​languages​or​variants​of​a​language​in​asymmetric​conditions​of​use​and​value.​One​of​the​languages​appropriates​to​itself​all​the​uses​and​ functions,​while​the​rest​restrict​their​uses​and​functions​to​domestic​and​agricultural​arenas.​For​the​term’s​technical​specificities,​see​Albó​(1998),​Fishman​(1995),​ and​Luykx​(1998). ​ 11.​I​cite​texts​of​the​ PCÑ ​by​indicating​the​number​of​the​issue​followed​by​the​ page​numbers. ​ 12.​These​examples​are​merely​illustrative​and​intended​to​support​the​assertions​ I​make. ​ 13.​For​the​case​of​Aymara​in​radio,​see​Condori’s​work​(2003).​Currently,​Soledad​ Guzmán​is​investigating​the​broadcasting​of​Quechua​in​a​Cochabamba​urban​area​ as​part​of​her​master’s​thesis​at​the​proeib ​Andes​(Guzmán​2005). ​ 14.​ In​ addition,​ cenDa ​ publishes​ a​ Children’s​ Supplement​ in​ Quechua​ called​ the​Añaskitu.​It​is​a​monolingual​magazine​that​seeks​the​socialization​of​children’s​ Quechua​knowledge​through​interschool​correspondence​and​the​valuation​of​community​knowledge. ​ 15.​On​the​strong​presence​of​Spanish​in​Bolivian​Quechua​and​especially​Cochobambino,​see​Sichra​(2003,​105–16). ​ 16.​The​Quechua​alphabet​currently​used​in​Bolivia​is​based​on​the​Alfabeto Único para el Idioma Quechua​(Unified​Alphabet​for​the​Quechua​Language),​made​official​ and​published​in​the​Supreme​Decree​No.​20227​(Gaceta Oficial de Bolivia​25:382,​ 10​April​1984)​by​President​Siles​Suazo.​Bolivian​Quechua’s​normative​written​inscription​is​developed​on​the​basis​of​scholasticized​Pan-​Andean​standardization​and​ historicized​criteria​(Luykx,​2001).​This​development​seeks​to​recover​the​etymological​forms​of​Quechua’s​previous​states.​It​takes​into​account​regional​variation​as​a​ way​of​diagnosing​current​forms​of​usage,​but​these​usages​absolutely​do​not​impact​ the​norm’s​definition. ​ 17.​The​topic​of​writing​with​an​oral​base​is​not​an​entirely​novel​phenomenon.​ 120 FernanDo​garcés​V.

For​the​case​of​Spanish,​see​the​studies​of​Oesterreicher,​Bustos,​Cano,​Eberenz,​and​ Stoll​in​the​edition​of​Kotschi,​Oesterreicher,​and​Zimmermann​(1996). ​ 18.​This​last​one​is​a​practice​with​a​long​tradition​in​the​Andean​world​(Guamán​ Poma​1615;​Pachacuti​Yamqui​c.​1613;​Yupanqui​1570;​Lienhard​1990). ​ 19.​Virginia​Zavala​(2002,​62)​questions​whether​objectivity​is​in​fact​an​intrinsic​ characteristic​of​writing,​or​instead​a​part​of​the​imaginary​created​by​the​scholastization​associated​with​it. ​ 20.​Beneath​the​heading​on​the​cover​there​are​two​photos​of​the​indigenous​peasant​mobilizations​of​12​October​1992. ​ 21.​See​Pari​(2005,​77–79),​who​posits​that​nature​is​one​of​the​teachers​of​peasant​ knowledge. ​ 22.​See​ PCÑ ​51,​which​has​a​four-​page​(9–12)​critique​of​chemicals​in​relation​to​ “natural”​peasant​production. ​ 23.​What​I​am​interested​in​showing​with​these​data​is​that​the​ngo ​that​publishes​ the​newspaper​uses​the​same​tools​of​Western​technological​knowledge​to​delegitimize​it.​Moreover,​it​shows​the​singular​interaction​between​the​ngo ’s​political​positioning​and​peasant​knowledge​in​an​effort​to​validate​this​knowledge.​This​means​ that​for​the​Conosur​or​for​cenDa ,​knowledge​is​a​tool​used​to​struggle​against​development​and​prepackaged​technology​rather​than​an​end​in​itself. ​ 24.​A​connection​with​this​topic​can​be​found​in​the​research​of​Romero​(1994).​ He​shows​that​the​ch’iki​makes​reference,​in​the​community​of​Titicachi,​to​a​type​of​ social​intelligence​adults​value​positively.​The​ch’iki​is​the​intelligent​child​who​knows​ how​to​behave​socially​in​the​proper​context.​By​contrast,​saqra​refers​to​children​ who​dazzle​others​with​their​individual​cognitive​intelligence,​but​who​do​not​receive​ positive​reinforcement​from​the​community​because​their​individualized​behavior​ locates​them​just​outside​its​borders. ​ 25.​On​this​last​aspect,​see​Arnold​and​Yapita​(2000).​The​authors​propose​that​ writing​promoted​by​the​Bolivian​Education​Reform​fulfills​the​same​dominating​ role​as​that​implanted​by​the​colonial​evangelization​model.

Quechua Knowledge and Writings 121

Joanne raPPaPort anD abelarDo ramos PacHo

Collaboration​and​Historical​Writing Challenges for the Indigenous–Academic Dialogue

More​than​three​decades​ago,​Delmos​Jones​proposed​that​a​“native​anthropology”​would​become​viable​only​when​it​developed​“a​set​of​theories​based​ on​non-​Western​precepts​and​assumptions​in​the​same​sense​that​modern​ anthropology​ is​ based​ on​ and​ has​ supported​ Western​ beliefs​ and​ values”​ (1970,​251).​Jones​was​thinking​of​minority​scholars​in​the​United​States​who,​ armed​with​the​double​consciousness​afforded​by​their​position​straddling​ the​ boundary​ between​ the​ dominant​ society​ and​ their​ own​ subordinated​ groups,​could​potentially​develop​what​W.​E.​B.​Du​Bois​(1989​[1903],​2–3)​ called​ “second-​sight,”​ a​ privileged​ minority​ vantage​ point​ from​ which​ to​ analyze​social​life. ​ While​Duboisian​concepts​resonate​in​very​specific​ways​within​the​Afro– North​American​context,​the​notion​of​double​consciousness​provides​fertile​ ground​for​the​interpretation​of​the​role​of​intellectuals​within​Latin​American​ethnic​movements,​where​efforts​have​been​made​to​develop​what​might​ be​called​an​indigenous​second-​sight:​in​other​words,​the​discovery​from​ within​Native​cultures​of​those​conceptual​elements​that​may​enable​new​ interpretations​ of​ reality​ consonant​ with​ the​ epistemologies​ and​ political​ priorities​of​indigenous​organizations.1​Theorization—the​creation​of​such​ conceptual​tools—is​one​of​the​fundamental​objectives​of​intellectuals​affiliated​with​Latin​American​indigenous​organizations.2​This​process​ranges​ from​the​development​of​narrative​models​that​decenter​Western​notions​ of​historical​chronology​(Fernández​Osco​2000;​Vasco,​Dagua,​and​Aranda​ 1993)​to​the​use​of​concepts​in​Native​languages​as​frameworks​for​adapting​ Western​concepts​to​indigenous​ends.​But​such​conceptual​tools​not​only​ function​as​models​for​interpreting​experience;​they​also​assist​indigenous​

organizations​in​acting​politically​upon​the​social​realities​in​which​they​live.​ In​other​words,​the​“second-​sight”​stimulated​by​these​intellectual​practices​ is​aimed​at​transforming​reality,​not​only​analyzing​it. ​ In​this​essay​we​probe​the​nature​of​this​moment​of​indigenous​theorizing,​inquiring​into​the​intellectual​conditions​of​its​emergence​and​its​epistemological​character.​For​us,​this​process​is​more​than​the​simple​appropriation​of​primordial​values​in​a​modern​context.​Indigenous​theorizing​ emerges​within​a​multiethnic​social​sphere,​a​reality​that​impacts​both​its​ epistemological​nature​and​the​ways​in​which​it​is​put​into​political​practice.​ It​emerges​out​of​a​process​of​appropriation​of​knowledge​systems​framed​by​ indigenous​thought​and​sustained​by​a​critical​appreciation​of​other​cultures.​ Such​strategies​originate​in​the​political​context,​given​that​the​indigenous​ movement​seeks​to​build​what​could​be​called​a​radically​pluralist​democracy​(Laclau​and​Mouffe​1985),​a​national​imaginary​in​which​social​justice​ is​constructed​through​the​infusion​in​the​social​process​of​a​multiplicity​of​ ethnic​demands​and​political​practices. ​ What​this​means​is​that​it​is​not​always​easy​to​identify​the​indigenous​ in​Native​theorizing​by​distinguishing​its​components​as​belonging​to​one​ indigenous​culture​or​another.​Much​of​the​conceptual​matrix​employed​by​ indigenous​organizations​has​been​appropriated​from​progressive​academic​ scholarship​in​education,​anthropology,​history,​linguistics,​and​political​science​as​well​as​from​the​methods​and​concepts​developed​by​popular​movements​and​nongovernmental​organizations​(ngo s).​There​is​a​desire​to​create​conceptual​vehicles​that​do​not​privilege​a​specific​Native​culture​over​the​ others​that​comprise​indigenous​organizations,​which​are​frequently​multiethnic.​What​makes​this​theorizing​indigenous​is​the​space​in​which​it​is​ appropriated—the​indigenous​organization—and​the​fact​that​it​is​filtered​ through​indigenous​languages​and,​through​translation,​is​transformed.​It​is​ more​the​locus​of​theorizing​and​its​linguistic​practices​than​its​contents​per​ se​that​are​at​stake​here. ​ The​ process​ of​ creating​ conceptual​ vehicles​ is​ at​ once​ methodological​ (in​the​sense​of​providing​new​research​tools)​and​political​(because​these​ methodologies​make​possible​the​establishment​of​Native​autonomy​in​specific​areas).​In​this​sense,​indigenous​theorizing​is​somewhat​akin​to​feminist​ research,​which​is​simultaneously​academic​and​political.​But​what​is​different​about​the​indigenous​theorizing​we​describe​here​is​the​fact​that​it​takes​ place​at​a​great​distance​from​the​academy.​While​it​is​true​that​Latin​American​ academics​ and​ a​ small​ number​ of​ foreigners​ collaborate​ on​ an​ intelCollaboration and Historical Writing 123

lectual​level​with​indigenous​organizations,​their​numbers​are​far​smaller​ proportionally​ in​ comparison​ to​ the​ collaboration​ of​ academics​ with​ the​ feminist​movement​or,​in​the​United​States,​of​African​American​scholars​ with​black​organizations.​Perhaps​the​discrepancy​is​due​to​the​fact​that​the​ results​of​indigenous​research​rarely​appropriate​academic​formats​for​their​ dissemination,​being​instead​directly​absorbed​into​the​projects​of​Native​ organizations.​Moreover,​feminist​scholars,​particularly​female​academics,​ have​a​direct​stake​in​the​feminist​movement,​which​is​not​as​true​of​the​ mostly​non-​Native​academics​who​work​with​Latin​American​indigenous​ organizations;​the​nature​of​Latin​American​universities​has​largely​excluded​ the​ hiring​ of​ Native​ and​ African-​descended​ faculty,​ producing​ a​ marked​ ethnic​or​racial​difference​between​the​academy​and​grass-​roots​organizations.​In​some​ways,​then,​the​research​currently​under​way​in​Latin​American​indigenous​organizations​is​sui​generis. ​ We​examine​the​process​of​indigenous​theory​making​through​a​critical​ analysis​of​a​recent​research​experience​in​which​we​studied​the​history​of​ the​Bilingual​and​Intercultural​Education​Program​(pebi)​of​the​Regional​ Indigenous​ Council​ of​Cauca​ (cric),​a​Colombian​ indigenous​ organization​that​over​the​course​of​the​past​thirty-​one​years​has​come​to​occupy​an​ important​role​as​an​interlocutor​between​the​indigenous​population​and​ the​Colombian​public​at​large.​In​the​course​of​our​collaboration,​which​included​bilingual​teachers,​ cric ​activists,​and​three​researchers—one​from​ the​ Nasa​ ethnic​ group,​ a​ nonindigenous​ collaborator​ with​ cric ,​ and​ a​ North​American​anthropologist—we​came​to​realize​that​indigenous​theorizing​finds​significant​sources​in​the​culture​of​the​indigenous​organization,​which​in​itself​is​a​kind​of​intercultural​microcosm,​including​not​only​ different​Native​ethnic​groups,​but​non-​Native​collaborators​as​well.​Several​ methodologies​and​key​concepts​informed​our​research.

Translating Theory Indigenous​theorizing​in​Cauca​arose​out​of​the​intersection​of​various​circumstances.​ On​ the​ one​ hand,​ in​ the​ mid-​1980s​ a​ Master​ of​ Arts​ degree​ in​ethnolinguistics​was​offered​for​the​first​time​at​the​Universidad​de​los​ Andes​in​Bogotá​to​indigenous​students​sponsored​by​ethnic​organizations.​ This​development​afforded​activists​the​opportunity​to​discover​the​possibilities​that​language​holds​as​a​source​of​theoretical​frameworks.3​On​the​ other​ hand,​ the​ experience​ of​ translating​ the​ Colombian​ Constitution​ of​ 124 Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos

1991,​which​includes​provisions​regarding​the​rights​of​Native​peoples​(Van​ Cott​2000),​into​Nasa​Yuwe,​the​language​of​the​Nasa​of​Cauca,​created​a​political​context​in​which​the​linguistic​methodologies​acquired​in​the​course​ of​graduate​study​could​be​appropriated​by​Native​leaders. ​ Translation​presents​an​innovative​strategy​through​which​Nasa​activists​ appropriate​concepts​originating​in​the​dominant​society​and​reconfigure​ them​in​an​indigenous​framework.​Nasa-​speakers​frequently​reflect​upon​ the​possible​array​of​meanings​of​a​term​in​their​own​language,​with​an​eye​ toward​adjusting​its​significance​to​bring​it​in​line​with​their​own​objectives.​ This​strategy​is​engaged​when​translators​encounter,​for​example,​terms​like​ development,​ interculturalism,​ and​ culture​ whose​ significance​ has​ limited​ resonance​within​the​Nasa​sphere,​but​whose​meaning​can​be​adapted​to​the​ politico-​cultural​project​of​the​movement.​Following​the​suggestions​of​the​ film​critic​Rey​Chow,​we​believe​that​the​translating​of​such​words​into​Nasa​ Yuwe​improves​the​original​Spanish​term,​injects​it​with​a​new​Nasa​significance​that​liberates​it​from​its​original​limitations​(1995,​186). ​ The​strategy​originated​when​ cric ​set​out​to​translate​the​Constitution​ of​1991​(Ramos​and​Cabildo​Indígena​de​Mosoco​1993;​cf.​Rojas​2000).​The​ intercultural​team​that​was​formed​to​undertake​the​task​was​composed​of​ the​traditional​authorities​of​the​indigenous​community​of​Mosoco,​bilingual​teachers,​indigenous​and​national​linguists,​and​a​range​of​professionals​ from​the​national​society,​among​them​lawyers,​sociologists,​psychologists,​ philosophers,​and​economists.​The​team​was​forced​to​confront​the​challenge​of​rendering​a​series​of​universal​political​concepts​in​Nasa​Yuwe.​The​ exercise​ transcended​ one​ of​ preparing​ a​ simple​ translation​ or​ of​ creating​ mere​neologisms.​The​team​sought​to​rethink​these​concepts​from​a​Nasa​ perspective,​and​the​result​was​something​that​went​far​beyond​a​glossary​of​ new​terms​in​Nasa​Yuwe:​the​exercise​in​translation​opened​up​the​possibility​ of​reconceptualizing​the​notions​of​justice​and​nation​from​the​vantage​point​ of​indigenous​cultures​and​organizational​needs.​That​is,​the​Constitution​ was​not​simply​translated;​instead,​its​fundamental​precepts​were​reimagined​ from​a​Nasa​subject​position,​offering​a​Nasa​critique​of​the​Colombian​state​ (Rappaport​2004).​In​this​sense,​translation​into​Nasa​Yuwe,​as​a​research— and​political—methodology,​provided​the​movement​with​the​philosophical​ foundations​of​its​pluralist​political​proposal. ​ At​the​same​time,​the​introduction​of​translation​as​a​methodology​fostered​new​approaches​to​the​indigenous​study​of​social​reality,​a​new​form​of​ Nasa​“autoethnography.”​Two​decades​ago​Talal​Asad​suggested​that​ethnogCollaboration and Historical Writing 125

raphy​is​a​kind​of​translation,​“addressed​to​a​very​specific​audience,​which​ is​waiting​to​read​about​another​mode​of​life​and​to​manipulate​the​text​it​ reads​according​to​established​rules,​not​to​learn​to​live​a​new​mode​of​life”​ (1986,​159).​Translation​is​equally​crucial​to​the​indigenous​project,​but​its​ function​is​the​inverse​of​what​Asad​proposed​for​ethnography.​When​Nasa​ activists​engage​in​cultural​translation​they​do​it​“to​learn​to​live​a​new​mode​ of​life”:​they​appropriate​external​concepts​within​an​indigenous​political​ matrix​with​the​aim​of​introducing​new​strategies​for​cultural​survival.​In​ other​words,​their​objective​is​to​take​hold​of​cultural​potentialities,​not​to​ textualize​cultural​differences.​This​autoethnographic​methodology​can​be​ better​comprehended​as​one​of​a​series​of​intercultural​approaches​that​the​ indigenous​movement​employs​to​negotiate​a​multiethnic​milieu.

Interculturalism The​translation​of​the​Constitution​sheds​light​on​a​fundamental​aspect​of​ indigenous​theorizing​ in​Colombia:​it​emerges​from​an​intercultural​ dialogue.​The​translation​process​was,​in​fact,​a​double​intercultural​dialogue:​ between​indigenous​activists​and​professionals​from​the​national​society​as​ well​as​between​Nasa​philosophies​and​Western​jurisprudence.​Indigenous​ organizations​ are​ themselves​ intercultural​ contexts​ in​ which​ indigenous​ militants​and​non-​Native​collaborators​interact​daily,​constantly​exchanging​ ideas​originating​as​much​in​national​and​international​spheres​of​theorizing​ as​in​Native​cultures.​Although​these​organizations​were​intercultural​from​ the​moment​of​their​inception—cric ,​for​example,​was​founded​by​Guambianos,​Nasas,​and​mestizo​activists—in​the​past​two​decades,​as​the​concept​ of​interculturalism​was​promoted​by​Latin​American​educators,​its​contents​ were​appropriated​within​indigenous​organizational​practice. ​ Interculturalism​ developed​ in​ Latin​ America​ alongside​ the​ popular​ struggles​of​the​1970s​and​1980s,​when​grass-​roots​organizations​posed​concrete​alternatives​to​traditional​notions​of​electoral​democracy​(López​1995).​ In​the​case​of​Colombia,​where​the​Constitution​of​1991​established​the​legal​ potential​ for​ the​ creation​ of​ a​ pluralist​ nation,​ interculturalism​ provides​ a​radical​alternative​to​the​concept​of​multiculturalism.​The​latter​poses​a​ threat​to​pluralism​insofar​as​it​promotes​a​simple​tolerance​for​ethnic​minorities,​fostering​their​participation​in​an​electoral​system​that​dilutes​their​ impact​upon​the​nation​(Hale​2002).​By​contrast,​interculturalism​(on​paper,​

126 Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos

at​least)​seeks​new​forms​of​establishing​conditions​of​equality​and​consensus​by​enhancing​the​contents​of​minority​voices​(Heise,​Tubino,​and​Ardito​ 1994).​The​objectives​of​interculturalism​transcend​those​of​multiculturalism​ because​interculturalists​seek​more​than​a​cross-​cultural​encounter​framed​ by​hegemonic​relations.​Their​objective​is​to​create​new​horizontal​relationships​(Gottret​1999)​within​a​pluralist​state​(López​1999).​In​addition,​interculturalists​aim​at​injecting​cultural​difference​within​the​demands​of​the​ Left​for​a​radically​pluralist​democracy​(Laclau​and​Mouffe​1985). ​ Interculturalism​is​an​emergent​project,​not​an​existing​social​reality.​It​ originated​ in​ Latin​ America​ within​ indigenous​ education,​ where​ radical​ educators​built​local​bilingual​programs​based​upon​its​precepts.​Intercultural​education​makes​cultural​difference​explicit​through​its​aim​of​fostering​the​incorporation​of​new​ideas​within​emergent​Native​cultural​constellations​(Mengoa​1999).​We​emphasize​ the​emergent​ nature​of​indigenous​ cultural​projects​because​the​notion​of​cultural​revival​is​oriented​not​toward​ the​retrieval​of​customs​from​the​past​but​toward​the​future​(Heise,​Tubino​ and​Ardito,​1994).​Interculturalism​ transcends​the​task​of​schooling​children​in​a​culturally​sensitive​manner.​It​presupposes​a​link​between​education​and​social​change,​suggesting​that​the​school​is​a​critical​scenario​for​ the​construction​of​democracy.​The​promotion​of​self-​esteem​and​the​creation​of​nonhierarchical​interethnic​relations​can​provide​firm​foundations​ for​building​political​pluralism​beyond​the​schoolhouse​(Heise,​Tubino,​and​ Ardito​1994;​Gottret​1999;​López​1996,​1999). ​ Indigenous​ theorizing​ is​ an​ example​ of​ putting​ interculturalism​ into​ practice.​ Interculturalism​ provides​ the​ conceptual​ tools​ needed​ to​ create​ indigenous​theory,​but​it​does​more​than​that:​it​has​a​political​objective.​ Intercultural​dialogue​is​valued​by​indigenous​organizations​in​Colombia​ precisely​ because​ Native​ people​ are​ also​ Colombians;​ they​ recognize​ that​ their​participation​in​popular​struggle​must​transcend​purely​indigenous​demands.​But​while​ethnic​organizations​participate​actively​in​the​construction​of​a​new​nation—the​best​current​example​is​the​organization​by​the​ indigenous​movement​of​a​popular​referendum​on​Colombia’s​acceptance​ of​the​Free​Trade​Area​of​the​Americas​and​indigenous​rejections​of​neoliberal​policy—the​creation​of​new​conceptual​tools​also​impacts​upon​local​ efforts​at​cultural​revival,​nourishing​the​emergence​of​new​indigenous​cultural​forms.

Collaboration and Historical Writing 127

Culture and Political Autonomy In​ this​ essay​ we​ problematize​ the​ nature​ of​ theorizing​ within​ the​ indigenous​movement,​analyzing​it​from​an​intercultural​perspective.​Frequently,​ as​ was​ the​ case​ in​ the​ translation​ of​ the​ Constitution,​ the​ theoretical​ vehicles​ are​ the​ product​ of​linguistic​ research,​ but​ cosmological​ knowledge​ is​also​an​important​source​of​theory.​One​of​the​models​most​frequently​ employed​by​indigenous​organizations​is​the​spiral​motif,​an​icon​that​appears​ on​ petroglyphs,​ is​ reproduced​ in​ the​ hand​ movements​ of​ shamans​ during​ritual​séances,​and​has​been​adduced​in​the​grammatical​structures​ of​various​Caucan​Native​languages​(Muelas​Hurtado​1995).​Adoption​of​a​ spiral​sense​of​time​allowed​the​Guambiano​History​Committee​to​generate​ an​alternative​to​linear​chronological​narration,​permitting​them​to​reorganize​historical​events​by​privileging​mythic​heroines​and​sacred​space​as​anchors​for​a​political​history​of​the​Guambianos​(Vasco,​Dagua,​and​Aranda​ 1993;​cf.​Rappaport​2005).4​But​it​is​also​possible​to​ground​theorization​in​ the​organizational​culture​of​the​indigenous​movement,​where​activists​have​ appropriated​universal​concepts​like​autonomy​and​territory​as​the​primary​ interpretive​ threads​ for​ historical​ and​ sociological​ research​ (Allen​ 2002;​ Field​1999),​transforming​their​contents​so​that​they​are​in​accord​with​the​ principles​and​demands​of​the​organization.5​The​discourse​of​political​autonomy​feeds​simultaneously​upon​the​work​of​cultural​activists​and​on​the​ demands​ of​ nonethnic​ social​ movements.​ The​ notion​ of​ territory,​ for​ instance,​which​has​come​to​replace​earlier​demands​for​land,​implies​a​degree​ of​sovereignty​over​a​population​and​its​landscape.​But​territory​also​emerges​ out​of​a​cosmological​relationship​with​that​landscape,​thus​merging​political​universals​with​specific​Native​notions​of​space. ​ In​reality,​discourses​of​cultural​difference​and​political​autonomy​operate​in​tandem​within​indigenous​ organizations.​ As​Bruce​Albert​explains​ so​convincingly​in​his​interpretation​of​the​discourse​of​the​Brazilian​Yanomami​leader​Davi​Kopenawa,​the​indigenous​movement​must​negotiate​an​ ethnically​heterogeneous​political​field.​Ethnic​organizations​survive​thanks​ to​their​simultaneous​appropriation​of​political​universals​and​cultural​specifics:​“If​the​indigenous​political​discourse​were​limited​to​the​mere​reproduction​of​white​categories,​it​would​be​reduced​to​empty​rhetoric;​if,​on​ the​other​hand,​it​remained​in​the​exclusive​sphere​of​cosmology,​it​would​ not​escape​from​cultural​solipsism.​In​any​case,​the​lack​of​articulation​between​these​two​registers​leads​to​political​failure”​(Albert​1995,​4).​The​na128 Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos

ture​of​the​indigenous​project​spans​both​universal​political​discourses​and​ Native​cultural​specifics,​its​objectives​interweaving​various​constructions​ of​pluralism​that​originate​as​much​from​inside​as​from​outside​indigenous​ communities,​established​through​intercultural​dialogue​among​indigenous​ ethnic​groups​and​with​members​of​the​national​society.​In​short,​if​we​are​ to​understand​this​project,​we​need​to​take​a​dual​approach​that​can​infiltrate​ the​interstices​where​universal​and​specific​discourses​meet. ​ In​reality​both​poles​of​this​equation​are​heterogeneous.​After​more​than​ four​centuries​of​colonization​and​in​the​wake​of​decades​of​dialogue​between​indigenous​organizations​and​sympathetic​popular​movements,​one​ cannot​speak​of​two​totally​incommensurable​logics.​The​process​of​cultural​ resistance​has​forced​the​ethnic​movement​to​develop​contestatory​cultural​ forms​that​are​deeply​modern​and​are​in​dialogue​with​national​forms.​As​ Paul​Gilroy​indicates,​echoing​Du​Bois,​the​power​of​minority​cultural​forms​ “derives​from​a​doubleness,​their​unsteady​location​simultaneously​inside​ and​outside​the​conventions,​assumptions,​and​aesthetic​rules​which​distinguish​and​periodise​modernity”​(1993,​73).​In​the​process,​minority​forms​ are​reimagined,​mixed​with​appropriated​cultural​forms​from​the​majority​ society​in​a​dynamic​antiphony​(1993,​74).​What​Gilroy​suggests​is​essential.​ Minority​theorizing​appropriates​concepts​and​methodologies​from​dominant​paradigms​and​reconfigures​them​within​a​minority​conceptual​space,​ at​the​same​time​that​indigenous​cultural​forms​are​reimagined​within​the​ space​of​struggle.​In​this​sense,​there​is​a​certain​urgency​to​maintaining​the​ balance​between​culture​and​autonomy,​so​that​one​register​does​not​erase​ the​other. ​ In​recognition​of​this​challenge,​indigenous​theorizing​in​Cauca​centers​ on​ the​ relationship​ between​ an​ inside​ and​ an​ outside.​ Native​ researchers​ have​reflected​on​the​meaning​of​the​process​of​constructing​cultural​difference​within​the​social​system​that​surrounds​them.​They​seek​to​define,​ through​research​and​political​action,​ways​to​maintain​a​cultural​inside​different​ from​ the​ outside​ of​ the​ national​ society​ (Rappaport​ 2005,​ chap.​ 1;​ 2008).​The​inside​is​not​a​cultural​essence​as​traditional​anthropology​would​ have​it,​although​it​is​based​on​constellations​of​values​and​structures​of​behavior;​the​cultural​forms​of​the​inside​articulated​by​the​indigenous​movement​do​not​correspond​to​an​observable​cultural​reality.​After​four​hundred​ years​of​colonial​domination,​the​cultural​topography​of​Cauca​is​heterogeneous​and​syncretic,​something​activists​not​only​recognize​but​appropriate​into​their​field​of​action.​Yet​there​are​a​few​localities​that​demonstrate​ Collaboration and Historical Writing 129

the​constellation​of​values​that​the​movement​seeks​to​revitalize​and​project​ across​the​vast​expanse​of​indigenous​territory.​For​this​reason,​the​inside​ is​not​really​located​in​a​concrete​site,​but​in​the​utopias​that​the​movement​ hopes​to​build​on​the​basis​of​models​generated​by​their​researchers.6

Collaborative Theorizing In​what​follows​we​reflect​upon​the​complexities​of​indigenous​theorizing​on​ the​basis​of​our​collaborative​work​on​the​history​of​the​pebi ,​a​program​of​ the​cric .​Two​members​of​the​team,​Abelardo​Ramos,​a​Nasa​linguist​and​ pebi ​member,​and​Joanne​Rappaport,​a​North​American​anthropologist,​ are​the​authors​of​this​essay;​a​third​member​of​the​team,​Graciela​Bolaños,​ is​a​non-​Native​collaborator​with​ cric ​and​a​member​of​ pebi .7​Since​our​ work​assumed​the​form​of​an​interethnic​dialogue—what​in​the​movement​ is​called​a​diálogo de saberes,​an​exchange​of​epistemologies—the​remainder​of​this​article​is​written​as​a​script.​Our​two​voices​are​marked​by​different​fonts. Joanne: Indigenous theorizing is the product of the complex negotiation of the ethnic movement’s priorities and discourses aimed at bridging different epistemologies and methodologies so that they are not incommensurate. Thus, as we have argued, the task of the collaborative researcher presupposes a conversation between several subject positions, in particular, between representatives of national society and indigenous groups. But we haven’t yet touched upon the organization of the production of such knowledge, which is inseparable from its theoretical qualities. In distinction to academic practice, which in anthropology is generally a solitary endeavor or organized into a relatively homogeneous group of researchers, in the indigenous movement research is profoundly collective; this presupposes a distinct methodology. Given that indigenous organizations include a range of activists, not only Native people from various ethnic groups but also nonindigenous collaborators, the research groups that coalesce within these organizations are also culturally—and epistemologically—heterogeneous.8 When external researchers collaborate in such enterprises, their methods and theory are subordinated to those created by the group (Vasco 2002, 449). This implies an acceptance not only of the equality of the different forms of knowledge, but also of their partial commensurability. Above all, it means that indigenous priorities must provide the general framework for 130 Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos

research, although external theory also enters into discussion. That is to say, the contributions of external researchers are appropriated and transformed just as the movement refashions external cultural and political elements in its everyday activities. It is imperative to understand that a collaborative dialogue is not between two monolithic poles—non-Native academics and indigenous researchers. Given that the research taking place in indigenous organizations emerges out of the joint work of indigenous actors and non-Native collaborators, who construct their research methodology as a team, it might be more fruitful to comprehend this process as a dialogue between activists (both indigenous and nonindigenous) and academics. I have discovered that the epistemological differences between my vision and that of my indigenous interlocutors is easily bridged, thanks to the anthropological training I received, which focused on Native epistemologies. However, I was not trained as an ethnographer to decipher the differences between activist and anthropological methodologies, where distinctions can be considerably more subtle. Research in an indigenous organization frequently takes place in workshops, whose collective methodology presupposes that the community itself, and not just the researchers, participate in framing the project and analyzing its results. In this sense, workshops are exegetical spaces where theory is produced, not simply occasions for collecting data (Vasco 2002). Under such conditions, theory emerges out of a process of “co-theorizing,” in which activists, the community, and external researchers all play a role. What makes this theorizing indigenous is its articulation with the priorities of the organization, which are developed collectively by traditional community authorities, the organizational leadership, shamans, bilingual teachers, nonNative collaborators, and others. In other words, what makes this knowledge indigenous is the particular way in which it is created and transmitted.9 Abelardo: The process of co-theorizing can be conceptualized in terms of local indigenous practice, through the application of the metaphor of the minga—collective work activities that benefit the community or a family— to the organization as a whole. It was in the experience of translating the Constitution of 1991 into Nasa Yuwe that we began to reconceptualize research as a minga in which various groups of people participated: the bilingual teachers of the community of Mosoco, cultural and political authorities recognized by the community (the cabildo, shamans, artisans, midwives), Collaboration and Historical Writing 131

students from the local high school, and specialists in linguistics and in law, the latter being non-Native. The work done by this collective had a concrete result, a book that could be read by both Native people and members of the national society (Ramos and Cabildo Indígena de Mosoco 1993). Our metaphor merged physical labor, which is what is generally done at a minga, with intellectual work. Frequently, local indigenous community members do not understand that intellectual labor is also a kind of work. Like work in the fields, intellectual work requires effort, produces fatigue, and creates results. But the comparison goes further than that. In Nasa Yuwe, both types of labor are referred to as majï, a term which is also used to describe the ritual activities of the shaman and the collective work of the cabildo in the building of territory (in particular, the walking of boundaries). Intellectual labor, when framed by the political priorities of the indigenous movement, fits neatly into this amplified notion of majï. The metaphor of the minga transcends the simple definition of collective labor, because it allows us to recognize that the notion of work is multifaceted. Majï is a concept that unites various interests and collectivities. Similarly, collaboration cannot be reduced to a simple dialogue between individuals belonging to different cultures. The institutional interests of the participants are always in the background—the interests of the university or of academic theory, the objectives of ngo s, the program of the indigenous movement. That is to say, collaboration and co-theorizing involve much more than interpersonal dialogue; they promote a conversation in which individuals articulate the collective interests of the groups they represent or of which they are members. This distinction is important because in some instances such interlocution can lead participants, especially academics, to transcend the interests of their institution and merge, perhaps temporarily, with an interethnic and nonacademic collectivity. When research funding has been acquired by the movement itself, the academic is at liberty to function independently of her or his institution in order to embrace indigenous priorities.10 The profile of the researcher is equally significant. He or she must recognize that research is not a neutral process, that one must choose dialogue. It is not just a question of respecting indigenous positions, but also of entering in active conversation with them. This is difficult for academics to accept since they are accustomed to treating indigenous ideas as ethnographic data, not as potential conceptual tools. 132 Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos

Despite the generosity of the participants, such a dialogue cannot but produce tensions. These may be due to the prejudices each member brings to the table, to the underlying sense of competition, and to the epistemological differences between them, whether academic or organizational epistemologies or those of the Native culture. Such conflict requires that participants act responsibly. Tensions can easily turn into nonnegotiable conflicts, or they can be fruitful. It is the responsibility of the participants to aim toward negotiation, not toward rupture. The balancing of institutional and cultural interests involves a highly complex process. There are cultural differences even among the members of indigenous organizations, since they include representatives of different ethnic groups and non-Native collaborators. This is to emphasize that conflicts will arise not only among academics and activists, but also in the movement itself. Collaborative research, with all of its institutional conflicts and cultural differences, is like two roads that cross each other, even if ultimately they are headed in the same direction. That is to say, difference is not necessarily negative, nor is it something that must be transcended. Assumed with responsibility, difference can produce new approaches to social reality, if the participants commit to the objectives of the indigenous organization. In other words, an intercultural framework, not the academic appropriation or concealing of indigenous ideas, must guide the research. The academic, who has been trained through a model of individual intellectual production, must recognize two fundamental realities: that collaborative work cannot be individual and that indigenous elements cannot be subsumed under an academic model. The two paths must nourish one another, being always conscious of their difference but also aware of their common goals. In the course of the research process, individual participants will be enriched intellectually by learning from one another. In the end, collaboration makes a contribution not only to the collectivity, but also to each of the participants.

The History of PEBI : Collaborative Research at the Grass Roots In​the​case​of​the​history​of​ pebi ,​collaboration​was​not​grounded​exclusively​in​the​dynamics​of​our​three-​member​research​team,​but​also​required​ initiating​dialogue​with​the​broader​group​of​activists. ​ pebi ​ was​ founded​ at​ the​ end​ of​ the​ 1970s​ as​ an​ initiative​ of​ the​ Fifth​ Congress​of​ cric ​and,​particularly,​of​its​vice​president,​Benjamín​DindiCollaboration and Historical Writing 133

cué.​ pebi ​was​conceived​as​an​organizing​space​in​which​communities​in​ struggle​could​be​mobilized​around​regional​demands.11​Although​ pebi ​is​ an​ educational​ program—including​ curricular​ design,​ historical​ and​ linguistic​research,​the​generation​of​theory,​and​teacher​training—its​central​ objectives​focus​on​the​creation​of​schools​as​a​vanguard​for​the​organizing​of​political,​social,​and​cultural​activities​in​indigenous​communities​in​ conjunction​with​cabildos​and​other​traditional​authorities.​In​other​words,​ from​the​start​ pebi ’s​objectives​have​transcended​pedagogy,​and​its​members​characterize​their​project​as​contestatory,​nourished​by​a​critical​and​ politicized​appreciation​of​intercultural​pedagogical​methods.​In​contrast​to​ other​popular​education​projects​in​Latin​America,​pebi ​originated​not​from​ within​ an​ educational​ movement,​ but​ in​ a​political​ organization.​ Schools​ were​founded​in​those​communities​that​exhibited​intense​involvement​in​ political​organizing,​and​the​first​teachers​were​chosen​from​a​pool​of​the​ most​committed​activists,​irrespective​of​their​level​of​schooling.​Community​members​served​as​evaluators​and​advisors,​developing​their​ideas​in​ workshops​and​community​assemblies.​More​than​a​space​for​training​children,​the​school​was​conceived​as​the​pivot​of​the​entire​community. ​ In​its​more​than​three​decades​of​existence,​ pebi ​has​entered​into​dialogue​ with​ educators​ across​ Colombia​ and​ Latin​ America,​ contributing​ innovative​cultural​and​curricular​projects​that​have​served​as​models​for​ ethnoeducation​at​the​regional​and​national​levels.​It​has​trained​a​significant​ number​of​indigenous​teachers​and​political​leaders​in​Cauca.​Its​intercultural​and​culture-​specific​proposals​for​the​construction​of​ethnic​pluralism​ have​ permeated​ cric ​as​ a​ whole,​ and​ increasingly​ cric ’s​ leadership​ has​ drawn​upon​pebi ​members​to​fill​important​political​roles​in​the​organization. ​ Around​2000​pebi ​undertook​the​task​of​researching​and​writing​its​history.​The​project​was​conceived​as​a​learning​experience​and​a​space​for​collective​analysis,​requiring​the​broad​participation​of​program​members​in​ the​research.​To​this​end,​a​series​of​workshops​and​meetings​were​held​in​ 2000​and​2001,​gatherings​at​which​activists,​including​staff​members​in​the​ regional​program​as​well​as​local​bilingual​teachers​and​leaders,​compiled​a​ list​of​fifty-​one​questions​meant​to​orient​the​research​process​and​prepare​ grass-​roots​ activists​ for​ collecting​ relevant​ information​ in​ their​ localities.​ pebi ’s​program​is​crystallized​in​these​guiding​questions.​The​questions​exhort​researchers​to​illustrate​how​education​is​a​political​vehicle,​how​it​leads​

134 Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos

communities​to​develop​a​cosmic​and​historical​relationship​with​their​territory,​how​this​project​lays​the​basis​for​forging​political​autonomy,​economic​ reconstruction,​and​community​development.​The​questions​emphasize​the​ centrality​of​intercultural​appropriation​of​ideas​within​a​project​that​is​not​ merely​educational,​but​political.​They​outline​how​ pebi ​objectives​are​directed​at​the​entire​organization​and​not​just​at​its​educational​sector.​They​ illustrate​how​the​program​acts​as​a​vanguard​promoting​indigenous​content​ in​the​organization​at​large. ​ However,​almost​all​of​the​questions​engage​pebi ’s​current​policies.​They​ are​not​at​all​retrospective,​in​part​because​so​many​of​the​workshop​participants​were​young,​most​with​a​scant​decade​of​experience​in​the​organization.​Their​presentist​cast​posed​a​challenge​for​the​research​team,​which​was​ charged​with​writing​a​history​of​the​program. Abelardo: For me, those fifty-one questions were challenging methodologically because I felt that they constrained the nature of the project, forcing us to focus on current organizing strategies instead of engaging in a politicalhistorical analysis. The latter was my primary political interest. For some of us who are Nasa-speakers, the idea of doing history was appealing because it would help us to trace the educational process retrospectively. We wanted to study the political nature of the process over time. In particular, we hoped to communicate to future generations the hopes of the elders who founded CriC and PeBi at the end of the seventies: how they fought to build a feeling of dignity as a people and how they gained their rights by building an educational system based upon our own culture. Doing history would permit us to engage in a dialogue with those first generations. In the final workshop we built a consensus in favor of the history project, with testimonies collected from the protagonists in the process.12 The truth is that the guiding questions were composed before we made the decision to write a history of PeBi . As a result, our team was forced to adapt them to the historical framework we had chosen. This meant we would have to engage in a negotiation, using the questions as conceptual guides for thinking retrospectively, and in the course of this reflection we would have to find a way to engage and foreground the voices of the narrators. I think that the questions helped me to see that a history of education was of necessity a political history. We would need to interpret the testimonies within this framework, bring together today’s political priorities with the memory of the past. Collaboration and Historical Writing 135

Joanne: The workshop participants did not seek answers to their questions in a historical narrative that highlighted the earlier experiences of PEBI but hoped to resolve them through reflection on their own experiences, which, on the whole, went back only a decade. In a sense, their questions contained the answers they sought, calling up accepted discourses instead of historical explanation. But although the questions expressed the concerns of the present, they would have to serve as a fulcrum around which we could organize our interpretation of the past. At the outset I resisted this arrangement because I did not fully comprehend it. The three-person research team began to debate the ways in which we hoped to frame this history. In numerous PEBI meetings, ranging from curricular planning and program evaluation to political meetings, I had observed that local teachers frequently made use of the spiral motif to organize their presentations. At one curricular meeting, the teachers from the experimental school in the community of Juan Tama presented their pedagogical projects—community history, organic agriculture, the school garden, Nasa literacy—in a chart organized into a spiral. PEBI ’s magazine, Çxayu’çe, published a board game to stimulate use of Nasa Yuwe among schoolchildren, also organized as a spiral (Anonymous 2000).13 I enthusiastically recommended that we consider the spiral as an organizing motif for our history project. The lukewarm response I received indicated that PEBI hoped to produce a document whose analytical character and sphere of circulation would be considerably wider than that which the culturally specific spiral motif could assume. There was a great desire to produce an intercultural history that incorporated the experiences of the various ethnic groups under the CRIC umbrella, despite the fact that the bulk of PEBI ’s work had been with Nasa speakers. Such a set of objectives obviated the possibility of employing the spiral as a conceptual model. I was confronted with the naiveté of my understanding of indigenous theorizing as something that could arise only out of Native cultural forms. The regional space of indigenous politics, where concepts originating in national and international debates could be appropriated, was a more apt space for theorizing the history of PEBI . Despite their presentist orientation, the fifty-one guiding questions provided us by the workshops supplied useful tools for conceptualizing movement history from the vantage point of a discourse of political autonomy, as opposed to one with a culturalist perspective.

136 Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos

Community Control, Interculturalism, and Cosmovision Joanne: In my three decades of ethnographic research in Colombia I had never followed such a conceptual itinerary: a research agenda that was more political than academic, a research plan for historical study based on presentist referents, a project whose conceptual framework originated outside of the academic community and whose objectives were determined by a group of nonacademics who were not directly involved with the research team. I quickly learned that when a social movement conducts research, its methodology is vastly different from that employed by academics. However, the broad participation of PEBI members in the establishment of our conceptual framework does not mean that activist research lacks rigor. In the course of collecting oral narratives from early indigenous activists and collaborators, I discovered that activist researchers have access to a much more extensive range of information than academics, and they are constantly submitting these data to collective evaluation and analysis. Where they differ from us is in their objectives, which lead them to produce analyses based upon explicit political criteria, whereas the politics inherent in academic research is frequently made imperceptible by academic discourse. ​ The​book​that​resulted​from​our​research​(Bolaños,​Ramos,​Rappaport,​ and​Miñana​2004)​draws​its​three​conceptual​threads​from​the​political​program​of​ pebi :​community​control​(an​educational​program​that​stimulates​ community​organizing),​interculturalism​(the​construction​of​an​intercultural​dialogue​framed​by​indigenous​values),​and​cosmovision​(the​need​to​ maintain​harmony​in​the​universe).​All​three​guiding​ideas​have​been​embraced​throughout​the​continent​by​ethnic​organizations​and​ ngo s;​however,​ we​ instrumentalized​ them​ in​ our​ narration​ of​ pebi ​ history​ by​ emphasizing​the​specific​constellation​of​political​contexts​in​which​they​were​ articulated.​Community​control​provided​the​conceptual​framework​for​a​ chapter​dealing​with​how​and​why​education​is​politics​for​ cric .​The​concept​of​interculturalism​allowed​us​to​take​a​critical​look​at​relations​over​ time​between​nonindigenous​collaborators​and​Native​activists.​Cosmovision,​embodied​in​a​creation​story​generated​through​collective​research​by​ pebi ​with​almost​ two​hundred​shamans,​ provided​us​with​an​alternative​ historical​chronology​rooted​in​how​notions​of​culture​evolved​within​the​ organization.

Collaboration and Historical Writing 137

Joanne: The way I visualize the interaction of the three conceptual threads we selected is that community control provides the political foundations for the educational activities in which PEBI has always engaged. Interculturalism allows for an outward-looking orientation, permitting educational activists to never lose sight of the larger picture, the fact that education is part of a general political struggle for recognition as participants in the construction of the Colombian nation. Cosmovision provides the tools for an introspective orientation that values indigenous lifeways and ideologies, providing a specific cultural framework for interculturalism and, ultimately, for political action. Abelardo: Our organizing strategy has always consisted in strengthening an indigenous cultural identity that has been impacted by colonization. This objective cannot be undertaken without the participation of the community, yet it also permits us to relate to other peoples and resolve our problems in conjunction with them. Our concept of identity is intimately related to one of community power. This is a principal axis in our political work and must necessarily mediate our analysis of our historical experience. The notion of interculturalism is related to the conceptual thread of community control. Cauca is a multicultural province, one in which the future of the Nasa people can be strengthened only by forging links of cooperation with other indigenous groups as well as with the rest of the social fabric, including mestizo peasants, Afrodescendants, and popular urban sectors. This means that we must stake out a clear intercultural position founded in respect and the sharing of survival strategies. Interculturalism is profoundly political for us: it leads us to demand that we be recognized as culturally different peoples and as national actors. Cosmovision is the accumulation of ancestral knowledge that, from our point of view, affords us important tools for interacting with others. Cosmovision defines our cultural difference, marking our participation in a diverse nation. It is only through recourse to cosmovision that we can put interculturalism into practice because cosmovision provides us with the conceptual model that permits us to act as Natives.

Joanne: Each of us experienced conceptual conflicts in the course of the process. Once having constructed our conceptual framework, we began the task of historical interpretation. It was not an easy process. Having opted for a retrospective approach, as opposed to a systematic organizational analysis, we had to construct a narrative of the evolution of the three unifying concepts. That meant accepting that some of these concepts, particularly 138 Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos

cosmovision and interculturalism, were only incipient during the first decade of the organization, not full-blown as we observe them today. Cosmovision was a particularly difficult concept to historicize. As it is articulated today, cosmovision is the product of an intensive research process that was undertaken in the 1990s, giving rise to an integrated cosmology and ritual complex that is being adopted by Nasa communities throughout Cauca. It is thus a recent arrival on the scene in the sense that although much of this knowledge existed among shamans, it was piecemeal and had never been verbalized in a coherent narrative. Cosmovision is an attempt to integrate cosmological knowledge and to give it a didactic form that can be internalized by the indigenous population. The challenge for us, as historians, was to explicate the origins and evolution of this concept without denying the millenarian existence of cosmological knowledge. But cosmovision was not the only sticking point we encountered. Abelardo: My personal preoccupation, as both an actor in and an interpreter of the process, was with transcending anecdotal narrative. This meant negotiating the constant tension I felt between these two roles, which implied a movement between orality and writing. The founding leaders of CriC eloquently expressed their political thought orally. With the exception of Manuel Quintín Lame, the elders had no experience in writing down their ideas.14 Therefore, in the development of a contestatory political process writing was not necessarily a task of the leadership, although they controlled the written production of other indigenous activists and of the nonindigenous collaborators. I was educated in such contexts, not as a leader, but as a cultural activist, a role that implied a command of written communication. Because Nasa Yuwe was my first language, my entry into the activity of written reflection has been an ongoing process, one in which my training as an activist unfolded parallel to the development of my literate sensibilities. I have written works in various genres, including educational documents, texts inspired by Nasa mythology, and linguistic analysis. But this was the first time in my experience that I was to participate in the production of a historical narrative, a story in which I was also an actor. For me, writing the history of PeBi has been a process of confronting the difficulties of thinking retrospectively in dialogue with other team members. I had to strive to transcend a recounting of everyday experience, which was what I, as an actor, could most easily narrate. Instead, I had to attempt to elaborate an interpretation that included, simultaneously, my own experiCollaboration and Historical Writing 139

ence, the objectives of the bilingual teachers and PeBi activists who formulated our guiding questions, and the evaluation of the actions of the elders.15 To weave all this into a written narrative that was pleasing to read and at once preserved the voices of the protagonists and situated them in their historical contexts: all of this forced me to be attentive to my responsibilities within the team. I could not adopt the role merely of an informant but had to exercise political and cultural responsibility, not only as a member of PeBi and of the indigenous movement, but also as a Nasa. I needed to transcend the biases that indigenous actors generally felt toward academics and collaborators, but in addition I had to ensure that what we wrote reflected an indigenous ideology. This was my role: to ensure that in the course of the project the intercultural team maintained the transcendence of the indigenous discourse.

Conclusion What​ did​ we​ learn​ in​ the​ process?​ That​ collaboration​ necessarily​ implies​ being​open​to​other​modes​of​thought,​to​different​ways​of​formulating​research​questions,​to​the​possibility​of​political​analysis.​But​these​differences​ do​not​always​arise​out​of​the​fault​lines​between​Western​academic​culture​ and​the​radical​cultural​alterity​of​an​indigenous​researcher;​they​more​frequently​result​from​the​disparities​between​academics​and​activists,​whose​ cultural​differences​are​more​subtle​and​not​as​easily​recognizable.​We​must​ also​ understand​ that​ the​ political​ aspirations​ of​ cultural​ activists​ are​ frequently​embedded​within​a​cultural​discourse​that​obscures​their​political​ nature—at​least,​for​the​external​observer,​but​not​for​the​internal​participant.​What​we​must​accomplish​is​to​build​methodological​and​conceptual​ bridges​across​divergent​but​not​always​completely​apparent​positions.​This​ can​be​achieved​only​by​adopting​a​framework​in​which​academic​analysis​ occupies​a​secondary​position​that​respects​and​does​not​violate​organizational​priorities;​even​if​academic​contributions​introduce​concepts​external​ to​the​indigenous​culture,​the​objective​is​to​internalize​them​by​resignifying​ them​through​translation.​If​an​academic​accepts​these​rules,​she​or​he​also​ accepts​the​intercultural​orientation​of​the​project. ​ Such​ are​ the​ priorities​ that​ determined​ the​ nature​ of​ our​ work.​When​ we​entered​into​conversation,​we​came​to​realize​that​the​guiding​concepts​ of​ pebi ​history​ would​ have​ to​assume​ a​discourse​ of​political​ autonomy,​

140 Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos

not​one​of​indigenous​culture​and​much​less​one​of​an​academic​nature.​To​ theorize​from​an​indigenous​perspective​does​not​always​mean​that​cultural​ alterity​is​foregrounded,​but​it​does​mean​that​cultural​difference​must​be​ grounded​in​an​intercultural​perspective. ​ Rey​Chow​(1995,​180)​distinguishes​between​ethnography​and​autoethnography​ by​ suggesting​ that​ the​ autoethnographer​ is​ simultaneously​ the​ subject​and​object​of​her​research:​as​she​engages​in​study​she​is​cognizant​ of​the​fact​that​others​have​studied​her,​something​that​Chow​calls​a​state​of​ “being-​looked-​at-​ness.”​Autoethnography​is​thereby​more​contestatory​than​ conventional​ethnography.​In​a​way,​our​history​of​pebi ​arose​out​of​a​sense​ of​being-​looked-​at-​ness:​the​fact​of​being​an​object​of​conventional​education​influenced​cric ’s​desire​to​achieve​indigenous​protagonism,​to​become​ a​subject​in​education.​Equally,​the​three​members​of​our​history​research​ team​experienced​being-​looked-​at-​ness.​This​was​certainly​the​case​for​Abelardo,​who,​as​actor​and​analyst,​was​simultaneously​a​subject​and​object​of​ historical​research.​But​by​virtue​of​the​collaborative​nature​of​the​project,​ Joanne​and​Graciela​also​came​to​experience​this​effect,​as​each​of​us​was​ exposed​to​the​gaze​of​the​other​team​members​and​of​the​ pebi ​collective​ whose​questions​guided​our​work.​The​complex​dialogue​that​arose​out​of​ this​exercise​helped​us​understand​the​deep​and​multifaceted​meaning​of​ collaboration​and​interculturalism.

Notes Acknowledgments:​The​German​foundation​Terre​des​Hommes​funded​ cric ​in​its​ efforts​to​write​a​history​of​its​bilingual​education​program.​Joanne​Rappaport’s​research​was​funded​by​an​international​collaborative​grant​from​the​Wenner-​Gren​ Foundation​ for​ Anthropological​ Research​ during​ 1999–2002.​ We​ thank​ Florencia​ Mallon​and​the​University​of​Wisconsin​for​inviting​us​to​participate​in​the​“Narrating​ Native​ Histories”​ conference,​ where​ this​ book​ originated.​ Portions​ of​ this​ essay​were​published​in​chapter​5​of​Joanne​Rappaport’s​Intercultural Utopias: Public Intellectuals, Cultural Experimentation, and Ethnic Pluralism in Colombia​(Duke​ University​Press,​2005);​in​this​essay,​however,​the​republished​sections​appear​in​ dialogue​with​the​observations​of​Abelardo​Ramos,​thus​transforming​their​intent. ​ 1.​The​Duboisian​notion​of​double​consciousness​arose​at​a​particular​moment​ in​the​history​of​interracial​relations​in​the​United​States​and​out​of​the​very​specific​intellectual​trajectory​of​Du​Bois​himself.​But​notwithstanding​its​origins​in​the​ highly​polarized​racial​atmosphere​of​the​United​States​in​the​early​twentieth​century​

Collaboration and Historical Writing 141

and​its​insertion​into​a​discourse​of​racial​pride,​the​concept​of​double​consciousness​ presupposes​ a​ complex​ and​ heterogeneous​ experience,​ not​ a​ simple​ essence​ (Chandler​1996,​85).​In​this​sense,​it​is​a​metaphor​that​can​be​fruitfully​applied​across​ geographic​and​historical​contexts.​In​a​workshop​with​some​forty​bilingual​teachers​ affiliated​with​the​ cric ,​the​concept​was​reconfigured​according​to​indigenous​political​priorities​as​“a​revaluing​of​our​own​culture​as​difference.”​One​of​the​participants​offered​the​following​rereading​of​the​concept:​“The​pain​of​being​indigenous,​ with​all​of​the​implications​of​rejection​to​which​we​are​subjected​and,​at​the​same​ time,​pride​in​being​different,​with​a​clear​and​defined​identity”​(Chocué​Guasaquillo​ 2000,​14).​For​an​analysis​of​this​exercise,​see​Rappaport​(2005,​chap.​1). ​ 2.​Theory​is​a​major​challenge​today,​when​Native​groups​across​the​Americas​ have​proposed​the​creation​of​indigenous​universities​(Pancho​Aquite​et​al.,​2004). ​ 3.​Abelardo​Ramos​graduated​from​this​program. ​ 4.​There​is​not​sufficient​space​here​to​describe​other​attempts​at​indigenous​theorization​in​Bolivia​(Fernández​Osco​2000);​Guatemala​(Montejo​2002;​cf.​Warren​ 1998,​chaps.​5,​6);​and​New​Zealand​(Bishop​1994;​Smith​1999),​which​also​present​ rich​sources​for​the​creation​of​Native​conceptual​tools. ​ 5.​Both​Allen​and​Field​employ​the​term​sovereignty​in​their​analyses​because​it​is​ a​fundamental​demand​of​Native​Americans.​However,​in​a​country​like​Colombia,​ where​indigenous​communities​exist​on​the​basis​of​colonial​royal​titles​instead​of​ treaties,​the​notion​of​sovereignty​is​not​as​relevant​as​that​of​autonomy,​which​permits​them​to​think​of​themselves​simultaneously​as​Native​people​and​as​​Colombians. ​ 6.​Our​use​of​utopia​to​signify​a​dream​that​is​partially​attainable​comes​from​the​ usage​in​cric ​itself. ​ 7.​The​final​product​of​our​research​(Bolaños,​Ramos,​Rappaport,​and​Miñana​ 2004)​was​also​coauthored​by​Carlos​Miñana,​an​anthropologist​at​the​National​University​of​Colombia​in​Bogotá​who​has​worked​on​a​number​of​pebi ​projects;​Carlos​ assisted​in​the​writing​of​the​final​chapter​on​pebi ’s​pedagogical​activities. ​ 8.​ We​ refer​ specifically​ here​ to​ cric ,​ whose​ various​ programs​ in​ education,​ health,​agricultural​production,​and​gender​operate​with​interethnic​personnel.​In​ the​Indigenous​Authorities​of​Colombia​(aico),​a​parallel​indigenous​organization​ that​works​in​Cauca,​there​are​no​non-​Native​collaborators.​Instead,​nonindigenous​ supporters​formed​a​distinct​solidarity​movement​parallel​to​aico ;​however,​even​in​ this​case,​research​takes​on​the​character​of​an​interethnic​dialogue,​as​the​two​organizations​enter​into​collaboration​(Vasco​2002). ​ 9.​ The​ term​ traditional authority​ is​ used​ in​ Cauca​ to​ refer​ to​ annually​ elected​ reservation​councils​(cabildos).​The​executive​council​of​ cric ​was​recognized​recently​as​a​traditional​authority​after​a​protracted​struggle​with​the​national​government,​entitling​them​to​carry​staffs​of​office,​as​cabildo​members​do.​However,​in​ practice​there​is​an​implicit​distinction​made​between​community​authorities​and​ líderes​(leaders)​in​the​organization. 142 Joanne​rappaport​anD​abelarDo​raMos

10. Joanne: Colombian academics are frequently constrained by their institutions in ways that are unfamiliar to those of us who work in U.S. universities. For instance, their research must be approved by the university administration if they are to conduct it during the academic year—which extends for considerably more weeks than in the United States. The constraints that operate upon academics in the United States are more subtle, generated by the venues in which we publish our research. Nevertheless, Abelardo, who has an M.A. in linguistics from a major Colombian university and was trained by French academics, is acutely aware of the ways in which the international academy limits the activities of its members. ​ 11.​Until​2004,​ pebi ​was​called​ peb ,​the​Bilingual​Education​Program.​As​a​result​of​research​into​pebi ’s​history​it​was​decided​that​interculturalism​was​a​critical​ component​of​the​program,​and​so​its​name​was​changed​to​the​Bilingual​and​Intercultural​Education​Program. 12. Joanne: Until the last of the three workshops, the general membership of PEBI did not have an opportunity to discuss the nature of the project. Many of them assumed that it would take the form of a sistematización, a collective analysis of current goals and objectives, evaluating their progress in the different components of the education program. In fact, the guiding questions were prepared with a sistematización in mind. It was only at the third workshop that the idea of writing a history was broached and subsequently chosen as a viable option by the Nasa-speakers at the meeting, who were in the majority. For more on these negotiations and on the nature of the guiding questions, see Rappaport (2005, chap. 5). ​ 13.​A​universal​orthography​for​Nasa​Yuwe​was​adopted​in​2000.​In​an​earlier​ alphabet​used​by​ cric ,​Çxayu’çe​was​written​as​C’ayu’ce.​We​will​cite​articles​in​the​ magazine​that​were​published​before​the​adoption​of​the​new​orthography​in​the​ earlier​alphabet. ​ 14.​Manuel​Quintín​Lame​was​a​Nasa​leader​who,​in​the​first​half​of​the​twentieth​ century,​organized​indigenous​communities​in​the​provinces​of​Cauca​and​Tolima.​ His​demands​form​the​basis​of​cric ’s​political​program.​Lame​wrote​a​treatise,​Los pensamientos del indio que se educó dentro de las selvas colombianas​(Thoughts​of​an​ Indian​educated​in​the​Colombian​forests),​which​has​become​a​foundational​text​for​ the​Colombian​indigenous​movement​(Lame​2004​[1939]). ​ 15.​Graciela​Bolaños,​the​third​member​of​the​team,​also​had​to​confront​this​challenge,​given​that​she​was​a​founding​member​of​cric .

Collaboration and Historical Writing 143

Jan rus anD Diane l. rus

The​Taller​Tzotzil​of​Chiapas,​Mexico A Native Language Publishing Project, 1985–2002

Between​1976​and​2002​the​Taller​Tzotzil​(Spanish​for​“Tzotzil​Workshop”)​ published​more​than​thirty​booklets​by​indigenous​authors​in​Tzotzil-​Maya,​ a​ language​ spoken​ by​ some​ four​ hundred​ thousand​ people​ in​ Mexico’s​ southernmost​state​of​Chiapas.​The​Taller​followed​the​model​of​the​Brazilian​educator​Paulo​Freire​(for​example,​1969),​and​the​original​purpose​ of​the​publications​was​to​put​on​paper​the​reflections​of​Tzotzil-​speakers​ as​they​finished​literacy​courses​in​their​own​language​as​an​exercise​in​concientización​(consciousness-​raising​or​empowerment.)1​Typical​themes​were​ the​importance​of​communal​labor,​the​revitalization​of​local​fiestas,​and​the​ achievement​of​indigenous​control​over​schools​and​town​halls—topics​that​ essentially​focused​inside​of​indigenous​communities​and​reaffirmed​their​ solidarity​and​continuity.​Beginning​in​the​mid-​1980s,​however,​as​Mexico’s​ economic​crisis​made​life​within​traditional​communities​more​and​more​ precarious​and​drove​increasing​numbers​of​people​into​cities​and​distant​ labor​migrations,​the​Taller​began​providing​a​space​in​which​to​examine​ Tzotzil​people’s​place​in​the​larger​society​and​economy,​to​discuss​economic​ and​ organizational​ alternatives,​ to​ explore​ alternate​ indigenous-​centered​ histories,​and​then​to​share​those​discussions​with​other​Tzotzil-​speakers.​ Publications​ began​ focusing​ outward,​ taking​ on​ contract​ labor​ on​ coffee​ plantations,​the​struggle​for​land,​organization​of​artisan​and​agricultural​ cooperatives,​indigenous​rights​in​the​city,​undocumented​migration​to​the​ United​States,​and​reactions​to​the​Zapatista​Rebellion. ​ This​essay​is​a​reflection​on​the​course​of​the​Taller​in​this​second​period.​ Most​of​the​questions​addressed​could​be​asked​of​any​publishing​project:​ How​were​topics​chosen?​How​were​the​texts​composed​and​edited?​How​

were​the​publications​distributed?​Beyond​the​extraordinary​historical​circumstances​of​the​1980s​and​1990s,​however,​the​fact​that​the​Taller​was​in​ two​senses​an​intercultural​project​adds​additional​levels​of​complication​to​ these​questions. ​ On​the​first​level,​because​there​was​no​recent​precedent​for​written​as​ opposed​ to​ oral​ communication​ within​ the​ larger​ community​ of​ Tzotzil-​ speakers,​the​very​fact​of​publishing​raised​questions​about​new​versus​old​ culture​among​Tzotzils​themselves.2​Who,​for​example,​had​the​authority​to​ be​an​author?​Although​they​are​increasingly​a​thing​of​the​past,​in​the​1980s​ there​were​still​deeply​felt​disagreements​over​the​right​to​write—to​express​ a​public​opinion—of​the​young​as​opposed​to​the​old,​women​as​opposed​to​ men,​and​people​who​had​not​achieved​offices​within​their​communities​as​ opposed​to​people​with​socially​defined​status.​What​dialect​and​orthography​should​be​used?​What​formats,​themes,​and​audiences​were​appropriate?​ That​is,​was​it​better​to​publish​monolingually​for​an​indigenous​audience​or​ bilingually​so​nonindigenous​people​could​listen​in?​Were​there​themes​too​ sensitive​to​share​with​nonindigenous​people​or​with​indigenous​political​ rivals—or​to​write​about​at​all? ​ On​the​second​level,​questions​arose​from​the​fact​that​the​Taller’s​coordinators—that​is,​we,​the​authors​of​this​essay—were​nonindigenous​participants​in​what​otherwise​aspired​to​be​an​indigenous​project.​Just​whose​culture​and​politics​came​into​play​in​making​choices​about​form​and​content,​ even​when​these​were​made​collectively​with​indigenous​colleagues?​How​ much​did​our​presence​affect​the​way​in​which​people​participated​in​the​ Taller—their​comfort​with​themes,​linguistic​forms,​and​processes​of​production—or​even​their​willingness​to​participate?​How​much,​finally,​was​a​ publishing​project,​as​opposed,​for​instance,​to​a​project​of​community​discussions​without​a​written​record,​“our​thing,”​itself​a​cultural​artifact,​not​ to​say​an​imposition? ​ By​the​time​we​went​to​work​in​the​Taller​we​had​lived​for​extended​periods​ in​ indigenous​ communities​ in​ Puno,​ Peru,​ and​ in​ highland​ Chiapas​ and​were​not​naive​about​our​status​as​outsiders.​At​the​same​time,​Rigoberta​Menchú’s​I, Rigoberta​had​appeared​only​a​year​and​a​half​before​we​ began​ our​ project,​ and​ the​ arguments​ about​ testimonio,​ representation,​ and​whether​the​subaltern​could​ever​speak​in​a​supposedly​colonial​form​ such​as​writing,​with​all​the​exquisite​self-​consciousness​these​arguments​ would​eventually​evoke​within​the​academy,​had​barely​begun.3​During​the​ 1970s​we​had​done​extensive​oral​history​and​ethnohistory​interviewing​in​ The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 145

Tzotzil​and​had​also​established​many​personal​relationships​and​alliances​ with​members​of​Tzotzil​communities.​Thus​we​knew​that​among​Tzotzil-​ speakers​speaking​in​Tzotzil​there​was​an​internal,​indigenous​conversation​ about​history​and​politics​that​was​not​only​different​from,​but​also​opposed​ to​the​ways​those​same​themes​were​talked​about​in​Spanish,​even​by​the​ same​ people.​ Through​ stories​ and​ gossip,​ people​ discussed​ and​ analyzed​ exploitative​ labor​ conditions,​ repressive​ government,​ and​ discrimination​ against​Indians​as​well​as​ways​to​combat​these​ills.​These​conversations​had​ always​existed​and​had​just​as​certainly​almost​always​been​kept​within​the​ community​of​those​who​spoke​Tzotzil,​secret​from​ladinos​(non-​Indians).​ Our​proposal,​in​all​its​straightforward​simplicity,​was​to​help​disseminate​ some​of​this​internal,​face-​to-​face​analysis;​to​encourage​communities​to​talk​ with​each​other​in​their​own​language​across​the​region,​with​us​acting​temporarily​as​“midwives”​for​what​they​had​to​say. ​ If​our​goal​was​to​help​Tzotzil-​speakers​express​themselves​in​print,​however,​it​should​also​be​clear​that​we​had​interests​and​points​of​view​of​our​ own.​From​the​beginning​of​our​time​with​the​Taller,​we​continued​to​study​ and​write​about​the​deep​economic​and​political​changes​occurring​in​rural​ Chiapas.​We​were​critical​of​the​inwardly​focused​community​studies​characteristic​ of​ most​ Chiapas​ anthropology​ through​ the​ mid-​1980s,​ and​ although​we​appreciated​the​efforts​of​others​to​publish​in​native​languages,​we​ were​also​impatient​with​the​tendency​of​many​writing​and​literacy​projects​ to​stay​at​the​level​of​myths​and​animal​stories.​To​us​it​seemed​obvious​that​ Tzotzil-​speaking​people​were​struggling​with​the​same​worldwide​forces​that​ affected​us​as​well.​Virtually​all​of​the​books​published​by​the​Taller​from​ its​inception​had​been​preceded​by​extensive​conversations​and​seminars​ within​communities​about​their​own​history;​about​the​exploitation,​repression,​ and​ discrimination​ they​ had​ experienced;​ and​ about​ how​ they​ had​ dealt​with​them.​As​much​as​we​hoped​to​continue​these​local​discussions​ and​ to​ connect​ them​ to​ wider​ conversations​ involving​ others​ who​ might​ pick​up​and​read​a​book​in​Tzotzil,​we​also​looked​forward​to​participating​ in​them​ourselves,​to​being​part​of​what​Andrés​Aubry​(2005)​called​the​“co-​ production​of​knowledge.” ​ It​seems​to​us​that​the​most​natural​way​to​get​to​these​questions​is​to​take​ them​on​chronologically,​as​we​came​upon​them,​or​tripped​over​them,​in​ the​course​of​working​in​the​Taller.​The​following​essay​thus​takes​the​form​ of​a​sort​of​diary,​describing​in​order​the​projects​created​by​the​Taller​during​ the​years​of​our​participation​and​then​probing​the​evolution​of​our​practice​ 146 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

with​each​new​project—that​is,​the​puzzles​that​arose,​and,​as​best​we​can​ reconstruct​them,​the​discussions​and​thinking​behind​the​Taller’s​solutions.

Chiapas in the Mid-1980s: Beginning Considerations When​we​started​our​collaboration​with​the​Taller​in​late​1985,​it​had​been​ eight​years​since​we​had​finished​our​long​ethnographic​fieldwork​in​Chiapas​ in​the​mid-​1970s.​The​first​change​we​discovered,​although​it​took​us​a​few​ months​to​recognize​it,​was​that​which​we​had​formerly​thought​of​as​indigenous​ communities’​ dissenting,​ critical,​ often​ angry​ private​ conversations​ among​themselves​had​become​increasingly​public.​By​that​point,​Chiapas’s​ indigenous​ communities​ were​ deeply​ immersed​ in​ the​ economic​ depression,​la crisis,​which​officially​dates​from​the​Mexican​financial​collapse​of​ 1982​but​which​in​fact​had​begun​in​the​countryside​almost​a​decade​earlier.​ The​seasonal,​often​migrant,​agricultural​labor​on​which​indigenous​communities​depended​for​their​livelihoods​had​stagnated​in​the​mid-​1970s,​and​ by​the​mid-​1980s​the​demand​for​workers​was​actually​slightly​less​than​it​ had​been​in​1975.4​For​a​while​Mexico’s​borrowing​against​its​oil​reserves​ had​underwritten​construction​projects​that​took​up​some​of​the​employment​slack,​but​after​1982​that​work​also​disappeared.​Under​these​circumstances,​indigenous​people​made​radical​changes​in​their​lives​to​support​ themselves.​Tens​of​thousands​abandoned​their​ancestral​communities​in​ order​to​homestead​land​in​the​Lacandón​jungle.​Many​tens​of​thousands​ more​moved​into​shantytowns​around​Chiapas’s​cities,​cities​that​had​never​ before​had​sizable​indigenous​populations.​Economic​choices​also​changed​ life​within​families.​Men​began​migrating​greater​distances​to​find​work​and​ staying​away​for​longer​periods​once​they​had​found​it.​Given​men’s​absences​ and​their​families’​pressing​needs,​women,​in​turn,​began​looking​for​ways​ to​make​money​outside​of​their​homes.​For​the​first​time,​many​women​became​agricultural​wage​laborers​in​regions​near​their​homes.​Many​others​ turned​ their​ traditional​ weaving​ and​ embroidery​ into​ artisan​ goods​ they​ could​sell​to​tourists. ​ Most​of​all,​indigenous​people​throughout​the​state,​previously​renowned​ for​the​insularity​of​their​communal​social​and​cultural​lives,​increasingly​ joined​new​regionwide​associations,​some​of​them​independent​political​and​ economic​organizations,​others​religious​groups,​both​Catholic​and​Protestant​(Harvey​1998;​Rus,​Hernández​Castillo,​and​Mattiace​2003,​1–26;​Collier​1994).​Some​of​these​groups​helped​resettle​those​who​migrated,​others​ The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 147

helped​with​the​production​and​marketing​of​new​kinds​of​goods,​and​still​ others​organized​protests​about​injustices​and​in​some​regions​even​led​land​ invasions.​The​rising​reorganization​and​reorientation​of​the​state’s​indigenous​population​are​beyond​the​present​discussion,​except​to​the​extent​that​ they​are​a​theme​of​many​of​the​Taller’s​books.​What​most​interests​us​here​ is​that​by​the​mid-​1980s​people​all​over​the​state​had​begun​to​say​publicly​ things​that​in​the​past​they​had​said​only​among​themselves.​Without​quite​ understanding​the​extent​of​this​break​or​even,​at​the​beginning,​that​it​was​ a​break,​we​clearly​had​come​into​a​very​different​political​and​cultural​environment​from​the​one​in​which​we​had​lived​during​the​1970s. ​ For​its​part,​the​Taller​Tzotzil​had​already​begun​responding​to​the​change​ even​before​we​arrived.​The​first​history​of​the​Mexican​Revolution​in​the​ Tzotzil​highlands​produced​by​Tzotzil-​speakers​themselves,​with​acute,​biting​commentary​about​the​behavior​of​landowners​and​the​government​during​the​decades​after​the​Revolution​(K’alal ich’ay mosoal / Cuando dejamos de ser aplastados;​When​we​were​no​longer​crushed),​was​coordinated​by​ Andrés​Aubry,​the​Taller’s​founder,​and​published​in​Tzotzil​and​Spanish​in​ 1982.​This​was​followed​in​February​1985​by​a​deeply​felt​book​by​the​Taller’s​ principal​Tzotzil​editor​and​translator,​José​González​Hernández​of​Zinacantán,​and​his​great-​uncle​Antonio​López​Pérez,​Zinacantán’s​first​Native​ municipal​secretary.​The​book​(Ja’ k’u x’elan ta jpojbatik ta ilbajinel yu’un jkaxlanetik / Cómo escapamos del control de los ladinos;​How​we​escaped​the​ control​of​the​ladinos)​was​about​their​community’s​successful​fight​at​the​ end​of​the​1950s​to​overthrow​the​state​government’s​custom​of​imposing​ nonindigenous​ municipal​ secretaries​ to​ supervise​ the​ community’s​ local​ council.​Neither​of​these​stories,​about​the​Revolution​of​the​1910s​and​the​ fight​for​ local​ self-​government​ in​the​1950s,​ was​a​new​one,​ but​in​retelling​them,​publishing​them,​in​the​1980s​the​authors​of​the​two​books​were​ ​holding​them​up​for​reflection​during​a​new​period​of​doubt​and​vulnerability. ​ We​did​not​fully​realize​the​extent​of​the​changes​that​had​already​begun​ when​we​arrived​in​the​fall​of​1985,​nor​could​we​have​predicted​that​a​new​ historical​ period​ was​ beginning.​ In​ the​ new​ configuration,​ most​ Tzotzils​ would​no​longer​be​occupied​full-​time​in​agriculture,​and​cultural​and​political​leadership​would​increasingly​swing​from​local​communities​to​city​ and​even​regional​organizations.​After​a​couple​of​months​of​talking​with​ our​ Tzotzil​ friends,​ however,​ we​ did​ begin​ to​ understand​ the​ urgency​ of​ their​economic​worries.​In​the​1970s,​as​a​couple​with​a​small​child,​we​had​ 148 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

studied​migrant​labor,​accompanying​Tzotzil​workers​to​coffee​plantations,​ sugar-cane​fields,​and​corn​haciendas,​staying​and​working​alongside​them​ for​ brief​ periods.​ We​ knew​ that​ mention​ of​ such​ labor​ had​ been​ left​ out​ of​most​ethnographies​of​the​highland​Tzotzils.​It​occurred​away​from​the​ communities​that​were​the​sites​of​research,​and​in​any​case​was​not,​according​to​most​anthropologists,​an​item​of​Native​culture.5​We​also​knew,​ however,​that​among​Tzotzils​themselves​that​work​had​been​an​important​ topic​of​conversation​in​the​1970s,​when​it​was​a​mainstay​of​their​families’​ incomes.​If​anything,​it​was​an​even​more​important​topic​in​the​1980s,​when​ it​was​disappearing.​We​thus​decided​that​our​first​booklet​should​be​about​ seasonal​migrant​labor,​specifically,​coffee​labor,​and​the​ways​it​was​woven​ into​community​life.6​Everyone​had​a​story​about​working,​and​not​working,​ in​coffee.​As​a​theme​that​might​spark​discussions​of​work​and​economic​ change,​it​seemed​ideal.​And​so​in​early​1986​we​began​interviewing​for​Abtel ta Pinka​(“Labor​on​Coffee​Plantations”).

1985–1986: “Turning Talk into Paper” Abtel ta Pinka​was​published​in​a​monolingual​Tzotzil​edition​in​September​ 1986​and​republished​in​a​bilingual​Tzotzil–Spanish​version​in​1991.​It​consisted​of​selections​from​the​testimonies​of​coffee​workers​from​the​municipio​of​Chamula,​three​men​and​a​woman,​plus​the​wives​of​the​men,​who​ had​felt​the​effects​of​enganche,​contract​labor.​In​all,​the​texts​spanned​the​ period​from​the​late​1930s​to​the​early​1980s.​The​sections​were​organized​by​ theme:​the​planters,​labor​contracting,​the​coffee​workers’​union,​life​on​the​ plantation,​what​it​was​like​to​be​the​wife​of​a​worker​who​stayed​behind​in​ the​village,​what​it​was​like​to​be​a​woman​coffee​worker,​and​so​forth.​After​ recording​ and​ transcribing​ the​ open-​ended​ testimonies,​ several​ of​ which​ were​done​over​several​days,​the​members​of​the​Taller—the​two​of​us​and​ two​colleagues,​one​from​the​community​of​Zinacantán​and​the​other​from​ Chamula—edited​the​texts​and​then​submitted​them​to​the​authors​for​approval.​In​all​but​one​case,​this​meant​reading​the​entire​manuscript​aloud​ for​those​who​could​not​read,​checking​both​content​and​language.​Finally,​ we​added​photographs,​both​historical​and​recent,​and​provided​captions​ with​additional​information​about​the​plantations,​such​as​the​dates​they​ were​founded,​the​nationalities​of​the​owners,​the​value​of​Chiapas’s​coffee​ production​through​the​years,​and​so​on.​The​final​booklet​was​twenty-​eight​ pages​long. The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 149

​ Following​ the​ precedent​ of​ earlier​ Taller​ publications,​ we​ printed​ two​ hundred​ copies.​ Most​ were​ sold​ for​ thirty​ cents,​ far​ less​ than​ the​ cost​ of​ printing​ them,​ but​ we​ felt​ it​ was​ important​ that​ the​ books​ have​ a​ value.7​ Copies​were​given​to​the​authors​and​their​families,​and​many​more​(some​ forty)​were​distributed​to​Tzotzil​schoolteachers​and​catechists​for​sharing​ with​ their​ classes​ or​ community​ discussion​ groups​ ( grupos de reflexión).​ To​our​surprise,​the​largest​single​market,​however,​consisted​of​the​mostly​ Protestant​settlers​in​the​colonias​surrounding​San​Cristóbal,​who​bought​ seventy​to​eighty​copies​for​the​full​price.​Smaller​numbers,​perhaps​twenty-​ five,​were​purchased​by​residents​of​other​rural​Tzotzil-​speaking​communities. ​ The​second​edition,​published​in​1991,​was,​as​noted,​bilingual​and​consisted​of​four​hundred​copies.​Most​of​the​edition​was​sold​through​bookstores,​where​it​was​still​available​at​the​beginning​of​the​Zapatista​Rebellion​ in​1994.​Soon​thereafter,​as​one​of​the​few​publications​that​described​indigenous​people’s​lives​in​their​own​words,​it​sold​out.​Over​the​next​several​ years,​parts​of​the​text​were​published​multiple​times​in​Spanish​and​Eng​lish​ (for​example,​Paz​Paredes,​Cobo,​and​Bartra,​1996;​Womack​1999,​111–18;​see​ also​Collier​1991). Practice: Initial Decisions ​ Voices:​From​the​beginning​we​set​out​to​counter​the​homogenizing​tendency​ of​ typical​ ethnographies​ and​ histories,​ with​ their​ single​ narrative​ voice.​Beginning​with​this​test​publication,​all​but​two​of​the​Taller’s​publications​after​1986​had​a​variety​of​voices:​men​and​women,​old​and​young,​ and,​if​possible,​individuals​from​more​than​one​community.​In​the​specific​ case​of​Abtel,​we​hoped​to​convey​the​testimonies’​message​that​the​system​ of​migrant​labor​affected​not​just​the​migrants​but​their​entire​families,​and​ not​only​during​the​months​migrants​were​away​at​work​but​throughout​the​ year.​Life​in​coffee​workers’​communities,​hundreds​of​miles​from​the​plantations,​was​organized​around​the​calendar​of​coffee.​Scheduling​of​community​work​days,​planting,​fiestas,​marriages,​and​baptisms​had​to​take​into​ account​the​prolonged​seasonal​absences​of​adult​men.​Everyone’s​life​was​ affected,​even​those​who​never​left​their​home​municipios.​By​letting​a​variety​ of​people​speak,​Abtel​tried​to​demonstrate​the​variety​of​ways​in​which​this​ impact​was​experienced. ​ On women’s participation:​With​only​two​exceptions,​we​believe,​women’s​ voices​were​not​present​in​native​language​books​in​Chiapas​before​Abtel,​ 150 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

either​ in​ the​ state​ projects,​ or​ among​ Protestant​ and​ Catholic​ missionaries’​books,​or​even​in​the​early​Taller​Tzotzil​publications​(1975–85).8​Nor,​as​ far​as​we​know,​had​scholarly​writing​about​coffee​work​and​other​migrant​ labor​in​Chiapas​ever​mentioned​the​impact​of​such​work​on​the​women​and​ children​who​stayed​at​home.​As​it​happened,​however,​including​women​ seemed​as​natural​to​our​collaborators​as​it​did​to​us.​Men​and​women​both​ knew​that​labor​migrations​affected​the​entire​family,​and​both​understood​ and​accepted​that​the​point​was​to​explore​the​experiences​and​hardships​ of​men​and​women​alike.​Indeed,​one​of​the​former​coffee​workers​encouraged​his​wife​to​come​forward​with​the​painful​story​of​her​fights​with​her​ first​husband​every​time​he​had​to​depart​for​the​fincas.​Another​woman​ talked​about​the​economic​survival​strategies​she​learned​during​her​husband’s​long​absences.​Still​a​third​told​of​the​difficulties​of​being​a​single​ mother​and​one​of​the​very​few​women​who​hired​on​as​a​coffee​picker. ​ Monolingual vs. bilingual publication:​Because​we​started​with​the​idea​ that​these​were​to​be​indigenous​books,​we​worked​solely​in​Tzotzil​on​the​ first​ two​ projects​ only,​ Abtel​ and​ Lo’il yu’un Kuskat​ (see​ below).​ One​ unexpected​ effect​ of​ this​ choice​ was​ our​ almost​ immediate​ popularity​ with​ urban​Protestants.​Many​adult​converts​had​become​literate​in​order​to​read​ the​Bible​in​Tzotzil,​and​by​the​early​1980s​they​were​probably​the​largest​ single​category​of​Tzotzil​readers.​Having​learned​to​read,​they​were​continually​ searching​ for​ new​ material,​ and​ when​ it​ appeared,​ word​ spread​ quickly​through​their​congregations​and​colonias.​A​side​effect​of​this​popularity,​however—and​a​paradoxical​one,​given​that​we​had​decided​to​work​ in​Tzotzil​precisely​to​emphasize​traditional​language​and​culture—was​that​ many​traditionalists​became​quite​suspicious​of​us.​By​the​mid-​1980s​municipios​throughout​the​highlands​were​riven​by​bitter​and​bloody​conflicts​ between​traditionalists​and​Protestants.​Many​traditionalists,​seeing​Abtel​ (which​most​of​them​could​not​read),​concluded​that​we​must​be​Protestant​missionaries.​Were​we​not​gringos,​like​the​missionaries?​Were​gringo​ missionaries​not​the​main​producers​of​books​in​Tzotzil?​Were​our​books​ not​widely​read​in​the​Protestant​settlements?​Given​the​bitterness​of​the​ religious​struggle,​this​assumption​could​have​closed​some​communities​to​ us,​particularly​Chamula,​where​we​had​hoped​to​concentrate​our​efforts.​ Luckily,​two​of​the​families​that​had​contributed​to​Abtel​were​themselves​ leading​traditionalists.​Although​at​first​they​were​discreet​about​their​participation​in​the​book,​eventually​they​helped​dispel​suspicions​of​us.​For​our​ part,​we​attempted​to​counter​gossip​against​the​Taller​by​giving​Chamula’s​ The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 151

leaders​free​copies​of​Abtel​as​well​as​copies​of​some​of​the​book’s​historic​ photos.​More​than​that,​we​made​a​conscious​choice​that​the​Taller’s​second​ publication​would​be​an​account​of​a​Chamula​uprising​in​the​nineteenth​ century​by​one​of​the​community’s​most​traditional​religious​leaders. ​ Editor-written introductions vs. letting the books speak for themselves:​To​ avoid​intruding​into​the​content​of​the​books,​we​resolved​at​the​beginning​ to​try​to​keep​editorial​introductions​to​a​minimum.​We​limited​ourselves​to​ stating​the​time​period,​the​locations​in​which​the​books​were​set,​and​perhaps​brief​descriptions​of​the​authors.​The​only​exception​to​this​rule​in​all​ of​the​books​was​the​second​book,​Lo’il yu’un Kuskat. ​ Orthography:​ Spelling​ and​ alphabet​ in​ Chiapas’s​ indigenous​ languages​ are​still​not​settled.​Since​1988​government​and​secular​groups​have​been​ using​conventions​chosen​in​meetings​called​by​the​National​Institute​for​ Adult​Education​(Instituto​Nacional​de​Educación​Adulta,​inea ),​in​which​ we​ participated.​ Publishers​ of​ Protestant​ materials,​ on​ the​ other​ hand— successors​of​the​Wycliffe​Bible​Translators​and​Summer​Institute​of​Linguistics​ (Wbt/sil)—who​ have​the​ overwhelming​ majority​of​native​ language​readers,​use​an​orthography​developed​fifty​years​ago​in​consultation​ with​the​Instituto​Nacional​Indigenista​of​the​Ministry​of​Education.​The​ Wbt/sil ​orthography​is​more​similar​to​Spanish​and​was​thus​presumed​to​ be​more​appropriate​for​literacy​programs​seeking​to​use​Tzotzil​as​a​transition​to​Spanish​reading.​Against​our​largely​Protestant​market,​we​chose​ to​use​the​simplified​government​alphabet​rather​than​the​Protestant​one.​ Although​ the​ actual​ differences​ between​ the​ orthographies​ are​ slight,​ the​ symbolic​ importance​ of​ the​ choice​ was​ enormous.​ In​ practice,​ we​ found​ that​readers​who​were​comfortable​with​the​Wbt/sil ​orthography​had​little​ trouble​with​the​inea ​variety.​Nor​did​they​seem​to​care.​Choosing​the​sil ’s​ “missionary​writing,”​on​the​other​hand,​would​have​clinched​our​association​with​the​Protestants​and​made​it​almost​impossible​to​be​accepted​in​ other​communities.9​In​the​long​run,​the​acceptance​of​a​conventional​orthography​will​be​decided​by​writers​and​readers. ​ Dialect choice:​There​is​considerable​difference​among​Tzotzil’s​still​mutually​intelligible​dialects.​As​a​result,​a​major​concern​of​some​anthropologists​ and​education​specialists​when​we​were​beginning​to​work​in​the​Taller​was​ which​dialect​we​would​use​and​whether​that​would​privilege​some​people​ over​others.​Would​we​pick​a​central​dialect,​supposedly​accessible​to​more​ speakers​and​readers,​participate​in​the​development​of​a​standardized​one,​ or,​our​preference,​transcribe​dialects​as​people​spoke?​In​the​ inea ​meet152 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

ings​on​orthography​in​1988,​Jacinto​Arias​Sojom,​a​Tzotzil-​speaker​from​ Chenalhó​who​had​studied​anthropology​at​Princeton​and​is​still​the​most​ accomplished​Tzotzil​writer,​argued​that​this​would​be​worked​out​by​the​ writers​themselves​as​they​chose​a​language​in​which​to​write—just​as​had​ happened​long​ago​in​Spanish​and​other​European​languages.​In​practice,​ we​discovered​that​sophisticated​speakers​of​all​the​dialects​not​only​understood,​but​took​great​delight​in​mimicking​the​others,​in​the​process​playing​with​different​communities’​stereotypes.​Indeed,​far​from​pushing​for​ standardization​over​the​past​twenty​years,​writers​appear​to​have​found​the​ differences​among​dialects​to​be​a​real​resource:​after​reading​three​or​four​ words​most​readers​can​tell​where​the​writer​or​character​is​from,​and​often​ how​old​they​are,​whether​they​are​male​or​female,​and​even,​from​the​incidence​and​shaping​of​words​borrowed​from​Spanish,​where​they​stand​with​ respect​to​modernization​and​politics. ​ Photographs:​We​set​up​a​darkroom​and​were​able​to​take​new​photos​as​ well​as​copy​historical​photos​to​illustrate​the​Taller’s​books​and​to​present​as​ gifts​to​our​collaborators.​Almost​no​one​had​ever​seen​late​nineteenth-​and​ early​twentieth-​century​photographs​of​Chiapas,​many​of​famous​indigenous​leaders,​so​they​were​a​great​conversation​opener. ​ Authorship:​While​we​made​no​secret​of​who​participated​in​the​Taller,​ our​initial​decision​ was​not​to​attribute​ authorship​ to​particular​ passages​ or​their​translations.​Authors,​editors,​and​helpers​were​all​listed​alphabetically,​ by​ the​ Tzotzil​ versions​ of​ their​ names,​ at​ the​ back​ of​ the​ books.​ In​ retrospect,​we​probably​were​trying​to​downplay,​perhaps​even​disguise,​our​ roles:​we​were​identified​in​the​lists​of​names​as​Xalik​Kurus​and​Tina​Kurus,​ the​names​by​which​we​have​always​been​known​in​Chamula.10​In​addition​ to​the​two​of​us,​the​Taller​consisted​of​a​very​small​permanent​team​who​ moved​from​one​project​to​another.​Both​of​our​long-​term​collaborators,​ Chep​Ernantes​(José​Hernández)​of​Zinacantán​and​Xalik​Kusman​(Salvador​Guzmán)​of​Chamula,​had​worked​as​translators​and​field​assistants​for​ ethnographers​before​working​with​us.​As​for​pay,​the​Taller​offered​all​of​us​ slightly​more​per​day​than​rural​schoolteachers​made.

1987–1988: Publishing and Politics In​the​months​after​Abtel​appeared​two​reactions​were​common​among​those​ who​read​it​or​heard​it​read.​First,​many​exclaimed,​“Yes,​that’s​the​way​it​was!​ That’s​my​story​too!”​After​a​little​probing,​it​turned​out​that​they​had​seen​ The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 153

school​texts​and​other​books​about​“ladino​things”​and​may​also​have​seen​ religious​texts​in​Tzotzil.​But​few​seem​even​to​have​imagined​books​in​their​ own​language​about​their​own​lives.​Indeed,​many​proceeded​to​ask​why​ schoolbooks​never​told​history​from​their​perspective​and​expressed​pleasure​that​“their​own”​history​might​be​saved​for​their​descendants.​Second,​ and​often​almost​simultaneously,​many​went​on​to​say​that​it​was​a​shame​ that​ladinos​and​Indians​who​did​not​speak​Tzotzil​could​not​read​the​book​ and​learn​about​the​“Tzotzils’​truth.”​Perhaps,​some​suggested,​Abtel​could​ be​printed​again,​in​Spanish.​Even​better,​said​others,​would​be​a​bilingual​ edition​so​that​while​others​could​read​it,​it​would​still​be​clear​to​them​that​ it​was​the​Tzotzils’​history. ​ Our​next​project​began​in​early​1987​with​a​suggestion​from​colleagues​ in​our​umbrella​nongovernmental​organization​(ngo)​who​wondered​if​we​ would​be​willing​to​undertake​a​collaborative​history​with​the​members​of​ the​ejido​(landholding​collective)​of​Los​Chorros​in​the​municipio​of​Chenalhó,​north​of​San​Cristóbal,​as​a​way​to​help​heal​what​had​become​a​bitter​ factional​fight.​Perhaps​the​process​of​recalling​what​they​had​in​common​ might​draw​the​two​factions​back​together.​We​agreed​to​initiate​the​project,​ and​late​in​the​spring​of​1987​we​made​several​overnight​trips​to​the​community.​After​the​first​trip,​we​took​along​historical​documents,​agrarian​reform​ files,​and​maps​as​well​as​our​tape​recorder​and​began​talking​about​the​past​ with​small​groups​of​elders​on​both​sides​of​the​split.​But​the​factionalism​ was​brutal:​people​on​one​side​would​see​us​talking​with​members​of​the​ other​and​either​grill​us​about​what​they​had​said​or​angrily​refuse​to​speak​ to​us.​There​seemed​no​way​to​get​the​leaders​of​the​two​sides​together,​but​ because​they​were​leaders,​it​was​also​hard​to​work​very​long​with​anyone​ else​without​their​help.11​After​many​visits​and​some​initially​very​fruitful​recorded​conversations​over​the​course​of​four​months,​we​reluctantly​gave​up​ on​any​hope​of​finishing​a​history​as​a​community​project. ​ Earlier​in​the​1980s​one​of​the​factions,​looking​for​support​against​its​ rivals,​who​ruled​the​community​in​the​name​of​the​state​party,​the​Partido​ Revolucionario​Institucional​(pri),​had​affiliated​for​a​time​with​the​Partido​ Socialista​de​los​Trabajadores​(pst).​Following​the​Zapatista​Rebellion​in​ 1994,​young​men​from​the​dominant​faction​used​their​connections​to​the​ state​government​and​security​forces​to​expel​many​of​these​formerly​ pst ,​ now​presumably​pro-​Zapatista,​neighbors.​Trained​by​the​army​as​paramilitary​forces,​some​of​these​same​young​men​participated​in​the​massacre​in​

154 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

the​ neighboring​ community​ of​ Acteal​ in​ December​ 1997​ (see​ Arias​ 1984;​ Aubry​and​Inda,​1998,​2003). ​ The​first​group​of​urban​Tzotzil​to​approach​us​on​their​own,​in​the​summer​of​1987,​were​representatives​of​San​Cristóbal’s​mostly​Protestant​Tzotzil​colonias.​Expelled​from​their​native​communities​by​their​traditionalist​ neighbors​beginning​in​the​mid-​1970s,​often​following​beatings​and​destruction​of​their​property,​the​first​of​these​migrants​had​by​the​end​of​that​decade​begun​to​establish​themselves​on​rocky​hillsides​and​former​pastures​ on​San​Cristóbal’s​periphery​(see​J.​Rus​2005).​Following​Mexico’s​financial​ collapse​in​1982,​these​original​settlers​were​joined​by​surging​numbers​of​ other​indigenous​people​displaced​by​the​economic​crisis.​At​the​end​of​the​ 1970s,​there​were​perhaps​two​thousand​indigenous​“exiles”​in​San​Cristóbal,​ people​who​were​accepted​as​refugees​by​most​of​the​city’s​Spanish-​speaking​ residents.​By​the​second​half​of​the​1980s,​however,​there​were​as​many​as​ twenty​ thousand,​ and​ Cristobalenses​ had​ begun​ to​ react​ xenophobically​ to​the​so-​called​invasion.​In​newspapers,​through​political​campaigns,​and​ even​to​the​migrants’​faces,​ladinos​told​them​they​should​go​“home”​to​their​ own​municipios​and​leave​the​ladinos​with​“theirs.”​Invited​to​a​meeting​of​ urban​Tzotzil​activists,​Jan​took​along​copies​of​Abtel ta Pinka,​which​most​ had​already​seen,​as​well​as​historical​photographs​from​as​early​as​the​1880s​ of​indigenous​men​doing​the​construction​work​on​the​city’s​most​important​buildings.​In​response​to​questions,​he​mentioned​that​not​only​had​the​ valley​land​been​part​of​Mayan​states​when​the​Spaniards​arrived,​but​also​ that​in​the​colonial​period​indigenous​people​had​built​and​paid​for​the​city’s​ many​churches​as​well​as​providing​the​workers,​tribute,​and​food​that​made​ the​ city’s​ existence​ possible.​ Several​ of​ those​ in​ attendance​ became​ quite​ enthusiastic​about​the​pictures​and​asked​if​a​book​could​be​made​to​show​ this​history​and​justify​their​presence​in​the​city​today.​And​so​Buch’u Lasmeltzan Jobel? / ¿Quién Hizo San Cristóbal?​(Who​Made​San​Cristóbal?)​was​ born.​Unlike​any​of​the​Taller’s​other​productions,​this​one​was​composed​ by​the​members​of​the​Taller​in​consultation​with​the​council​of​urban​migrants.​Published​in​May​1988,​it​was​a​brief,​illustrated​account,​in​Tzotzil​and​Spanish,​of​indigenous​people’s​contributions​to​the​history​of​San​ Cristóbal.​Three​hundred​copies​were​printed,​and,​at​thirty​cents​each,​more​ than​one​hundred​were​quickly​sold​in​San​Cristóbal’s​colonias.​Most​of​the​ rest​went​to​the​city’s​two​bookstores​and​by​the​end​of​1988​were​sold​out.​ For​a​brief​period​there​was​intense​interest​in​the​city​about​who​had​been​

The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 155

responsible​for​tal provocación​(such​a​provocation.)​As​in​other​Taller​publications,​the​contributors’​names,​including​our​own,​were​listed​in​the​back​ in​Tzotzil. ​ During​ the​ preparation​ of​ Buch’u Lasmeltzan Jobel​ close​ questioning​ about​ the​ book​ and​ about​ the​ pattern​ of​ distribution​ of​ Abtel​ by​ friends​ in​Chamula​finally​led​us​to​realize​that​we​were​becoming​identified​with​ Protestant​activists​in​the​city​and​that​this​might​jeopardize​our​ability​to​ continue​working​in​the​more​traditionalist​countryside.​By​this​time​the​ expulsion​of​Protestant​converts​had​spread​from​Chamula​to​indigenous​ municipios​throughout​the​highlands,​and​as​the​Protestant​urban​colonies​ became​more​established​and​successful​and​their​attractiveness​to​unemployed​ rural​ families​ grew​ stronger,​ animosity​ deepened​ (Rus​ and​ Vigil,​ 2007;​Rus​and​Morquecho,​2008).​Since​one​of​our​goals​at​the​Taller​was​to​ encourage​reconciliation​within​communities​by​getting​them​to​think​about​ their​common​histories,​we​began​looking​for​a​way​to​keep​the​doors​open​ to​both​sides. ​ The​solution​we​hit​upon​was​another​book,​to​appear​at​the​same​time​ as​ Buch’u.​ Entitled​ Lo’il yu’un Kuskat: Sk’op mol Marian Koyaso Panchin​ (Kuskat’s​Story:​The​Words​of​Marian​Koyaso​Panchin;​in​Spanish,​Mariano​ Collazo​Panchín),​it​was​an​account​of​the​Chamulas’​brief,​rebellious​attempt​to​found​an​autonomous​market​and​political​center​in​the​late​1860s​ and​the​ensuing​massacre​of​its​participants​by​the​state​militia​(Bricker​1981,​ 260–72).​In​succeeding​years,​ladino​histories​and​folklore​had​turned​these​ events​on​their​head​and​sensationalized​them​as​an​indigenous​bloodletting,​with​fanatical,​crazed​Tzotzils​killing​innocent​ladinos.​By​publishing​ Koyaso​ Panchin’s​ very​ accurate​ oral​ history​ of​ these​ events,​ we​ hoped​ to​ counter​the​inflammatory​version​that​was​still​current​in​state​textbooks,​ serving​as​an​implied​warning​about​the​dangers​of​indigenous​government.​ At​the​same​time,​mol​Marian​(“elder​Marian”)​was​a​respected,​conciliatory​figure​among​Chamula’s​traditional​leaders.​By​doing​a​little​book​with​ him,​to​be​published​concurrently​with​Buch’u Lasmeltzan Jobel,​we​hoped​ to​establish​that​the​Taller​welcomed​traditionalists;​that​it​was​not​a​Protestant​activity​and​we​were​not​missionaries.​We​printed​one​hundred​copies,​ and​most​were​distributed​with​Koyaso​Panchin’s​help​in​the​head​town​of​ Chamula—often​ as​ part​ of​ a​ two-​book​ set​ with​ Buch’u.​ The​ Tzotzils​ who​ had​built​San​Cristóbal​over​the​course​of​several​centuries​and​who​had​ struggled​for​autonomy​in​the​1860s​were,​after​all,​the​ancestors​of​traditionalists​and​Protestants​alike. 156 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

Practice: Refinements ​ Bilingual Editions:​Both​of​the​communities​where​we​worked​through​ most​of​1987​specifically​requested​books​with​bilingual​or​Spanish​texts.​In​ the​case​of​the​urban​Protestants,​the​reason​for​this​was​precisely​that​they​ wanted​ ladinos​ to​ read​ their​ history​ and​ recognize​ their​ legitimate​ claim​ to​a​share​of​the​city.​In​making​Buch’u Lasmeltzan Jobel​our​first​bilingual​ publication,​we​determined​that​if​we​were​going​to​use​two​(or​more)​languages,​they​were​going​to​be​on​facing​pages​and​strictly​parallel,​sentence-​ by-​sentence,​paragraph-​by-​paragraph. ​ Meanwhile,​for​those​in​Los​Chorros​who​would​participate​in​our​conversations,​the​text​was​going​to​have​to​be​Spanish​alone​because​one​of​the​ rifts​in​the​ejido​(although​not​the​only​one)​was​between​Tzotzil-​speakers​ and​Tzeltal-​speakers​who​had​been​forced​to​live​together​decades​earlier.​ In​fact,​both​groups​understood​both​languages,​and​after​their​long​coexistence​had​even​intermarried.​But​if​we​could​not​publish​in​both​Tzotzil​and​ Tzeltal​as​well​as​Spanish,​they​preferred​that​neither​indigenous​language​be​ used. ​ Practices and politics:​If​Buch’u​was,​in​its​bilingualism,​more​like​later​ publications,​ the​ simultaneously​ published​ Lo’il yu’un Kuskat​ was​ in​ several​ways​an​anomaly.​Because​an​important​reason​for​publishing​it​was​ to​broach​the​idea​of​books​in​Tzotzil​to​the​Chamula​traditionalists,​it​was​ monolingual,​like​Abtel ta Pinka.​At​the​same​time,​unlike​Abtel​and​Buch’u​ but​like​the​later​books,​it​credited​mol​Marian​as​the​author​and​even​included​ a​ photo​ of​ him​ on​ the​ title​ page.​ In​ part,​ this​ was​ the​ result​ of​ a​ changing​view​of​authorship​within​the​Taller​(a​point​to​which​we​shall​return​below).​However,​it​was​also​a​political​decision,​to​make​as​public​as​ possible​that​we​and​mol​Marian​had​worked​together.​Finally,​unlike​the​ books​that​came​before​and​after,​we​composed​an​introduction​in​Tzotzil​to​ enumerate​the​ways​in​which​Koyaso​Panchin’s​oral​history​of​the​events​of​ the​late​1860s—like​those​of​other​Chamula​elders—differed​from​the​dominant,​ladino​version​and​was​more​true​to​the​latest​historical​reconstructions​(J.​Rus,​1983,​1989).

1988–1990: Community Collaborations By​the​spring​of​1988​we​had​begun​to​understand​more​fully​the​extent​of​ Tzotzil​communities’​adaptation​to​the​post-​1982​crisis.​Beyond​colonizing​ the​jungle​and​moving​into​cities,​beyond​developing​new​ways​of​making​a​ The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 157

living,​from​flower​growing​to​producing​textiles​for​tourists,​highland​Tzotzils​were​also​experimenting​with​new​forms​of​organization.​Most​visible​ were​the​independent​regional​organizations​and​urban​councils​mentioned​ earlier.​However,​even​within​apparently​settled​municipios​still​considered​ traditional,​ the​ structure​ and​ orientation​ of​ extended​ families​ and​ local​ hamlets​were​shifting,​challenging​age​and​gender​hierarchies,​and​eventually​entrenched​political​power. ​ Many​of​these​local​changes​were​not​apparent​from​outside.​By​the​time​ Buch’u​and​Kuskat​were​published​in​the​spring​of​1988,​however,​we​had​ been​drawn​into​a​series​of​new​projects​that​would​place​the​Taller​at​the​ center​of​the​conversations​about​these​changes.​Diane​had​begun​to​interview​women​in​Chamula​about​their​responses​to​the​economic​crisis,​eventually​completing​a​survey​of​household​economics​in​a​Chamula​hamlet​in​ collaboration​with​the​women​of​the​hamlet​(D.​Rus​1990).​At​the​same​time,​ she​undertook​in-​depth​conversations​with​the​women​about​how​their​lives​ and​families​had​been​changed​by​the​fact​that​their​husbands​and​fathers​ had​trouble​finding​work.​This​led​to​a​book​on​the​life​history​of​one​of​the​ women,​Maruch​Komes​(María​Gómez),​and​her​role​in​building​a​local,​independent​artisan​cooperative,​Ta jlok’ta chobtik ta ku’il / Bordando Milpas​ (“Embroidering​Cornfields,”​a​beautiful​wordplay​on​the​fact​that​since​she​ and​her​husband​had​stopped​planting​corn​she​had​begun​embroidering​ stylized​corn​plants​on​blouses​for​tourists). ​ As​Maruch’s​story​revealed,​the​cooperative​had​begun​in​the​mid-​1980s,​ as​women​began​gathering​to​watch​their​children​collectively​as​they​wove​ and​embroidered.​Within​a​few​months​they​were​purchasing​thread​together​ and​soon​thereafter​were​starting​to​take​turns​carrying​products​made​by​ the​group​to​the​city​to​sell.​By​the​time​they​came​to​the​attention​of​artisan​ organizations​run​by​state​and​national​governments​in​1988,​they​were​a​ functioning,​independent​cooperative​(for​comparison,​see​Nash​1993;​Eber​ and​Rosenbaum​1993;​Eber​and​Tansky​2001).​Unlike​other​texts​about​indigenous​women​artisans,​in​Bordando Milpas​Maruch​talked​not​only​about​ her​art​and​its​meaning,​but​also​about​the​difficulties​indigenous​women​ encountered​in​working​with​external​organizations​and​traveling​to​distant​ markets​without​knowing​Spanish​or​being​literate.​She​also​discussed​the​ profound​changes​in​household​dynamics​when​women​took​leading,​entrepreneurial​roles.​Finally,​she​described​the​dire​economic​circumstances​that​ forced​her​to​sell​her​goods​to​coyotes,​intermediaries,​fully​aware​that​by​ doing​so​she​was​underselling​her​own​products​in​the​cooperative​store. 158 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

​ This​was​the​history​captured​by​Ta jlok’ta chobtik ta ku’il,​which​was​published​in​1990​with​a​print​run​of​four​hundred​copies.​One​hundred​of​these​ were​distributed​immediately​to​other​artisans​through​Maruch​and​her​cooperative.​Almost​simultaneously​the​book​also​came​to​the​attention​of​the​ Fondo​Nacional​de​Artesanías​(Fonart),​the​federal​government’s​agency​ for​promoting​folk​art,​which​informed​us​that​Maruch’s​testimony​was​the​ first​they​had​seen​of​a​native​artisan​in​all​of​Mexico.​Somewhat​contrary​to​ our​intentions​for​the​book,​Fonart ​bought​fifty​copies​to​distribute​to​its​ employees​and​member​cooperatives​and​invited​Maruch,​Diane,​and​our​ Chamula​collaborator,​Xalik​Kusman,​to​Mexico​City​to​present​the​book​in​ the​national​artisan​store.​To​promote​indigenous​art​and​also​Fonart ,​they​ arranged​for​Maruch​to​be​interviewed​on​the​morning​culture​program​of​ the​national​network​Radio​Educación.​Within​a​short​time,​Ta jlok’ta chobtik ta ku’il​was​republished​in​Spain,​France,​and​Italy. ​ Jan,​meanwhile,​at​the​suggestion​of​the​agronomist​of​the​Instituto​de​ Asesoría​ Antropológica​ para​ la​ Región​ Maya,​ A.C.​ (inareMac),​ Alain​ Retière,​began​a​two-​year​collaboration​with​five​constituent​communities​ of​the​Unión​de​Uniones​(u du ),​an​independent​peasant​organization​concentrated​in​the​Lacandón​jungle​and​adjacent​lowlands.​The​u du ​had​a​history​of​aggressively​confronting​ladino​planters​for​control​of​the​land​and​ of​farming​and​marketing​collectively​on​the​lands​they​acquired​(Harvey​ 1998;​Legorreta​1998;​Leyva​2003).​Taking​advantage​of​a​government​loan-​ guarantee​program​that​enabled​peasants​to​buy​ladino​haciendas​(a​program​which,​not​incidentally,​bailed​out​wealthy​owners​whose​failing​farms​ no​one​else​would​buy),​the​five​communities​had​bought,​in​1986,​the​combined​ coffee​ and​ cattle​ plantation​ on​ which​ their​ families​ had​ served​ for​ generations​as​indebted​workers.​By​1988​they​wanted​to​produce​a​memoir​ of​their​passage​from​debt​servitude​to​co-​ownership​of​the​planation,​from​ suffering​forced​labor​to​dreams​of​starting​a​cheese​factory​and​founding​ a​peasant​university​(universidad campesina)​to​teach​agricultural​science​ and​humanities​to​the​next​generation​of​the​ u du .​At​the​same​time,​they​ also​wanted​a​step-​by-​step​account​of​the​process​of​labor​organization​and​ strategic​land​invasion​by​which​they​had​finally​convinced​the​owner​to​ sell.​They​felt​that​the​u du​could​use​it​to​proselytize​other​indigenous​rural​ laborers.​The​result​was​Kipaltik: K’u cha’al lajmankutik jpinkakutik / Cómo compramos nuestra finca​(“Kipaltik:​How​we​bought​our​plantation”),​published​in​1990.​An​eighty-​page​book​based​on​the​testimonies​of​men​and​ women​members​of​the​cooperative,​with​photographs​of​collective​labor​ The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 159

and​governance,​half​of​Kipaltik’s​four​hundred​copies​went​to​the​members​ of​the​collective​and​the​u du .​One​hundred​of​these​were​for​the​members​ themselves,​so​that​someday,​as​one​of​them​put​it,​“our​grandchildren’s​children​could​read​about​how​we​got​our​families​out​of​poverty.”​Several​dozen​ more​were​distributed​through​the​Taller​itself​and​San​Cristóbal​bookstores.​ The​rest​were​for​internal​promotion​in​other​u du ​communities​and​to​use​ in​organizing​campaigns,​often​clandestine,​on​other​plantations. Practice ​ Authorship:​After​1988​we​decided​to​attribute​authorship​and​editorship​ more​overtly,​namely,​on​title​pages.​The​problem​with​not​naming​those​responsible​for​texts​was​that,​in​the​absence​of​obvious​attribution,​journalists​had​several​times​commissioned​translations​of​passages​from​Abtel​and​ then​cited​them​without​mentioning​the​source.​Unfortunately,​even​when​ authors’​names​were​given,​as​in​Ta jlok’ta chobtik,​such​pirating​continued.​ In​the​most​egregious​case,​a​self-​described​proindigenous​solidarity​group​ in​Europe​republished​the​entire​text​and​included​the​photo​of​the​author,​ Maruch​Komes,​without​mentioning​either​her​name​or​where​the​text​had​ come​from.​It​seemed​to​us​that​indigenous​“artifacts,”​including​stories​and​ testimonies,​were​viewed​as​“naturally​occurring​objects”​that,​like​rocks​or​ flowers​ or​ birds,​ could​ belong​ to​ whoever​ “found”​ them.​ When​ we​ complained​about​the​failure​to​attribute​authorship,​we​and​the​author​received​ a​formal​apology.​But​we​also​heard​from​mutual​friends​that​the​reason​no​ credit​was​given​was​that​“indigenous​people​aren’t​contaminated​by​ideas​ of​individualism​and​property”​and​that​the​preoccupation​with​naming​authors​was​ours​alone. ​ More on translation:​Publishing​testimonio​bilingually​also​led​to​questions​about​what​level​and​tone​of​Spanish​should​be​used.​In​the​past,​representations​of​indigenous​speech​in​Chiapas,​whether​in​fiction​or​translations​of​testimonies,​had​often​used​a​rural,​backwoods​Spanish,​suggesting​ an​ equivalence​ between​ rural​ indigenous​ people​ and​ poor,​ rural​ ladinos.​ Some​texts​even​mimicked​ the​grammatical​ errors​Tzotzil-​speakers​commonly​commit​in​Spanish,​suggesting​a​sort​of​minstrel-​speak.​We​decided​ that​since​our​Tzotzil​texts​were​in​perfectly​proper​and​sometimes​elegant​ Tzotzil,​the​Spanish​translations​should​be​straightforward​and​correct. ​ Beyond​these​concerns,​each​of​the​two​new​projects,​Ta jlok’ta chobtik​ and​ Kipaltik,​ brought​ its​ own​ demands.​ From​ the​ beginning​ of​ our​ publishing​project​the​editing​we​did​was​aimed​primarily​at​cutting​repetition.​ 160 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

Tzotzil​language,​particularly​prayers​and​formal​or​ritual​speech,​frequently​ coupled​words​and​phrases,​and​occasionally​repeated​whole​passages​in​different​words.​To​make​the​texts​read​smoothly​and​to​achieve​economies​in​ the​printing​process​we​had​to​edit​out​such​duplication​before​the​translations​were​made.​We​always​read​the​edited​texts​with​the​authors,​many​of​ whom​were​unlettered,​and​never​considered​them​finished​until​they​had​ agreed​to​the​changes.​But​we​did​cut. ​ An​ amusing​ result​ of​ such​ editing​ was​ that​ during​ the​ national​ radio​ interview​about​Ta jlok’ta chobtik,​the​interviewer​asked​Maruch​Komes​to​ say​the​weaver’s​prayer​that​appeared​at​the​end​of​her​book​so​the​radio​ audience​could​hear​Tzotzil​being​spoken.​When​praying,​Maruch​always​ closes​her​eyes​and​chants,​composing​the​phrases​as​she​goes​along,​and​ they​often​last​fifteen​to​thirty​minutes.​The​prayer​in​the​book,​however,​ had​been​abbreviated​to​thirty-​six​short​lines.​When​Maruch’s​prayer​on​the​ radio​began​to​run​beyond​two​minutes,​then​three​heading​for​four​with​no​ sign​of​ending,​the​interviewer​began​to​panic.​How​to​make​it​stop?​Eventually,​Maruch​understood​why​the​interviewer​was​nervous​and​brought​ the​prayer​to​an​end.​With​the​help​of​Diane​and​Xalik​Kusman,​she​then​ explained​that​there​was​no​set​prayer,​that​what​she​did​was​enumerate​and​ repeat​in​different​ways​the​help​she​would​need​with​her​work​and​ask​for​ guidance​and​patience​from​God​and​the​saints.​Although​on​this​occasion​ everyone​finally​understood​what​had​happened,​in​some​sense​the​original​prayer​had​been​violated​by​being​shortened​for​publication,​truncating​ what​the​author​might​have​thought​the​most​important​part​of​her​book.​ Given​the​expense​of​making​books​and​the​need​to​be​concise,​we​were​ unable​to​find​an​alternative​that​would​meet​everyone’s​ideas​of​what​mattered. ​ Soon​after​work​began​on​Ta jlok’ta chobtik,​the​women’s​artisan​cooperative​described​in​the​book​began​to​receive​offers​of​loans​and​grants​from​ the​ government.​ Although​ they​ had​ not​ sought​ these​ funds,​ the​ women​ of​the​co-​op,​including​Maruch​Komes,​were​more​than​willing​to​accept​ them.​Traditionally,​such​government​resources​would​have​been​brokered​ through​the​regional​indigenous​caciques​(political​bosses)​in​the​head​town​ of​Chamula​rather​than​contracted​directly​by​community​members,​much​ less​women​community​members​(Rus​and​Collier​2003).​Although​the​production​of​a​book​was​an​entirely​separate​project​from​the​organization​of​ the​cooperative​that​was​attracting​government​funds​(in​fact,​when​we​were​ asked​our​opinion,​we​advised​caution​in​accepting​government​help),​by​the​ The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 161

time​the​caciques​became​aware​of​the​cooperative’s​funding​the​book​had​ appeared,​and​the​women​were​able​to​use​the​book​as​a​calling​card​to​maintain​their​independence​from​cacique​control. ​ After​1990​Maruch​and​her​group​also​used​the​book​as​an​entry​point​ to​make​contact​with​ngo s,​ever​hopeful​that​such​contacts​would​broaden​ their​support​and​perhaps​help​them​establish​their​own​store.​At​the​same​ time,​Maruch’s​published​and​therefore​public​explanation​of​why​her​group​ sold​items​outside​the​cooperative​stores,​in​the​process​driving​prices​downward,​could​have​endangered​her​ties​to​the​government​agencies​and​ngo s​ that​sponsored​those​stores.​As​it​turned​out,​however,​they​found​her​analysis​instructive. ​ Finally,​outside​of​their​immediate​families​women​had​rarely​expressed​ themselves​about​how​their​insertion​into​the​market​economy​had​affected​ their​relationships​with​their​husbands.​Maruch’s​admission​that​at​first​her​ husband​ and​ other​ women’s​ husbands​ had​ tried​ to​ destroy​ the​ women’s​ work​and​end​their​participation​in​organizations​that​brought​them​into​ relationships​with​mestizos​in​town​potentially​made​her​subject​to​marital​ problems.​What​actually​happened​was​that​the​appearance​of​the​book​and​ her​subsequent​invitation​to​visit​Mexico​City​helped​legitimate​her​and​the​ women’s​new​roles​in​their​husbands’​eyes. ​ Our​work​on​Kipaltik​brought​up​other​questions,​most​notably​in​regard​ to​editing.​Previously,​editing​had​been​done​for​reasons​of​style​and​economy​of​expression.​In​the​case​of​Kipaltik​we​were​faced​for​the​first​time​with​ the​problem​of​editing​as​censorship.​The​story​of​Kipaltik​is​one​not​only​of​ the​triumph​of​a​group​of​Tzotzils​in​buying​the​plantation​on​which​they​ had​been​virtual​slaves,​but​also​of​their​families’​century-​long​fight​to​recover​their​land,​expropriated​in​the​late​nineteenth​century.​After​the​Mexican​Revolution,​from​the​1920s​to​the​1970s​the​struggle​was​rarely​an​open​ one.​Debt-​laborers​sabotaged​production​and​resisted​work​when​they​could,​ but​the​landowner​had​overwhelming​force​on​his​side​and​with​impunity​ could​beat,​expel,​and​even​kill​those​who​defied​him.​The​balance​of​power​ between​the​two​sides​began​to​change​in​the​1970s,​when​declining​agricultural​prices​led​landowners​to​expel​resident​workers​and​turn​cropland​ into​pasturage​for​cattle.​Simultaneously—and​not​by​chance—independent​ peasant​and​indigenous​organizations​arose​and​became​increasingly​militant​ as​ they​ pushed​ back​ against​ the​ landowners’​ attempts​ to​ expel​ them​ from​ land​ that​ had​ belonged​ to​ their​ ancestors​ (see​ Harvey​ 1998;​ Toledo​ 2002;​Bobrow-​Strain​2007;​Garza​and​Toledo​2008).​Violence​between​the​ 162 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

two​sides​escalated​throughout​northern​Chiapas,​with​indigenous​workers​ cutting​fences,​killing​cattle,​and​invading​land,​while​owners​responded​by​ getting​the​state​police​and​army​to​repress​their​former​workers​and​hiring​ private​gunmen,​guardias blancas,​to​do​the​job​when​the​state​would​not.​ Some​of​the​passages​we​transcribed​in​preparing​Kipaltik​described​the​first​ real​attack​on​landowners​and​their​ladino​employees​in​this​isolated​region​ in​1974. ​ After​they​had​invaded​a​neighboring​finca,​men​from​the​communities​ that​ eventually​ bought​ Kipaltik​ beat​ the​ overseer,​ who​ had​ cheated​ them​ of​wages​and​treated​them​brutally​for​two​decades,​and​then​assaulted​his​ particularly​cruel,​arrogant​wife.​The​description​is​a​raw​one.​Those​of​us​in​ the​Taller​and​others​working​in​the​region​who​we​consulted​did​not​know​ what​to​do​with​it.​The​acts​it​described​were​ugly​and​certainly​illegal.​Yet​the​ men​who​had​participated​were​quite​open​about​their​deeds​as​justified​vengeance​for​decades​of​mistreatment.​It​was​an​example​of​the​kind​of​revolutionary​violence​described​by​Frantz​Fanon.​As​editors​and​sympathizers,​ we​were​especially​concerned​about​preserving​the​anonymity​of​those​involved—of​the​perpetrators​but​also​of​the​victim,​who​still​lived​in​a​small​ town​nearby.​During​a​long,​at​times​contentious​discussion,​Jan​finally​convinced​the​men​that​the​story​should​be​cut​on​the​grounds​that​it​described​ the​details​of​a​crime,​and​it​was​impossible​to​predict​what​would​happen​if​ we​committed​evidence​of​it​to​paper.​Caution​prevailed,​but​we​still​wonder​ whether​we​denatured​history​in​the​process.​Could,​or​should,​a​different​ decision​have​been​made? ​ Elsewhere​ in​ Kipaltik,​ as​ in​ the​ Taller’s​ other​ books,​ individuals​ and​ places​were​identified:​landowners,​politicians,​settlements,​and​plantations.​ The​risk,​faced​more​often​by​journalists​than​by​academic​writers,​was​not​ only​that​many​of​those​who​were​named​ or​were​identifiable​ from​their​ landholdings​were​still​alive​(certainly​their​families​were),​but​also​that​they​ were​ still​ likely​ to​ be​ in​ powerful​ positions​ in​ the​ region.​ Publishing​ accounts​of​their​deeds​might​have​had​negative​economic,​political,​or​personal​repercussions​for​the​actors​themselves,​for​community​members,​or​ for​the​Taller​should​they​take​offense.​Nevertheless,​the​Taller’s​purpose​was​ to​try​to​present​for​analysis​history​as​people​had​lived​and​remembered​it,​ and​if​such​details​had​been​omitted​discussion​would​have​been​impossible.​ Only​in​the​case​in​which​someone​could​be​hurt​gratuitously​was​a​name​ suppressed.12 ​ At​the​beginning​of​the​Kipaltik​collaboration,​the​community​made​it​ The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 163

clear​in​an​assembly​that​it​was​to​be​a​collective​product,​none​of​which​ could​be​published​until​it​had​been​read​and​approved​in​subsequent​assemblies.​Nor​were​we​to​interview​anyone​separately​and​represent​them​as​ spokespeople​for​the​group.​Accordingly,​all​the​interviews​were​conducted​ with​groups​of​at​least​four​or​five​and​on​occasion​as​many​as​fifteen​or​ twenty.​Jan​and​Xalik​Kusman​interviewed​the​men​over​the​course​of​half​a​ year,​often​during​rest​periods​on​communal​workdays.​Diane​interviewed​ the​women​in​the​schoolyard.​In​fact,​a​handful​of​senior​men​and​women​ did​most​of​the​talking​but​never​apart​from​the​group. ​ This​sharing,​or​diffusion,​of​authorship—and,​in​a​sense,​of​responsibility—seemed​to​us​another​expression​of​the​ u du ​customs​of​collective,​ consensual​decision​making​and​of​protecting​the​identities​of​leaders,​practices​that​have​become​well​known​through​the​Zapatistas.​During​demonstrations,​scores​and​even​hundreds​of​demonstrators​would​huddle​tightly​ when​they​had​to​make​a​decision​so​that​no​one​from​outside​could​see​ who​was​talking​or​identify​the​leaders.​Given​the​assassinations​of​some​ 195​indigenous​and​campesino​activists​in​rural​Chiapas​between​the​mid-​ 1970s​and​late​1980s,​this​precaution​was​well​warranted​(Burguete​and​Montero,​nd.).

1991–1994: Transitions As​publishing​ventures​and​even​as​political​projects​Ta jlok’ta chobtik​and​ Kipaltik​ were​ successes:​ widely​ read​ by​ the​ measure​ used​ in​ indigenous​ Chiapas,​where​print​runs​number​in​the​low​hundreds,​and​useful​as​representations​of​their​authors’​projects.​Even​as​they​were​being​printed,​however,​Mexico​and​rural​Chiapas​alike​were​entering​a​new​political​and​economic​environment,​one​that​would​eventually​undo​the​successes​of​both​ Maruch​Komes’s​cooperative​and​the​collective​farm​of​Kipaltik. ​ At​the​end​of​1988​Carlos​Salinas​de​Gortari​became​president​of​Mexico​ and​immediately​accelerated​the​pace​of​the​neoliberal​economic​reforms​ that​had​begun​in​the​early​1980s.​Over​the​next​six​years​he​would​privatize​ most​of​the​remaining​state​enterprises,​remove​controls​on​foreign​investment,​and​dismantle​the​laws​on​communal​landholding​that​had​been​one​ of​the​triumphs​of​the​Mexican​Revolution.​Almost​unremembered​among​ these​ sweeping​ reforms​ is​ that​ during​ the​ first​ weeks​ of​ his​ term​ Salinas​ undermined​the​International​Coffee​Agreement,​the​cartel​that​maintained​ the​stability​of​world​coffee​prices.​One​of​Salinas’s​overall​goals​was​to​help​ 164 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

the​administration​of​George​H.​W.​Bush​convince​the​U.S.​Congress​and​ public​opinion​in​the​United​States​of​Mexico’s​worthiness​as​a​partner​in​ the​North​American​Free​Trade​Agreement.​From​Salinas’s​perspective​his​ act​was​little​more​than​a​token​of​his​commitment​to​free​markets.​For​producers​around​the​world,​however,​including​those​in​Mexico,​it​was​a​disaster.​By​spring​1989​the​international​coffee​market​had​collapsed,​plunging​ millions​into​poverty.​Among​those​whose​plans​for​the​future​were​dashed​ were​the​members​of​the​Kipaltik​collective,​who​lost​the​coffee​income​they​ had​counted​on​to​make​their​mortgage​payments.​For​the​next​two​and​a​ half​years,​the​collective​managed​to​survive​by​obtaining​emergency​credit​ from​various​government​agencies.​The​condition​for​securing​the​last​of​ these​loans,​in​early​1992,​was​that​the​elderly​president​of​the​collective,​a​ former​debt-​laborer​who​had​fought​all​of​his​life​for​the​land,​had​to​stand​ behind​President​Salinas​with​two​other​historic​peasant​leaders,​in​native​ dress,​as​Salinas​signed​the​end​of​agrarian​reform.​When​the​news​photos​ of​the​event​appeared,​Kipaltik​fractured,​and​even​some​of​the​leader’s​sons​ refused​to​speak​to​him​or​face​him.​With​no​credit​forthcoming​for​the​fall​ harvest​of​1992,​Kipaltik’s​members​and​the​u du ’s​officers​divided​the​land​ among​themselves​before​the​bank​could​foreclose.​The​collective​was​dissolved. ​ Although​the​mechanism​was​different,​the​impact​of​Salinas’s​reforms​ on​the​artisan​cooperative​was​no​less​destructive.​Concerned​with​the​independence​and​the​increasingly​oppositional​stance​of​the​grass-​roots​organizations​that​had​taken​up​much​of​the​burden​of​sustaining​the​poor​during​ the​years​of​government​neglect​after​the​financial​crisis​of​1982,​the​Salinas​ government​came​into​office​with​a​plan​to​buy​back​their​loyalty:​the​Programa​Nacional​de​Solidaridad​(National​Solidarity​Program—pronasol )​ (Dresser​1991).​In​return​for​affiliating​with​government​organizations​and​ confederations​ of​ organizations,​ pronasol ​ funneled​ to​ so-​called​ popular​groups​a​share​of​the​profits​from​the​privatization​of​state-​owned​businesses.​In​the​case​of​Maruch​Komes’s​cooperative,​this​aid​came​in​the​form​ of​a​large​loan​composed​of​inferior​materials​and​a​complicated​scheme​ tying​repayment​to​government​participation​in​the​commercialization​of​ the​group’s​products.​To​cement​the​relationship,​women​in​the​cooperative​ were​also​compelled​to​participate​in​ pri ​electoral​campaigns​in​1988​and​ 1991,​for​which​purpose​they​were​bused​around​Chiapas​with​other​brightly​ costumed​indigenous​groups​so​that​they​could​take​a​prominent​place​in​the​ front​row​of​televised​events.​Unfortunately,​the​women’s​production​was​not​ The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 165

sufficient​to​pay​back​the​loans​that​had​been​foisted​on​them,​and​in​mid-​ 1992​the​state​held​back​both​the​pay​they​were​due​for​products​they​had​ turned​over​on​consignment​and​the​fees​they​had​paid​to​incorporate​as​an​ official​cooperative.​The​two​losses​added​up​to​far​more​than​they​had​ever​ received​in​loans.​Their​protection​as​members​of​a​favored​cooperative​now​ removed,​the​ pri ​bosses​of​their​municipio,​who​resented​them​for​having​ made​contracts​with​the​state​over​the​heads​of​the​municipio’s​supposedly​ legitimate​representatives,​prevented​them​from​sharing​in​any​of​the​local​ pronasol ​funds​to​which​they​were​entitled.​As​a​result​of​what​they​considered​a​swindle,​many​of​the​women​and​their​families​became​staunchly​ anti-​pri ​after​1992.​But​their​group,​which​had​come​together​out​of​common​need​and​grown​into​a​powerful​force​in​the​women’s​lives​through​the​ 1980s,​broke​into​factions​that​blamed​each​other​for​their​losses​(Rus​and​ Collier​2003). ​ If​the​Salinas​government’s​goal​had​been​to​rein​in​the​organizations​of​ the​poor,​by​the​end​of​1992​it​had​succeeded​in​the​cases​of​the​Kipaltik​collective​and​Maruch​Komes’s​cooperative:​both​had​ceased​to​exist.​Although​ every​case​is​different,​similar​fates​befell​independent​organizations​across​ Chiapas.​If​this​was​“success,”​however,​the​eventual​cost​to​the​government​ was​a​high​one.​Those​whose​painfully​organized​projects​failed​often​became​ bitter​ opponents​ of​ the​ government​ and​ the​ pri ,​ and​ those​ whose​ organizations​survived​were​usually​more​determined​than​ever​to​maintain​ their​independence. ​ At​the​beginning​of​this​period​of​renewed​government​intervention,​in​ the​fall​of​1988,​our​family​moved​back​to​California.​We​still​had​projects​ and​grants,​so​through​1992​Jan​spent​half​of​each​year​in​Chiapas​over​two​ or​three​visits,​and​Diane​two​and​a​half​months​during​the​summers.​Jlok’ta chobtik,​Kipaltik,​and​a​third​book,​Slo’il cha’vo’ kumpareil / Cuento de los dos compadres​ (Story​ of​ the​ two​ compadres),​ were​ finished​ under​ these​ conditions​ and​ published​ in​ 1990.13​ While​ we​ did​ begin​ two​ new​ publishing​ projects​between​1990​and​1993,​the​increasing​distress​of​the​communities​ and​organizations​ with​which​we​had​collaborated​ led​us​to​spend​much​ of​our​time​with​them,​talking​about​the​rapidly​changing​conditions​and​ discussing​alternatives.​Before​any​of​us​could​act​on​them,​however,​these​ conversations,​like​almost​everything​else​in​Chiapas,​were​overtaken​by​the​ Zapatistas’​invasion​of​San​Cristóbal​on​New​Year’s​Day,​1994.

166 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

Post-1994: Zapatismo After​the​economic​depression​and​official​neglect​of​the​1980s,​and​then​the​ assault​on​indigenous​organizations​of​the​early​1990s—not​to​mention​the​ centuries​of​exploitation​and​humiliation​that​had​gone​before—the​armed​ rebellion​of​1994​was​almost​overdetermined.​Following​an​initial​period​of​ confusion​on​the​part​of​those​who​were​not​Zapatistas,​within​a​few​weeks​ of​ January​ 1​ indigenous​ people​ throughout​ Chiapas,​ indeed,​ throughout​ Mexico,​remember​feeling​a​surge​of​pride​that​others​like​them​had​occupied​ a​ mestizo​ city​ and​ defeated​ the​ Mexican​ army​ in​ initial​ encounters.​ Friends​of​ours​say​that​for​months​afterward​upon​encountering​other​indigenous​people​on​the​sidewalk​they​smiled​knowingly​at​each​other,​proud​ of​their​identity. ​ Although​they​pale​next​to​the​other​effects​of​the​Zapatista​Rebellion,​the​ impacts​of​the​revolt​on​independent​projects​like​ours​were​also​profound.​ While​there​was​more​than​enough​to​learn,​talk,​and​write​about,​for​several​years​working​on​publishing​projects​within​communities​became​problematic.​By​the​summer​of​1994,​as​the​state’s​reaction​to​the​Zapatistas​became​organized,​there​began​to​be​paramilitary​patrols,​assassinations,​and​ random​shootings​throughout​rural​Chiapas.​As​a​result,​whereas​formerly​ it​had​been​our​practice​to​stay​overnight​in​people’s​houses​and​participate​ in​local​discussions,​now​we​worried​about​bringing​unwanted​attention​to​ those​with​whom​we​collaborated.​ Aside​from​any​danger​ to​ourselves— which​ we​ actually​ judged​ to​ be​ slight14—we​ worried​ about​ how​ this​ surveillance​and​violence​and​the​reaction​to​them​might​affect​our​friends​and​ hosts.​Would​someone​mistake​us​for​government​representatives​or​subversivos​and​take​it​out​on​our​collaborators?15​As​for​native​language​publishing​itself,​in​the​highly​polarized​atmosphere​of​the​second​half​of​the​1990s​ everyone​was​forced​to​choose​sides.​In​the​summer​of​1994​the​government​ held​meetings​of​native​language​writers​and​publishers​and​soon​after​began​ subsidizing​many​as​a​way​of​promoting​the​idea​that​the​state​was​“with”​indigenous​people.​The​Ejército​Zapatista​de​Liberación​Nacional​(eZln)​and​ the​generally​pro-​Zapatista​independent​political​organizations,​meanwhile,​ also​published​manifestos​and​newsletters​in​indigenous​languages—both​ sides​demonstrating,​parenthetically,​that​in​just​a​few​years​writing​in​native​ language​ had​ become​ a​ well-​established​ means​ of​ communicating​ across​ entire​regions.16​There​was​no​question​of​which​side​our​ngo ,​inareMac ,​ was​on​in​this​division.​At​great​personal​risk,​those​members​of​inareMac​ The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 167

who​were​resident​in​Chiapas​traveled​to​the​most​conflictive​parts​of​the​ state​and​documented​human​rights​abuses.17​As​summer​visitors,​however,​ the​two​of​us​were​not​in​a​position​either​to​sustain​a​contestatory​publishing​project​or​to​encourage​indigenous​communities​whose​dangers​we​did​ not​share​to​do​so.​Instead,​over​the​first​several​years​after​1994​we​continued​to​make​open,​public​visits​to​places​where​we​were​known,​concentrating​less​on​publishing​than​on​documenting​economic​deterioration​and​ political​change​(see​Rus​and​Rus​2004).18 ​ Nevertheless,​ two​ Taller​ Tzotzil​ productions​ did​ appear​ during​ this​ period.​The​first​was​a​pair​of​translations​for​nonindigenous​audiences​of​ Tzotzil-​language​accounts​of​the​rebellion​of​1994​and​its​aftermath:​“Los​primeros​meses​de​los​zapatistas”​(“The​first​months​of​the​Zapatistas”)​(1995)​ and​“Conversaciones​interrumpidas”​(“Interrupted​conversations,”​2000),​by​ Mariano​Peres​Tsu​(the​pseudonym​our​partner​Xalik​Kusman​had​chosen​ for​ himself).​ The​ two​ translations​ present​ vignettes​ of​ indigenous​ life​ in​ Chiapas​ after​ 1994.​ The​ first​ told​ of​ the​ emotions​ and​ reactions​ of​ different​groups​immediately​following​the​rebellion,​and​the​second​of​events​ in​ an​ urban​ colony​ in​ the​ late​ 1990s​ as​ the​ state​ tried​ to​ reassert​ control​ and​the​inhabitants​tried​to​evade​it.​Both​chronicles​have​been​published​ several​times​in​four​countries​and​in​2002​were​published​together​as​“A​ Tzotzil​Chronicle​of​the​Zapatista​Uprising”​in​Gilbert​Joseph’s​and​Timothy​ Henderson’s​Mexico Reader​(Duke,​2002.)​Unlike​earlier​publications​of​the​ Taller,​most​of​which​were​transcribed​oral​histories,​these​essays​were​written​in​Tzotzil​by​a​native​writer;​we​provided​only​the​translation​and​editing. ​ The​ second​ publication,​ Jchi’iltak ta Slumal Kalifornya​ (“Chamulas​ in​ California”),​ which​ appeared​ in​ 1996,​ originated​ from​ one​ of​ the​ two​ projects​we​had​begun​between​1990​and​1993​and​grew​out​of​our​contact​ with​some​of​the​first​undocumented​Tzotzil​workers​to​arrive​in​California.​ Four​hundred​copies​of​the​testimonies​of​the​brothers​Manuel,​Salvador,​ and​ Pedro​ Pérez​ were​ printed,​ and​ they​ were​ distributed​ largely​ through​ ngo s​and​churches​working​in​the​Tzotzil​region.​“Going​north”​was​still​ almost​unheard​of​in​rural​Chiapas​in​the​1990s,​and​in​addition​to​telling​a​ story​the​book​attempted​to​offer​counsel​to​those​planning​to​make​the​trip.​ In​addition​to​the​brothers’​adventures​getting​to​and​crossing​the​border​ and​learning​to​survive​in​the​United​States,​woven​into​the​story​was​advice​ about​obtaining​and​safely​using​false​identification,​avoiding​being​cheated​ by​employers​or​caught​by​the​migra​(border​patrol),​and​getting​help​after​

168 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

being​detained​and​dumped​back​on​the​Mexican​side​of​the​border​without​money​or​documents.​In​appendices​which​were​later​copied​separately​ as​flyers,​Jchi’iltak​also​provided​information​in​Tzotzil​and​Spanish​about​ groups​along​both​sides​of​the​border​that​offered​aid​to​migrants​and​about​ the​rights​of​undocumented​workers. ​ The​biggest​difference​between​the​projects​undertaken​after​1994​and​ those​before​is​that​in​the​later​projects​authors’​identities​were​sometimes​ hidden.​In​the​case​of​Jchi’iltak​we​had​conducted​the​interviews​in​California,​ and​ neither​ we​nor​the​interviewees​ were​ sure​what​ pressures​ the​ brothers’​families​might​experience​in​Chiapas​if​their​absence​and​dollar​ income​were​publicized.​To​be​safe,​we​all​agreed​to​mask​their​identities.​ When​the​brothers​returned​to​Chiapas​after​the​book’s​appearance,​however,​and​realized​that​it​was​circulating​in​the​shantytowns​and​that​Xalik​ Kusman​of​the​Taller​had​been​interviewed​about​it​on​a​Tzotzil-​language​ radio​program,​they​were​proud​to​claim​authorship.​One​brother​later​used​ it​in​his​campaign​to​be​the​first​indigenous​member​of​San​Cristóbal’s​city​ council,​and​in​radio​interviews​elaborated​on​the​book’s​account​of​his​experiences.​In​the​case​of​Xalik​Kusman’s​own​vignettes​of​the​Zapatista​Rebellion,​on​the​other​hand,​the​disguise​has​been​maintained​for​years​because​of​Xalik’s​well-​founded​fear​of​reprisals​from​the​ladino​authorities​he​ so​humorously​portrayed.19 ​ In​general,​our​practice​had​been​to​keep​from​intruding​in​the​texts​with​ introductions​and​explanatory​footnotes.​In​the​case​of​Jchi’iltak,​however,​ where​the​purpose​was​in​part​to​warn​readers​about​the​hardships​of​undocumented​migration,​we​felt​it​was​necessary​to​say​something​about​why​ people​migrated​and​to​elaborate​on​the​conditions​migrants​faced.​We​also​ wanted​to​explain​that​most​U.S.​citizens​were​the​descendants​of​migrants.​ A​brief​socio-​politico-​historical​section​was​added.​In​the​case​of​the​translated​chronicles,​introductions​were​provided​to​explain​the​unusual​origin​ of​the​documents. ​ This​brings​the​story​of​the​Taller​up​to​the​present.​Although​the​Taller​ never​formally​closed,​its​activity​waned​after​the​1990s.​One​project​is​still​in​ progress:​a​Tzotzil-​language​history​of​San​Cristóbal’s​shantytowns.​Undertaken​in​collaboration​with​the​Tzotzil​writer​Xalik​Kusman​in​1990,​it​had,​ by​the​summer​of​2009,​generated​more​than​thirty-​eight​hundred​handwritten​pages​of​testimony​and​stories.​All​that​remains​to​be​done​is​editing​ and​organization.20

The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 169

Final Reflections As​economic​and​then​social​and​political​conditions​deteriorated​during​ the​1970s​and​1980s,​the​tradition​of​critical​historical​narrative​and​analysis​that​had​always​existed​within​Tzotzil​and​other​indigenous​communities​increasingly​transcended​social​and​cultural​borders​and​spread​across​ Chiapas.​What​native​speakers​talking​to​each​other​in​their​own​languages​ had​formerly​said​only​among​themselves​was​now​increasingly​expressed​to​ indigenous​people​beyond​their​local​groups​as​well​as​to​Spanish-​speakers.​ Information​ traveled​ the​ other​ way​ as​ well,​ deepening​ Tzotzil-​speakers’​ knowledge​of​the​changes​affecting​all​Mexicans,​not​just​themselves.​By​the​ second​half​of​the​1980s​all​of​indigenous​Chiapas​was​engaged​in​an​earnest​intellectual​and​political​debate,​as​within​every​family​different​members​ tried​new​ways​of​making​a​living,​organizing​themselves,​and​even​thinking​ about​life.​What​was​the​news​from​those​who​had​moved​to​the​city;​had​they​ found​work​and​places​to​live?​What​of​homesteading​in​the​jungle,​did​clearing​land​and​planting​coffee​seem​to​offer​a​safe​future?​What​about​the​many​ independent​organizations​and​cooperatives,​what​did​they​offer?​Were​Protestantism,​in​its​many​varieties,​or​liberation​Catholicism​better​ways​of​organizing​and​thinking​about​life​than​traditional​communities​and​religion? ​ Native​language​writing​and​the​birth​of​media​controlled​by​indigenous​ people​ were​ among​ the​ by-​products​ of​ this​ effervescence.​ The​ plantation​ economy​ and​ the​ community​ structures​ bound​ to​ it​ were​ swept​ away​ so​ quickly​that​people​who​spoke​Tzotzil​and​Chiapas’s​other​native​languages​ had​little​choice​but​to​talk​about​the​change​and​discuss​alternatives​in​their​ own​ tongues.​ In​ the​ process,​ they​ made​ Tzotzil—including​ written​ Tzotzil—not​only​a​means​of​communication,​but​also​a​basis​of​solidarity​in​the​ new​urban​and​national​environments​they​were​entering.​If​we​and​others​ helping​with​communications​projects​found​receptive​audiences,​in​turn,​ the​reason​was​not​so​much​our​own​persuasiveness​as​this​changed​context.​ By​the​early​2000s,​in​a​region​where​only​thirty​years​earlier​native​language​speakers​were​only​beginning​to​write,​university​theses​are​now​being​ completed​in​indigenous​languages;​the​international​and​national​news​are​ translated​daily​into​Tzotzil​and​circulated​in​xeroxed​“newspapers”​in​the​ market;​unregulated,​low-​power​FM ​radio​stations​broadcast​in​Tzotzil​from​ San​ Cristóbal’s​ shantytowns;​ and​ the​ number​of​government​ institutions,​ churches,​ngo s,​independent​organizations,​and​private​presses​that​publish​ in​Tzotzil​and​other​indigenous​languages​continues​to​multiply. 170 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

​ Thinking​about​indigenous​people​in​developing​societies​from​the​comfortable,​urbanized​North,​it​is​possible​to​despair.​“Our”​world​is​systematically​squeezing​theirs​out​of​its​environmental​and​economic​niches,​in​ the​process​unraveling​their​societies​and​ways​of​life.​Seeing​how​one-​sided​ this​change​is​and​always​has​been,​one​might​well​believe​that​the​people​of​ small​cultures​and​languages​do​not​see​what​is​happening​to​them,​and​that​ even​if​they​do,​whether​through​our​fault​or​theirs,​they​cannot​make​themselves​heard.​Those​of​us​who​have​had​the​opportunity​to​be​in​direct​contact​with​people​in​places​like​Chiapas,​however—to​have​experienced​both​ their​eagerness​to​communicate​and​the​power​of​their​ideas—are​probably​ more​hopeful.​Writing​and​publishing​in​native​languages​cannot​roll​back​ the​current​global​order.​But​by​giving​as​many​people​as​possible​the​means​ and​the​confidence​to​express​their​views,​they​do​make​it​possible​for​ever​ more​voices​to​join​our​common​conversation,​for​the​subaltern​to​speak.

Notes Acknowledgments:​ We​ would​ like​ to​ thank​ John​ Burstein,​ George​ Collier,​ María​ Elena​Fernández​Galán,​Edward​Fischer,​Christine​Kovic,​Ámbar​Past,​Pedro​Pitarch,​ Stephen​Lewis,​and​Juan​Pedro​Viqueira​for​their​comments​and​suggestions.​Particular​thanks​to​Florencia​Mallon​for​her​careful​readings​and​editing.​The​essay​ is​dedicated​to​the​memory​of​Andrés​Aubry​and​Angélica​Inda,​who​founded​the​ Taller​Tzotzil​in​1974​and​entrusted​it​to​us​in​1985.​From​then​until​the​ends​of​their​ lives​they​shared​friendship​and​counsel​and​always​their​fullest​support.​We​never​ stop​missing​them. ​ 1.​The​Instituto​de​Asesoría​Antropológica​para​la​Región​Maya,​A.C.​(inareMac )​ was​founded​by​Andrés​Aubry​in​1973​with​the​sponsorship​of​Bishop​Samuel​Ruiz,​ who​felt​Chiapas’s​liberationist​Catholic​Church​needed​independent​anthropological​advice.​Following​the​Congreso​Indígena​of​1974​(Morales​1992),​in​which​it​played​ a​role,​ inareMac ​acted​as​host​for​experimental,​community-​directed​projects​in​ organic​agriculture,​health​education,​a​furniture​cooperative,​and​the​Taller​Tzotzil.​ In​its​first​years​the​Taller​organized​language​classes​for​clergy​and​social​workers.​ Under​the​direction​of​the​anthropologist​John​Burstein,​however,​it​soon​turned​to​ providing​literacy​courses​in​Tzotzil​communities.​The​first​booklet​to​follow​these​ courses​was​published​in​the​fall​of​1976​(Aubry​1988).​During​our​own​time​in​the​ Taller,​funds​have​been​provided​by​the​French​Comité​Catholique​Contre​la​Faim​ et​Pour​le​Dévellopement,​the​European​Community,​inareMac ’s​French​support​ group,​ inareMac ’s​Chiapas​board​of​directors,​headed​by​Amado​Avendaño​and​ Carlos​Rodríguez,​and​the​Jacobs​Research​Fund​of​Bellingham,​​Washington. The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 171

​ 2.​There​are​no​known​documents​written​in​Tzotzil​by​native​speakers​to​be​read​ by​ other​ native​ speakers​ from​ the​ arrival​ of​ Europeans​ (1524)​ through​ the​ 1940s.​ During​the​1940s​writing​was​reintroduced​in​Tzotzil,​as​in​Chiapas’s​other​Maya​languages,​by​the​missionary​linguists​of​the​Summer​Institute​of​Linguistics/Wycliffe​ Bible​Translators​(sil/Wbt).​After​1951​ sil/Wbt ​linguists​produced​the​materials​ for​ the​ bilingual​ education​ programs​ of​ the​ Instituto​ Nacional​ Indigenista​ (ini),​ which​became​the​source​of​Chiapas’s​new​indigenous​literacy.​The​first​publishing​ by​native​writers​appeared​after​the​mid-​1970s.​Among​those​who​produced​this​material​in​addition​to​the​Taller​Tzotzil​were​Taller​Leñateros​(1979–)​(see​note​8);​Sna​ Jtz’ibajom​(1982–),​founded​by​former​language​assistants​to​anthropologists​with​ help​from​Robert​M.​Laughlin;​the​writers’​project​of​the​state​government​(1982–88),​ led​by​Dr.​Jacinto​Arias​Sojom;​La​Castalia,​advised​by​Gudrun​and​Carlos​Lenkersdorf,​which​published​in​Tojolabal​from​the​mid-​1970s​through​the​1980s;​the​Instituto​ de​ Estudios​ Indígenas​ of​ the​ Universidad​ Autónoma​ de​ Chiapas,​ which​ has​ published​occasionally​in​native​languages​since​1985;​and​various​irregular​projects​ of​independent​organizations,​churches,​and​Mexican​universities​with​programs​in​ Chiapas.​Since​the​mid-​1990s,​the​native​writers’​own​organization,​celali ,​has​also​ published​native​language​texts​or​placed​them​with​other​publishers.​(For​more,​see​ Laughlin​1993;​Benjamin​2000;​and​Past​2005.) ​ 3.​Menchú​(1984​[1983]),​in​reaction,​see​Stoll​(1999),​J.​Rus,​ed.​(1999);​Chakravorty-​ Spivak​(1988),​Gugelberger​(1996). ​ 4.​Chiapas’s​commercial​agriculture​required​some​125,000​seasonal​workers​in​ the​ early​ 1970s,​ and​ only​ a​ few​ thousand​ more​ in​ the​ mid-​1980s.​ Meanwhile,​ the​ number​of​indigenous​men​looking​for​such​work​almost​doubled​between​1970​and​ 1990,​from​150,000​to​more​than​300,000​(see​Collier​1994;​J.​Rus​1995). ​ 5.​This​was​true​of​virtually​all​studies​published​before​the​1980s.​The​exception​ was​Ricardo​Pozas​(1952;​1962),​whose​Juan, the Chamula,​although​classified​as​a​ novel​when​it​first​appeared​in​1948,​was​arguably​the​Maya​region’s​first​testimonio.​ See​J.​Rus​(2004). ​ 6.​Originally​we​intended​to​produce​both​booklets​and​tape​cassettes​of​sound​ documentaries​ blending​ the​ interviews​ with​ music.​ Thinking​ about​ all​ the​ time​ people​spent​in​minibuses​and​colectivos,​with​their​omnipresent​tapes​of​ranchero​ music,​we​thought​tapes​would​broaden​our​audience.​After​a​first​experiment,​however,​we​realized​that​recording,​mixing,​producing,​and​distributing​tapes​was​beyond​our​capacity. ​ 7.​At​a​panel​entitled​the​“Current​State​and​Future​Prospects​of​Maya​Language​ Literature”​at​the​Congreso​Internacional​de​Mayistas​in​1989,​there​was​an​energetic​ discussion​about​the​distribution​and​sale​of​native​language​materials.​Minimum​ wage​in​Chiapas​is​regularly​adjusted​to​remain​at​approximately​three​dollars​per​ day,​with​agricultural​workers​typically​making​half​to​two-​thirds​of​that​wage,​often​ paid​in​kind.​Potential​readers’​ability​to​pay​is​severely​limited.​ini ​has​historically​ 172 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

given​away​its​materials,​while​the​sil/Wbt ​and​most​of​the​writing​projects​charged​ low,​highly​subsidized​prices.​For​example,​both​editions​of​Abtel​sold​for​the​equivalent​of​twenty​cents​in​indigenous​communities,​and​the​second​edition​for​five​dollars​in​bookstores. ​ 8.​The​exceptions​both​involved​Ámbar​Past​(1989;​1980),​and​in​Burstein,​Past,​ and​Wassestrom​(1979).​Past​began​collecting​women’s​stories​and​lore​in​1975​and​ has​helped​indigenous​women​publish​continuously​since​1979​through​Taller​Leñateros.​Since​the​late​1980s​there​have​been​a​number​of​other​writing,​theater,​and​ media​projects​managed​by​women​and​dedicated​to​women’s​themes,​among​them​ Fortaleza​ de​ la​ Mujer​ Maya​ (FoMMa)​ (1992–),​ inspired​ and​ advised​ by​ Miriam​ Laughlin;​and​the​Proyecto​Fotográfico​Maya,​founded​by​Carlota​Duarte. ​ 9.​The​principal​differences​between​the​orthographies​is​inea ’s​use​of​“k”​versus​ sil/Wbt ’s​use​of​“c”​and​“qu”​for​the​same​sound,​and​slight​differences​in​conventions​about​glottal​stops.​Ironically,​in​discussions​with​Maya​writers​from​Guatemala​ at​the​Congreso​Mayista​of​1989,​it​turned​out​that​the​Academia​de​Lenguas​Mayas​ de​Guatemala​chose​to​use​“c/qu”​over​“k”​because​in​Guatemala​the​latter​was​associated​with​the​despised​national​government.​In​Chiapas,​the​sil/Wbt ​orthography​ received​a​boost​as​a​universal​convention​at​the​end​of​the​1990s​when​Bible​translations​in​Tzotzil​and​Tzeltal,​originally​undertaken​by​the​Protestants,​were​approved​ by​the​progressive​Catholic​diocese​of​San​Cristóbal​(e.g.,​Sociedad​Bíblica​1997). ​ 10.​Our​Tzotzil​names​since​our​first​summer​in​Chiapas​were​Xalik​for​Jan,​and​ Tina​for​Diane.​When​we​added​“Rus,”​Jan’s​name​sounded​to​Tzotzil-​speakers​like​ “Xalik​Kurus,”​Tzotzil​for​“Salvador​Cruz.”​Kurus​thus​became​our​last​name. ​ 11.​Most​of​those​on​one​side​were​descendants​of​the​ejido’s​original​ Tzotzil-​ speaking​community,​dispossessed​by​a​ladino​planter​in​the​mid-​nineteenth​century.​Most​of​the​members​of​the​other​were​Tzeltal​speakers​whose​ancestors​had​ been​brought​to​Los​Chorros​as​debt​laborers​after​the​1890s.​In​all​the​years​of​inhabiting​the​same​space,​many​on​each​side​spoke​the​other​side’s​language,​and​there​ were​even​intermarriages.​But​since​the​1970s​they​had​joined​rival​political​parties​ and​by​the​mid-​1980s​were​locked​in​conflict​(see​Arias​1984;​Aubry​and​Inda​1998;​ Hernández​Castillo​2001). ​ 12.​In​the​United​States,​whether​to​use​names​or​not​is​still​debated​among​oral​ historians​and​the​university​and​government​officials​charged​with​protection​of​ research​subjects.​See​the​website​of​Perspectives​of​the​American​Historical​Association​for​the​range​of​views:​www.historians.org/Perspectives​(accessed​30​January​2006). ​ 13.​Slo’il cha’vo’ kumpareil / Cuento de los dos compadres​was​a​Zinacanteco​folktale​transcribed​by​our​colleague​Chep​Ernantes.​Edited​as​a​bilingual​children’s​story​ by​Chep​and​Diane,​with​illustrations​by​Elizabeth​Ross,​it​was​later​translated​into​ French​by​Isabelle​Duquesne​of​ inareMac ​for​distribution​to​Taller​supporters​in​ France.​A​fourth​book​from​this​period​was​Historia de un pueblo evangelista: Triunfo The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 173

Agrarista​(1993),​by​Ricardo​Pérez.​A​ladino​campesino​from​Chiapas’s​Central​Valley,​Pérez​read​the​Taller’s​books​and​then​wrote​his​own​history​of​his​Protestant​ refugee​colony,​illustrated​it​with​his​own​snapshots,​and​presented​it​to​the​Taller​for​ publication. ​ 14.​Aside​from​expulsion​for​interfering​in​Mexican​politics,​occasional​heavy-​ handed​surveillance​and​interrogation,​and​a​handful​of​cases​of​official​assault,​foreigners​were​largely​immune​to​the​repression​after​1994.​The​hope​that​this​would​ be​so​was​the​basis​for​stationing​foreign​citizens​in​Peace​Camps​in​the​midst​of​ threatened​communities.​That​none​have​been​killed​does​not​in​any​way​diminish​ the​courage​of​peace​campers,​who​still,​as​this​is​written​in​2006,​face​the​prospect​ of​violence. ​ 15.​This​did​not​apply​to​our​“home”​hamlet​in​Chamula,​where​our​sons’​godparents​resided​and​everyone​knew​us.​Even​there,​however,​although​it​had​nothing​to​do​with​us,​a​paramilitary​patrol​surrounded​and​menaced​a​primary​school​ graduation​we​attended​in​1997​until​local​men​calmed​them​down. ​ 16.​For​the​larger​context​of​this​shift,​see​Benjamin​(2000). ​ 17.​Angélica​Inda,​one​of​inareMac ’s​six​members,​was​the​eZln ’s​secretary​at​ the​San​Andrés​Peace​Talks.​Andrés​Aubry​worked​full-​time​writing​and​editing​the​ summaries​and​communiqués​of​Bishop​Samuel​Ruiz​and​the​mediators​at​the​talks.​ At​great​personal​risk​and​eventually​cost​to​their​health,​they​also​documented​and​ spoke​out​about​human​rights​abuses​throughout​the​period​after​1994​(see​Aubry​ and​Inda,​2003).​Still​a​third​associate,​Michel​Chanteaux,​a​resident​of​Chiapas​for​ more​than​thirty-​five​years,​was​expelled​from​Mexico​two​days​after​the​Acteal​massacre​in​December​1997​for​having​been​the​source​of​the​first​news​reports​that​the​ army​was​nearby​and​did​not​intervene​(Chanteaux​1999). ​ 18.​Outside​of​Mexico​we​felt​freer​and​lectured​and​were​interviewed​frequently.​ We​also​helped​organize​an​international​campaign​in​1998​to​keep​Chiapas​open​to​ scholars​and​human​rights​observers​and​to​free​a​Mexican​scholar​who​had​been​ swept​up​in​a​military​raid. ​ 19.​In​confimation​of​the​continuing​power​of​Xalik’s​words,​in​Subcomandante​ Marcos’s​speech​celebrating​the​fifteenth​anniversary​of​the​Zapatistas’​rebellion​of​ 1994,​he​quoted​directly​and​at​length​from​“Los​primeros​meses​de​los​zapatistas”​ (Subcomandante​Marcos,​“Siete​vientos​en​los​calendarios​y​geografías​de​abajo,”​reprinted​in​La Jornada,​Mexico​City,​4​January​2009). ​ 20.​ Meanwhile,​ beginning​ soon​ after​ the​ San​ Andrés​ Peace​ Accords​ of​ 1996,​ Andrés​Aubry​supervised​the​translation​of​the​accords​and​related​documents,​more​ than​one​hundred​pages,​into​ten​indigenous​languages​spoken​in​Chiapas,​including​ Tzotzil​(Los Acuerdos de San Andrés​2003).

174 Jan​rus​anD​Diane​l.​rus

decade​ of​ the​ twenty-​first​ century,​ as​ globalized​ indigenous​ movements​completed​their​fourth​decade​of​struggle,​a​new​generation​of​ Native​intellectuals​took​shape​and​found​its​own​voice.​As​the​two​essays​ in​part​3​make​clear,​these​younger​Native​intellectuals​are​well​versed​in​ postcolonial​theory​as​well​as​indigenous​methodologies.​They​straddle​the​ line​between​activism​and​academic​work,​committed​and​aspiring​to​both.​ Brian​Klopotek​and​Edgar​Esquit​are​both​committed​to​building​what​is,​ in​essence,​an​“insider’s​critique”​of​the​accomplishments​and​limitations​of​ Native​political​and​intellectual​production.​But​neither​wishes​this​critique​ to​stay​only​inside​Native​circles.​In​a​sense,​they​demonstrate​that​in​the​new​ generation​it​is​important​to​eschew​false​unities​in​order​more​fully​to​build​ true​and​enduring​ones. ​ In​ addition​ to​ these​ generational​ similarities,​ however,​ Klopotek​ and​ Esquit​ exhibit​ the​ differences​ generated​ by​ their​ distinct​ locations​ in​ the​ American​hemisphere.​While​both​aspire​to​a​place​in​the​academy,​Klopotek​is​more​firmly​placed​within​it​given​the​comparatively​greater​presence​ that​Native​intellectuals​have​carved​out​in​academe​in​the​United​States.​The​ political​and​historical​context​in​which​each​has​lived​is​also​quite​distinct.​ Klopotek​has​come​of​age​in​a​time​of​antiracist​activism​that​is​attempting​ to​build​coalitions​across​the​distinct​experiences​of​various​ethnic​and​racial​ minorities​within​the​United​States.​Esquit,​on​the​other​hand,​is​part​of​the​ first​generation​of​Maya​intellectuals​to​come​of​age​after​the​Guatemalan​ civil​war​of​1962–96,​when​more​than​83​percent​of​the​approximately​two​ hundred​thousand​victims​of​violence​were​Maya.1​He​is​attempting​to​place​ the​Maya​struggle​for​self-​determination​that​emerged​most​strongly​as​a​ reaction​to​this​civil​war​into​historical​context.​For​each,​then,​the​meaning​ of​multiculturalism​is​different,​and,​as​we​shall​see,​for​Esquit​it​cannot​be​ separated​from​questions​of​neoliberalism. ​ Basing​his​work​on​that​of​the​Maori​scholar​Linda​Tuhiwai​Smith,​Klopotek​ reflects​ deeply​ on​ the​ double​ meaning​ of​ the​ phrase​ “decolonizing​ methodologies.”​Not​only​do​some​methodologies​decolonize​research​and​ knowledge,​he​argues,​but​we​must​also​learn​to​decolonize​the​methodologies​we​use.​In​addressing​the​very​sensitive​issue​of​racism​against​blacks​ among​ southern​ Natives​ in​ the​ United​ States,​ Klopotek​ sees​ opportunity​ within​the​danger​of​“speaking​secrets.”​While​recognizing​that​for​many​ in tHe First

years​subaltern​people​have​reacted​to​academic​researchers​by​closing​ranks​ and​not​being​open​about​internal​issues,​Klopotek​also​considers​the​possibility​that​speaking​the​truth​about​internal​divisions​may​be​a​form​of​activist​healing. ​ For​his​part,​Esquit​is​interested​in​who​speaks​for​whom​in​the​Maya​ movement.​He​explores​the​historical​dynamics​and​origins​of​the​pan-​Maya​ movement​across​the​twentieth​century,​focusing​on​prosperous,​educated​ Maya​ elites​ in​ certain​ urban​ regions​ and​ among​ certain​ Maya​ linguistic​ groups,​most​notably​the​K’ich’e​and​Kaqchikel.​Esquit​demonstrates​that​ the​use​of​Mayanist​discourse​to​claim​space​in​particular​worlds,​such​as​national​politics,​that​were​previously​closed​to​the​Maya​has​a​tradition​going​ back​to​the​end​of​the​nineteenth​century.​He​shows​that​this​form​of​Maya​ empowerment​has​been​used​by​Maya​elites​in​relation​to​both​ladinos​and​ to​poor​and​uneducated​Maya.​What​is​different​in​the​post–civil​war​period,​ he​suggests,​is​a​discourse​of​peoplehood​which,​one​might​presume,​has​ a​new​ethnic​inclusiveness​to​it.​Taking​this​inclusiveness​seriously,​Esquit​ concludes,​means​being​attentive​to​all​sectors​of​the​Maya​people​and​finding​ways​to​get​beyond​internal​class,​gender,​and​ethnic​differences.​And​ it​is​in​this​sense​that​the​economic​problems​exacerbated​by​globalization​ must​take​center​stage.​Unless​the​Maya​movement​takes​account​of​the​ways​ in​which​globalization​hurts​all​the​poor,​Maya​and​ladino​alike,​then​educated​Maya​who​participate​in​the​government​will​ultimately​become​complicit​in​the​deployment​of​multiculturalism​as​a​tool​of​state​control​and​in​ the​continued​oppression​and​exclusion​of​the​poor​more​generally. ​ Taken​together,​then,​these​two​essays​suggest​that​a​more​open​and​self-​ critical​ perspective​ on​ indigenous​ cultural​ and​ political​ issues,​ when​ formulated​from​within​indigenous​intellectual​circles​themselves,​can​provide​ new​insights​about​the​past​and​new​clues​for​the​future​of​indigenous​activism.​This​combination​of​unity​and​loyalty​to​one’s​group,​yet​a​willingness​ to​criticize​from​within​and​to​do​so​openly,​with​eyes​on​the​future,​is​an​ important​mark​of​the​new​generation​of​indigenous​activist-​intellectuals​ taking​shape​across​the​Americas.

Note ​ 1.​Guatemala: Memory of Silence,​Report​of​the​Commission​for​Historical​Clarification,​http://shr.aaas.org/guatemala.

Indigenous Activism and Debates 177

brian kloPotek

Dangerous​Decolonizing Indians and Blacks and the Legacy of Jim Crow

For​the​past​ten​years​I​have​been​doing​ethnological​and​historical​research​ in​the​southeastern​United​States​that​revolves​around​federal​recognition​of​ Indian​tribes.​One​of​the​thorniest​issues​to​negotiate​with​people​I​interview​ has​been​the​place​of​blackness​in​southern​Indian​communities.​The​subject​ quickly​raises​hackles​because​of​the​ways​in​which​the​presence​of​blackness​undermines​claims​to​a​distinct​Indian​identity;​as​a​result​of​this​and​ other​factors,​antiblack​racism​remains​an​unresolved​internal​and​external​ conflict​in​the​South.​As​a​Choctaw​with​roots​in​Louisiana​and​an​activist​for​racial​equality,​I​feel​obliged​to​discuss​the​matter​publicly​to​counter​ antiblack​racism​and​free​indigenous​communities​from​what​is​ultimately​a​ self-​defeating​support​of​white​supremacy.​By​doing​so,​however,​I​am​forcing​other​southern​Indians​to​talk​about​the​matter​against​their​will​and​ discussing​a​history​that​sometimes​reflects​poorly​on​us.​On​the​basis​of​the​ conflicts​and​methodological​problems​I​have​encountered​in​this​process,​I​ suggest​some​revisions​to​indigenous​methodologies​and​discuss​the​implications​of​this​knowledge​for​indigenous​studies​as​a​field. ​ This​ essay​ addresses​ the​ stories​ we​ are​ not​ supposed​ to​ talk​ about,​ a​ thought​that​gives​me​pause.​Decades​of​subaltern​groups​talking​back​to​ academics​have​made​it​clear​that​colonial​gazing,​airing​dirty​laundry,​and​ treating​indigenous​people​as​laboratory​animals​undermine​the​safety​and​ integrity​of​the​communities​being​studied.​In​light​of​these​critiques,​indigenous​peoples​and​scholars​have​developed​a​new​model​based​in​collaboration​with​and​respect​for​indigenous​sovereignty,​and​scholars​try​to​ be​self-​critical​and​self-​aware,​ensuring​that​scholarly​work​benefits​the​community​in​some​direct​way.​Collaboration,​mutual​benefit,​and​scholarly​sup-

port​of​tribal​endeavors​are​central​both​to​indigenous​methodologies​and​to​ my​ethical​concerns​as​an​indigenous​researcher.1 ​ But​the​problem​of​antiblack​racism​in​Indian​communities​presents​a​ theoretical​oversight​in​indigenous​methodologies​in​a​couple​of​ways.​First,​ indigenous​methodologies​need​to​be​able​to​account​for​indigenous​peoples​ as​entities​with​blurred​boundaries​and​internal​heterogeneity​rather​than​as​ discretely​bounded,​homogeneous​communities.​While​scholars​have​often​ acknowledged​the​blurred​boundaries​between​indigenous​and​colonizing​ populations​that​result​in​mestizaje,​middle​grounds,​and​colonial​domination​in​American​Indian​studies,​we​have​only​recently​become​more​careful​ about​accounting​for​the​ways​in​which​Indian​communities​have​come​into​ contact​with​other​marginalized​groups​and​at​times​reproduced​systems​of​ oppression​from​the​colonizers​within​our​own​communities.​Moreover,​we​ too​rarely​account​for​the​multiplicity​of​social​and​political​positions​within​ a​community,​preferring​the​simplicity​of​well-​intentioned​declarative​statements​about​supporting​tribal​sovereignty​that​carry​a​secret,​homogenizing,​ nationalist​ “conceptual​ prison”​ for​ Indians​ within​ them.2​ Indigenous​ methodologies​in​some​ways​depend​on​a​presupposition​of​a​tidy​power​ relationship​between​a​tightly​bound,​oppressed​subject​group​and​a​separate,​oppressive​external​world,​and​a​presupposition​that​all​of​the​values​ of​the​indigenous​community​are​worthy​of​upholding​and​in​line​with​the​ values​of​the​researcher.​So​what​should​we​do​when​that​is​not​true?​Or,​ more​accurately,​what​do​we​do​once​we​understand​that​it​is,​in​fact,​an​impossibility?​Can​we​classify​as​collaborative​work​that​which​seeks​to​change​ the​values​of​a​community?​In​this​case,​I​view​it​as​part​of​a​painful​process​ of​decolonization​and​a​conversation​long​overdue​in​Indian​country,​but​it​ raises​the​question​of​how​to​make​these​ethical​considerations​fit​into​a​collaborative​model. ​ That​leads​to​the​second​area​of​concern,​which​is​that​in​the​context​of​ U.S.​indigenous​studies,​we​need​to​have​a​better​infusion​of​the​study​of​ race​more​broadly​than​simply​in​the​Indian–white​context.​In​many​ways,​ the​native–white​relationship​is​unique.​We​need​to​keep​this​in​mind​because​as​a​field​U.S.​ethnic​studies​does​not​have​a​solid​understanding​of​ the​distinction​between​indigenous​groups​and​racial​minorities​and​typically​fails​to​see​the​ways​ in​which​the​colonizer–indigenous​ relationship​ is​central​to​understanding​other​racial​projects.​At​the​same​time,​Indian​ studies​as​a​field​has​focused​so​intently​on​what​sets​indigenous​nations​ apart​from​racial​minorities​that​we​have​failed​to​fully​account​for​our​com180 brian​KlopoteK

mon​experiences​as​racial​minorities.​Indians​are​part​of​a​racial​system​that​ goes​beyond​the​binary​racial​relationship​with​whites​and​beyond​the​colonial​relationship;​we​are​part​of​a​dynamic​constellation,​an​entire​system​of​ race,​and​every​node​in​that​system​affects​Native​people​to​some​degree.​ We​understand,​for​example,​that​white​racializations​of​Indian​people​affect​everything​from​the​government-​to-​government​relationship​to​the​way​ Indian​kids​are​socialized​in​educational​systems.​But​Indians​are​part​of​and​ participate​in​a​national​conversation​about​race,​and​we​need​to​understand​ more​fully​how​racial​formations​and​indigeneity​are​tied​together,​too.​How​ do​ ideas​ about​ whiteness,​ Indianness,​ and​ blackness,​ for​ example,​ shape​ tribal​ identities?​ How​ were​ shifting​ attitudes​ toward​ Indians​ in​ the​ 1920s​ tied​to​the​classification​of​Chicanos​as​white​in​the​census​of​1930​(Foley​ 2002)?​How​have​Japanese-​and​Anglo-​American​myths​of​racial​equality​in​ Hawai‘i​undermined​indigenous​Hawaiian​sovereignty​efforts​(Trask​2000)? ​ Stories​ from​ my​ experiences​ in​ Indian​ communities​ in​ Louisiana​ exemplify​the​complex​historical​relations​between​black,​white,​and​Indian​ peoples,​but​this​pattern​of​antiblack​racism​is​evident​in​many​Indian​communities​ in​ the​ southeastern​ United​ States,​ as​ other​ scholars​ have​ documented​extensively.​James​Merrell,​for​example,​makes​the​starkly​illustrative​statement​in​an​article​from​1984​that​“as​recently​as​1981,​informants​ on​the​reservation​called​avoidance​of​and​contempt​for​blacks​‘a​Catawba​ tradition’”​(1984,​374).​Similarly,​Arica​Coleman​discusses​the​Rappahannock​identity​of​Mildred​Loving,​one​of​the​plaintiffs​in​Loving v. Virginia,​ the​famous​court​case​that​struck​down​Virginia’s​antimiscegenation​laws.​ While​widely​perceived​as​an​African​American​woman,​in​an​interview​in​ 2004​Loving​denied​having​any​African​ancestry,​arguing​that​“the​Rappahannocks​never​had​anything​to​do​with​blacks”​(Coleman​2006,​75).​Helen​ Rountree​discusses​the​ways​in​which​Virginia’s​racial​purity​laws,​beginning​ immediately​after​the​Civil​War,​became​“a​veritable​cornerstone”​of​Indian​ self-​identity​in​Virginia​because​of​the​ways​it​distinguished​the​legal​rights​ of​Indians​with​no​African​ancestry​from​those​with​African​ancestry.3​The​ Mississippi​Choctaws,​a​tribe​notable​for​its​high​degree​of​language​and​cultural​conservatism,​historically​refused​to​associate​with​blacks​(Thompson​ and​Peterson​1975,​180).​The​Lumbees,​a​tribe​whose​status​as​such​is​called​ into​question​by​some​who​think​they​are​mulattoes​masquerading​as​Indians,​have​historically​exhibited​some​of​the​same​behavior,​refusing​to​send​ their​children​to​black​schools​when​they​were​not​allowed​to​enroll​in​white​ schools​under​Jim​Crow​(Blu​2001,​62–65).​Each​of​the​so-​called​Five​CiviIndians and Blacks 181

lized​Tribes​of​Oklahoma​has​in​varying​degrees​excluded​people​from​tribal​ enrollment​because​of​their​African​ancestry,​leading​some​of​the​remaining​ tribal​members​with​African​ancestry​to​hide​their​heritage​behind​particularly​loud​antiblack​rhetoric.4​The​list​goes​on,​but​these​examples​should​ suffice​to​establish​the​broad,​deeply​set​pattern​of​antiblack​racism​among​ southern​Indians​that​reaches​beyond​the​borders​of​any​individual​tribe​or​ state.​In​fact,​the​pattern​reaches​beyond​the​southeastern​United​States​and​ beyond​indigenous​communities,​to​be​sure,​but​I​will​limit​the​conversation​ here​to​my​area​of​expertise​to​make​the​arguments​most​effectively.​I​state​ this​at​the​outset​to​help​frame​the​discussion​that​follows​and​to​shield​tribes​ I​am​discussing​specifically​from​being​singled​out​for​any​special​contempt​ they​have​not​earned.​I​hope​the​fact​that​we​are​all​in​this​narrative​together​ provides​some​consolation​to​the​fact​that​I​am​discussing​here​matters​that​ many​would​rather​bury.​This​is​our​common​heritage​as​colonized​subjects​ of​a​racist​nation,​and​this​is​my​attempt​to​contribute​to​our​decolonization.

Research in Louisiana Indian Communities I​am​a​Native​American​studies​scholar​rather​than​an​anthropologist​or​a​ historian,​and​the​research​for​this​project​grew​out​of​my​interdisciplinary​ dissertation​in​American​studies.​While​certainly​informed​by​anthropological​methods,​theories,​and​methodologies,​my​research​was​never​a​strictly​ anthropological​endeavor.​My​primary​sources​were​oral​history​interviews​ and​archival​research​focusing​on​the​federal​recognition​process,​though​ more​traditional​fieldwork​during​ten​months​in​Louisiana​also​provided​ valuable​context​and​points​of​discussion​that​would​not​have​been​available​ to​me​through​formal​interviews​or​archival​research​alone. ​ Rather​than​immersing​myself​in​one​tribal​community,​I​worked​with​ three​ tribal​ communities​ within​ an​ hour’s​ drive​ of​ each​ other​ because​ I​ wanted​ to​ be​ able​ to​ examine​ their​ experiences​ with​ the​ federal​ recognition​process​from​a​comparative​perspective.​The​dissertation​focuses​on​the​ Tunica-​Biloxi​Tribe,​federally​recognized​in​1981,​the​Jena​Band​of​Choctaw​ Indians,​federally​recognized​in​1995,​and​the​Clifton-​Choctaws,​currently​ petitioning​for​federal​recognition.​Within​these​tribes​and​several​others​in​ the​region,​I​interviewed​tribal​leaders​almost​exclusively—more​than​thirty​ people​ who​ had​ been​ involved​ in​ the​ tribal​ governments​ or​ tribal​ enterprises​in​some​central​way​over​the​previous​decades—people​who​I​thought​ would​be​able​to​give​me​the​most​information​about​the​federal​recogni182 brian​KlopoteK

tion​process.​The​resulting​product​might​be​called​an​intellectual​history​of​ recognition​activism​in​Louisiana.​This​particular​design​has​its​limitations,​ but​it​provided​insights​into​patterns​of​racial​thinking​that​would​not​likely​ have​been​as​visible​with​another​research​plan. ​ While​the​stories​of​every​tribal​community​in​Louisiana​could​supply​ ample​ material​ for​ discussion​ on​ this​ topic,​ I​ will​ focus​ on​ the​ Clifton-​ Choctaws​presently​because​they​epitomize​the​dilemma​under​study.​The​ Clifton-​Choctaws​are​a​state-​recognized​tribe​in​the​process​of​petitioning​ for​federal​recognition.​Some​local​tribes​and​tribal​members​support​the​ Clifton-​Choctaws’​bid​for​recognition​while​others​oppose​it.​A​substantial​ part​of​the​opposition​to​recognition​stems​from​the​fact​that​some​of​the​ members​of​the​community​have​African​ancestry,​which​makes​them​automatically​black,​regardless​of​any​other​ancestry​under​legal​and​popular​U.S.​ racial​codes.​As​a​result,​the​issue​becomes​central​to​Clifton-​Choctaw​identity​construction. ​ When​I​visited​the​community​between​1998​and​2000,​the​tribal​member​serving​as​the​federal​recognition​liaison​and​unofficial​office​manager​ looked​to​be​of​Native,​African,​and​European​descent,​as​did​her​son​and​ several​other​family​members.​Her​name​was​Maria​Dixon,​and​she​occupied​a​position​of​visibility​and​power,​a​diplomatic​position​that​in​many​ ways​made​her​the​face​of​the​tribe.5​I​assumed​her​presence​in​that​position​ meant​the​Clifton-​Choctaws​were​uninterested​in​downplaying​their​African​ ancestry,​despite​reports​to​the​contrary​from​outsiders. ​ During​ my​ first​ interview​ with​ her​ I​ asked​ Dixon​ about​ the​ Clifton-​ Choctaws’​ relations​ with​ surrounding​ black​ and​ white​ communities.​ She​ said​ the​ Clifton-​Choctaws​ have​ good​ relations​ with​ some​ blacks,​ such​ as​ the​ state​ representative​ from​ Alexandria,​ but​ that​ typically​ distrust​ flavors​the​relationship.​She​quickly​added​that​distrust​also​typifies​Clifton-​ Choctaw​attitudes​toward​whites.​They​have​good​relations​with​some,​bad​ with​others,​she​said,​citing​conflicts​with​the​sheriff ’s​office​and​the​school​ board​as​examples​of​the​latter.​She​asserted​that​perceptions​depended​on​ the​individuals​involved​in​the​relationship,​given​that​many​Clifton​people​ distrust​outsiders​in​general,​regardless​of​their​race.​There​is​an​element​of​ truth​in​her​statement​about​distrust​of​all​outsiders,​but​after​about​ten​seconds​of​silence,​another​truth​burst​out​from​its​place​just​beneath​the​surface.​“But​on​the​whole,”​Dixon​told​me,​“they​trust​whites​more​than​they​ trust​blacks.”6 ​ Setting​aside​for​the​moment​her​use​of​the​word​they​rather​than​we,​ Indians and Blacks 183

it​is​clear​that​Dixon​was​abundantly​aware​of​the​antiblack​racism​among​ her​fellow​community​members​but​was​trying,​no​doubt​for​a​number​of​ reasons​both​personal​and​political,​to​convey​that​reality​in​an​understated​ way.​Other​leaders​tiptoed​around​the​subject​of​antiblack​racism,​too,​distancing​themselves​from​it,​feeling​me​out,​without​necessarily​performing​ an​overt​display​of​contempt​for​blacks.​Consider,​for​example,​the​words​of​a​ Clifton​man​in​his​seventies,​a​man​who​might​pass​for​white​in​many​places.​ In​his​youth,​he​recalled,​“they’d​call​you​Redbone,​they’d​call​you​mulatto,​ they’d​call​you​everything​but​probably​what​you​are.​So,​we​always,​it​was​a​ fight​with​us​when​they’d​call​us​all​these​other​names,​’cause​we​always​had​ been​taught​that​we​was​from​Indian​people.”​The​narrative​implies​that​the​ inaccuracy​of​the​labels​mulatto​and​Redbone​was​at​issue;​antipathy​hides​ in​the​subtext,​where​it​is​obvious​that​the​blackness​of​the​labels​caused​the​ offense.​The​element​of​Indian​identity​that​depended​on​not​only​a​lack​of​ black​ancestry​but​also​antipathy​toward​blacks,​it​seemed​to​me,​was​a​holdover​from​the​older​generations,​a​fading​tradition,​verging​on​becoming​ covert​even​in​this​older​man’s​statement​about​his​childhood.​I​recognized​ that​it​was​a​part​of​community​history,​but​I​categorically​separated​it​from​ the​modern​community.​I​later​realized​it​was​a​mistake​to​tie​these​attitudes​ to​specific​generations​and​assume​declining​acceptance​of​these​traditions​ merely​because​of​Dixon’s​central,​visible​position​in​the​community. ​ After​I​had​been​away​from​the​community​for​three​years,​a​series​of​ incidents​made​me​realize​I​had​been​underestimating​the​importance​of​ antiblack​racism​and​the​extent​of​community​denials​of​black​ancestry.​In​ December​2003,​as​part​of​the​collaborative​process​mandated​by​indigenous​ methodologies,​I​resent​a​draft​of​the​Clifton-​Choctaw​chapter​from​my​dissertation​to​Dixon​so​tribal​members​could​read​and​comment​on​it​before​ it​was​finalized.​Dixon​had​left​her​position​shortly​after​I​sent​the​original​ draft,​and​apparently​no​one​had​seen​it​the​first​time​around.​The​new​recognition​coordinator​was​a​white​woman,​the​wife​of​a​tribal​member​who​was​ eager​to​read​the​chapter.​I​sent​off​two​copies​and​waited​for​the​marked-​up​ copy​to​be​returned​to​me.​I​waited​and​waited,​but​nothing​came.​I​called​a​ couple​of​times​in​the​intervening​two​months​and​left​messages​but​never​ heard​ back.​ Finally,​ one​ day​ I​ reached​ her​ by​ phone​ and​ asked​ her​ what​ she​and​others​thought​of​the​draft.​I​was​anxious​because​community​approval​represents​a​hurdle​at​least​as​significant​as​academic​approval​and​ infinitely​more​challenging​and​fraught​with​danger.​More​than​mere​courtesy,​collaboration​makes​for​more​rigorous​academic​work​because​it​makes​ 184 brian​KlopoteK

scholars​accountable​to​the​expertise​and​authority​of​community​members​ as​lifelong​participant-​observers.​The​new​coordinator​was​hesitant,​and​I​ could​sense​that​a​significant​critique​was​about​to​emerge.​She​told​me​that​ “all​this​information”​was​new​to​her​and​that​she​was​shocked​by​it.​I​asked​ her​what​information​specifically​was​so​shocking.​She​started​talking​in​a​ tone​that​let​me​know​she​was​choosing​her​words​carefully.​“You​know,​the​ stuff​about​the​[pause]​.​.​.​muhlahtas.” ​ She​was​referring​to​my​discussions​of​blackness​in​the​community’s​ancestry,​to​the​fact​that​many​of​the​ancestors​of​community​members​were​ identified​as​mulattoes​in​the​census​of​1910,​to​the​history​of​intermarriage​ with​the​nearby​Cane​River​Creoles​of​Color,​to​the​fact​that​I​had​described​ the​community​as​mixed​Indian,​black,​and​white.​She​said​her​husband​was​ angry​about​this​characterization,​but​that​he​acknowledged​that​the​perception​of​his​people​as​mulattoes​had​been​present​for​a​number​of​years.​She​ guessed​that​many​other​community​members​would​be​similarly​angry,​but​ only​about​the​issue​of​mixing​with​blacks—mixing​with​whites​was​completely​acceptable. ​ As​it​turns​out,​she​was​right.​When​I​next​visited​the​Clifton-​Choctaw​ community,​she​was​no​longer​working​for​the​tribe,​so​I​talked​with​the​ new​tribal​recognition​coordinator.​I​brought​two​copies​of​my​completed​ dissertation​on​this​trip:​one​to​give​to​the​tribal​chair​and​one​to​the​tribal​ council.​While​I​had​made​some​minor​adjustments​in​phrasing​to​indicate​ that​some​of​the​community​had​African​ancestry​and​some​potentially​did​ not,​I​did​not​remove​discussions​of​blackness​altogether.​I​talked​with​the​ new​coordinator,​who​was​a​tribal​member,​and​told​her​about​the​concerns​ of​her​predecessor.​She​concurred​that​it​certainly​would​go​over​poorly​with​ many​tribal​members,​and​it​did​not​sit​well​with​her,​either.​She​said​that​ blacks​had​always​been​excluded​from​the​community​and​that​if​she​had​ any​say​in​the​matter​the​tribe​would​uphold​that​tradition.​She​told​me​that​ Dixon​had​always,​in​fact,​been​marginal​to​the​community​because​of​her​ blackness,​a​troubling​statement​that​opened​a​window​onto​Dixon’s​experiences​of​belonging​in​her​community. ​ I​had​a​conversation​with​the​tribal​chair​about​the​issue​later​that​week,​ and​she​spoke​in​the​more​diplomatic​tones​I​had​heard​from​other​officials,​ though​she,​like​others,​expressed​concern​that​I​had​suggested​that​the​community​had​black​ancestry​and​black​cultural​influences.​Perplexed,​I​told​ her​I​thought​it​was​commonly​acknowledged​that​some​members​of​the​ Clifton-​Choctaw​community​had​black​ancestry,​in​particular​through​its​ Indians and Blacks 185

ties​to​the​Cane​River​Creoles​of​Color.​Her​eyes​brightened​in​recognition​ and​what​appeared​to​be​relief,​and​she​said,​“Oh,​well,​yes,​the​Cane​River​ Creoles,​we​do​share​ancestry​with​them.”​In​local​terms,​the​Cane​River​ Creoles,​who​have​African,​French,​and​Native​ancestry,​were​distinguished​ from​blacks​by​their​large​percentage​of​European​ancestry,​their​history​as​ free​people​of​color​and​slaveholders​themselves​(which​carries​connotations​ about​both​race​and​class),​their​francophone​traditions,​and​their​celebrity​ as​bearers​of​a​unique​tradition​that​sets​Louisiana​apart​from​the​rest​of​the​ United​States.​In​central​Louisiana,​they​were​“a​race​apart​from​blacks,”​certainly​in​their​own​minds​and​to​a​significant​degree​in​local​custom​as​well.7​ These​were​not​the​blacks​that​many​Clifton-​Choctaws​were​loath​to​be​affiliated​with.​French​and​Latin​American​style​racial​gradations,​which​are​ multifaceted​rather​than​binary,​are​still​in​operation​in​the​area​to​the​extent​ that​the​terms​black​and​Creole of Color​connote​different​sets​of​people​and​ different​levels​of​prejudice.​This​clarifies​to​some​extent​the​protestations​by​ Clifton-​Choctaws​against​the​suggestion​that​they​had​black​ancestry. ​ Though​the​tribal​chair​acknowledged​her​community’s​connections​with​ the​ Cane​ River​ Creoles​ of​ Color,​ she​ insisted​ that​ whatever​ racial​ ancestry​ the​ community​ had,​ they​ had​ been​ largely​ isolated​ from​ mainstream​ black​and​white​influences​and​intermarriage​for​many​years.​That​is,​while​ there​was​intermarriage​with​Creoles​of​Color​and​white​outsiders​at​various​ points,​the​community​had​been​largely​insular,​marrying​among​themselves​ for​the​better​part​of​150​years.​Certainly​there​was​white​influence​and​(less​ so,​she​points​out)​black​influence​in​the​community,​but​on​some​level​she​ believes​a​discussion​of​black​influences​in​particular​diminishes​the​community’s​distinctive​Indian​identity.​In​terms​of​the​perceptions​of​the​community​and​of​the​federal​recognition​process,​which​is​at​its​heart​about​ perceptions,​she​may​be​right.

Regulating Racial Categories The​ origin​ of​ antiblack​ racism​ among​ southern​ Indians​ rests​ in​ Anglo-​ American​racism​and​colonialism,​two​phenomena​that​are​so​closely​related​ that​they​might​be​better​accounted​for​if​we​understand​them​as​behavior​ resulting​ from​an​ideology​centered​ in​white​ supremacy—an​ ideology​ in​ which​white​people​and​their​ancestors​are​understood​to​be​morally,​intellectually,​politically,​and​spiritually​superior​to​nonwhites​and​therefore​entitled​to​various​forms​of​privilege,​power,​and​property.8​This​ideology​was​ 186 brian​KlopoteK

forced​on​southern​Indian​communities​gradually​but​surely​through​the​ twin​hammers​of​military​conquest​and​assimilationism.​A​number​of​scholars​have​documented​southern​Indians’​adoption​of​Anglo​systems​of​racial​ thinking​as​one​component​of​a​multifaceted​response​to​U.S.​aggression;​in​ mirroring​the​peculiar​notions​of​civility​held​by​southern​Anglos​around​ race​and​gender,​tribes​hoped​to​protect​themselves​against​conquest​based​ on​constructions​of​Indian​savagery​(Saunt​2005,​1999;​Miles​2004;​Perdue,​ 1979,​1999;​Littlefield,​1977).​Claudio​Saunt​suggests​that​as​a​result,​race​became​“a​central​element​in​the​lives​of​southeastern​Indians,​not​just​as​a​ marker​of​difference​between​natives​and​white​newcomers​but​as​a​divisive​and​destructive​force​within​Indian​communities​themselves”​(2005,​4).​ Though​there​was​conflict​within​the​tribes​over​the​issues​of​slavery​and​ blackness,​southeastern​tribes​increasingly​adopted​Anglo-​American​racializations​of​African-​descended​people​over​the​course​of​the​nineteenth​century. ​ For​much​of​the​twentieth​century,​segregation​policies​were​the​arena​in​ which​the​boundaries​of​race​and​privilege​were​officially​policed,​and​because​of​this​history​in​educational​policy​specifically​Indians​in​the​South​ learned​ to​ define​ themselves​ in​ ways​ that​ distanced​ them​ from​ blacks​ as​ much​ as​ possible.​ While​ there​ were​ simultaneous​ impulses​ toward​ isolationism​ from​ whites,​ when​ southern​ Indians,​ of​ African​ ancestry​ or​ not,​ wanted​access​to​education​they​fought​to​have​their​children​enrolled​in​ white​schools​and​refused​to​send​them​to​black​schools.​Rather​than​challenging​the​existence​of​the​color​line,​most​tried​to​position​themselves​on​ the​right​side​of​it.​By​saying​they​would​not​go​to​school​with​blacks,​an​act​ of​self-​defense​taken​with​the​intention​of​ameliorating​racial​discrimination​ against​ Indian​ people​ and​ maintaining​ a​ distinct​ Indian​ identity,​ Indians​ were​complicit​in​the​segregation​and​oppression​of​blacks.9​Consequently,​ antiblack​racism​seeped​deeper​still​into​the​construction​of​Indian​identity.​ The​Clifton-​Choctaws,​like​other​southern​Indians,​continue​to​grapple​with​ this​legacy​today. ​ More​recently,​federal​Indian​policy​that​determines​whether​previously​ nonfederal​ tribes​ should​ qualify​ for​ federal​ recognition​ has​ been​ a​much​ clearer​venue​for​the​regulation​of​the​boundaries​of​Indian​identity,​and​ by​extension​in​this​case​of​black,​white,​and​Creole​of​Color​identities​as​ well.​Blackness​and​its​absence​come​into​the​federal​recognition​discussion​ in​ several​ ways.​ The​ first​ is​ the​ significance​ of​ previous​ recognition​ from​ governments,​surrounding​communities,​and​social​scientists.10​Because​of​ Indians and Blacks 187

Anglo-​American​conceptions​of​race​and​the​one-​drop​rule,​anyone​with​ visible​or​known​African​ancestry​(“one​drop”​of​African​“blood”)​was​considered​black​or​colored​for​most​purposes.​An​Indian​community​with​even​ a​small​degree​of​black​ancestry​is​much​less​likely​historically​to​have​been​ acknowledged​as​an​Indian​community​by​governments,​social​scientists,​ and​ surrounding​ populations​ than​ a​ community​ with​ greater​ degrees​ of​ white​ancestry.11 ​ The​census​is​a​good​example​of​this​bias​in​historical​records.​The​census​of​1910​for​Rapides​Parish,​for​example,​lists​many​of​the​families​in​the​ Clifton​community​as​mulattoes.12​The​special​Indian​Schedule​for​Rapides​ Parish​in​1910​lists​none​of​the​seven​family​surnames​represented​in​the​ Clifton​ community​ in​ recent​ years.​ The​ census​ enumerators​ in​ 1910​ were​ instructed​to​use​the​Indian​Schedules​“principally​for​the​enumeration​of​ Indians​ living​ on​ reservations​ or​ in​ tribal​ relations,​ and​ also​ by​ the​ enumerators​in​certain​counties​containing​a​considerable​number​of​Indians”​ (United​States​Census​Bureau​2002,​55).​They​were​given​further​instructions​ on​ deciding​ how​ to​ group​ mixed​ communities:​ “Detached​ Indians​ living​ either​ in​ white​ or​ negro​ families​ outside​ of​ reservations​ should​ be​ enumerated​on​the​general​population​schedule​as​members​of​the​families​in​ which​they​are​found;​but​detached​whites​or​negroes​living​in​Indian​families​should​be​enumerated​on​this​special​Indian​schedule​as​members​of​the​ Indian​families​in​which​they​are​found.​In​other​words,​every​family​composed​mainly​of​Indians​should​be​reported​entirely​on​this​special​schedule,​and​every​family​composed​mainly​of​persons​not​Indians​should​be​ reported​entirely​on​the​general​population​schedule”​(United​States​Census​ Bureau​2002,​56). ​ This​ presents​ a​ problem​ for​ the​ Clifton​ community.​ People​ of​ mixed​ black,​white,​and​Indian​ancestry​were​classified​as​mulattoes​by​the​census,​ undifferentiated​ from​ people​ of​ solely​ white​ and​ black​ ancestry.​ The​ surrounding​population​did​acknowledge​Indian​ancestry​in​the​Clifton​community​when​they​called​them​Redbones,​a​derogatory​term​that​connotes​ Indian,​black,​and​white​ancestry,​but​the​official​census​record​did​not​have​ a​category​to​reflect​that​distinction,​which​would​allow​people​to​conclude​ that​the​record​stated​they​were​solely​black​and​white​instead​of​Indian.13 ​ The​ census​ enumerator’s​ decision​ also​ reflected​ the​ broader​ American​understanding​that​the​presence​or​absence​of​Indian​ancestry​did​not​ usually​alter​a​designation​as​mulatto,​a​term​that​could​mean​any​mix​of​ black​and​nonblack​ancestry​in​the​United​States.​The​presence​of​African​ 188 brian​KlopoteK

ancestry​among​any​of​the​Clifton​families​may​very​well​have​closed​the​ enumerator’s​eyes​to​the​possibility​that​this​might​be​an​Indian​community​ as​much​as​anything​else,​particularly​if​any​links​to​the​Cane​River​Creoles​ were​known​to​the​enumerator.14​Moreover,​Jack​Forbes’s​research​on​Virginia​census​records​at​the​very​least​suggests​that​one​needs​to​be​cautious​ in​assigning​African​ancestry​to​people​listed​in​historical​records​as​mulatto.​Certainly​people​of​visible​African​ancestry​were​classified​as​such,​but​ so​were​people​of​undetermined​racial​ancestry.​A​designation​as​mulatto​is​ not​in​itself​confirmation​of​African​ancestry​and​certainly​is​not​confirmation​of​a​lack​of​Indian​ancestry​(Forbes​1993).​The​only​firm​conclusion​one​ can​draw​is​that​the​enumerators​believed​the​people​they​listed​as​mulatto​ should​not​be​considered​white. ​ Similarly,​in​terms​of​previous​federal​acknowledgment​of​Indian​communities,​the​Bureau​of​Indian​Affairs​of​the​1930s​was​extremely​disinclined​ to​serve​communities​with​black​ancestry​because​of​the​one-​drop​rule.​Bureau​officials​expressed​concern​that​they​might​be​called​on​to​serve​Louisiana​Indians​who​were​“mixed​with​negroes”​like​other​“so-​called​Indians​ in​Louisiana​particularly​in​Terrebonne​Parish​[in​reference​to​the​Houma​ tribe],​such​people​being​of​various​racial​mixtures.”15​Bureau​records​indicate​that​black​ancestry​among​some​Louisiana​Indian​groups​made​officials​ less​inclined​to​serve​any​of​the​Louisiana​tribes,​but​they​did​briefly​serve​ those​who​could​demonstrate​that​they​had​not​mixed​with​blacks,​such​as​ the​Jena​Choctaws​and​the​Coushattas.​Thus,​tribes​with​black​ancestry​petitioning​for​federal​recognition​are​at​a​disadvantage​in​this​aspect​as​well. ​ Perhaps​the​most​difficult​rejection​to​deal​with​is​that​which​comes​from​ other​Indians.​While​several​Tunica-​Biloxi​tribal​leaders​have​expressed​support​for​Clifton-​Choctaw​tribal​status,​some​of​the​neighboring​and​now​ federally​recognized​Jena​Choctaws​have​been​fairly​critical​of​the​Clifton-​ Choctaws’​claims​to​tribal​status.​Individuals​within​the​Jena​Band​respond​ to​the​Clifton-​Choctaws​in​different​ways,​though,​so​any​impression​that​ they​uniformly​reject​Clifton-​Choctaws​because​of​African​ancestry​in​the​ community​would​flatten​and​compress​the​range​of​opinions​other​Indian​ people​have​about​Clifton. ​ One​Jena​Choctaw​leader​argues​that​there​certainly​are​Indian​individuals​in​the​Clifton-​Choctaw​community,​but​that​the​presence​of​Indian​ancestry​in​some​of​the​members​does​not​make​them​a​tribe.​After​attending​a​ festival​sponsored​by​the​Louisiana​Inter-​Tribal​Council​in​Clifton​in​the​late​ 1990s,​she​noted​that​“one​of​the​new​leaders​or​council​members​or​someIndians and Blacks 189

thing,​he​looked​just​like​a​perfect​old​Choctaw​Indian​man​would​look​like,​ you​know,​just​Indian.​I​mean,​he’s​Indian.”​She​feels​the​same​way​about​ other​ state-​recognized​ tribes,​ acknowledging​ that​ some​ members​ clearly​ have​Indian​ancestry​but​withholding​support​for​their​federal​recognition.​ If​the​community​as​a​whole​could​demonstrate​more​social,​cultural,​and,​ frankly,​racial​markers​of​Indian​identity,​they​would​seem​more​like​a​cohesive​Indian​community​to​her,​one​that​could​be​classified​as​a​tribe. ​ A​Jena​Choctaw​elder​adds​that​it​is​unfair​to​withhold​recognition​from​ the​“real”​Indians​at​places​like​Clifton​and​Houma,​but​by​the​same​token​ it​would​be​unfair​to​recognize​non-​Indians​with​them.​Her​definition​of​ what​constitutes​a​real​Indian​is​not​terribly​complex—she​believes​anyone​ who​can​trace​their​genealogy​back​to​any​documented​Indian​can​be​a​real​ Indian.​Any​relation​is​real,​she​says,​and​that​ancestry​cannot​be​cut​off​or​ erased.​ While​ she​ was​ a​ full​ blood,​ her​ tribe’s​ minimum​ blood​ quantum​ is​one-​eighth,​and​she​believed​that​would​change​soon​since​most​of​the​ young​people​were​marrying​whites​at​the​time.​The​Clifton-​Choctaws​may​ meet​her​standards​for​tribal​recognition​if​they​can​document​that​they​all​ have​at​least​one​Indian​ancestor. ​ Another​ Jena​ Choctaw​ leader​ believes​ the​ Clifton-​Choctaws​ have​ no​ Indian​ ancestry​ at​ all​ and​ should​ have​ their​ state​ recognition​ revoked.​ His​opinion​relies​on—and​contributed​to—a​genealogical​argument​that​ erupted​in​1988​between​the​Clifton-​Choctaws​and​Mary​Carter,​a​specialist​ in​Indian​genealogy​who​worked​for​both​Jena​and​Clifton.16​Carter​concluded,​after​researching​Clifton​genealogy​for​six​months,​that​the​Clifton-​ Choctaws​were​not​Indians​but​“really”​blacks​with​some​Indian​ancestry.​ Apparently​after​arguing​with​the​spouse​of​the​Clifton​tribal​chair​in​1988,​ Carter​went​to​the​newspapers​with​her​“revelation,”​leading​to​articles​that​ publicly​declared​them​non-​Indian​poseurs.​One​Jena​Choctaw​leader​described​the​articles​as​being​horrible.​The​articles​were​supposed​to​say​that​ the​Clifton-​Choctaws​were​primarily​mixed​black​and​white​with​only​a​little​ Indian​ancestry,​but​that​finding,​the​Jena​Choctaw​leader​contends,​ended​ up​being​distorted​to​say​that​they​were​not​Indian​at​all.17 ​ During​another​formal​interview​with​Maria​Dixon,​I​asked​her​about​ accusations​made​in​those​articles​that​the​Cliftons​were​really​black​and​not​ Indian​at​all.​She​bristled:​“Mary​Carter​came​up​with​that,​who​also​worked​ for​the​tribe.​As​a​matter​of​fact,​she’s​the​one​that​started​training​me​to​do​ genealogy.​And​she​and​[a​former​recognition​coordinator]​got​in​it​about​ something,​I​don’t​really​know.​And​next​thing​we​knew,​she​did​have​two​ 190 brian​KlopoteK

articles​ in​the​paper​about​ it.​.​.​.​I​would​ put​ it​this​ way.​We​have​ documented​our​Indian​ancestry.​Now,​whether—and​I’m​not​going​to​say​there’s​ no​black​blood​in​the​tribe,​because​quite​a​few​people​in​the​community​are​ triracial.​But​the​majority​are—I​mean,​it​all​goes​back​to​Native​Americans.​ We​have​been​able​to​document​that.​And​I​really​don’t​think​there’s​a​tribe​ in​Louisiana​that​can​say​that​they​did​not​have​maybe​a​drop​of​black​blood​ or​Caucasian​or​anything​else​within​them.” ​ Members​of​the​Clifton-​Choctaw​community​who​appear​to​have​black​ ancestry,​people​such​as​Dixon,​bear​a​unique​burden​in​being​discriminated​ against​within​the​tribe,​within​their​families.​Doubts​about​tribal​authenticity​that​are​linked​to​accusations​of​blackness​are​placed​on​their​shoulders​ or,​ more​ accurately,​ on​ their​ faces.​ This​ situation​ presents​ an​ ethical​ and​scholarly​dilemma:​how​do​I​encourage​Clifton-​Choctaws​to​embrace​ or​at​least​acknowledge​black​ancestry​in​their​community​when​there​is​a​ strong​sentiment​in​the​community​to​deny​it​altogether?​I​contend​that​it​ would​help​their​recognition​case​if​they​dealt​with​their​black​ancestry​directly;​ skirting​ around​ it​ gives​ the​ impression​ they​ are​ trying​ to​ hide​ the​ truth,​never​a​productive​stance​in​the​acknowledgment​process.​It​would​ also​help​ease​their​sense​of​shame​over​the​issue​and​take​some​of​the​burden​off​phenotypically​black​tribal​members.​What​is​my​responsibility​as​a​ Louisiana​Choctaw​researcher​to​this​other​Louisiana​Choctaw​community,​ of​which​I​am​not​a​member​but​with​whom​I​share​Choctaw​heritage?​How​ do​I​implement​the​supportive,​collaborative​model​of​indigenous​methodologies​without​undermining​my​personal​responsibilities​as​a​racial​activist?​If​the​Clifton-​Choctaws​know​that​talking​about​African​ancestry​in​the​ community​has​caused​them​problems​in​the​past,​I​am​putting​myself​in​a​ position​of​betraying​their​trust​and​saying​that​I​know​better​than​they​do​ about​how​and​when​to​talk​about​these​things. ​ Cornel​Pewewardy,​in​grappling​with​his​own​role​as​an​indigenous​person​within​the​academy,​similarly​concludes​that​“sometimes​we​(as​Indigenous​scholars)​have​to​redefine​our​roles​as​scholars​in​academe​to​become​ involved​as​facilitators​and​informants​in​the​process​of​tribal​community​ empowerment.​To​take​on​the​role​of​facilitator​is​to​deny​my​own​activism.​ I​must​recognize​that​my​own​liberation​and​emancipation​in​relationship​ with​my​tribal​community​are​at​stake,​and​that​continued​marginalization​ and​subjugation​are​the​perils”​(Pewewardy​2004,​14).​It​is​in​that​spirit​of​ activism​for​the​liberation​of​my​people,​of​Indian​people,​from​white​supremacy​that​I​move​forward​with​this​discussion. Indians and Blacks 191

​ In​Ties that Bind: The Story of an Afro-Cherokee Family in Slavery and Freedom,​Tiya​Miles​notes​that​various​individuals,​black​and​Indian,​discouraged​her​from​discussing​the​history​of​Cherokee​slaveholding​and​of​ Cherokees​as​colonized​and​colonizing​subjects.​The​desire​to​“disremember”​these​painful​shared​histories​among​communities​of​color​is​entangled​ with​contemporary​desires​and​anxieties​about​imagined​histories​of​“natural​affinity”​or​“natural​animosity”​among​communities​of​color,​the​ways​ we​construct​race​and​righteousness,​the​ways​we​draw​connections​or​construct​boundaries.​But​there​is​a​story​to​tell,​even​if​it​is​“not​a​story​to​pass​ on,”​not​a​story​anyone​wants​to​remember​or​address​publicly.18​However,​ as​Miles​wrote,​drawing​on​the​theoretical​underpinnings​of​Toni​Morrison’s​Beloved,​“The​void​that​remains​when​we​refuse​to​speak​of​the​past​is​ in​fact​a​presence,​a​presence​both​haunting​and​destructive.”19​When​we​examine​these​histories,​we​gain​knowledge​that​opens​ways​to​work​through​ the​theoretical​and​emotional​conflicts​inherent​in​the​subject.​If​I​thought​ this​conversation​had​no​implications​across​Indian​Country,​I​would​not​ address​it​in​this​public​forum,​but​we​need​healing​and​redemption​around​ this​issue.​And​we​need​decolonization. ​ We​are​dynamic​people,​and​we​have​the​power​to​change​and​adapt​our​ strategies​as​new​information​comes​to​light.​When​we​understand​that​the​ ideology​of​white​supremacy​performs​multiple​tasks,​diverting​multiple​resources​away​from​oppressed​groups​and​toward​whites​through​multiple​ kinds​of​behavior,​we​can​see​more​clearly​that​antiblack​racism,​when​performed​by​Indians,​confirms​a​racial​formation​that​places​whites​at​the​top​ of​a​racial​hierarchy.20​Such​an​ideology​hardly​seems​to​be​in​the​best​interests​ of​ Indians,​ especially​ when​ we​ connect​ it​ to​ the​ “cultural​ bomb”​ described​by​Ngugi​wa​Thiong’o​as​the​most​devastating​weapon​of​the​colonial​project.​Its​effect,​he​writes,​“is​to​annihilate​a​people’s​belief​in​their​ names,​in​their​languages,​in​their​environment,​in​their​heritage​of​struggle,​ in​their​unity,​in​their​capacities​and​ultimately​in​themselves.”21​Rather​than​ pathologizing​Indians,​we​need​to​recognize​the​source​of​Indian​antiblack​ racism​within​a​broader​colonial​project​and​acknowledge​its​hidden​impact​ not​only​on​Indian​resources,​but​also​on​Indian​senses​of​self. ​ In​ terms​ of​ the​ scholarly​ dilemma,​ the​ double​ meaning​ in​ the​ title​ of​ Linda​Tuhiwai​Smith’s​foundational​book,​Decolonizing Methodologies,​clarifies​and​justifies​the​role​of​scholarly​activism​in​a​case​such​as​this​(1999).​ First,​it​speaks​of​creating​methodologies​that​do​not​perpetuate​colonial​ practices​of​exploitation​and​assimilation,​that​is,​methodologies​that​have​ 192 brian​KlopoteK

been​decolonized.​Second,​it​is​about​pursuing​decolonization​as​a​goal​that​ can​be​achieved​through​methodologies​designed​for​the​task,​that​is,​it​is​ about​decolonizing​indigenous​peoples​through​specific​methodologies.​The​ second​definition​motivates​my​decision​to​have​this​conversation​in​this​ essay:​a​desire​to​decolonize​minds​and​illustrate​the​ways​in​which​antiblack​ racism​supports​a​white​supremacist​racial​formation.22​White​supremacy​ clearly​ does​ not​ support​ indigenous​ people.​ Its​ pathology​ is​ well​ known,​ but,​in​the​absence​of​a​more​inclusive​understanding​of​how​race​works,​ we​do​not​always​see​whom​it​infects​and​how.​Racial​theory​and​racial​histories​help​us​rethink​indigenous​studies,​indigenous​methodologies,​and​ the​collaborative​process​to​better​serve​indigenous​communities.​Decolonizing​can​be​dangerous,​but​that​moment​of​danger​is​also​a​moment​of​ ​opportunity.

Notes ​ 1.​Linda​Tuhiwai​Smith​is​often​credited​with​developing​this​field​as​an​area​of​focused​study​through​her​book​Decolonizing Methodologies: Research and Indigenous Peoples​(1999).​Her​work​draws​on​and​builds​upon​many​traditional​critiques​of​the​ relationship​of​the​academy​to​subaltern​groups,​including​the​work​of​scholars​in​ postcolonial​studies​and​Native​American​studies​as​well​as​the​writings​of​feminist​ women​of​color,​feminist​anthropologists,​and​postmodernists.​Generally,​see​Vine​ Deloria,​Jr.,​Custer Died for Your Sins: An Indian Manifesto,​(1988,​78–100);​Lila​Abu-​ Lughod,​“Writing​Against​Culture”​(1991,​137–62);​Edward​Said,​Orientalism​(1978);​ Ngugi​wa​Thiong’o,​Decolonising the Mind​(1986);​Frantz​Fanon,​The Wretched of the Earth​(2004);​Nannerl​O.​Keohane,​Michelle​Z.​Rosaldo,​and​Barbara​C.​Gelpi,​eds.,​ Feminist Theory​(1982). ​ 2.​Deloria​critiques​the​“conceptual​prison”​created​for​Indians​by​anthropologists​ through​notions​of​authenticity​in​his​foundational​work​of​1969​(1988).​Paige​Raibmon​offers​a​useful​history​of​the​development​of​the​concept​of​authenticity​and​its​ impact​on​indigenous​peoples​in​Authentic Indians: Episodes of Encounter from the Late-Nineteenth-Century Northwest Coast​(2005).​Abu-​Lughod​argues​the​merits​of​ “ethnography​of​the​particular”​as​a​way​of​avoiding​the​flattening​tendency​of​cultural​theory​(1991). ​ 3.​Any​Indian​person​in​Virginia​who​had​more​than​one-​quarter​African​blood​ (later​one-​sixteenth)​would​be​classified​as​colored​and​have​access​to​fewer​rights​ and​ resources​ than​ those​ classified​ as​ Indians,​ people​ who​ had​ more​ than​ one-​ quarter​Indian​blood​(later​one-​sixteenth)​(Rountree​1990,​200,​211). ​ 4.​On​Cherokees,​see​Sturm​(1998)​and​Miles​(2004).​On​Creeks,​see​Saunt​(2005).​ Generally,​see​Miles​and​Holland​(2006);​Brooks​(2002). Indians and Blacks 193

​ 5.​“Maria​Dixon”​is​a​pseudonym. ​ 6.​A​close​reading​of​this​statement​would​note​her​use​of​the​word​they​to​refer​to​ the​Clifton​community,​when​it​would​seem​more​appropriate​for​her​to​use​we.​This​ seems​like​evidence​of​discomfort​in​including​herself​in​that​opinion​by​saying​“we​ trust​whites​more​than​we​trust​blacks.”​But​it​also​seems​to​be​a​long-​standing​reflex​ to​distance​the​community​“on​the​whole”​from​blacks​and​blackness​even​though​ she​is​unwilling​to​ally​herself​with​such​thinking. ​ 7.​(Mills​1977,​xiv).​Lalita​Tademy,​a​Cane​River​Creole​herself,​wrote​a​bestselling​ novel​and​Oprah’s​Book​Club​selection​about​her​people,​giving​perhaps​the​most​ visible​moment​in​recent​Cane​River​history​(Tademy​2002). ​ 8.​While​typically​the​term​white supremacy​conjures​images​of​Klan​robes​and​ neo-​Nazi​skinheads,​the​term​as​it​is​used​in​contemporary​ethnic​studies​also​refers​ to​the​everyday​ideology​of​white​racial​superiority​and​domination​carried​even​by​ people​who​do​not​consider​themselves​racist​and​even​by​people​of​color.​For​a​general​discussion​of​white​racial​ideology​and​material​advantages​in​the​United​States,​ see​Rothenberg​(2002)​and​Lipsitz​(1998). ​ 9.​Neil​Foley​draws​heavily​on​Toni​Morrison’s​ideas​about​southern​European​ immigrants​becoming​white​in​the​United​States​by​demonstrating​their​hatred​of​ blacks​as​he​grapples​with​similar​racial​formation​issues​in​Mexican-​American​integration​activism​in​Texas​in​the​1930s​(2002,​49–59). ​ 10.​Susan​Greenbaum​adeptly​and​precisely​addresses​this​matter,​though​others​ have​addressed​it​elsewhere​(Greenbaum​1991;​Paschal​1991;​Starna​1996;​Campisi​ 1991;​Clifford​1988).​A​number​of​significant​contributions​can​be​found​in​Miles​and​ Holland​(2006)​and​in​Brooks​(2002). ​ 11.​Circe​Sturm​discusses​this​issue​(Sturm​1998). ​ 12.​The​Census​of​1910,​Rapides​Parish,​Louisiana,​lists​many​Clifton,​Tyler,​and​ Smith​families​as​mulatto.​This​is​not​a​complete,​diagnostic​genealogical​connection,​ but​obviously​these​are​the​ancestors​of​at​least​some​of​the​modern​Clifton​families. ​ 13.​See​also​Williams​(1979). ​ 14.​ United​ States​ Census​ Bureau​ 2002,​ 56:​ “Proportions​ of​ Indian​ and​ other​ blood.—If​the​Indian​is​a​full-​blood,​write​‘full’​in​column​36,​and​leave​columns​37​ and​38​blank.​If​the​Indian​is​of​mixed​blood,​write​in​column​36,​37,​and​38​the​fractions​which​show​the​proportions​of​Indian​and​other​blood,​as​(column​36,​Indian)​ 3/4,​(column​37,​white)​1/4,​and​(column​38,​negro)​0.​For​Indians​of​mixed​blood​all​ three​columns​should​be​filled,​and​the​sum,​in​each​case,​should​equal​1,​as​1/2,​0,​1/2;​ 3/4,​1/4,​0;​3/4,​1/8,​1/8;​etc.​Wherever​possible,​the​statement​that​an​Indian​is​of​full​blood​ should​be​verified​by​inquiry​of​the​older​men​of​the​tribe,​as​an​Indian​is​sometimes​ of​mixed​blood​without​knowing​it.” ​ 15.​A.​C.​Hector​to​W.​Carson​Ryan,​Jr.,​12​September​1934,​file​68776-​1931-​800,​ part​I,​National​Archives​Record​Group​75. ​ 16.​“Mary​Carter”​is​a​pseudonym. 194 brian​KlopoteK

​ 17.​“La.​Tribe​Fights​to​Prove​Its​Heritage,”​Times-Picayune,​14​August​1988,​C8. ​ 18.​Miles​(2004,​xv),​citing​Morrison​(1987,​274–75). ​ 19.​ Miles​ (2004,​ xvi).​ Miles​ and​ many​ others​ witnessed​ the​ calamity​ and​ pain​ of​this​ghostly​presence​at​a​conference​on​black–Indian​relations​she​organized​at​ Dartmouth​in​1998​called​“‘Eating​Out​of​the​Same​Pot’:​Relating​Black​and​Native​ (Hi)stories.”​Several​pieces​have​been​written​about​the​dramatic​conflicts​that​surfaced​throughout:​Phillips​(2002);​Saunt​(2005,​6–9);​Tiya​Miles,​“Preface:​Eating​ Out​of​the​Same​Pot?,”​in​Miles​and​Holland​(2006);​Warrior,​“Afterword,”​in​Miles​ and​Holland​(2006). ​ 20.​George​Lipsitz​suggests​the​value​of​this​formulation​in​his​work​(1998). ​ 21.​Thiong’o​(1986,​3),​cited​in​Silva​(2004,​2). ​ 22.​Following​Omi​and​Winant’s​definition​of​racial​formation​as​“the​sociohistorical​process​by​which​racial​categories​are​created,​inhabited,​transformed,​and​destroyed,”​and​a​racial​project​as​“simultaneously​an​interpretation,​representation,​or​ explanation​of​racial​dynamics,​and​an​effort​to​reorganize​and​redistribute​resources​ along​particular​racial​lines”​(1994,​55–56).

Indians and Blacks 195

eDgar esquit

Nationalist​Contradictions Pan-Mayanism, Representations of the Past, and the Reproduction of Inequalities in Guatemala

For​ over​ three​ decades​ the​ Maya​ peoples​ of​ Guatemala​ have​ been​ transforming​the​ways​in​which​they​struggle​against​continuing​colonial​power​ relations​in​the​country.​Local​processes​of​protest​are​now​accompanied​by​ protests​with​a​national​character​that​challenge​not​only​the​state,​but​also​ other​dominant​ideologies,​like​patriarchy,​Protestant​and​Catholic​visions,​ and​certain​popular​constructions​of​history​and​identity.​Now,​new​discussions​about​the​Maya’s​national​position​occur​between​different​actors​and​ across​opposing​spaces.​According​to​these​analysts’​different​conceptions,​ the​so-​called​pan-​Mayanist​or​Mayan​movement​is​engaged​in​a​complex​ process​of​defining​demands,​discourses,​ideological​constructions,​diverse​ forms​of​political​struggle,​new​relationships​of​power,​and​the​construction​ of​other​identities​(Warren​1998;​Fischer​2001;​Cojtí​Cuxil​1991;​Bastos​and​ Camus​2003).​As​this​movement​progresses,​contradictions​have​emerged​ in​relation​to​demands,​representativeness,​the​conformation​of​intellectual​ elites,​and​ways​of​imagining​the​past. ​ In​this​essay​I​delineate​relevant​aspects​of​the​Maya​political​movement,​ principally​the​reconstruction​of​history​and​its​link​to​the​present.​The​Maya​ political​ movement​ is​ primarily​ guided​ by​ an​ intelligentsia​ that​ produces​ and​adopts​a​series​of​organizing​and​discursive​ideological​definitions​and​ strategies​about​the​struggle​in​which​it​is​engaged.​These​leaders,​linked​to​ debates​on​human​rights,​religion,​education,​languages,​Maya​rights,​and​ racism,​belong​to​different​organizations​that​get​reorganized​during​each​ crisis​the​movement​suffers.​They​generate​a​series​of​ideas​and​images​about​ the​Maya​past​with​the​double​aim​of​pinning​down​the​idea​of​the​Maya​

people​(Maya​unity)​and​challenging​the​exclusionary​makeup​of​the​Guatemalan​nation-​state. ​ The​general​questions​guiding​the​essay​can​be​stated​as​follows:​In​what​ way​ does​ this​ emerging​ sector​ of​ educated​ Maya​ delimit​ a​ new​ narrative​ about​the​past?​How​is​this​narrative​linked​to​the​definition​of​new​identities​and​the​formation​of​unexpected​power​relations?​Being​a​Maya​and​a​ researcher,​I​am​personally​involved​in​this​process​of​constructing​imaginaries​(imaginarios)​about​the​past. ​ We​understand​the​notion​of​Maya​as​both​a​construct​that​evolved​as​ the​Maya​movement​developed​and​as​a​tool​for​defining​the​ethnic​identity​ of​those​who​up​to​now​have​been​called​indigenous,​Indians,​or​aboriginals​ (naturales).​ This​ definition​ acknowledges​ the​ contradictions​ and​ political​ differences​that​Maya​individuals​encounter​as​they​appropriate​other​identities.​The​Mayanists,​as​they​are​defined​in​this​essay,​are​the​people​and​ institutions​that​openly​promote​Maya​political​rights​and​recover​a​culturalist​definition​of​their​own​past.​They​do​so​with​the​purpose​of​assigning​ meaning​and​giving​historical​support​to​the​notion​of​Maya​peoples​and​ multiculturalism. ​ Finally,​since​I​will​be​speaking​about​the​colonial​forms​of​power​relations​in​Guatemala,​I​consider​how​some​of​the​Maya​movement’s​intellectuals​have​characterized​the​concept​of​colonialism.​Some​of​them​define​ colonialism​in​relation​to​the​Guatemalan​state​and​ladinos,​affirming​that​ only​one​community,​the​ladino,​currently​controls​the​state.1​They​assert​ that​ladinos​instrumentalize​the​state​to​control​and​limit​the​development​ of​subordinate​indigenous​nations.​According​to​these​intellectuals,​Guatemala​is​a​colonial​state​that​manifests​an​internal​colonialism​in​which​one​ national​group​oppresses​others​within​the​same​environment​(Cojtí​Cuxil​ 1989,​140–41). ​ Demetrio​ Rodríguez​ posits​ that​ colonialism,​ by​definition,​ starts​ from​ the​political​domination,​economic​exploitation,​and​cultural​and​linguistic​ assimilation​of​one​people​over​another​and​involves​diverse​historical​conditions​ like​ invasion,​ conquest,​ or​ annexation​ (Rodríguez​ 2004,​ 46).​ Following​the​same​line​of​thought,​Demetrio​Cojtí​proposes​that​colonialism​ is​a​doctrine​that​legitimizes​one​people’s​domination​over​another​and​employs​ various​ arguments​ to​ justify​ Maya​ subordination​ (Cojtí​ Cuxil​ 1995,​ 148).​These​notions​attempt​to​explain​the​political​relations​between​indigenous​peoples​and​ladinos​in​Guatemala,​understanding​the​latter​as​almost​ homogeneous​entities. Nationalist Contradictions 197

​ Colonial​relations,​however,​are​highly​complex​and​must​be​observed​ at​different​moments​and​in​specific​spaces.​Colonialism​traverses​relations​ between​social​sectors,​genders,​classes,​regions​and​localities,​institutions,​ and​diverse​organizations.​In​this​case,​one​can​talk​about​the​colonial​shape​ of​power​relations​in​Guatemala,​where​class​relations​are​strongly​tied​to​ society’s​ethnic​makeup,​establishing​a​racial​hierarchy​that​acts​as​the​basis​ for​exchange​among​social​groups.2

Imagining New Histories In​their​article​“The​Maya​Workshop​of​Hieroglyphic​Writing”​Linda​Schele​ and​ Nikolai​ Grube​ describe​ a​ series​ of​ activities​ related​ to​ teaching​ and​ learning​the​Mayas’​ancient​writing​that​they​and​other​epigraphists​developed​together​with​a​group​of​Maya​activists​and​intellectuals​(1999).​The​ authors​note​that​some​Maya​intellectuals​requested​that​they​carry​out​different​workshops​from​1987​to​1995.​The​workshops​took​place​in​the​city​of​ Antigua​and​in​archeological​sites​like​Tikal,​Copán,​and​Iximché​as​well​as​ in​certain​municipalities​and​smaller​localities​like​San​Andrés​Semetabaj​ in​the​department​of​Sololá.​Attendees​at​these​activities​included​Mayas​ linked​with​organizations​dedicated​to​strengthening​and​studying​indigenous​languages,​professionals​in​linguistic​fields,​and​people​with​less​formal​ academic​and​professional​training​in​these​fields. ​ According​ to​ the​ authors,​ the​ Mayas​ who​ participated​ in​ these​ events​ showed​a​great​deal​of​interest​in​the​writings’​meanings​and​were​very​creative​when​comparing​the​interpretations​the​specialists​proposed​with​those​ that​were​recognized​in​their​mother​tongues.​The​participants​were​keenly​ interested​in​studying​the​glyphs​in​order​to​understand​ancient​Maya​history​and​particularly​Maya​cultural​development.​Schele​and​Grube​propose​ that​the​workshop​on​the​classical​period’s​story​of​creation​was​one​of​the​ most​meaningful​because​it​related​directly​to​religious,​social,​ritual,​and​ agricultural​practices​of​the​modern​Maya.​According​to​the​authors,​the​ participants’​reactions​and​conversations​over​the​following​year​suggest​that​ the​information​extracted​from​the​epigraphic​texts​created​strong​ties​between​contemporary​experience​and​the​ancient​pre-​Colombian​past​(Schele​ and​Grube​1999). ​ In​addition​to​the​workshops​in​Guatemala,​Schele​and​Grube​developed​ a​workshop​in​Mérida,​Mexico,​attended​by​a​sizable​number​of​Yukateco​

198 eDgar​esquit

speakers.​During​the​final​event,​held​at​the​ruins​of​Chichén-​Itzá,​a​participant​named​Kokom​affirmed​that​on​his​previous​visits​to​the​ruins​he​ had​not​taken​the​glyphs​and​their​meanings​into​account.​Yet​on​this​occasion​he​had​noticed​that​his​last​name​was​written​in​the​glyphs.​The​authors​ think​it​is​important​that​the​Yucatekan​and​Guatemalan​Maya​meet​in​the​ future​ to​ share​ their​ knowledge.​ This​ and​ other​ experiences​ led​ different​ Guatemalan​organizations​to​use​the​glyphs​in​new​ways​to​support​sharing​ their​newfound​knowledge​and​newly​recognized​history.​By​participating​ in​similar​workshops,​other​Maya​took​this​newfound​knowledge​to​their​ communities​of​origin,​such​as​Chimaltenango,​Cobán,​Palín,​and​Tecpán,​ and​shared​it​with​community​members.​The​authors​propose​that​this​represented​the​transfer​and​dissemination​of​a​system​of​teaching​and​writing​ into​Maya​hands. ​ Kay​Warren​wrote​an​article​about​a​weeklong​workshop​developed​in​ 1992​by​a​group​of​Kaqchikel​linguists.​The​participants​studied​the​book​ Annals of the Kaqchikels,​a​work​written​by​Kaqchikel​authorities​(principales)​during​the​colonial​era​(Warren​1999).​Warren​explains​that​the​participating​linguists​had​taken​part​in​other​community​education​projects​ and​had​developed​a​series​of​activities​and,​later,​published​extracts​of​the​ book,​which​were​used​as​material​in​informal​educational​programs.​Warren​ argues​ that​ Maya​ culturalists​ see​ these​ ancient​ texts​ as​ both​ vital​ resources​for​learning​about​the​past​and​fundamental​guides​for​contemporary​projects. ​ According​to​Warren,​the​participants​believed​the​study​of​the​ancient​ texts​ could​ reveal​ that​ Kaqchikels​ have​ a​ unique​ origin.​ However,​ some​ of​the​participants​thought​this​revision​was​not​necessarily​an​argument​ against​official​history,​but​a​search​for​the​truths​that​have​not​been​completely​ understood.​ Citing​ another​ participant​ in​ the​ workshop,​ Warren​ highlights​new​perspectives​on​the​ancient​texts.​Some​Maya​activists,​she​ says,​think​this​book​describes​official​Maya​history.​In​other​words,​they​see​ the​book​as​a​retelling​of​Maya​origins,​cosmology​(cosmogonía),​and​experiences​with​the​European​invasion​as​well​as​of​the​genealogical​continuity​of​ one​of​Guatemala’s​most​important​peoples. ​ Warren’s​text​proposes​that​the​culturalists​argue​heatedly​among​themselves​as​they​try​to​strip​Maya​cosmovision​of​its​contact​with​European​ religions,​other​ideologies,​and​intentional​manipulations.​The​new​readings​ of​certain​parts​of​the​text​are​counterposed​to​traditional​ones​made​by​na-

Nationalist Contradictions 199

tional​and​foreign​scholars​in​relation​to,​for​example,​the​arrival​of​the​Spanish​and​the​ensuing​armed​struggle.​In​their​eagerness​to​imagine​continuity​ in​Maya​descent,​culture,​and​languages,​Maya​activists​face​the​challenge​of​ confronting​official​histories​that​talk​about​conquest​and​assimilation​(Warren​1999). ​ The​texts​I​have​cited​show​some​of​the​activities​Mayanists​are​engaging​in​to​recover​and​define​another​representation​of​their​past.​This​interest,​however,​is​not​recent.​The​effort​to​develop​a​new​perspective​on​the​ Maya​past​and​present​likely​has​its​origins​in​these​individuals’​first​attempts​ to​study​their​mother​tongues.​In​the​mid-​twentieth​century​Adrián​Inés​ Chávez,​an​eminent​K’iche​intellectual,​organized​congresses​of​Maya​educators​to​discuss​topics​related​to​languages.​Since​then,​Chávez​has​posited​ the​need​to​establish​truly​indigenous​symbols​to​write​K’iche,​while​emphasizing​linguistic​and​cultural​unity​(Fischer​1990,​90).​In​1979,​he​translated​ and​published​the​Pop​Wuj​(Popol​Vuh)​into​graphics​that​laid​out​a​new​ alphabet​exclusively​for​this​language​(Chávez​2001). ​ In​the​1980s​and​1990s​Maya​intellectuals​began​shaping​a​new​content​ and​ meaning​ of​ Maya​ history​ by​ organizing​ activities​ such​ as​ meetings,​ workshops,​ and​seminars​as​well​as​by​editing​bibliographic​ and​didactic​ material.​They​produced​a​number​of​important​texts​on​this​issue,​for​example,​those​by​Víctor​Racancoj​(1994),​Raxche’​Demetrio​Rodríguez​(1995),​ Demetrio​ Cojtí​ Cuxil​ (1991,​ 1995),​ and​ Víctor​ Montejo​ (1997).​ Important​ Maya​leaders​and​investors​founded​a​press​that​reprinted​books​by​national​ and​foreign​authors,​among​them​Robert​Carmack,​Carlos​Guzmán​Böckler​and​Jean-​Loup​Herbert,​and​Robert​M.​Hill,​that​analyze​the​history​of​ the​Maya.3​Currently,​various​institutions​are​also​editing​popular​texts,​including​children’s​stories​that​evoke​the​Maya​past.​Many​people​are​putting​ a​great​deal​of​effort​into​building​new​ways​of​representing​and​analyzing​ Maya​history. ​ These​representations​can​be​synthesized​as​the​construction​of​a​historical​base,​which​recognizes​the​principles​that​unite​the​actions​and​knowledge​of​the​ancient​Maya​with​those​that​nourish​the​contemporary​Maya.​ By​examining​these​sorts​of​ancient​texts​as​well​as​works​by​archeologists,​ anthropologists,​linguists,​and​historians,​Mayanists​try​to​rebuild​a​version​ of​their​past​that​specifies​the​particularity​or​essentiality​of​Maya​culture.​ They​also​attempt​to​reconstruct​the​history​of​resistance​and​leadership​that​ they​believe​can​have​an​important​role​in​thinking​about​and​imagining​resistance​today. 200 eDgar​esquit

​ Mayanists​look​to​contribute​to​a​definition​of​Maya​unity​with​this​new​ historical​narrative.​Through​these​efforts​they​affirm​that​we​Maya​share​ common​ancestors​who​bequeathed​us​a​common​culture​and​languages​of​ origin​that​we​need​to​protect.​We​Maya​participate​in​a​specific​way​of​looking​at​the​world​and​at​ourselves,​recognizing​that​all​Maya​intellectuals​have​ shared​a​similar​adversity​since​1524—an​adversity​Maya​intellectuals​have​ defined​as​internal​colonialism.4 ​ The​new​historical​narrative​feeding​the​pan-​Mayanist​movement’s​political​struggle​has​defined​dates​and​periods​of​historic​succession,​tracing​the​ greatness​and​catastrophes​lived​and​suffered​by​the​Maya​people.​Now,​we​ could​say​that​as​a​people​we​probably​have​a​date​of​birth​(some​five​thousand​years​ago)​and​of​growth,​something​that​until​just​a​few​decades​ago​ was​not​defined​in​the​historical​narratives​that​our​parents,​grandparents,​ elders​in​general,​and​the​leaders​and​community​guides​presented​to​us.​In​ different​ways​this​new​historic​Mayanist​imaginary​is​expressed​as​the​real​ Maya​history​that​reveals​a​past​hidden​or​distorted​by​official​history.​These​ discourses​form​the​notion​of​the​Maya​people​and​are​tied​to​the​speeches​ about​multiculturalism​that​are​generated​by​Mayanist​intellectuals​and​their​ organizations​as​well​as​by​the​state. ​ This​way​of​evoking​the​past​represents​an​important​break​in​the​Maya​ imaginary​and​in​the​ways​they​are​recreating​themselves​to​build​and​confront​their​own​present​and​that​of​Guatemala.​This​narrative​generates​pride​ among​those​familiar​with​it,​primarily​Mayanists.​Maya​individuals,​for​example,​can​make​reference​to​their​millenarian​past​when​they​present​their​ demands​to​the​government,​just​as​they​can​cite​their​history​of​greatness​ when​they​appear​in​public,​attend​universities,​or​talk​on​national​and​international​stages. ​ Maya​educators​who​are​directing​schools​known​as​Maya​schools​are​ teaching​children​this​new​way​of​understanding​the​past.​Here,​the​ancient​ Maya​are​not​seen​as​a​civilization​of​great​inventors​who​disappeared​before​the​arrival​of​the​Spanish,​as​the​state​schools​taught​and​continue​to​ teach.​Instead,​teachers​instruct​students​that​they​are​the​grandchildren​of​ Maya​ancestors​who​created​a​great​civilization,​as​evidenced​in​architecture,​ mathematical​advances,​and​hieroglyphic​writing,​in​the​artistic​creations​ found​in​our​sacred​centers​and​in​our​ancient​books,​as​well​as​in​our​restored​political​and​religious​ceremonies.​In​addition,​some​community​histories​and​histories​of​municipalities​with​a​Maya​majority​incorporate​this​ way​of​viewing​the​past. Nationalist Contradictions 201

Educated Maya and Narratives about the Past It​is​primarily​one​sector​of​educated​Maya​who​construct​and​evoke​this​ new​narrative.​From​Chávez​in​the​middle​of​the​twentieth​century​to​Montejo​at​the​start​of​the​twenty-​first​century,​what​characterizes​these​historical​ narrators​is​their​professional​formation.5​In​this​case,​the​new​imaginary​or​ historical​representation​is​generated​not​only​from​communities’​oral​tradition,​but​also​(and​more​extensively)​from​other​knowledges​acquired​as​ a​result​of​close​contact​with​schools,​organizations,​and​other​worlds,​from​ Western​or​ladino​to​North​American. ​ Since​the​1960s,​a​sector​of​the​Maya​from​different​communities​entered​ secondary​schools​and​university​(Bastos​and​Camus​2003).​In​subsequent​ decades,​in​spite​of​the​repression​this​population​suffered​in​the​1970s​and​ 1980s,​some​continued​this​trajectory,​adding​to​the​number​of​Maya​who​ have​graduated​from​secondary​school​and​university.​These​well-​educated​ Maya​assumed​other​identities​that​partly​contrasted​with​those​of​uneducated​(iletrados)​Maya,​men​and​women​who​cultivate​the​earth​and​maintain​a​subsistence​economy.6​Those​identities​also​contrast​with​those​of​the​ ladinos​with​whom​they​had​lived​in​their​communities​as​well​as​with​those​ of​colleagues​in​schools​and​workplaces​(Sincal​Coyote​2004). ​ This​tradition​of​education​since​the​1960s​was​most​evident​among​the​ Kaqchikels​and​K’iche,​but​similar​processes​can​be​observed​in​other​ethnic​ groups.​ An​ exemplary​ case​ is​ that​ of​ the​ Comalapa​ municipality,​ located​ in​the​central​department​of​Chimaltenango,​where​the​majority​of​the​inhabitants​ are​ Kaqchikels.​ From​ the​ beginning​ of​ the​ twentieth​ century​ a​ small​group​of​distinguished​families​characterized​by​their​status​as​intermediaries,​their​economic​resources,​and​their​capacity​for​political​negotiation,​began​to​implement​a​series​of​transformations​ at​the​productive​ level,​in​political​participation,​and​in​the​educational​formation​of​some​of​ their​young​members.​In​the​1920s​a​small​group​of​Maya​teachers​from​this​ community​graduated​from​the​country’s​normal​schools.​They​returned​to​ their​community,​where​they​served​as​primary​school​teachers​in​a​school​ founded​by​prominent​families​specifically​for​indigenous​people.​From​the​ 1970s​until​the​present,​the​number​of​professionals​emerging​from​this​municipality​has​increased​significantly.​They​distinguished​themselves​in​several​important​professions.​Many​graduated​as​primary​school​teachers​and​ others​as​accountants,​engineers,​doctors,​lawyers,​linguists,​soldiers,​priests,​ and​administrators.​Many​lived​through​processes​of​cultural​change​and​ 202 eDgar​esquit

economic​ascent​that​transformed​their​ways​of​relating​to​one​another​and​ to​the​people​in​their​communities​who​are​involved​in​agricultural,​artisanal,​and​commercial​activities.​Most​of​these​professionals​continue​differentiating​themselves​from​ladinos,​but​at​the​same​time​they​value​highly​ their​professional​identities​and​their​ties​with​urban​centers​like​the​department​capital,​Chimaltenango,​or​the​country’s​capital,​Guatemala​City.​They​ also​recognize​the​importance​of​their​linguistic,​ideological,​and​nationalist​ connections. ​ These​well-​educated​Maya​now​define​themselves​as​Kaqchikels,​Mayas,​ Chimaltecos,​inhabitants​of​the​capital,​and​as​Guatemalan.​Their​identification​with​liberal​state​ideology​is​prominent​when​they​speak​about​citizenship,​democracy,​the​legal​system,​their​political​participation,​and​human​ rights.​They​have​so​capitalized​on​their​time​and​knowledge​that​they​can​ now​ reject​ so-​called​ traditional​ forms​ of​ cooperation​ and​ ties​ with​ other​ groups​and​peoples​in​Comalapa.​The​remaining​Comalapans,​agriculturalists​and​merchants,​can​simultaneously​reject​or​legitimize​these​new​professional​identities,​thoughts,​and​practices​according​to​the​specific​circumstances. ​ Starting​in​the​1970s​people​from​this​community​with​a​lower​level​of​ education​ began​ participating​ in​ different​ organizational​ bodies,​ such​ as​ Protestant​and​Catholic​churches,​political​parties,​and​guerrilla​groups— although​certainly​some​professionals​did​likewise.​Through​this​participation,​these​less-​educated​Maya​discovered​other​ways​of​living​and​understanding​ their​ communities’​ social​ reality​ and​ thereby​ devised​ their​ own​ ways​of​transforming​the​lives​of​Comalapans​and​of​the​Maya​in​general.​ Other​Comalapans​have​recently​occupied​important​posts​in​the​government,​including​the​National​Congress​and​some​ministries. ​ Some​national​leaders​who​support​Mayanism​are​from​Comalapa​and​ are​members​of​this​professional​sector.7​Together​with​activists​and​intellectuals​from​other​Guatemalan​communities,​principally​Kaqchikels​and​ K’iche,​these​leaders​foster​the​novel​discourse​about​the​Maya​past.​Nevertheless,​at​present​most​of​these​Comalapans​can​simultaneously​resort​to​ discourses​and​political​practices​inherently​tied​to​the​liberal​state’s​ideology.​ On​ the​ basis​ of​ these​ facts​ (paraphrasing​ Dipesh​ Chakrabarty),​ I​ must​still​insist​on​asking,​Who​speaks​in​the​name​of​our​Maya​ancestors​ (Chakrabarty​1999)?​The​answer​is​obviously​not​simple​because​it​requires​ understanding​other​important​facts. ​ Heretofore​the​analysis​of​Guatemala’s​pre-​Hispanic​and​colonial​history​ Nationalist Contradictions 203

has​ been​ in​ the​ hands​ of​ Creoles,​ ladinos,​ and​ foreigners,​ commentators​ who​have​constructed​different​images​about​the​Maya​and​their​past.8​At​ other​moments,​the​state​has​used​this​historiography​and​archeology​to​delineate​a​national​history​that​is​taught​in​schools​and​transmitted​through​ official​ discourses.​ That​ history​ has​ been​ expressed​ in​ racist​ and​ colonial​ terms.​It​fosters​a​vision​of​the​Maya​and​of​indigenous​people​in​general​as​ backward,​childlike​(mozos),​uncivilized​peasants​subject​to​integration​and​ incapable​of​realizing,​to​use​a​contemporary​concept,​development​without​ outside​intervention.9 ​ Despite​ these​ tendencies,​ people​ in​ the​ communities​ continue​ to​ narrate​their​own​histories,​which​are​also​categorized​disdainfully​by​liberal​ and​racist​Guatemalan​ideology.​In​any​case,​Maya​narratives​delineate​and​ construct​images​about​recent​and​remote​ancestors.​In​diverse​ways​these​ histories​ have​ given​ life​ to​ past​ indigenous​ communities,​ to​ their​ identities​and​ways​of​organizing​as​well​as​to​the​conditions​of​resistance​produced​at​different​moments​and​in​distinct​eras​(Florescano​2001).​In​many​ of​ these​ stories​ the​ ancestors​ remembered​ are​ nameless​ and​ the​ dates​ of​ events​are​not​precisely​defined​because​the​stories​simultaneously​relate​to​ the​daily​life​of​listeners​and​narrators.10​Many​Maya​people​in​communities​and​villages​have​never​stopped​sharing​and​listening​to​these​remembrances.​Nevertheless,​these​narratives​do​not​comprise​the​dominant​history.​Even​though​they​form​part​of​the​social​and​ideological​reproduction​ of​the​Maya,​they​do​not​resonate​nationally.​Instead,​other​voices​are​taken​ to​be​the​true​ones,​primarily​Creole​and​ladino​narratives​that​up​to​now​ have​told​us​how​our​past​truly​happened. ​ For​the​past​two​decades​well-​educated​Maya​have​been​telling​their​own​ stories,​talking​about​the​Maya​past​through​the​use​of​westernized​images​ and​narrative​styles.​As​a​rule,​these​new​stories​questioned​the​literary​constructions​of​national​and​foreign​academics​and​of​official​discourses.​For​ some​people,​such​self-​expression​means​that​the​Maya​are​starting​to​take​ their​turn​at​speaking​about​their​past,​and​consequently​the​history​they​ are​telling​now​represents​the​truth​for​them.​Now,​well-​educated​Maya​are​ the​narrators​and​are​often​legitimated​as​such​and​welcomed​by​different​ sectors.​Carmack,​for​example,​affirms​that​great​civilizations​like​the​K’iche​ are​destined​to​influence​the​modern​world​and​that​this​great​culture’s​time​ has​come​inside​Guatemala​and​must​be​welcomed​(Carmack​2001;​see​also​ Warren​1998;​Fischer​2001;​Cojtí​Cuxil​1991;​Bastos​and​Camus​2003;​Fischer​ and​Brown​1999).​These​assertions​raise​many​questions:​Who​receives​us?​ 204 eDgar​esquit

In​what​space​are​we​welcome,​and​why​are​we​appreciated​now​(or​not​until​ now)?​Finally,​if​this​is​the​Maya’s​time,​what​importance​can​a​critique​have​ for​imagining​new​ways​to​giving​meaning​to​the​past?

Elites, Narratives about the Past, and Fragility Even​though​it​has​been​said​that​Mayanists’​new​versions​of​the​past​challenge​official​history,​the​reality​is​not​that​simple.​The​contemporary​Guatemalan​ state​ also​ speaks​ about​ Guatemala’s​ history,​ about​ the​ history​ of​ the​Maya​as​a​people,​and​about​interculturalism.​This​represents​an​apparent​acceptance​of​Mayanist​discourse​and​demands​from​the​four​peoples​ (Maya,​Garífuna,​Xinka,​and​ladino),​their​multiculturalism​and​diversity.11​ The​state​has​thereby​supposedly​accepted​educated​Mayas’​version​of​history​and​rights.

Mayanists and the State Construction of Multiculturalism In​the​past​two​decades​Maya​leaders​have​created​a​series​of​organizations​ like​the​Consejo​de​Organizaciones​Mayas​en​Guatemala​and​the​Coordinación​de​Organizaciones​del​Pueblo​Maya​de​Guatemala.​Using​these​associations​as​platforms,​the​Maya​leaders​wrote​documents​and​negotiated,​protested,​and​elaborated​discourses​about​history,​cultural​diversity,​rights,​and​ identity.​Through​this​process,​they​created​ties​with​the​government​and​the​ state,​setting​the​terms​of​their​relationships. ​ The​discussion​and​signing​in​1995​of​the​Identity​and​Rights​of​the​Indigenous​Peoples​Accord​between​the​Unión​Revolucionaria​Nacional​Guatemalteca​ (urng)​and​the​government​ is​considered​ one​of​the​key​moments​in​the​consolidation​of​these​relations.​Mayanists​took​part​in​this​ process,​and​their​proposals​were​incorporated​into​the​document’s​formal​ definitions.​In​this​way,​the​Guatemalan​nation’s​multiethnic,​pluricultural,​ and​multilingual​character​was​formally​recognized.​This​accord​embraced​ Mayanists’​concept​of​a​people,​a​concept​that​alludes​to​and​is​based​upon​ their​new​notions​of​history.12 ​ Currently,​the​government​has​promulgated​some​secondary​laws​that​ give​ legal​ support​ to​ Maya​ rights,​ spirituality,​ languages,​ and​ education.​ There​are​government​entities​designed​to​support​the​Maya​peoples’​effort,​ such​as​the​Fondo​Indígena​(Indigenous​Fund),​the​Academia​de​las​Lenguas​Mayas​de​Guatemala​(Academy​of​Maya​Languages​of​Guatemala),​and​ Nationalist Contradictions 205

the​Defensoría​de​la​Mujer​Indígena​(Indigenous​Women’s​Defense​Office).​ School​texts​sponsored​by​the​Ministry​of​Education​include​new​lessons​ about​the​Maya’s​millenarian​history,​and​children​in​public​schools​even​ learn​ Maya​ numeration.​ From​ the​ moment​ the​ multicultural​ discourse​ gained​legitimacy,​the​state​began​defining​ethnic​difference​in​Guatemala​ and​recognized​Maya​organizations​and​their​leaders​as​interlocutors​and​ representatives​of​the​Guatemalan​Maya. ​ Many​would​interpret​this​new​situation​to​mean​that​the​state’s​recognition​of​Guatemala’s​cultural​diversity​implies​that​the​nation​is​now​a​democratic,​plural​body.13​Alternatively,​one​might​see​the​state’s​recognition​as​a​ Mayanist​victory​in​the​Maya’s​ideological​and​political​struggle​to​influence​ dominant​history​and​thought.​This​victory,​however,​was​not​so​straightforward​because​it​also​represented​the​state’s​influence​in​the​political​definition​of​multiculturalism,​identity,​and​rights.​Even​though​the​state​purports​to​support​Mayanist​claims,​this​recognition​also​restricts​Mayanists’​ capacity​to​establish​their​own​parameters​and​discourses​of​the​past​and​ of​their​identity,​their​rights,​and​the​elaboration​of​proposals​(Bastos​and​ Hernández​2005).​This​suggests​that​the​Guatemalan​state​and​governing​ elites​are​able​to​nourish​themselves​with​Mayanist​ideology​and​discourse​ to​again​impose​and​redefine​their​own​legitimacy​at​the​local​as​much​as​ the​international​level.​Brackette​Williams​has​defined​this​process​as​transformist​hegemony;​in​other​words,​a​process​through​which​the​state​appropriates​certain​resources​defined​by​subaltern​groups,​leaving​these​peoples​ once​again​at​the​margins​of​the​national​process​(1989). ​ An​interesting​ example​ in​ this​ regard​ is​ that​ of​ a​ group​ of​ Kaqchikels​ from​the​western​department​of​Sololá​who,​in​early​2005,​protested​against​ the​establishment​of​a​mining​company​in​the​Guatemalan​highlands.​They​ claimed​ that​ nature​ (“Mother​ Earth,”​ they​ said)​ was​ being​ damaged​ and​ that​the​government​had​not​consulted​indigenous​peoples​or​communities​ regarding​the​company’s​new​installations;​some​groups​invoked​Convention​169​of​the​International​Labor​Organization​on​the​rights​of​indigenous​ peoples​within​existing​states.​The​protests​were​violent,​and​the​government​ used​the​police​and​the​army​to​repress​the​population​opposed​to​the​mine’s​ operations.​The​Mayas​in​the​region​succeeded​in​achieving​strong​political​cohesion​around​the​so-​called​indigenous​municipality​and​managed​to​ sustain​an​important​discourse​and​practice​regarding​the​“traditional”​conservation​of​their​natural​resources.​Because​of​their​protests,​they​were​repressed.14 206 eDgar​esquit

​ We​can​see​here,​as​Rachel​Sieder​posits,​that​the​recomposition​of​the​ state​and​of​Latin​American​multiculturalism​tie​into​other​processes,​such​ as​neoliberalism​and​subsequent​subaltern​challenges​to​these​policies.​Tensions​emerge​between​the​state​and​Maya​groups​when​state​actors​seek​to​ exploit​natural​resources​located​in​territories​historically​occupied​by​the​ Maya,​territories​they​wish​to​continue​using​according​to​their​local​interests.​Sieder​proposes​that​the​public​policies​implemented​by​Latin​American​governments​contributed​to​the​reorganization​of​the​state​but​did​not​ necessarily​reduce​existing​inequalities.​This​establishes​that​a​model​of​a​ multicultural​society​must​not​only​address​the​rights​of​ethnic​groups​but​ also​confront​patterns​of​development​established​by​neoliberalism​or​capitalism​(Sieder​2004). ​ The​intervention​of​Maya​peoples​is​central​in​defining​a​new​model​of​ the​nation.​Their​ideological​constructions​of​the​past​overlap​with​current​ notions​and​images​of​a​multicultural​Guatemala.​Here​one​has​to​analyze​ how​the​state​legitimizes​itself​through​Mayanist​discourses​of​the​past​and​ of​Maya​culture​but​at​the​same​time​uses​force​and​violence,​also​legitimized,​against​those​supposedly​represented​in​the​plural​nation​to​impose​ the​realities​and​new​logics​of​the​global​economy. ​ The​newly​deployed​historical​discourse​about​Mayanness​and​multiculturalism​influences​official​acts,​including​the​teaching​of​national​history​ and​the​discursive​definition​of​the​rights​of​the​peoples​who​live​together​ in​ Guatemala.​ Nevertheless,​ images​ of​ our​ past​ greatness​ and​ discourses​ about​a​multicultural​country​have​little​impact​on​other​processes,​including​the​definition​of​coexistence,​development,​the​establishment​of​rights​ and​obligations,​and​citizenship.​The​question​therefore​is,​What​is​the​place​ of​a​people,​of​their​culture​and​their​rights,​in​the​definition​and​negotiation​ of​the​country’s​democracy​and​economy?​Within​liberal,​capitalist​logic,​the​ question​is​of​little​importance​and​might​even​be​understood​as​imprudent.​ Yet​it​is​highly​relevant​if​one​thinks​of​the​colonial​manner​in​which​power,​ democratization,​and​cultural​and​social​diversity​are​exercised​in​​Guatemala. ​ How​ are​ the​ discourses​ about​ the​ Maya​ past​ and​ about​ multiculturalism​that​are​formulated​by​Mayanist​intellectuals​used?​And​what​status​are​ they​granted?​Rather​than​constituting​a​simple​opposition​to​official​history,​ Mayanist​history​can​itself​constitute​the​basis​for​developing​new​discursive​ perspectives​that​the​state​then​replicates.​Mayanists​can​believe​they​have​ achieved​ their​ objectives​ when​ the​ government​ begins​ to​ print​ books​ reproducing​their​new​history​and​recreated​symbols.​The​ministers​and​vice​ Nationalist Contradictions 207

ministers​of​education​who​encourage​the​publication​and​use​of​these​new​ texts​may​even​be​Mayas​themselves,​yet​the​majority​of​the​Maya​continue​ to​be​seen​as​backward​and​ignorant​when​the​state​supposedly​brings​them​ progress​and​development​that​they​oppose. ​ Unfortunately​for​the​Mayanists,​they​still​do​not​have​enough​power​to​ control​ the​ reconstructions​ and​ ideologies​ that​ their​ movement​ has​ generated​and​that​are​now​reshaping​the​state​and​government.​Their​incipient​participation​as​government​functionaries​still​does​not​represent​a​significant​force,​yet​their​ideological​creations​about​the​past​and​the​present​ are​molding​the​narratives​that​strengthen​new​images​of​the​multicultural​ nation.​These​narratives​also​construct​other​forms​of​legitimacy​and​state​ power​that​do​little​to​eliminate​privileges​or​equalize​the​concentration​of​ resources​and​power. ​ In​light​of​the​preceding​discussion,​we​are​now​in​a​better​position​to​ determine​who​speaks​in​the​name​of​the​Maya​past.​Now​that​they​are​well​ educated​and​have​the​power​to​do​so,​Maya​elites​effectively​discuss​their​ past.​Nevertheless,​the​power​achieved​by​some​Mayanist​leaders​coexists​ with​ other​ conditions​ and​ contexts​ that​ may​ generate​ contradictions.​ On​ the​one​hand,​Mayanists​do​not​have​the​capacity​to​control​how​others​use​ their​discourses​and​images.​On​the​other​hand,​some​Mayanists​are​satisfied​ when​ they​ hear​ government​ functionaries​ talking​ about​ Guatemala’s​ cultural​wealth.​Many​Mayanists​speak​in​the​name​of​all​Maya​and​their​ past,​but​their​new​discourses​of​the​glorious​Maya​past​run​counter​to​the​ reality​that​many​Maya​individuals​and​communities​still​face​a​power​that​ responds​ to​ their​ concerns​ with​ violence​ and​ continues​ to​ exclude​ them​ from​the​nation.

Mayanist Elites: Redefining Identities and Power Relations One​can​ask​how​Mayanists,​or​at​least​some​Mayanists,​live​these​new​histories.​In​other​words,​how​are​they​using​these​new​discourses​to​nurture​ their​social​life,​their​identity,​and​their​political​activity?​The​intellectuals​of​ the​Maya​movement​are​primarily​educated​men​and​women​who​are​highly​ visible​at​the​local​and​national​levels.​In​some​central​highland​communities,​principally​in​the​department​of​Chimaltenango,​they​are​present​in​sizable​numbers.​Even​though​many​do​not​live​in​their​communities​of​origin,​ but​in​cities​like​Chimaltenango​or​the​capital,​at​certain​moments​they​run​ into​and​greet​each​other​in​their​local​communities.​Likewise,​when​they​ 208 eDgar​esquit

converge​on​places​like​Guatemala​City,​they​also​distinguish​their​fellow​ Maya​who​come​from​specific​towns,​regions,​and​linguistic​groups.​They​ also​cross​paths​with​Maya​who​profess​Mayanist​ideology​only​moderately​ or​not​at​all​but​who​are​also​educated​or​hold​positions​in​the​professions​ and​who​are​familiar​with​ladino​and​Western​spaces​and​perspectives.15 ​ The​story​of​a​Maya​political​leader​from​the​department​of​Chimaltenango,​a​man​who​was​prominent​at​the​local​and​national​levels,​is​instructive​in​this​context.​In​the​mid-​twentieth​century​the​man​was​an​important​ promoter​of​Acción​Católica​in​his​municipality​and​one​of​the​most​widely​ known​catechists.​His​allegiance​to​this​organization​led​him​to​participate​ in​the​local​branch​of​a​major​national​political​party,​as​a​result​of​which​he​ rose​to​the​post​of​mayor​in​his​home​municipality​during​the​second​half​ of​the​twentieth​century.​In​the​1970s​his​party​nominated​him​to​fill​a​seat​ in​the​federal​parliament,​making​him​one​of​the​first​Maya​deputies​to​sit​ in​Guatemala’s​Congress.16​Although​little​was​heard​about​his​political​activities​at​the​national​level​during​the​1980s,​his​name​was​associated​with​ Mayanist​organizations​in​the​1990s​and​up​to​the​present.​At​one​point,​he​ was​a​member​of​the​Consejo​de​Ancianos​del​Fondo​de​Desarrollo​Indígena​de​Guatemala​(Council​of​Elders​of​the​Indigenous​Development​Fund​ of​Guatemala),​a​government​entity​founded​at​the​demand​of​and​led​by​ Mayanists.​He​was​also​an​active​member​of​organizations​that​encourage​ Maya​spirituality. ​ Though​the​man​lived​his​last​years​outside​of​his​municipality,​his​remains​ were​ transferred​ there​ after​ his​ death.​ The​ day​ of​ his​ funeral,​ his​ friends​ and​ relatives,​ myself​ included,​ attended​ a​ Mass​ celebrated​ in​ the​ community​church;​several​of​these​people​held​important​positions​in​the​ national​ political​arena,​either​at​the​governmental​ level​or​in​popular​or​ Mayanist​organizations.​During​the​Eucharist​ceremony​the​priest​spoke​of​ how​this​was​an​uncommon​and​even​special​ceremony​given​the​dignity​ and​trajectory​of​the​deceased.​Once​the​religious​service​ended,​we​left​for​ the​cemetery,​where​a​customary​prayer​was​said.​Afterward,​a​close​K’iche​ relative​ of​ the​ deceased​ climbed​ onto​ a​ podium​ and​ spoke​ in​ his​ native​ tongue​about​how​the​deceased​was​now​reunited​with​Maya​elders​(abuelos).​The​speech​was​translated​into​Spanish.​Some​said​that​the​deceased​had​ probably​heard​these​same​words​about​respect​for​the​ancestors​spoken​to​ him​by​his​mother​in​K’iche​when​he​was​a​child.​The​same​relative​read​a​ text​about​the​deceased’s​life,​highlighting​his​participation​in​the​Congress​ and​in​organizations​that​fought​for​and​defended​Maya​rights.​Most​of​those​ Nationalist Contradictions 209

attending​the​wake​returned​to​the​house,​where​a​vigil​was​held​and​coffee​ and​bread​were​served.​At​the​vigil​someone​circulated​a​photograph​of​the​ deceased,​explaining​that​it​had​been​taken​in​the​Congress​during​his​tenure​ in​that​legislative​body. ​ Several​ conclusions​ can​ be​ arrived​ at​ from​ this​ anecdote.​ On​ the​ one​ hand,​even​though​the​dead​man’s​ancestors​were​not​explicitly​labeled​as​ Maya,​such​labeling​was​implicit​in​the​discourse.​When​Maya​peasants​remember​their​dead,​they​generally​affirm​that​the​deceased’s​soul​now​rests​ in​peace​to​be​resuscitated​by​God​when​the​world​ends.​The​speeches​at​the​ wake​likewise​made​references​to​the​ancestors​using​allusions​to​Mayanist​ discourses​about​elders.​On​the​other​hand,​many​people​who​attended​the​ wake​were​promoters​of​Mayanism,​and​by​translating​the​K’iche​speeches​ into​Spanish​they​were​positioning​Mayanist​values​and​symbols​at​center​ stage​and​thereby​using​Spanish​in​an​instrumental​way. ​ What​I​want​to​highlight​here​is​the​relationship​between​Maya​historical​ discourse,​the​new​identities​of​the​professionals​and​leaders​who​promote​ this​discourse,​and​their​linkage​with​the​state​through​policies​regarding​ Maya​rights​and​multiculturalism.​What​is​happening​among​these​elites?​ The​description​of​the​funeral​highlights​how​Maya​professionals​can​link​ different​events​or​facts​by​articulating​them​with​their​new​historical​discourse​and​with​their​connections​to​state​policy​on​rights​and​culture.​We​ can​see​that​in​this​case​Mayanists​are​not​deploying​a​discourse​about​history​and​culture​in​an​isolated​way,​so​as​to​define​their​nationalism,​difference,​and​pride​only​in​relation​to​their​glorious​past,​as​they​might​do​in​ other​speeches​and​texts.​In​cases​like​this,​for​Maya​historical​discourses​to​ succeed​they​must​interconnect​with​other​narratives​about​contemporary​ Mayas’​ability​to​enter​the​state​apparatus,​become​professional,​and​engage​ other​worlds​assumed​to​be​closed​to​most​Maya.​They​must​also​connect​ with​ arguments​ and​ proclamations​ about​ their​own​ capacity​ to​represent​ and​defend​the​rights​of​the​rest​of​the​Maya​people.​Evidently​in​operation​ here​is​a​complex​process​of​attempted​legitimation​in​which​new​power​relations​are​being​constructed. ​ To​understand​all​of​this,​I​want​to​continue​exploring​the​historical​effects​ of​Western​modernity,​liberal​ideology,​capitalism,​government​policies​regarding​education​and​integration,​and​racism​in​the​lives​of​Mayanists​and​ the​rest​of​the​Maya​people.​It​is​important​to​analyze​both​the​particular​ ways​in​which​political​and​economic​elites​are​constituted​historically​and​ the​links​they​establish​with​systems​of​inequality. 210 eDgar​esquit

​ Greg​Grandin​and​Irma​Alicia​Nimatuj​entered​into​this​discussion​with​ their​ analyses​ of​ historical​ processes​ lived​ by​ the​ Quetzaltec​ elites​ in​ the​ nineteenth​century​and​the​twentieth.​Grandin​proposes​that​K’iche​leaders​ of​this​area​reconfigured​their​communal​relations​and​maintained​their​social​ and​ cultural​ authority​ by​ forming​ alliances​ with​ the​ colonial​ and​ republican​states.​Amidst​the​political​and​economic​changes​of​the​eighteenth​ century​and​the​nineteenth,​K’iche​elites​transformed​Quetzaltenango​into​a​ commercial,​multiethnic​city.​Ethnic​leaders​(principales)​used​Creole​elites​ to​ sustain​ their​ domination​ over​ K’iche​ cultural​ processes,​ strengthening​ their​political​power​and​access​to​capital.​With​the​support​of​indigenous​ principales,​Creoles​maintained​the​city’s​caste​divisions​and​thereby​controlled​ the​ population​ and​ the​ possibility​ of​ multiethnic​ alliances.​ These​ nineteenth-​century​ elites​ pursued​ similar​ alliances​ with​ the​ Guatemalan​ president​Rafael​Carrera​to​protect​their​privileges. ​ These​alliances,​in​combination​with​late​nineteenth-​century​liberal​ideology​and​capitalist​economy,​led​K’iche​elites​to​develop​alternative​understandings​of​ethnicity​and​nationalism.​The​elites​built​a​conception​of​ethnicity​ that​ was​ intimately​ tied​ to​ ideas​ of​ progress​ encouraged​ by​ liberal​ intellectuals.​They​thought​that​indigenous​people’s​regeneration​would​necessarily​lead​to​civil​and​political​equality.​These​ideological​constructions​ ultimately​justified​K’iche​elites’​positions​of​authority​as​well​as​those​of​ ladinos​at​the​local​and​national​level.​Privileged​K’iche​looked​to​reproduce​ an​ethnic​identity​based​on​their​common​origin​and​on​the​maintenance​of​ cultural​markers​primarily​grounded​in​women’s​roles​(Grandin​2000). ​ Nimatuj,​ in​turn,​ observes​ that​ these​ elites​ were​ not​ homogenous​ and​ responded​in​different​ways​to​historical​processes​and​concrete​social​contexts.​Similarly,​she​shows​that​this​Quetzaltec​sector,​characterized​by​their​ commercial​economic​power,​shared​and​continue​to​share​diverse​contexts​ with​the​rest​of​the​Guatemalan​Maya.​They​thereby​reproduce​a​patriarchal​ system​that​subordinates​Maya​women.​Like​the​rest​of​the​country’s​Maya,​ they​ confront​ the​ racism​ dividing​ Guatemalan​ society​ and​ share​ general​ Maya​cultural​patterns​like​dress,​collective​memory,​languages,​and​diverse​ wisdoms​(Velásquez​Nimatuj​2002). ​ At​ the​ beginning​ of​ the​ twentieth​ century​ and​ in​ a​ way​ similar​ to​ the​ K’iche​elites​in​Quetzaltenango,​indigenous​elites​from​different​Chimaltenango​municipalities​simultaneously​acted​as​intermediaries,​speaking​on​ behalf​of​Chimaltenango’s​indigenous​peoples​and​their​rights,​while​also​ competing​with​local​ladino​elites​even​as​they​shared​some​privileges​with​ Nationalist Contradictions 211

those​elites,​such​as​the​right​to​vote​and​exemptions​from​forced​labor​and​ taxes.​Indigenous​elites’​competition​with​ladinos​led​them​to​not​only​discuss​and​demand​citizenship​rights,​but​also​to​take​action.​They​founded​ schools​for​indigenous​people​and​educated​a​small​group​of​youth​who​in​ certain​ways​and​at​certain​moments​could​compete​with​ladinos. ​ At​the​present​time​ladinos​in​many​of​this​department’s​communities​ no​longer​have​decisive​political​power,​and​it​is​Maya​who​lead​local​politics.​But​as​we​have​seen,​the​Maya​are​also​gaining​prominence​within​the​ governmental​apparatus​at​the​national​level.​In​diverse​ways​they​often​act​ as​intermediaries​speaking​in​the​name​of​all​Maya,​doing​so​by​building​a​ linear​discourse​about​the​past,​demanding​rights,​and​establishing​development​programs​for​the​Maya. ​ Many​of​these​indigenous​elites​have​been​successful​because​they​understood​and​entered​the​world​of​national​politics​and​familiarized​themselves​ with​the​practices​and​customs​of​ladino​elites.​Much​of​this​awareness​was​ the​result​of​education​and​adaptation.​Even​though​the​indigenous​elites​ still​endure​what​they​view​as​virulent​racism,​they​do​not​experience​it​in​ the​same​way​or​under​the​same​conditions​as​other​Maya.​Education​has​ been​central​to​the​elites​in​achieving​recognition​and​relative​acceptance​in​ some​nonindigenous​circles;​once​educated,​they​are​still​indigenous,​but​ “civilized.”​Likewise,​the​Mayanist​version​of​their​past​has​acquired​moderate​acceptance​by​certain​intellectuals,​politicians,​and​businessmen​because​ it​entails​a​rational,​as​opposed​to​a​mythical,​way​of​comprehending​the​ past,​while​at​the​same​time​serving​to​minimize​the​violence​used​against​ Maya​protests.17 ​ These​processes​empower​Mayanists​(and​also​other​professional​Maya​ who​do​not​follow​this​ideology)​in​the​eyes​of​some​ladino​and​Creole​sectors​and​also​of​community​and​village-​based​Maya.​Maya​students​and​professionals​enjoy​greater​prestige​where​they​live​or​originate​from,​not​only​ because​of​their​knowledge,​but​also​because​of​the​ties​and​networks​they​ presumably​have​developed​with​ladinos,​organizations,​and​institutions​at​ the​national​level.​An​important​differentiation​thus​arises​between​sectors​ of​the​Maya,​one​that​cannot​be​analyzed​simply​in​terms​of​a​description​ of​social​stratification​within​localities​or​municipalities,​but​must​consider​ processes​like​power​relations,​the​development​of​ideologies,​and​the​historical​constitution​and​reproduction​of​elites. ​ During​the​nineteenth​century​and​the​twentieth,​some​ladinos​and​Creoles​reproduced​their​power,​prestige,​and​legitimacy​by​claiming​to​be​civi212 eDgar​esquit

lized​and​modern.​Similarly,​in​the​twenty-​first​century​Mayanists​and​some​ non-​Mayanists​are​constructing​their​prestige​and​legitimacy​on​the​basis​ of​education,​professionalization,​ and​links​to​the​government​apparatus.​ New​to​this​contemporary​construction,​however,​is​the​identification​with​ a​People​that​has​a​glorious​and​millenarian​history,​one​that​is​imagined​by​ these​selfsame​actors.18 ​ Apparently,​ Mayanists’​ discursive​ control​ over​ the​ past​ and​ their​ demands​ regarding​ rights​ ultimately​ have​ produced​ results​ for​ these​ individuals.​Nevertheless,​this​discursive​control​is​diluted​by​the​control​and​ power​relations​established​by​Guatemala’s​oligarchy​and​political​class.​As​ Claudio​Lomnitz-​Adler​proposed​in​1995​in​the​Mexican​case,​intellectuals’​ discourses​often​serve​to​generate​closer​relationships​between​the​intellectuals​and​dominant​groups​and​in​this​way​continue​to​perpetuate​state​ideologies​(Lomnitz-​Adler​1995).​Much​the​same​can​be​said​about​contemporary​Mayanists’​historical​narratives.

Alternative Histories and the Present How​can​we​Maya​benefit​from​this​power​to​locate​not​only​our​past​but​ also​our​present?​In​what​way​does​the​Maya​people’s​alternative​history,​ as​developed​by​Mayanists,​generate​the​possibility​of​imagining​a​different​ nation​and​nationalism?​There​are​many​answers​to​these​questions​because​ these​new​historical​narratives​also​question​the​forms​of​exclusion​historically​reproduced​by​the​state​and​the​dominant​sectors.​We​can​see​nevertheless​that​Mayanist​history​partly​constructs​itself​by​taking​official​history​as​ a​model​when​it​establishes​or​seeks​to​represent​the​unity​of​the​four​peoples​ living​in​this​territory. ​ When​ Mayanists​ elaborate​ a​ historical​ narrative​ delineating​ the​ Maya​ people’s​cultural​inheritance​and​their​existential​basis,​while​at​the​same​ time​constructing​an​imaginary​about​the​four​peoples​of​Guatemala,​they​ are​helping​to​build​the​myth​of​the​multicultural​nation.​This​myth,​as​we​ have​seen,​is​easily​appropriated,​manipulated,​and​redefined,​both​in​the​ discourses​of​governing​elites​and​in​the​auxiliary​laws​they​have​proposed​ and​approved.​From​this​historical​definition​of​the​four​peoples,​it​is​possible​to​build​linear​and​diaphanous​narratives​about​identity,​equality,​and​ cultural​ inheritance—that​ is​ to​ say,​ about​ Guatemalan​ multiculturalism.​ These​narratives​underestimate​the​differences,​contradictions,​power​relations,​and​economic​inequality​prevalent​in​the​country. Nationalist Contradictions 213

​ Some​ Maya,​ for​ example,​ can​ now​ speak​ about​ multiculturalism​ and​ globalization​ processes​ like​ free​ trade​ treaties​ as​ inescapable​ realities​ in​ which​we​must​necessarily​involve​ourselves.​These​Maya​hold​that​multiculturalism​offers​a​formula​for​confronting​globalization,​implying​that​so​ long​as​we​maintain​our​identity​as​a​people​and​remain​creative,​we​will​be​ able​to​navigate​free​trade​successfully​and​offer​the​world​important​goods​ and​products.19​This​Mayanist​reasoning​is​centered​in​market​logics​and​ leaves​history​and​the​present​agenda​of​the​oligarchy​almost​unquestioned.​ In​this​case,​the​Maya,​too,​can​participate​in​the​colonial​form​taken​by​Guatemalan​and​global​power​relations. ​ Under​such​conditions​it​is​crucial​to​bring​different​Maya​historical​experiences​into​the​discussion,​for​they​are​central​to​the​definition​of​multiculturalism’s​ideological​and​material​foundations.​Different​sectors​of​the​ Maya​(and​Guatemalan)​people​have​long​developed,​according​to​their​own​ life​situations,​a​variety​of​relations​with​their​social​and​natural​surroundings.​Just​like​well-​educated​Maya,​peasants,​women,​merchants,​and​others​ have​had​contact​with​the​national​society,​the​global​economy​and​politics,​ the​ culture​ and​ knowledge​ preserved​ by​ other​ societies,​ and​ diverse​ religious​ forms.​ The​ Maya​ have​ not​ been​ isolated​ from​ Guatemala’s​ politics,​economy,​and​liberal​and​nationalist​ideologies,​or​from​the​ladino​and​ Western​worlds.​It​is​unlikely​they​have​lived​in​a​homogeneous​way.​Their​ diverse​historical​circumstances​have​given​rise​to​diverse​viewpoints,​interests,​and​identities.​Among​the​Maya,​one​can​therefore​discern​many​forms​ of​memory​and​thought.​In​short,​we​Maya​must​pay​close​attention​to​the​ relationship​between​memory​and​identity​in​order​to​recognize​that​our​ own​images​about​history​are​not​uniform​and​instead​reflect​the​complexity​ of​our​lives​and​relations​(Norval​2001). ​ We​must​therefore​focus​our​reflections​on​how​these​memories​can​support​the​construction​of​the​present​and​control​of​the​future.​It​is​important​ to​posit,​as​Partha​Chatterjee​says,​that​the​form​of​remembering​the​past​ and​ the​ power​ to​ represent​ oneself​ is​ nothing​ other​ than​ political​ power​ (Chatterjee​1995).​We​Maya​can​imagine​a​multicultural​society​by​taking​ into​account​these​multiple​historical​conditions.​Also​central​to​constructing​a​multicultural​society​is​an​understanding​of​the​ways​in​which​Guatemalans​have​historically​linked​themselves​and​been​linked​to​their​environment,​keeping​in​mind​their​experiences,​positions,​and​relations​of​power. ​ All​of​this​can​help​us​reflect​more​deeply​about​the​many​ways​in​which​ we​ can​ construct​ our​ alternative​ histories,​ perhaps​ seek​ out​ a​ variety​ of​ 214 eDgar​esquit

styles​of​development​and​understand​and​construct​a​multicultural​nation.​ Santiago​Bastos​and​Domingo​Hernández,​for​example,​highlight​an​interesting​case​detailing​the​process​of​state​control​and​the​Maya​struggle​for​ autonomy​(Bastos​and​Hernández​Ixcoy​2005).​They​analyze​some​of​the​ attempts​to​advance​the​recognition​and​indemnification​of​the​victims​of​ armed​conflict.​They​argue​that​the​social​and​political​experiences​of​people​ involved​in​the​process​have​prompted​them​to​rethink​how​they​imagined​ and​spoke​about​the​past​and​about​Maya​needs​and​rights. ​ According​to​Bastos​and​Hernández,​the​people​and​organizations​involved​in​this​task​have​assumed​the​category​of​Maya​as​part​of​an​ideological​construction​tied​to​the​indemnification,​using​it​as​an​ethnic​category​ that​also​helps​explain​the​past​and​the​violence​suffered.​In​this​case,​the​ process​of​recovering​the​Maya’s​long-​term​history​is​also​linked​with​more​ recent​memories​of​political​violence​endured​by​Maya​peasants,​women,​ and​students.​In​this​way,​peoples’​own​actions,​that​is,​their​struggles​and​ the​paths​they​chose​to​take,​mark​them​not​as​victims​but​as​individuals​ and​as​Maya​who​have​struggled​in​the​face​of​repression​and​exclusion.​All​ these​factors​form​part​of​the​Maya​experience​and​the​memory​they​are​ constructing. ​ These​ efforts​ are​ fundamental,​ and​ their​ recognition​ through​ ethnographic​description​is​central​to​the​discovery​of​other​explanations​related​ to​the​interactions​of​different​political​actors​(Hale​2002).​These​academic​ analyses​are​important​contributions​as​long​as​they​do​not​fall​into​a​simple​ celebration​of​Maya​resistance.​By​taking​a​more​critical​perspective​we​can​ see​the​contradictions​generated​in​the​different​arenas​where​Maya​launch​ their​struggles​and​the​ensuing​consequences.​By​focusing​on​these​multiple​ arenas,​we​can​understand​how​political​resistance​and​memory​often​challenge​the​control​and​power​of​dominant​groups​and​of​their​common​sense,​ even​as​they​can​sometimes​reinforce​the​established​order​and​neutralize​ the​strength​of​Maya​organizations​and​communities​(Hale​2002).

Epilogue Nobody​could​argue​that​the​Guatemalan​Maya​movement​has​not​been​an​ important​force​in​the​transformation​of​Guatemalan​society.​Over​the​past​ two​decades​a​national​discussion​of​indigenous​peoples’​cultural​and​political​rights​has​opened​multiple​opportunities​for​struggle​for​people​in​different​regions​and​localities.​Many​Maya​women,​for​example,​now​make​their​ Nationalist Contradictions 215

voices​heard​in​diverse​contexts,​emphasizing​their​suffering,​desires,​and​ struggles​and​challenging​patriarchal​domination​in​their​homes,​localities,​ and​country​(Chirix​2003).​Similarly,​Maya​spirituality​represents​an​important​challenge​to​the​Protestant​and​Catholic​churches​as​well​as​to​society​in​ general​through​the​public​presentation​of​religious​rituals​prohibited​until​ the​1990s.​Mayanists​have​brought​to​light​many​issues​and​problems,​including​racism,​an​outdated​educational​system​from​the​elementary​to​the​ postsecondary​level,​political​and​social​exclusion,​and​unequal​landholding​patterns. ​ My​essay​does​not​talk​in​terms​of​betrayal.​Rather,​it​has​dealt​with​social​ processes​that​deserve​recognition​and​careful​analysis​so​as​to​further​clarify​the​relation​between​hegemonic​processes​and​indigenous​resistance​in​ Guatemala​(Scott​2002).​I​have​attempted​to​represent​and​analyze​the​relationship​between​the​narratives​about​the​past​constructed​by​Mayanist​ intellectuals​ and​ the​ vested​ interests​ present​ in​ the​ state​ that​ are​ also​ involved​in​defining​Guatemalan​multiculturalism.​We​have​been​able​to​observe​that​the​ties​established,​the​discourses​and​ideologies​promoted​and​ implemented,​are​often​contradictory​because​they​both​represent​and​unfold​within​Guatemala’s​complex​social​reality.​Elite​and​nonelite​Maya​have​ also​been​fundamental​participants​in​the​construction​of​the​Guatemala​of​ the​past​two​decades.​They​participate​not​only​because​they​have​been​and​ continue​to​be​the​most​important​labor​force​in​the​country’s​economy,​but​ also​because​they​model​the​Guatemalan​state​with​their​ideological​constructions​and​political​interests.​They​remain​linked​to​nationalist​ideologies—ideologies​whose​form​dominant​groups​adopted​and​used​to​build​ their​hegemony—but​they​also​constitute​an​important​social​force​in​the​ transformation​of​our​society. ​ This​work​is​a​critical​approximation​by​the​Maya​themselves​to​the​social​ processes​we​live.​Our​experiences​in​these​diverse​environments​provide​ evidence​both​of​what​our​struggles​have​achieved​and​of​the​mistakes​we​ have​made.​We​Maya​will​not​give​too​much​away​if​we​see​our​intellectual​ activity​and​creations​in​a​more​problematic​way​and​not​as​diaphanous,​as​ we​would​like​our​reality​or​our​past​to​be.20​This​may​be​too​much​to​ask,​ given​how​we​Mayanists​make​strategic​use​of​essentialist​notions​about​the​ continuity​of​our​past​and​present.21​Yet​we​must​also​listen​to​our​many​ voices,​which,​though​contradictory,​influence​the​processes​we​live. ​ Maya​peasants,​businessmen,​women,​Catholics,​and​youth​have​many​ historical​experiences​and​talk​in​many​ways,​and​their​discourses​and​prac216 eDgar​esquit

tices​tie​into​the​ideologies​they​employ.​With​their​multiple​identities,​interests,​and​dreams,​they​inevitably,​together​with​elites,​take​part​in​the​contradictions​our​current​nationalisms​generate.

Notes ​ 1.​In​the​Guatemalan​context,​ladino​refers​to​most​non-​Indians,​including​Guatemalans​of​European​or​mixed​descent​(translator’s​note). ​ 2.​In​citing​Quijano,​Walter​Mignolo​(2004)​explains​how​one​should​understand​ the​concept​of​the​coloniality​of​power​and​talks​about​the​historical​establishment​ of​a​racial​division​of​labor​in​America.​A​racial​hierarchy​that​overdetermined​social​ relations​and​ideologies​and​influenced​ideas​of​equality​and​liberty​was​put​in​place.​ At​the​beginning​of​the​nineteenth​century​and​with​the​onset​of​independence,​he​ argues,​ instead​of​being​ overcome,​ colonialism​ was​rearticulated.​ Following​ Greg​ Grandin’s​(2000)​ideas,​we​can​also​say​that​even​though​all​the​Maya​of​Guatemala​ are​not​oppressed​for​being​Maya,​they​suffer​domination​as​Maya. ​ 3.​Carmack​(2001),​Gúzman​Böckler​and​Herbert​(1998),​and​Hill​(2001).​The​first​ two​books​were​first​edited​in​the​1960s​and​the​last​in​1992. ​ 4.​See​Edgar​Esquit​(2004)​for​a​more​in-​depth​critical​study​of​this​topic​in​relation​to​recent​narratives​about​the​past​by​Maya​activists. ​ 5.​Montejo​(2004)​is​a​recent​text​about​Maya​history. ​ 6.​In​some​municipalities​these​identities​also​contrasted​with​Maya​merchants,​ most​of​whom​have​a​low​level​of​educational​training. ​ 7.​Many​other​professionals​from​Comalapa​or​the​region​have​few​or​no​ties​with​ the​Maya​movement​and​its​discourse. ​ 8.​Creoles​(criollos)​refers​to​elite​Guatemalans​of​European​descent​(translator’s​ note).​For​example,​see​Batres​Jáuregui​(1989),​Martínez​Peláez​(1973),​and​Carmack​ (2001). ​ 9.​But​the​political,​cultural,​and​economic​exclusion​of​the​Maya​within​the​nation​does​not​occur​only​at​the​discursive​level.​There​are​concrete,​material​practices​ that​establish​exclusion,​implying​that​the​state’s​historic​narrative​contributes​to​the​ construction​of​colonial​forms​within​Guatemala’s​power​relations. ​ 10.​In​the​K’iche​language,​for​example,​najtir,​meaning​“ancient,”​is​used​only​to​ talk​about​an​ancestor’s​past​and​culture.​In​the​Mam​language,​ojtxe​refers​to​the​remote​past.​García​Ruiz​(1992). ​ 11.​Mayanists​have​created​the​image​of​Guatemala​as​made​up​of​four​peoples— the​Maya,​Garífuna,​Xinca,​and​ladino—each​with​its​respective​history. ​ 12.​Minugua ​(2001). ​ 13.​See​Donna​Lee​Van​Cott’s​(2000)​discussion​about​constitutional​multiculturalism.​Santiago​Bastos​deals​critically​with​this​issue​in​the​notion​of​cosmetic​ multiculturalism,​which​refers​to​the​creation​of​new​state​policies​that​adopt​laws​ Nationalist Contradictions 217

and​discourses​attempting​to​always​include​indigenous​people​(Conference​at​the​ Colegio​de​Michoacán,​2003). ​ 14.​Some​people​have​suggested​that​political​members​of​the​leftist​party​Unión​ Revolucionaria​ Nacional​ Guatemalteca​ (urng)​ manipulated​ the​ Maya​ in​ these​ events.​Though​it​is​clear​that​the​ urng ​has​influence​in​the​Indigenous​Municipality​of​Sololá​and​other​departmental​organizations,​we​cannot​disregard​the​interests​and​agency​of​the​region’s​Kaqchikels. ​ 15.​Uneducated​Maya​are​also​not​isolated​from​liberal​Guatemalan​politics,​economics,​ and​ ideology​or​from​ the​ladino​ and​ Western​ world.​The​ problem​ is​ not​ whether​the​Maya​are​tied​to​national​and​global​processes​or​not;​rather,​it​is​important​to​understand​the​forms​and​conditions​in​which​such​connections​happen​and,​ extrapolating​from​there,​peoples’​experiences,​positions,​and​relations​of​power. ​ 16.​Two​former​Maya​congresspeople​were​the​K’iche​Augusto​Sac​Racancoj,​a​ lawyer,​and​Pablo​Pastor,​a​professor.​They​obtained​their​posts​in​the​1940s​only​because​of​the​space​the​Revolution​of​1944​opened.​Velásquez​Nimatuj​(2002). ​ 17.​ Nevertheless,​ there​ are​ ladinos​ who​ question​ the​ way​ in​ which​ Mayanism​ recovers​the​past​through​essentialist​and​fundamentalist​arguments.​See​Morales​ (1998).​Some​provincial​ladinos​also​question​Mayanism,​but​their​main​arguments​ originate​within​official​history.​They​affirm​that​indigenous​peoples​no​longer​have​ the​ right​ to​ call​ themselves​ Maya​ because​ the​ Maya​ empire​ disappeared​ with​ the​ Spanish​ conquest​ and​ subsequent​ communities​ were​ no​ longer​ pure​ but​ mixed.​ Moreover,​these​provincial​ladinos​believe​the​adhesion​of​indigenous​peoples​to​the​ ancient​Maya​is​a​strategy​of​some​opportunistic​individuals.​Hale​(2002). ​ 18.​This​comparison​is​not​overly​ahistorical​because​the​nation​is​still​constructed​ on​exclusion,​even​though​the​national​and​global​social,​political,​and​economic​ contexts​have​varied. ​ 19.​For​Walter​Mignolo​(2004)​globalization​is​a​rearticulation​of​the​coloniality​ of​power,​similar​to​what​happened​in​the​nineteenth​century​with​the​foundation​of​ nations​in​America.​Many​Mayanists​who​have​adopted​a​perspective​that​includes​ the​concept​of​internal​colonialism​hardly​question​globalization​processes​and​the​ contexts​in​which​they​are​produced. ​ 20.​I​use​the​term​problematic​to​denote​the​complexity​of​our​social​life​and​to​ argue​about​the​many​paths​our​struggles​can​take​if​we​pay​attention​to​our​many​ realities. ​ 21.​In​discussing​cultural​continuity,​Fischer​and​Watanabe​(2004)​affirm​that​we​ frequently​do​not​realize​the​different​ways​it​can​happen,​such​as​through​the​recreation​of​the​present​or​through​profiling​the​legacy​of​our​ancestors​as​unchanging.​ According​to​the​authors,​Mayanists​would​have​opted​for​the​first​way.​The​authors’​ conclusion​ may​ be​ quite​ correct;​ nevertheless,​ we​ also​ have​ to​ point​ out​ that​ the​ recreation​of​the​present​is​mediated​by​power​relations,​social​contexts,​and​new​ identities. 218 eDgar​esquit

Florencia e. mallon

Conclusion

When​Noenoe​Silva​and​Stéfano​Varese​attempted,​at​the​close​of​our​conference​in​Madison,​to​summarize​our​discussions​as​a​frame​for​our​last​ plenary​session,​they​highlighted​both​the​promises​and​the​difficulties​in​ taking​the​kind​of​international​ and​comparative​perspective​we​have​attempted​in​this​book.​In​this​brief​conclusion​I​revisit​some​of​the​general​ themes​and​challenges​associated​with​such​a​perspective.​I​cannot​presume​ to​represent​here​the​richness​of​the​perceptions​and​conclusions​contained​ in​each​essay.​Instead,​I​highlight​three​general​points​that​emerge​from​the​ overall​conversation,​reiterating​the​desire—present​in​the​work​of​all​the​ contributors​to​this​book​as​well​as​of​all​those​present​at​the​conference— that​we​can​contribute​in​some​way​to​a​deeper​and​more​productive​dialogue​among​Native​peoples​and​between​Native​and​other​forms​of​knowledge. ​ At​the​core​of​the​project​envisioned​by​the​authors​represented​in​this​ book​is​the​understanding​of​Native​histories​and​narratives​in​international​ and​comparative​context.​As​the​recent​history​of​indigenous​movements​ has​demonstrated,​international​collaboration​has​fostered​new​possibilities​ for​indigenous​mobilization​and​empowerment.​At​the​same​time,​the​process​of​examining​Native​histories​and​narratives​in​comparative​and​international​perspective​extends​and​deepens​our​understanding​of​each​one.​ Both​the​similarities​and​the​differences​we​find​among​them​sharpen​our​ appreciation​of​how,​and​for​what​purpose,​these​narratives​are​elaborated​ and​constructed.​Finally,​our​comparisons​of​North​and​South​America​as​ well​as​of​the​continental​Americas​with​the​Pacific​world​help​remind​us​ how​deeply​geography​itself,​and​through​it​the​relationships​among​distinct​ indigenous​peoples​and​traditions,​has​been​affected​by​colonialism. ​ A​second​theme​that​arises​from​the​essays​collected​here​is​that​decolo-

nization​begins​at​home.​Taken​together,​the​authors​demonstrate​the​multiple​ways​in​which​Native​narrative​and​history​can​be​rendered,​from​local​ community​ history​ or​ personal​ story​ to​ discussions​ of​ indigenous​ rights​ on​an​international​level.​That​each​provides​a​different​but​necessary​perspective​on​Native​histories​is​an​important​lesson​that​we​all​relearn,​again​ and​ again,​ as​ we​ labor​ to​ decolonize​ indigenous​ narratives​ with​ the​ very​ same​tools​we​have​inherited​from​colonialism.​And​as​we​continue​to​strive​ toward​this​goal,​we​see​the​importance,​also​represented​in​this​book,​of​the​ work​that​has​been​done​by​generations​of​activist-​intellectuals,​both​Native​ and​non-​Native.​In​the​context​of​collaboration​and​solidarity,​the​authors​ suggest,​it​is​also​possible​to​speak​about​and​analyze​internal​divisions​and​ differences​in​productive​and​inclusive​ways. ​ A​third​and​final​salient​theme​here​is​that​indigenous​theorizing​and​ translation—understood​ as​ the​ interpretation,​ reinterpretation,​ and​ improvement​of​ideas​and​concepts​in​their​transition​from​one​language​or​ epistemology​ to​ another—transform​ our​ understanding​ of​ national​ and​ global​processes​and​histories.​Indigenous​histories​themselves​have​never​ really​been​local,​except​in​the​eyes​of​the​colonizers.​Rather,​they​have​from​ the​very​beginning​participated​and​been​embedded​in,​transformed​by,​and​ resistant​to​globalization.​At​the​same​time,​with​the​powerful​revitalization​ worldwide​of​indigenous​identity-​based​politics​and​in​the​new​globalized​ context​that​has​emerged​after​the​fall​of​the​Berlin​Wall,​the​long​and​critical​ engagement​of​Native​peoples​with​world​histories​and​processes​can​more​ easily​and​clearly​come​into​view.​Our​goal​is​that​the​multiple​experiences​ and​perspectives​offered​here​can​contribute​to​a​deeper,​more​grounded​debate​over​our​common,​global,​and​hopefully​ever​more​decolonized​future.​ As​ became​ clear​ from​ the​ plenary​ session​ at​ our​ conference,​ the​ work​ of​ decolonization​will​not​be​done​until​Native​narratives​and​epistemologies​ not​only​occupy​a​prominent​position​within​the​circle​where​knowledge​is​ produced,​but​also​constitute​a​central​part​of​the​knowledge​that​everyone​ seeks​out.

220 Florencia​e.​Mallon

reFerences

Primary Sources: Websites, Unpublished Papers, Legislation, Newspaper Articles, Historical Published Sources Los Acuerdos de San Andrés.​2003.​Bilingual​edition​Spanish–Tzotzil.​Tuxtla​ Gutiérrez,​Chiapas:​Gobierno​del​Estado. Akaka,​D.​K.​2009.​“Akaka​Bill.​Native​Hawaiian​Government​Reorganization​Act​ Reintroduced​in​Senate​and​House.”​Press​release,​4​February. ———.​2005.​“Hawaii​Congressional​Delegation​Introduces​Native​Hawaiian​Government​Reorganization​Act.”​Press​release,​25​January. ———.​2001a.​“Native​Hawaiian​Federal​Recognition​Bill​Introduced.”​Press​release,​January​22. ———.​2001b.​“Statement​of​Senator​Daniel​K.​Akaka​on​Revisions​to​the​Native​ Hawaiian​Federal​Recognition​Bill.”​16​April.​http://www.senate.gov/~akaka/ speeches​(accessed​11​August​2009). ———.​2000.​“Native​Hawaiian​Recognition​Bill​Introduced.”​Press​release,​ 20​July. Apology Resolution to acknowledge the 100th anniversary of the January 17, 1893 overthrow of the Kingdom of Hawaii, and to offer an apology to Native Hawaiians on behalf of the United States for the overthrow of the Kingdom of Hawaii.​Resolution​No.​19,​known​as​the​Apology​Resolution,​103d​Congress,​23​November​ 1993;​U.S.​Public​Law​103–150. Barrientos,​D.​1998.​“Informe​sobre​el​D.L.​2.885​y​de​la​Ley​No​19.253.​Referencia​al​ Régimen​jurídico​aplicable​a​las​tierras​insulares.”​Paper. DePledge,​D.​2003.​“Lawmakers​Agree​to​Revise​Hawaiian​Recognition​Bill.​Honolulu Advertiser,​14​May.​http://www.the.honoluluadvertiser.com​(accessed​ 11​August​2009). Documento​de​la​Marina.​1926.​Memorias, Balances, Inventarios y Registro de Propiedades. Enomoto,​K.​2009.​“Akaka​Bill​May​Have​a​Shot​at​Law:​Opposition​Continues,​But​ Sympathetic​New​President​Could​Be​Key.”​Maui News,​1​March.​http://www .mauinews.com/page​(accessed​11​August​2009). Gómez,​R.​2004.​Informe final sobre Catastro de tenencia, dominio y transferencias

de Inmuebles en Isla de Pascua.​Isla​de​Pascua.​Bienes​Nacionales.​Unpublished​ document. Gómez​Vargas,​J.​H.​2006.​“Consultoría​Internacional​para​el​asesoramiento​en​la​ elaboración​del​Estatuto​Especial​para​Isla​de​Pascua.​Informe​primera​visita.”​ Unpublished​document. Guatemala: Memory of Silence.​2003.​Report​of​the​Commission​for​Historical​ Clarification.​http://www.shr.aaas.org/guatemala. Informe de la Comisión Verdad Histórica y Nuevo Trato de los Pueblos Indígenas.​ Santiago:​Gobierno​de​Chile. Joint-Senate Resolution to Provide for Annexing the Hawaiian Islands to the United States.​1898.​Resolution​No.​55,​known​as​the​Newlands​Resolution,​2nd​Session,​55th​Congress,​7​July​1898;​30​Sta.​at​L.​750;​2​Supp.​R.​S.​895. Kingdom​of​Hawai‘i—International​Treaties.​Http://www.hawaiiankingdom.org/ treaties.shtml. Libro de Registros de propiedades llevado por la Armada de Chile, Isla de Pascua.​1962. Ministerio de Marina: Oficios de la Dirección General de la Armada.​1902. Namuo,​C.​2004.​“Misinformation​Abounds​on​Revisions​to​Akaka​bill.”​Honolulu Advertiser,​2​May.​Http://www.thehonoluluadvertiser.com/article​(accessed​ 8​August​2009). Omandam,​P.​2003.​“Native​Hawaiians​Will​Not​Benefit​by​Bill,​Say​Some​Sovereignty​Groups.”​Honolulu Star-Bulletin,​25​February. ———.​1998.​“Report:​Annexation​Could​Be​Declared​Invalid.”​Honolulu StarBulletin.​11​August. Revista de Marina: Publicación Bimestral de la Armada de Chile.​1983.​Año​XCVIII.​ May–June. Taller​Tzotzil.​1982.​K’alal ich’ay mosoal/Cuando dejamos de ser aplastados: La Revolución en Chiapas.​2​vols.​San​Cristóbal:​Editorial​Tiempo.​Tzotzil​of​Zinacantán​and​Spanish. ———.​1983.​Li’i ja’ sventa tzobol chij’abtej ta komon/Organización comunitaria del trabajo.​Tzotzil​of​San​Andrés​and​Spanish. ———.​1985.​Ja’ k’u x’elan ta jpojbatik ta ilbajinel yu’un jkaxlanetik / Cómo escapamos del control de los ladinos.​Tzotzil​of​Zinacantán​and​Spanish. ———.​1986.​Abtel ta Pinka.​Tzotzil​of​Chamula.​Republished​in​1990​in​a​bilingual​Tzotzil–Spanish​edition. ———.​1988a.​Lo’il yu’un Kuskat: Sk’op mol Marian Koyaso Panchin.​Tzotzil​of​Chamula. ———.​1988b.​Buch’u lasmeltzan Jobel? / ¿Quién hizo San Cristóbal?​Tzotzil​of​Chamula​and​Spanish. ———.​1990a.​Kipaltik: Lo’il sventa k’ucha’al la jmankutik jpinkakutik / La historia de cómo compramos nuestra finca, por los socios de la Unión “Tierra Tzotzil.”​ Tzotzil​of​San​Andrés​and​Spanish. 222 reFerences

———.​1990b.​Ta jlok’ta chobtik ta k’u’il / Bordando milpas.​Tzotzil​of​Chamula​and​ Spanish. ———.​1990c.​Slo’il cha’vo’ kumpareil / Los dos compadres.​Tzotzil​of​Zinacantán​ and​Spanish. ———.​1993.​Historia de un pueblo evangelista: Triunfo Agrarista.​Ricardo​Pérez. ———.​1996.​Jchi’iltak ta slumal Kalifornia / Chamulas en California.​Tzotzil​of​ Chamula​and​Spanish. ———.​1995.​“Los​primeros​meses​de​los​zapatistas:​Una​crónica​tzotzil​en​siete​ escenas​by​Marián​Peres​Tzu​(Xalik​Kusman).”​J.​Rus​(Trans.).​Ojarasca,​numbers​40–41,​January–February​1995,​13–16. ———.​2000.​“Conversaciones​ininterrumpidas:​Las​voces​indígenas​del​mercado​ de​San​Cristóbal.”​Marián​Peres​Tzu​(Xalik​Kusman).​Translated​by​J.​Rus.​J.​P.​ Viqueira​and​W.​Sonnleitner,​eds.,​Democracia en tierras indígenas: Las elecciones en los Altos de Chiapas (1991–1998),​259–67.​Mexico​City:​ciesas /Colegio​de​México/Instituto​Electoral​Federal. Toro,​P.​P.​1892.​“Informes​de​la​comisión​nombrada​para​estudiar​la​colonización​ (Juan​Fernandez​y​Pascua).”​Memoria del Ministerio de Culto i Colonización,​ 188–216.​15​November. United​Nations​General​Assembly​Resolution​1514.​1960.​“Declaration​on​the​ Granting​of​Independence​to​Colonial​Countries.” United​States​Congress.​1900.​“The​Act​of​Congress​Organizing​Hawaii​into​a​Territory,​An​Act​to​provide​a​government​for​the​Territory​of​Hawaii,​April​30.”​ Rice v. Cayetano Governor of Hawaii​(98–818)​528​U.S.​495​(2000)​146​F.3d​1075,​ reversed. Viotti,​V.​2003a.​“Conservatives​Blamed​for​Stalling​Akaka​Bill.”​Honolulu Advertiser,​29​August. ———.​2003b.​“Inouye:​Maybe​2004​for​Akaka​Bill.”​Honolulu Advertiser,​30​August. Secondary Sources Abu-​Lughod,​L.​1991.​“Writing​against​Culture.”​Recapturing Anthropology: Working in the Present,​ed.​Richard​G.​Fox,​137–62.​Santa​Fe:​School​of​American​Research. Albert,​B.​1995.​“O​ouro​canibal​e​a​queda​do​céu:​uma​crítica​xamânica​da​economia​política​da​naturaleza.”​Série Antropologica,​no.​174,​1–33.​Departamento​de​ Antropología,​Universidade​de​Brasília. Albó,​X.​1998.​“Expresión​indígena,​diglosia​y​medios​de​comunicación.”​Sobre las huellas de la voz: Sociolingüística de la oralidad y la escritura en su relación con la educación,​ed.​Luis​Enrique​López​and​Ingrid​Jung,​126–55.​Cochabamba:​ Morata,​proeib ​Andes,​Dse . reFerences 223

Albó,​X.,​and​Anaya,​A.​2003.​Niños alegres, libres, expresivos: La audacia de la educación intercultural bilingüe en Bolivia.​La​Paz:​uniceF ,​cipca . Alfred,​T.​2004.​“Warrior​Scholarship:​Seeing​the​University​as​a​Ground​of​Contention.”​Indigenizing the Academy: Transforming Scholarship and Empowering Communities,​ed.​D.​A.​Mihesuah​and​A.​C.​Wilson,​88–99.​Lincoln:​University​ of​Nebraska​Press. Allen,​C.​2002.​Blood Narrative: Indigenous Identity in American Indian and Maori Literary and Activist Texts.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. Anonymous.​2000.​“Sxabwes’​‘El​ombligo’:​El​juego​didáctico​de​las​matemáticas.”​ C’ayu’ce​4,​42–43.​Popayán,​Colombia. Anonymous.​1988.​“Informe​sobre​la​situación​de​derechos​humanos​de​los​grupos​ étnicos​aborígenes​en​Chile.”​Revista Chilena de Derechos Humanos​16​(May),​ 83–91.​Santiago:​Academia​de​Humanismo​Cristiano. Andueza​Guzmán,​P.​2005.​“La​tierra​en​Rapanui​como​desafío​jurídico​intercultural.”​Paper​presented​at​the​VI​International​Conference​on​Rapa​Nui​and​the​ Pacific,​in​Reñaca,​Chile. Anzaldúa,​G.​1987.​Borderlands/La Frontera: The New Mestiza.​San​Francisco:​Aunt​ Lutte​Books. Arias,​J.​1984.​Historia de la colonia de “Los Chorros,” Chenalhó.​Tuxtla​Gutiérrez,​ Chiapas:​Gobierno​del​Estado. Arnold,​D.,​and​J.​de​Dios​Yapita.​2000.​El rincón de las cabezas: Luchas textuales, educación y tierras en los Andes.​La​Paz:​uMsa ,​ilca . Arratia,​M.​2001.​Wata Muyuy: Ciclos de vida en culturas agrocéntricas y tiempos de la escuela. Una aproximación sobre gestión educativa e interculturalidad en un distrito quechua de Bolivia.​Buenos​Aires:​unesco . Asad,​T.​1986.​“The​Concept​of​Cultural​Translation​in​British​Social​Anthropology.”​Writing Culture: The Poetics and Politics of Ethnography,​ed.​James​Clifford​and​George​E.​Marcus,​141–64.​Berkeley:​University​of​California​Press. Aubry,​A.​2005.​“La​experiencia​de​Chiapas​y​la​democracia​intelectual,​testimonio​ de​una​práctica​alternativa​de​las​ciencias​sociales.”​Contrahistoria​4​(March– August),​103–7. ———.​1988.​El rescate del ‘libro robado’: La producción histórica del Taller Tzotzil del INAREMAC .​San​Cristóbal:​inareMac . Aubry,​A.,​and​A.​Inda.​2003.​Los llamados de la memoria: Chiapas 1995–2001.​ Tuxtla​Gutiérrez,​Chiapas:​coneculta . ———.​1998.​“Who​Are​the​Paramilitaries​in​Chiapas?”​North American Congress on Latin America​31:5​(March–April),​8–9. Barsh,​R.​L.​1986.​“Indigenous​Peoples:​An​Emerging​Object​of​International​Law,”​ American Journal of International Law​80,​369–85. Bastos,​S.,​and​M.​Camus.​2003.​Entre el Mecapal y el Cielo: Desarrollo del Movi-

224 reFerences

miento Maya en Guatemala.​Cholsamaj,​Guatemala:​Facultad​Latinoamericana​ de​Ciencias​Sociales​(Flacso)–Sede​Guatemala. Bastos,​S.,​and​D.​Hernández​Ixcoy.​2005.​Resarcimiento y Reconstitución del Pueblo Maya en Guatemala: Entre la acción autónoma y el reconocimiento estatal.​ Guatemala:​n.p. Batres​Jáuregui,​A.​1989.​Los indios, su historia y su civilización.​Guatemala:​Tipografía​Nacional. Benjamin,​T.​2000.​“A​Time​of​Reconquest:​History,​the​Maya​Revival,​and​the​ Zapatista​Rebellion​in​Chiapas.”​American Historical Review​105:2,​417–50. Bishop,​R.​1994.​“Initiating​Empowering​Research?”​New Zealand Journal of Educational Studies​29:1,​175–88. Blu,​K.​2001​(1980).​The Lumbee Problem: The Making of an American Indian People.​ Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. Bobrow-​Strain,​A.​2007.​Intimate Enemies: Landowners, Territory, and Violence in Chiapas.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. Bolaños,​G.,​A.​Ramos,​J.​Rappaport,​and​C.​Miñana.​2004.​¿Qué pasaría si la escuela . . . ? Treinta años de construcción educativa.​Popayán,​Colombia:​Programa​de​Educación​Bilingüe​e​Intercultural,​Consejo​Regional​Indígena​del​ Cauca. Bricker,​V.​R.​1981.​The Indian Christ, the Indian King.​Austin:​University​of​Texas​ Press. Brooks,​J.​F.,​ed.​2002.​Confounding the Color Line: The Indian–Black Experience in North America.​Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. Burguete,​A.,​and​J.​Montero​Solano.​N.d.​“Morir​en​la​impunidad:​Violencia​política​en​regiones​indígenas​de​Chiapas,​Cronología​1974–1988.”​Manuscript.​San​ Cristóbal,​Chiapas,​Mexico. Burstein,​J.,​Á.​Past,​and​R.​Wasserstrom.​1979.​En sus propias palabras: Cuatro vidas tzotziles.​San​Cristóbal:​Editorial​Fray​Bartolomé​de​Las​Casas. Bushnell,​D.,​and​N.​Macaulay.​1988.​Latin America in the Nineteenth Century.​ Oxford:​Oxford​University​Press. Campisi,​J.​1991.​The Mashpee Indians: Tribe on Trial.​Syracuse:​Syracuse​University​ Press. Carmack,​R.​2001.​Kik’ulmatajem le k’iche’aab’ Evolución del Reino k’iche’.​Guatemala:​Editorial​Cholsamaj. Castro-​Gómez,​S.​2003.​“Apogeo​y​decadencia​de​la​teoría​tradicional:​Una​visión​ desde​los​intersticios.”​Estudios culturales latinoamericanos: Retos desde y sobre la región andina,​ed.​C.​Walsh,​59–72.​Quito:​uasb ,​Abya​Yala. ———.​2000.​“Teoría​tradicional​y​teoría​crítica​de​la​cultura.”​La reestructuración de las ciencias sociales en América Latina,​ed.​S.​Castro-​Gómez,​93–107.​Bogotá:​ Pensar.

reFerences 225

Chakrabarty,​D.​2000.​Provincializing Europe: Postcolonial Thought and Historical Difference.​Princeton:​Princeton​University​Press. ———.​1999.​“La​poscolonialidad​y​el​artilugio​de​la​historia:​¿Quién​habla​en​ nombre​de​los​pasados​‘indios’?”​Pasados Poscoloniales,​ed.​S.​Dube,​441–71.​ Mexico​City:​El​Colegio​de​México. Chandler,​N.​D.​1996.​“The​Economy​of​Desedimentation:​W.​E.​B.​Du​Bois​and​the​ Discourses​of​the​Negro.”​Callaloo​19:1,​78–93. Chanteaux,​M.​1999.​Las andanzas de Miguel: La biografía del padre expulsado de Chenalhó.​San​Cristóbal:​Editorial​Fray​Bartolomé​de​Las​Casas. Chatterjee,​P.​1995.​“Alternative​Histories,​Alternative​Nations:​Nationalism​and​ Modern​Historiography​in​Bengal.”​Making Alternative Histories: The Practice of Archaeology and History in Non-Western Western Settings,​ed.​P.​R.​Schmidt​ and​T.​C.​Patterson,​229–54.​Santa​Fe:​School​of​American​Research​Press. ———.​1986.​Nationalist Thought and the Colonial World. A Derivative Discourse?​ Tokyo:​Zed​Books / United​Nations​University. Chávez,​A.​I.,​ed.​2001.​Pop Wuj.​Guatemala:​tiMach . Chirix,​E.​2003.​Alas y raíces: Afectividad de las mujeres mayas rik’in ruxik’ y ruxe’il ronojel qajowab’al ri mayab’ taq ixoqi’.​Kaqla’,​Guatemala:​n.p. Chocué​Guasaquillo,​A.​A.​2000.​“Nuestra​doble​conciencia.”​C’ayu’ce​4,​14–15. Choque,​C.​1982.​Criterios para la normalización en la escritura de la lengua quechua en Bolivia.​Sucre:​p.eib . Chow,​R.​1995.​Primitive Passions: Visuality, Sexuality, Ethnography, and Contemporary Chinese Cinema.​New​York:​Columbia​University​Press. Clifford,​J.​1988.​“Identity​in​Mashpee.”​The Predicament of Culture: TwentiethCentury Ethnography, Literature, and Art,​ed.​J.​Clifford,​277–346.​Cambridge:​ Harvard​University​Press. Clifford,​J.,​and​G.​Marcus,​eds.​1986.​Writing Culture: The Poetics and Politics of Ethnography.​Berkeley:​University​of​California​Press. Cobo,​J.​M.​1987.​Study of the Problem of Discrimination against Indigenous Populations.​Volume​5:​Conclusions, Proposals and Recommendations.​un ​Doc.​ E/CN.4/Sub.2/1983/21/dd8.​New​York:​United​Nations. Cojtí​Cuxil,​D.​1996.​“The​Politics​of​Maya​Revindication.”​Maya Cultural Activism in Guatemala,​ed.​E.​F.​Fischer​and​R.​McKenna​Brown,​19–50.​Austin:​University​of​Texas​Press / Institute​of​Latin​American​Studies. ———.​1995.​Ub’aniik ri una’ooj uchomab’aal ri maya’ tinamit: Configuración del pensamiento político del pueblo maya.​Guatemala:​n.p. ———.​1991.​Configuración del pensamiento político del Pueblo Maya.​Guatemala:​ Asociación​de​Escritores​Mayances. ———.​1989.​“Problemas​de​la​‘identidad​nacional’​guatemalteca.”​cocaDi ,​Cultura Maya y Políticas de Desarrollo.​B’okob’,​Guatemala:​n.p.

226 reFerences

Coleman,​A.​L.​2006.​“‘Tell​the​Court​I​Love​My​[Indian]​Wife’:​Interrogating​Race​ and​Self-​Identity​in​Loving v. Virginia.”​Souls​8:1,​67–80. Collier,​G.​A.​1994.​Basta! Land and the Zapatista Rebellion in Chiapas.​Oakland:​ Food​First​Books. ———.​1991.​“Mesoamerican​Anthropology:​Between​Production​and​Hegemony.”​ Latin American Research Review​26:2,​203–10. Condori,​G.​2003.​“Experiencias​comunicacionales​de​la​Asociación​de​Radioemisoras​Aimaras​de​La​Paz.”​Los andes desde los andes: Aymaranakana, qhichwanakana yatxatawipa, lup’iwipa,​ed.​E.​Ticona,​81–121.​La​Paz:​Yachaywasi. El Consejo de Jefes de Rapa Nui. Te Mau Hatu’O Rapa Nui.​1988.​Santiago:​Editorial​ Emisión. Coronil,​F.​2004.​“¿Globalización​liberal​o​imperialismo​global?​Cinco​piezas​para​ armar​el​rompecabezas​del​presente.”​Comentario Internacional,​no.​5,​103–32.​ Quito:​uasb . Cristino,​C.,​et​al.​1984.​Isla de Pascua: Proceso, Alcances y Efectos de la Aculturación.​ Santiago​de​Chile:​Universidad​de​Chile. Cruikshank,​J.​2002.​“Oral​History,​Narrative​Strategies,​and​Native​American​Historiography:​Perspectives​from​the​Yukon​Territory,​Canada.”​Clearing a Path: Theorizing the Past in Native American Studies,​ed.​N.​Shoemaker,​3–27.​New​ York:​Routledge. Delgado​Pop,​A.​2000.​“¿Qué​es​ser​indígena​a​las​puertas​del​nuevo​milenio?”​ Identidad: rostros sin máscaras. Reflexiones sobre cosmovisión, género y etnicidad,​ed.​M.​McLeod​and​M.​L.​Cabrera,​15–24.​Guatemala:​Oxfam-​Australia. Deloria​Jr.,​V.​1988​(1969).​Custer Died for Your Sins: An Indian Manifesto.​Norman:​ University​of​Oklahoma​Press. Deloria​Jr.,​V.,​and​C.​Lytle.​1984.​The Nations Within: The Past and Future of American Indian Sovereignty.​New​York:​Pantheon. Dirlik,​A.,​V.​Bahl,​and​P.​Gran,​eds.​2000.​History after the Three Worlds: PostEurocentric Historiographies.​Lanham,​Md.:​Rowman​and​Littlefield. Dresser,​D.​1991.​Neopopulist Solutions to Neoliberal Problems: Mexico’s National Solidarity Program.​La​Jolla,​Calif.:​Center​for​U.S.–Mexican​Studies. Du​Bois,​W.​E.​B.​1989​(1903).​The Souls of Black Folk.​New​York:​Bantam. Eber,​C.,​and​B.​Rosenbaum.​1993.​“‘That​We​May​Serve​beneath​Your​Flowery​ Hands​and​Feet:’​Women​Weavers​in​Highland​Chiapas,​Mexico.”​Crafts in Global Markets,​ed.​J.​Nash,​154–80.​Albany:​sunY ​Press. Eber,​C.,​and​J.​M.​Tanski.​2001.​“Obstacles​Facing​Women’s​Grassroots​Development​Strategies​in​Mexico.”​Review of Radical Political Economics​33,​441–60. Escobar,​A.​2000.​“El​lugar​de​la​naturaleza​y​la​naturaleza​del​lugar:​¿globalización​ o​postdesarrollo?”​La colonialidad del saber: Eurocentrismo y ciencias sociales, perspectivas latinoamericanas,​ed.​E.​Lander,​113–43.​Buenos​Aires:​clacso .

reFerences 227

———.​1999.​El final del salvaje: Naturaleza, cultura y política en la antropología contemporánea.​Bogotá:​cerec ,​ican . Esquit,​E.​2004.​“Las​Rutas​que​nos​Ofrecen​el​Pasado​y​el​Presente:​Activismo​Político,​Historia​y​Pueblo​Maya.”​Memorias del Mestizaje,​ed.​D.​A.​Euraque,​J.​L.​ Gould,​and​C.​Hale,​167–92.​Guatemala:​cirMa . Fanon,​F.​2004.​The Wretched of the Earth.​New​York:​Grove,​2004. Fenton,​S.,​and​P.​Moon.​2002.​“The​Translation​of​the​Treaty​of​Waitangi:​A​Case​ of​Disempowerment.”​Translation and Power,​ed.​M.​Tymoczko​and​E.​Gentzler,​25–44.​Amherst:​University​of​Massachusetts​Press. Fernández​Osco,​M.​2000.​La ley del ayllu: Práctica de jach’a justicia y jisk’a justicia (justicia mayor y justicia menor) en comunidades aymaras.​La​Paz:​pieb . Field,​L.​1999.​“Complicities​and​Collaborations:​Anthropologists​and​the​‘Unacknowledged​Tribes’​of​California.”​Current Anthropology​40(2),​193–209. Fischer,​E.​2001.​Cultural Logics and Global Economies.​Austin:​University​of​Texas​ Press. Fischer,​E.,​and​M.​Brown,​eds.​1999.​Rujotayixik ri maya’ b’anob’al. Activismo Cultural Maya.​Guatemala:​Editorial​Cholsamaj. Fishman,​J.​1995.​Sociología del lenguaje.​4th​edn.​Madrid:​Cátedra. Florescano,​E.​2001.​“Memoria​indígena:​Un​nuevo​enfoque​sobre​la​construcción​ del​pasado.”​Trayectorias, Revista de Ciencias Sociales,​no.​4/5,​133–41.​Mexico​ City:​Universidad​Autónoma​de​Nuevo​León. Foley,​N.​2002.​“Becoming​Hispanic:​Mexican-​Americans​and​Whiteness.”​White Privilege: Essential Reading on the Other Side of Racism,​ed.​P.​S.​Rothenberg,​ 49–59.​New​York:​Worth. Forbes,​J.​1993.​Africans and Native Americans: The Language of Race and the Evolution of Red-Black Peoples.​2d​edn.​Urbana:​University​of​Illinois​Press. Freire,​P.​1969.​La educación como práctica de la libertad.​Montevideo:​Tierra​Nueva. Garcés,​F.​2006.​“Herramientas​para​pensar​la​globalización,​el​capitalismo​y​la​ cultura​sin​morir​en​el​intento.”​Punto Cero: Revista de la carrera de communicación social,​no.​12:​43–58.​Cochabamba:​ucb . ———.​2005a.​“Las​políticas​del​conocimiento​y​la​colonialidad​lingüística​y​epistémica.”​Pensamiento crítico y matriz (de)colonial: Reflexiones latinoamericanas,​ ed.​C.​Walsh,​137–67.​Quito:​Abya​Yala,​uasb . ———.​2005b.​De la voz al papel: La escritura quechua del Periódico CONOSUR Ñawpaqman.​La​Paz:​cenDa ,​Plural. Garcés,​F.,​and​S.​Guzmán.​2006.​“La​‘escuela​ayni’​de​Rumi​Muqu.”​Escuelas y proceses de cambins,​ed.​Alejandra​Ramírez,​35–44.​Cochabamba:​cesu . ———.​2003.​Educacionqa kawsayninchikmanta kawsayninchikpaq kanan tiyan. Elementos para diversificar el currículo de la Nación Quechua.​Cochabamba:​ cenaq .

228 reFerences

García,​F.​2005.​Yachay. Concepciones sobre enseñanza y aprendizaje en una comunidad quechua.​La​Paz:​Plural,​pinseib ,​proeib ​Andes. García​Ruiz,​J.​1992.​Historias de nuestra historia.​Guatemala:​iripaZ . Garza,​A.​M.,​and​S.​Toledo.​2008.​“Women,​Agrarianism​and​Militancy:​Chiapas​ in​the​1980s.”​Latin American Perspectives​35:6,​61–78. Gilroy,​P.​1993.​The Black Atlantic: Modernity and Double Consciousness.​Cambridge:​ Harvard​University​Press. González​Casanova,​P.​1965.​“Internal​Colonialism​and​National​Development.”​ Studies in Comparative Development​1:4,​27–37. Goody,​J.​1996​(1968).​“Introducción.”​Cultura escrita en sociedades tradicionales,​ ed.​J.​Goody,​11–38.​Barcelona:​Gedisa. Gottret,​G.​1999.​“Interculturalidad​en​el​aula.”​Interculturalidad y calidad de los aprendizajes en ámbitos escolares urbanos,​ed.​N.​Mengoa,​31–40.​La​Paz:​Centro​Boliviano​de​Investigación​y​Acción​Educativas. Grandin,​G.​2000.​The Blood of Guatemala: A History of Race and Nation.​Durham:​ Duke​University​Press. Greenbaum,​S.​“What’s​in​a​Label?​Identity​Problems​of​Southern​Indian​Tribes.”​ Journal of Ethnic Studies​19:2​(summer​1991),​107–26. Griswold,​E.​A.​1996.​“State​Hegemony​Writ:​International​Law​and​Indigenous​ Rights.”​Political and Legal Anthropology Review​19:1,​91–104. Guamán​Poma​de​Ayala,​F.​1993​(1615).​Nueva Coronica y Buen Gobierno.​Edited​by​ F.​Pease.​Translated​by​J.​Szeminski.​Mexico​City:​Fondo​de​Cultura​Económica. Gugelberger,​G.​1996.​The Real Thing: Testimonial Discourse and Latin America.​ Durham:​Duke​University​Press. Guha,​R.,​and​G.​C.​Spivak,​eds.​1998.​Selected Subaltern Studies.​New​York:​Oxford​ University​Press. Guzmán,​S.​2005.​“El​quechua​en​las​radios​urbanas.”​Presentation​given​at​the​ National​Seminar​Las​lenguas​andinas​y​su​enseñanza​en​contextos​urbanos.​ Cochabamba,​24–26​November​2005. Guzmán​Böckler,​C.,​and​J.​Herbert.​1998.​Guatemala: Una interpretación histórico social.​Guatemala:​Editorial​Cholsamaj. Hale,​C.​R.​2002.​“Does​Multiculturalism​Menace?​Governance,​Cultural​Rights​ and​the​Politics​of​Identity​in​Guatemala.”​Journal of Latin American Studies​34,​ 485–524. Hale,​C.​R.,​and​R.​Millamán.​2006.​“Cultural​Agency​and​Political​Struggle​in​the​ Era​of​the​Indio Permitido.”​Cultural Agency in the Americas,​ed.​D.​Sommer,​ 281–304.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. Harvey,​N.​1998.​The Chiapas Rebellion: The Struggle for Land and Democracy.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. Hasager,​U.,​and​J.​Friedman.​1994.​Hawai‘i Return to Nationhood.​Copenhagen:​ International​Working​Group​for​Indigenous​Affairs,​Document​no.​75. reFerences 229

Heise,​M.,​F.​Tubino,​and​W.​Ardito.​1994.​Interculturalidad: Un desafío.​Lima:​Centro​Amazónico​de​Antropología​y​Aplicación​Práctica. Hernández​Castillo,​R.​A.,​ed.​2001.​The Other Word: Women and Violence in Chiapas before and after Acteal.​Copenhagen:​International​Work​Group​for​ ​Indigenous​Affairs. Herrero,​J.,​and​F.​Sánchez​de​Lozada.​1979.​Diccionario quechua: Estructura semántica del quechua cochabambino contemporáneo.​Cochabamba:​ceFco . Hill,​R.​2001.​Los kaqchikeles de la época colonial.​Plumsock​Mesoamerican​Studies.​ Guatemala:​Editorial​Cholsamaj. Howe,​L.​2002.​“The​Story​of​America:​A​Tribalography.”​Clearing a Path: Theorizing the Past in Native American Studies,​ed.​N.​Shoemaker,​29–48.​New​York:​ Routledge. Hurtado​de​Mendoza,​W.​2002.​Pragmática de la cultura y la lengua quechua.​Quito:​ Abya​Yala. James,​D.​2000.​Doña María’s Story: Life History, Memory, and Political Identity.​ Durham:​Duke​University​Press. Jameson,​F.​1991​(1984).​El posmodernismo o la lógica cultural del posmodernismo avanzado.​Barcelona:​Paidós. Jones,​D.​J.​1970.​“Towards​a​Native​Anthropology.”​Human Organization​29:4,​ 251–59. Kame‘eleihiwa,​L.​1992.​Native Land and Foreign Desires.​Honolulu:​Bishop​Museum​Press. Kauanui,​J.​K.​2008.​“Colonialism​in​Equality:​Hawaiian​Sovereignty​and​the​Question​of​US​Civil​Rights.”​South Atlantic Quarterly​107:4​(October),​635–50. ———.​2005a.​“The​Multiplicity​of​Hawaiian​Sovereignty​Claims​and​the​Struggle​ for​Meaningful​Autonomy.”​Comparative American Studies​3:3,​283–99. ———.​2005b.​“Precarious​Positions:​Native​Hawaiians​and​Federal​Recognition.”​ Contemporary Pacific​17:1,​1–27. ———.​2002.​“The​Politics​of​Blood​and​Sovereignty​in​Rice v. Cayetano.”​Political and Legal Anthropology Review​25:1,​100–128. Kent,​N.​1993.​Hawai‘i: Islands under the Influence.​2d​edn.​Honolulu:​University​of​ Hawai‘i​Press. Kirch,​P.​V.​2000.​On the Road of the Winds: An Archeological History of the Pacific Islands before European Contact.​Berkeley:​University​of​California​Press. Kotschi,​T.,​W.​Oesterreicher,​and​K.​Zimmermann,​eds.​1996.​El español hablado y la cultura oral en España e Hispanoamérica.​Madrid:​Iberoamericana. Kristeva,​J.​1982.​Semiótica I.​Madrid:​Espiral. Laclau,​E.,​and​C.​Mouffe.​1985.​Hegemony and Socialist Strategy: Towards a Radical Democratic Politics.​London:​Verso. Laime,​T.​1998.​Qhichwata allinta qillqanapaq p’anqa. Manual de ortografía quechua.​ La​Paz:​ceipliM . 230 reFerences

Lakoff,​G.,​and​M.​Jonson.​1995​(1980).​Metáforas de la vida cotidiana.​Madrid:​ Cátedra. Lam,​M.​C.​2000.​At the Edge of the State: Indigenous Peoples and Self-Determination.​ Ardsley,​N.Y.:​Transnational. ———.​1992.​“Making​Room​for​Peoples​at​the​United​Nations:​Thoughts​Provoked​by​Indigenous​Claims​to​Self-​Determination.”​Cornell International Law Journal​25:3,​603–22. Lame,​M.​Q.​2004​(1939).​Los pensamientos del indio que se educó dentro de las selvas colombianas.​Cali​and​Popayán,​Colombia:​Editorial​Universidad​del​ Valle/Editoral​Universidad​del​Cauca. Lander,​E.​2002a.​“La​utopía​del​mercado​total​y​el​poder​imperial.”​Revista venezolana de Economía y Ciencias Sociales​8:2,​51–79. ———.​2002b.​“Los​derechos​de​propiedad​intelectual​en​la​geopolítica​del​saber​ de​la​sociedad​global.”​Indisciplinar las ciencias sociales: Geopolíticas del conocimiento y colonialidad del poder, Perspectivas desde lo andino,​ed.​C.​Walsh,​ F.​Schiwy,​and​S.​Castro-​Gómez,​73–102.​Quito:​uasb ,​Abya​Yala. Laughlin,​R.​M.​1993.​“En​la​vanguardia:​Sna​Jtz’ibajom.”​Situación actual y perspectivas de las literaturas en lenguas indígenas,​ed.​C.​Montemayor​155–72.​Mexico​ City:​coneculta . Legorreta,​C.​1998.​Religión, política y guerrilla en Las Cañadas de la Selva Lacandona.​Mexico​City:​Cal​y​Arena. Leyva​Solano,​X.​2003.​“Regional,​Communal,​and​Organizational​Transformations​in​Las​Cañadas.”​Mayan Lives, Mayan Utopias: The Indigenous People of Chiapas and the Zapatista Movement,​ed.​J.​Rus,​R.​A.​Hernández​Castillo,​and​ S.​L.​Mattiace,​161–84.​Lanham,​Md.:​Rowman​and​Littlefield. Lienhard,​M.​1992.​La voz y su huella: Escritura y conflicto étnico-cultural en América Latina 1492–1988.​3d​edn.​Lima:​Horizonte. Lipsitz,​G.​1998.​American Studies in a Moment of Danger.​Minneapolis:​University​ of​Minnesota​Press. ———.​2006​(1998).​The Possessive Investment in Whiteness: How White People Profit from Identity Politics.​Philadelphia:​Temple​University​Press. Littlefield,​D.​F.​1977.​Africans and Seminoles: From Removal to Emancipation.​Westport,​Conn.:​Greenwood​Press. Lomnitz-​Adler,​C.​1995.​Las salidas del Laberinto.​Mexico​City:​Editorial​Planeta. Loomba,​A.,​S.​Kaul,​M.​Bunzl,​A.​Burton,​and​J.​Esty,​eds.​2005.​Postcolonial Studies and Beyond.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. López,​L.​E.​1999.​“El​lenguaje​en​el​desarrollo​de​los​conocimientos​en​ámbitos​ escolares​urbanos​con​diversidad​cultural.”​Interculturalidad y calidad de los aprendizajes en ámbitos escolares urbanos,​ed.​N.​Mengoa,​47–70.​La​Paz:​Centro​Boliviano​de​Investigación​y​Acción​Educativas. ———.​1996.​“No​más​danzas​de​ratones​grises:​Sobre​interculturalidad,​democrareFerences 231

cia​y​educación.”​Educación e interculturalidad en los Andes y la Amazonía,​ed.​ J.​Godenzzi​Alegre,​23–80.​Serie​Estudios​y​Debates​Regionales​Andinos,​93.​ Cusco:​Centro​de​Estudios​Regionales​Bartolomé​de​Las​Casas. ———.​1995.​La educación en áreas indígenas de América Latina: Apreciaciones comparativas desde la educación bilingüe intercultural.​Guatemala​City:​Centro​ de​Estudios​de​la​Cultura​Maya. López,​L.​E.,​and​W.​Küper.​2004.​La educación intercultural bilingüe en América Latina.​La​Paz,​Cochabamba:​pinseib ,​proeib ​Andes. Loveman,​B.​2001​(1979).​Chile: The Legacy of Hispanic Capitalism.​Oxford:​Oxford​ University​Press. Luykx,​A.​1998.​“La​diferencia​funcional​de​códigos​y​el​futuro​de​las​lenguas​minoritarias.”​Sobre las huellas de la voz: Sociolingüística de la oralidad y la escritura en su relación con la educación,​ed.​L.​E.​López​and​I.​Jung,​192–212.​Madrid,​ Cochabamba,​Bonn:​Morata,​proeib ​Andes,​Dse . ———.​2001.​“Diversity​in​the​New​World​Order:​State​Language​Policies​and​the​ Internationalization​of​Quechua.”​Abstract​of​paper​presented​at​the​Second​ Spencer​Early​Career​Institute​in​Anthropology​and​Education:​Globalization​ and​Education,​10–13​May.​Chicago. McCall,​G.​1976.​“Reaction​to​Disaster:​Continuity​and​Change​in​Rapanui​Social​ Organization.”​Ph.D.​diss.,​Australian​National​University. Makihara,​M.​1999.​“Bilingualism,​Social​Change,​and​the​Politics​of​Ethnicity​on​ Rapanui​(Easter​Island),​Chile.”​Ph.D.​diss.,​Yale​University. Mannheim,​B.​1991.​The Language of the Inka since the European Invasion.​Austin:​ University​of​Texas​Press. Marcone,​J.​1997.​La oralidad escrita: Sobre la reivindicación y la re-inscripción del discurso oral.​Lima:​puc-p . Marcus,​G.​1995.​“Ethnography​in/of​the​World​System:​The​Emergence​of​Multi-​ Sited​Ethnography.”​Annual Review of Anthropology,​24,​95–117. Marcus,​G.,​and​M.​Fischer.​1986.​Anthropology as a Cultural Critique: An Experimental Moment in the Human Sciences.​Chicago:​University​of​Chicago​Press. Marimán,​Pablo,​Sergio​Caníuqueo,​José​Millalén,​and​Rodrigo​Levil.​2006.​​ ¡​.​.​.​Escucha,​winka​.​.​.​!​Cuatro​ensayos​de​Historia​Nacional​Mapuche​y​un​ epílogo​sobre​el​futuro.​Santiago,​Chile:​loM ​Ediciones. Martínez​Peláez,​S.​1973.​La Patria del Criollo.​Costa​Rica:​eDuca . Menchú,​R.​1984.​I, Rigoberta Menchú.​Edited​by​Elisabeth​Burgos.​London:​Verso. Mengoa,​N.​1999.​“Diversidad​y​procesos​pedagógicos:​Lineamientos​para​una​propuesta​de​educación​intercultural​en​escuelas​urbano-​populares​de​la​región​ andina​en​Bolivia.”​Interculturalidad y calidad de los aprendizajes en ámbitos escolares urbanos,​ed.​N.​Mengoa,​11–20.​La​Paz:​Centro​Boliviano​de​Investigación​y​Acción​Educativas.

232 reFerences

Merrell,​J.​H.​1984.​“The​Racial​Education​of​the​Catawba​Indians.”​Journal of Southern History​50:3,​363–84. Merry,​S.​2000.​Colonizing Hawai‘i: The Cultural Power of Law.​Princeton:​Princeton​University​Press. Métraux,​A.​1971​(1940).​Ethnology of Easter Island.​Honolulu:​Bishop​Museum​Press. Mignolo,​W.​2004.​“Capitalismo​y​geopolítica​del​conocimiento.”​Modernidades Coloniales,​ed.​S.​Dube,​I.​Banergee​Dube,​and​W.​Mignolo.​Mexico​City:​El​ Colegio​de​México. ———.​2002.​“El​potencial​epistemológico​de​la​historia​oral:​Algunas​contribuciones​de​Silvia​Rivera​Cusicanqui.”​Estudios y otras prácticas intelectuales latinoamericanas en cultura y poder,​ed.​D.​Mato,​201–11.​Caracas:​clacso ,​ Faces . ———.​2001.​“Introducción.”​Capitalismo y geopolítica del conocimiento: El eurocentrismo y la filosofía de la liberación en el debate intelectual contemporáneo,​ 9–53.​Buenos​Aires:​Signo. ———.​2000.​Local Histories / Global Designs. Coloniality, Subaltern Knowledges and Border Thinking.​Princeton:​Princeton​University​Press. ———.​1999.​“Globalización,​procesos​civilizatorios​y​la​reubicación​de​lenguas​y​ culturas.”​Pensar (en) los intersticios: Teoría y práctica de la crítica poscolonial,​ ed.​S.​Castro-​Gómez,​O.​Guardiola-​Rivera,​and​C.​Millán​de​Benavides,​55–74.​ Bogotá:​Pensar. Mihesuah,​D.​A.​2004.​“Should​American​Indian​History​Remain​a​Field​of​Study?”​ Indigenizing the Academy: Transforming Scholarship and Empowering Communities,​ed.​D.​A.​Mihesuah​and​A.​C.​Wilson,​143–59.​Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. Mihesuah,​D.​A.,​ed.​1998.​Natives and Academics: Researching and Writing about American Indians.​Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. Mihesuah,​D.​A.,​and​A.​C.​Wilson,​eds.​2004.​Indigenizing the Academy: Transforming Scholarship and Empowering Communities.​Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. Miles,​T.​2004.​The Ties that Bind: The Story of an Afro-Cherokee Family in Slavery and Freedom.​Berkeley:​University​of​California​Press. Miles,​T.,​and​S.​P.​Holland,​eds.​2006.​Crossing Waters, Crossing Worlds: The African Diaspora in Indian Country.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. Mills,​G.​B.​1977.​The Forgotten People: Cane River’s Creoles of Color.​Baton​Rouge:​ Louisiana​State​University​Press. Minugua .​2001.​Proceso de negociación de la Paz en Guatemala.​Guatemala:​ Minugua . Montejo,​V.​2005.​Maya Intellectual Renaissance: Identity, Representation and Leadership.​Austin:​University​of​Texas​Press. ———.​2004.​“Angering​the​Ancestors:​Transnationalism​and​Economic​TransforreFerences 233

mation​of​Maya​Communities​in​Western​Guatemala.”​Pluralizing Ethnography: Comparison and Representation in Maya Cultures, Histories, and Identities,​ ed.​J.​Watanabe​and​E.​Fischer,​231–56.​Santa​Fe:​School​of​American​Research​ Press. ———.​2002.​“The​Multiplicity​of​Maya​Voices:​Maya​Leadership​and​the​Politics​ of​Self-​Representation.”​Indigenous Movements, Self-Representation, and the State in Latin America,​ed.​K.​B.​Warren​and​J.​Jackson,​123–48.​Austin:​University​of​Texas​Press. ———.​1999.​Voices from Exile: Violence and Survival in Modern Maya History.​ Norman:​University​of​Oklahoma​Press. ———.​1997.​“Panmayanismo:​La​pluriformidad​de​la​cultura​maya​y​el​proceso​de​ autorepresentación​de​los​mayas.”​Mesoamérica,​no.​33,​93–123.​Antigua,​Guatemala:​cirMa ,​pMs . ———.​1987.​Testimony: The Death of a Guatemalan Village.​Willimantic,​Conn.:​ Curbstone​Press. Morales,​M.​R.​1998.​La articulación de las diferencias.​Guatemala:​Flacso -​ Guatemala. Morales​Bermúdez,​J.​1992.​“El​Congreso​Indígena​de​Chiapas:​Un​testimonio.”​ Anuario 1991,​242–370.​Instituto​Chiapaneco​de​la​Cultura,​Tuxtla​Gutiérrez. Morrison,​T.​1988.​Beloved.​New​York:​Plume. Muelas​Hurtado,​B.​1995.​“Relación​espacio-​tiempo​en​el​pensamiento​guambiano.”​ Proyecciones Lingüísticas​1:1,​31–40. Muyulema,​A.​2001.​“De​la​cuestión​indígena​a​lo​indígena​como​cuestionamiento:​ Hacia​una​crítica​del​latinoamericanismo,​el​indigenismo​y​el​mestiz(o)aje.”​Convergencia de tiempos: Estudios subalternos/contextos latinoamericanos. Estado, cultura y subalternidad,​ed.​I.​Rodríguez,​327–63.​Amsterdam:​Editions​Rodopi. Nannerl,​O.​K.,​M.​Z.​Rosaldo,​and​B.​C.​Gelpi,​eds.​1982.​Feminist Theory: A Critique of Ideology.​Chicago:​University​of​Chicago​Press. Nash,​J.​1993.​Crafts in Global Markets: Changes in Artisan Production in Middle America.​Albany:​State​University​of​New​York​Press. Newcomb,​S.​2008.​Pagans in the Promised Land: Decoding the Doctrine of Christian Discovery.​Golden,​Colo.:​Fulcrum. Norval,​A.​2001.​“Reconstructing​National​Identity​and​Renegotiating​Memory:​ The​Work​of​the​TRC.”​States of Imagination: Ethnographic Explorations of the Postcolonial State,​ed.​T.​Blom​Hansen​and​F.​Stepputat,​182–202.​Durham:​ Duke​University​Press. Olson,​D.​1998​(1994).​El mundo sobre el papel: El impacto de la escritura y la lectura en la estructura del conocimiento.​Barcelona:​Gedisa. Omi,​M.,​and​H.​Winant.​1994.​Racial Formation in the United States from the 1960s to the 1990s.​2d​edn.​New​York:​Routledge. Ong,​W.​1992.​“Writing​Is​a​Technology​that​Restructures​Thought.”​The Linguis234 reFerences

tics of Literacy,​ed.​P.​Downing,​S.​Lima,​and​M.​Noonan,​293–319.​Philadelphia:​ John​Benjamins. ———.​1999​(1982).​Oralidad y escritura: Tecnologías de la palabra.​Mexico​City:​ Fce . Osorio,​J.​K.​2002.​Dismembering Lahui: A History of the Hawaiian Nation to 1887.​ Honolulu:​University​of​Hawai‘i​Press. Pachacuti​Yamqui​Salcamaygua,​J.​1993​(1613).​Relacion de antiguiedades deste reyno del Piru.​Estudio​etnohistórico​y​lingüístico​de​Pierre​Duviols​y​César​Itier.​ Lima,​Cuzco:​iFea ,​cbc . Pancho​Aquite,​A.,​et​al.​2004.​Educación superior indígena en Colombia: Una apuesta de futuro y esperanza.​Cali,​Colombia:​iesalc –unesco . Pari,​A.​2005.​“Epistemología​del​conocimiento​científico​andino:​yachaymanta​ yachay.”​Qinasay, Revista de Educación Intercultural Bilingüe​3:3,​67–81.​Cochabamba:​proeib ​Andes. Paschal,​R.​1991.​“The​Imprimatur​of​Recognition:​American​Indian​Tribes​and​the​ Federal​Acknowledgment​Process.”​Washington Law Review​66​(1991),​209–28. Past,​Á.​2005.​“Notes​on​the​Creators.”​Incantations by Mayan Women,​ed.​Á.​Past,​ X.​Okotz,​and​X.​Ernándes,​257–84.​San​Cristóbal:​Taller​Leñateros. ———.​1989​(1980).​Bon, tintes naturales.​San​Cristóbal:​Taller​Leñateros. Paz,​S.​2005.​“Propuesta​base​para​pensar​las​autonomías​indígenas​en​Bolivia.”​ Paper​given​in​the​Seminar​Territorios​indígenas,​interculturalidad,​participación​y​autonomías.​Cochabamba,​3–4​March. Paz​Paredes,​L.,​R.​Cobo,​and​A.​Bartra.​1996.​“Dos​siglos​de​cafeticultura​en​ México​a​muchas​voces.”​Ojarasca,​no.​46,​26–49. Perdue,​T.​1999.​Cherokee Women: Gender and Culture Change, 1700–1835.​Lincoln:​ University​of​Nebraska​Press. ———.​1979.​Slavery and the Evolution of Cherokee Society, 1540–1866.​Knoxville:​ University​of​Tennessee​Press. Peres​Tzu,​M.​2002.​“A​Tzotzil​Chronicle.”​The Mexico Reader,​ed.​G.​Joseph​and​ T.​Henderson,​655–69.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. Pérez,​Calvo,​J.​1993.​Pragmática y gramática del quechua cuzqueño.​Cuzco:​cbc . Pewewardy,​C.​2004.​“So​You​Think​You​Hired​an​‘Indian’​Faculty​Member?:​The​ Ethnic​Fraud​Paradox​in​Higher​Education.”​Indigenizing the Academy: Transforming Scholarship and Empowering Native Communities,​ed.​D.​A.​Mihesuah​ and​A.​C.​Wilson,​200–217.​Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. Phillips,​V.​J.​2002.​“Epilogue:​Seeing​Each​Other​through​the​White​Man’s​Eyes.”​ Confounding the Color Line: The Indian–Black Experience in North America,​ed.​ J.​Brooks,​371–85.​Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. Plaza,​P.​1995.​Qhichwata qillqanapaq.​La​Paz:​MDh ,​unst-p . Portelli,​A.​1997.​The Battle of Valle Giulia: Oral History and the Art of Dialogue,​ Madison:​University​of​Wisconsin​Press. reFerences 235

———.​1991.​The Death of Luigi Trastulli and Other Stories: Form and Meaning in Oral History.​Albany:​State​University​of​New​York​Press. ———.​1989.​“Historia​y​memoria:​La​muerte​de​Luigi​Trastulli.”​Historia y fuente oral,​no.​1,​15–32.​Barcelona:​Universidad​de​Barcelona. Porteous,​D.​1981.​The Modernization of Easter Island.​Victoria,​British​Columbia:​ University​of​Victoria​Press. Postero,​N.​2005.​“Movimientos​indígenas​bolivianos:​Articulaciones​y​fragmentaciones​en​búsqueda​de​multiculturalismo.”​Movimientos Indígenas y Estado en Bolivia,​ed.​L.​E.​López​and​P.​Regalsky,​53–96.​La​Paz:​proeib ​Andes,​cenDa ,​ Plural. Pozas,​R.​1962.​Juan, the Chamula.​Berkeley:​University​of​California​Press. ———.​1952.​“El​trabajo​en​las​plantaciones​de​café​y​el​cambio​socio-​cultural​del​ indio.”​Revista Mexicana de Estudios Antropológicos​12:1,​31–48. Prakash,​G.,​ed.​1995.​After Colonialism: Imperial Histories and Postcolonial Displacements.​Princeton:​Princeton​University​Press. Qayum,​S.​2002.​“Nationalism,​Internal​Colonialism​and​the​Spatial​Imagination:​ The​Geographic​Society​of​La​Paz​in​Turn-​of-​the-​Century​Bolivia.”​Studies in the Formation of the Nation-State in Latin America,​ed.​J.​Dunkerley,​275–98.​ London:​Institute​of​Latin​American​Studies,​University​of​London. Quijano,​A.​2000.​“Colonialidad​del​poder​y​clasificación​social.”​Journal of WorldSystems Research​6:2,​342–86. Quiroz,​A.​1998.​Chichwa simipirwa.​Qullasuyu,​Bolivia:​Mec yD ,​uniceF . Racancoj,​V.​1994.​Socioeconomía maya precolonial.​Guatemala:​Editorial​Cholsamaj. Raibmon,​P.​2005.​Authentic Indians: Episodes of Encounter from the LateNineteenth-Century Northwest Coast.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. Rajpopi’​ri​Mayab’​Amaq’​coMg .​1995.​Ru junamil ri Mayab’ Amaq’ pa Rubi’inib’al Runuk’ik ri Saqk’aslemal. Construyendo un futuro para nuestro pasado.​Guatemala:​Editorial​Cholsamaj. Ramos,​A.,​and​Cabildo​Indígena​de​Mosoco.​1993.​Ec ne’hwe’s’: Constitución política de Colombia en nasa yuwe.​Bogotá:​ccela -​UniAndes. Rappaport,​J.​2008.​“Beyond​Participant​Observation:​Collaborative​Ethnography​ as​Theoretical​Innovation.”​Collaborative Anthropologies​1,​1–31. ———.​2005.​“Los​nasa​de​frontera​y​la​política​de​la​identidad​en​el​Cauca​Indígena.”​Retornando la mirada: Una investigación colaborativa interétnica sobre el Cauca a la entrada del milenio,​ed.​J.​Rappaport,​31–56.​Popayán,​Colombia:​ Editorial​Universidad​del​Cauca. ———.​2004.​“Imaginando​una​nación​pluralista:​Intelectuales​y​la​jurisdicción​ especial​indígena.”​Revista Colombiana de Antropología​39,​105–38. ———.​1998.​The Politics of Memory: Native Historical Interpretation in the Colombian Andes.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. 236 reFerences

Regalsky,​P.​2003.​Etnicidad y clase: El Estado boliviano y las estrategias andinas de manejo de su espacio.​La​Paz:​cenDa ,​ceiDis ,​Plural. Reuque​Paillalef,​R.​I.​2002a.​When a Flower Is Reborn: The Life and Times of a Mapuche Feminist.​Edited​and​translated​by​F.​E.​Mallon.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. ———.​2002b.​Una flor que renace: Autobiografía de una dirigente Mapuche.​Santiago,​Chile:​DibaM . Rivera,​S.​2004​(1987).​“El​potencial​epistemológico​y​teórico​de​la​historia​oral:​ De​la​lógica​instrumental​a​la​descolonización​de​la​historia.”​Peri-feria,​no.​4,​ 16–26.​Neiva:​Editorial​Universidad​Surcolombiana. Rivera​Cusicanqui,​S.,​and​R.​Barragán.​1997.​“Presentación.”​Debates Post Coloniales: Una Introducción a los Estudios de la Subalternidad,​ed.​S.​Rivera​Cusicanqui​and​R.​Barragán,​11–19.​La​Paz,​Bolivia:​Editorial​historias/Ediciones​ Aruwiyiri/sephis . Rochna-​Ramírez,​S.​1996.​La propiedad de la tierra en Isla de Pascua.​Santiago:​ conaDi . Rodríguez,​D.​R.​2004.​“Racismo​y​discriminación:​Conceptualización​y​sus​manifestaciones.”​Genocidio, la máxima expresión del racismo.​Guatemala:​calDh . Rodríguez,​D.​R.,​et​al.​1995.​Nab’ey taq tzij pa ruwi’ ri maya’ k’aslemal. Introducción a la cultura maya.​Guatemala:​Editorial​Cholsamaj. Rojas​Curieux,​T.​2000.​“Transportar​la​cosa​hablada​a​otra​lengua:​La​experiencia​ de​la​traducción​de​la​Constitución​de​la​República​a​lenguas​indígenas.”​Concepciones de la Conquista: Aproximaciones interdisciplinarias,​ed.​F.​Castañeda​ and​M.​Vollet,​361–88.​Bogotá:​Ediciones​UniAndes. Romero,​R.​1994.​Ch’iki: Concepción y desarrollo de la inteligencia en niños quechuas pre-escolares de la comunidad de Titicachi.​La​Paz:​cee ,​peib . Rothenberg,​P.​S.,​ed.​2002.​White Privilege: Essential Readings on the Other Side of Racism.​New​York:​Worth. Rountree,​H.​C.​1990.​Pocahontas’s People: The Powhatan Indians of Virginia through Four Centuries.​Norman:​University​of​Oklahoma​Press. Routledge,​K.​1998​(1919).​The Mystery of Easter Island.​Kempton,​Australia:​Adventurers​Unlimited​Press. Rus,​D.​1990.​La Crisis y la mujer indígena: El caso de Chamula, Chiapas.​San​ Cristóbal:​inareMac . Rus,​D.,​and​J.​Rus.​2004.​“Los​últimos​diez​años​en​las​comunidades​de​Los​Altos​ en​el​contexto​de​los​últimos​treinta.”​Paper​presented​to​the​symposium​ Chiapas,​10​años​después.​San​Cristóbal,​23–27​August. Rus,​J.​2005.​“The​Struggle​against​Indigenous​Caciques​in​Highland​Chiapas,​1965– 1993.”​Cacique and Caudillo in 20th Century Mexico,​ed.​A.​Knight​and​W.​Pansters,​169–200.​London:​Institute​for​Latin​American​Studies. ———.​2004.​“Rereading​Tzotzil​Ethnography:​Recent​Scholarship​from​Chiapas,​ reFerences 237

Mexico.”​Pluralizing Ethnography: Comparison and Representation in Maya Cultures, Histories and Identities,​ed.​J.​Watanabe​and​E.​Fischer,​199–230.​Santa​Fe:​ School​of​American​Research. ———.​1995.​“Local​Adaptation​to​Global​Change:​The​Reordering​of​Native​Society​in​Highland​Chiapas,​1974–1994.”​European Review of Latin American and Caribbean Studies​58,​82–91. ———.​1989.​“The​‘Caste​War’​of​1869​from​the​Indians’​Perspective:​A​Challenge​ for​Ethno​History.”​Memorias del Segundo Coloquio Internacional de Mayistas​ 2,​1033–47.​Mexico​City:​Centro​de​Estudios​Mayas,​unaM . ———.​1983.​“Whose​Caste​War?​Indians,​Ladinos,​and​the​‘Caste​War’​of​1869.”​ Spaniards and Indians in Southeastern Mesoamerica,​ed.​M.​MacLeod​and​R.​W.​ Wasserstrom,​127–68.​Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. Rus,​J.,​ed.​1999.​If Truth Be Told: A Forum on David Stoll’s “Rigoberta Menchú and the Story of All Poor Guatemalans.”​Special​issue​of​Latin American Perspectives​ 26:6. Rus,​J.,​and​G.​A.​Collier.​2003.​“A​Generation​of​Crisis​in​the​Chiapas​Highlands:​ The​Tzotzils​of​Chamula​and​Zinacantán,​1974–2000.”​Mayan Lives, Mayan Utopias: The Indigenous People of Chiapas and the Zapatista Movement,​ed.​ J.​Rus,​R.​A.​Hernández​Castillo,​and​S.​L.​Mattiace,​33–61.​Lanham,​Md.:​Rowman​and​Littlefield. Rus,​J.,​R.​A.​Hernández​Castillo,​and​S.​L.​Mattiace,​eds.​2003.​Mayan Lives, Mayan Utopias: The Indigenous People of Chiapas and the Zapatista Movement.​Lanham,​Md.:​Rowman​and​Littlefield. Rus,​J.,​and​G.​Morquecho.​2008.​“El​movimiento​indígena​de​San​Cristóbal,​ Chiapas,​Mexico.”​Paper​presented​to​the​conference​Enduring​Reform,​Responses​to​Civil​Society-​Based​Reform.​Porto​Alegre,​Brazil,​22–24​November. Rus,​J.,​and​J.​D.​Vigil.​2007.​“Rapid​Urbanization​and​Migrant​Indigenous​Youth​in​ San​Cristóbal,​Chiapas.”​Gangs in the Global City,​ed.​John​Hagedorn,​152–83.​ Urbana:​University​of​Illinois​Press. Said,​E.​W.​1978.​Orientalism.​New​York:​Pantheon. Santos,​B.​2003.​“Desigualdad,​exclusión​y​globalización:​Hacia​la​construcción​ multicultural​de​la​igualdad​y​la​diferencia.”​La caída del Angelus Novus: Ensayos para una nueva teoría social y una nueva práctica política,​ed.​B.​Santos,​ 125–65.​Bogotá:​ilsa ,​Universidad​Nacional​de​Colombia. Saunt,​C.​2005.​Black, White, and Indian: Race and the Unmaking of an American Family.​Oxford:​Oxford​University​Press. ———.​1999.​A New Order of Things: Property, Power, and the Transformation of the Creek Indians, 1733–1816.​Cambridge:​Cambridge​University​Press. Schele,​L.,​and​N.​Grube.​1999.​“El​Taller​maya​de​escritura​jeroglífica.”​Rujotayixik ri maya’ b’anob’al. Activismo Cultural maya,​ed.​E.​Fischer​and​M.​Brown,​175– 86.​Guatemala:​Editorial​Cholsamaj. 238 reFerences

Scott,​J.​2002.​“Prólogo.”​Aspectos cotidianos de la Formación del Estado,​ed.​ G.​Joseph​and​D.​Nugent,​17–23.​Mexico​City:​Editorial​Era. Sichra,​I.​2003.​La vitalidad del quechua: Lengua y sociedad en dos provincias de Cochabamba.​La​Paz:​proeib ​Andes,​Plural. Sieder,​R.​2004.​Del indigenismo institucional integracionista a la gestión pluralista de las políticas públicas.​London:​Institute​for​the​Study​of​the​Americas,​University​of​London. Silva,​N.​K.​2007.​“Indigenous​Hawaiian​Political​Thought.”​Presentation​on​New​ Research​Project,​Wesleyan​University,​April. ———.​2004.​Aloha Betrayed: Native Hawaiian Resistance to American Colonialism.​Durham:​Duke​University​Press. ———.​1998.​“Kanaka​Maoli​Resistance​to​Annexation.”​‘oiwi: a native hawaiian journal.​Inaugural​issue​(December),​40–80. Silva​Galdames,​O.​1995.​Breve historia contemporánea de Chile.​Mexico​City:​Fondo​ de​Cultura​Económica. Sincal​Coyote,​E.​2004.​“Elites​e​identidades:​La​diferenciación​social​del​sector​ profesional​indígena​de​Patzún,​Chimaltenango.”​Thesis,​Universidad​de​San​ Carlos​de​Guatemala. Sociedad​Bíblica​de​México.​1997.​Xch’ul C’op Jtotic Dios.​Mexico​City:​Sociedad​ Bíblica​de​México,​S.A. Spaulding,​T.​M.​1923.​The Crown Lands of Hawaii.​Honolulu:​University​of​Hawai‘i​ Press. Spivak,​G.​C.​1988.​“Can​the​Subaltern​Speak?”​Marxism and the Interpretation of Culture,​ed.​C.​Nelson​and​L.​Grossberg,​271–313.​Urbana:​University​of​Illinois​ Press. Starna,​W.​1996.​“‘We’ll​All​Be​Together​Again’:​The​Federal​Acknowledgment​of​ the​Wampanoag​Tribe​of​Gay​Head.”​Northeast Anthropology​51,​3–12. Stavenhagen,​R.​1965.​“Classes,​Colonialism,​and​Acculturation.”​Studies in Comparative Development​1:6,​53–77. Stoll,​D.​1999.​Rigoberta Menchú and the Story of All Poor Guatemalans.​Boulder:​ Westview​Press. Street,​B.​1984.​Literacy in Theory and Practice.​Cambridge:​Cambridge​University​ Press. Sturm,​C.​1998.​“Blood​Politics,​Racial​Classification,​and​Cherokee​National​Identity:​The​Trials​and​Tribulations​of​the​Cherokee​Freedmen.”​American Indian Quarterly​22:1–2​(winter/spring​1998),​230–58. Subercaseaux,​B.​1997.​Historia de las ideas y de la cultura en Chile.​Vol.​2:​Fin de siglo: La época de Balmaceda.​Santiago:​Editorial​Universitaria. Tademy,​T.​2002.​Cane River: A Novel.​New​York:​Warner. Thiong’o,​Ngugi​wa.​1986.​Decolonising the Mind: The Politics of Language in African Literature.​Portsmouth,​N.H.:​Heinemann. reFerences 239

Thompson,​B.,​and​J.​H.​Peterson,​Jr.​1975.​“Mississippi​Choctaw​Identity:​Genesis​ and​Change.”​The New Ethnicity: Perspectives from Ethnology,​ed.​J.​W.​Bennett,​ 179–96.​St.​Paul:​West​Publishing. Toledo,​S.​2002.​Fincas, poder, y cultura en Simojovel, Chiapas.​Mexico​City:​Universidad​Nacional​Autónoma​de​México/Universidad​Autónoma​de​Chiapas. Toledo​Llancaqueo,​V.,​and​S.​Fuenzalida​Bascuñan.​2005.​“Reforma​al​artículo​17​ de​la​ley​indígena​y​política​de​suelos​(DL​3.516):​Análisis​preliminar​de​sus​ efectos​jurídicos​e​impactos​territoriales.”​Notes​for​an​analytical​workshop.​ Colegio​de​Antropólogos​de​Chile.​Santiago,​19​May. Trask,​H.​2000.​“Settlers​of​Color​and​‘Immigrant’​Hegemony:​‘Locals’​in​Hawai‘i.”​ Amerasia Journal​26:2,​1–24. ———.​1993.​From a Native Daughter: Colonialism and Sovereignty in Hawai‘i.​ Monroe,​Maine:​Common​Courage​Press. Trask,​M.​1994.​“The​Politics​of​Oppression.”​Hawai‘i Return to Nationhood.​iWgia​ Document​75,​ed.​Ulla​Hasager​and​Jonathan​Friedman,​68–87.​Copenhagen:​ iWgia . Tuhiwai​Smith,​L.​1999.​Decolonizing Methodologies: Research and Indigenous Peoples.​Dunedin,​New​Zealand:​University​of​Otago​Press;​and​London:​Zed​ Books. United​States​Census​Bureau.​2002.​Measuring America: The Decennial Censuses from 1790 to 2000. Uyehara,​M.​1977.​The Ceded Land Trusts: Their Use and Misuse.​Honolulu:​Hawaiiana​Almanac. Vallejos,​F.​1995.​Tata Fermin yachaq. Inti k’anchay jina yachayniyki qhipakuchkan.​ Cochabamba:​cenDa . Van​Cott,​D.​L.​2000.​The Friendly Liquidation of the Past: The Politics of Diversity in Latin America.​Pittsburgh:​University​of​Pittsburgh​Press. Vasco​Uribe,​L.​G.​2002.​Entre selva y páramo: Viviendo y pensando la lucha indígena.​Bogotá:​Instituto​Colombiano​de​Antropología​e​Historia. Vasco​Uribe,​G.,​A.​Dagua​Hurtado,​and​M.​Aranda.​1993.​“En​el​segundo​día,​la​ Gente​Grande​(Numisak)​sembró​la​autoridad​y​las​plantas​y,​con​su​jugo,​ bebió​el​sentido.”​Encrucijadas de Colombia amerindia,​ed.​F.​Correa,​9–48.​ Bogotá:​Instituto​Colombiano​de​Antropología. Velásquez​Nimatuj,​I.​A.​2002.​La pequeña Burguesía Indígena Comercial de Guatemala.​Guatemala:​serJus . Vergara,​V.​1939.​La Isla de Pascua: Dominación y dominio.​Santiago:​Publicaciones​ de​la​Academia​Chilena​de​Historia. Viluche,​J.​2001.​“¿Por​qué​una​organización​social​como​cric ​asume​un​proceso​de​investigación​y​construcción​de​la​educación​alternativa?”​Manuscript.​ Popayán,​Colombia. Wallace,​R.​1997.​International Law.​London:​Sweet​and​Maxwell. 240 reFerences

Warren,​K.B.​1999.​“La​lectura​de​la​historia​una​forma​de​Resistencia:​Intelectuales​ públicos​mayas​en​Guatemala.”​Rujotayixik ri maya’ b’anob’al. Activismo Cultural maya,​ed.​E.​Fischer​and​M.​Brown,​133–54.​Guatemala:​Editorial​Cholsamaj. ———.​1998.​Indigenous Movements and Their Critics: Pan-Maya Activism in Guatemala.​Princeton:​Princeton​University​Press. Warrior,​R.​2006.​“Afterword.”​Crossing Waters, Crossing Worlds: The African Diaspora in Indian Country,​ed.​T.​Miles​and​S.​P.​Holland,​321–25.​Durham:​Duke​ University​Press. Watanabe,​J.,​and​E.​Fischer,​eds.​2004.​Pluralizing Ethnography.​Santa​Fe:​School​of​ American​Research​Press. Wilkins,​D.​E.​1997.​American Indian Sovereignty and the U.S. Supreme Court: The Masking of Justice.​Austin:​University​of​Texas​Press. Williams,​B.​1989.​“A​Class​Act:​Anthropology​and​Race​to​Nation​across​Ethnic​ Terrain.”​Annual Review of Anthropology,​no.​18,​401–44. Williams,​W.​L.​1979.​“Patterns​in​the​History​of​the​Remaining​Southeastern​Indians,​1840–1975.”​Southeastern Indians since the Removal Era,​193–210.​Athens:​ University​of​Georgia​Press. Wilson,​A.​C.​2004.​“Reclaiming​Our​Humanity:​Decolonization​and​the​Recovery​ of​Indigenous​Knowledge.”​Indigenizing the Academy: Transforming Scholarship and Empowering Communities,​ed.​D.​A.​Mihesuah​and​A.​C.​Wilson,​69–87.​ Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. ———.​1998a.​“American​Indian​History​or​Non-​Indian​Perceptions​of​American​History.”​Natives and Academics: Researching and Writing about American Indians,​ed.​D.​A.​Mihesuah,​23–26.​Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. ———.​1998b.​“Grandmother​to​Granddaughter:​Generations​of​Oral​History​in​a​ Dakota​Family.”​Natives and Academics: Researching and Writing about American Indians,​ed.​D.​A.​Mihesuah,​27–36.​Lincoln:​University​of​Nebraska​Press. Womack,​J.​1999.​Rebellion in Chiapas: An Historical Reader.​New​York:​Free​Press. Yupanqui,​T.​C.​1992​(1570).​Instrucción al licenciado Lope García de Castro.​Edited​ by​Liliana​Regalado​de​Hurtado.​Lima:​puc-p . Zavala,​V.​2002.​Desencuentros con la escritura: Escuela y comunidad en los andes peruanos.​Lima:​Red​para​el​Desarrollo​de​las​Ciencias​Sociales​en​el​Perú. Žižek,​S.​1993.​“Multiculturalismo,​o​la​lógica​cultural​del​capitalismo​multinacional.”​Estudios culturales: Reflexiones sobre el multiculturalismo,​ed.​ F.​Jameson​and​S.​Žižek,​137–88.​Buenos​Aires:​Paidós.

reFerences 241

contributors

riet Delsing ​is​an​independent​researcher.​She​received​her​Ph.D.​in​anthropology​ from​the​University​of​California​at​Santa​Cruz​in​2009.​She​conducts​research​in​the​ history​and​place​of​Rapa​Nui​in​the​narratives​of​the​Chilean​nation-​state. eDgar arturo esquit cHoy ​is​a​Kaqchikel​Maya​historian​and​researcher​at​the​Instituto​de​Estudios​Interétnicos​in​Guatemala.​He​is​the​author​of​Otros Poderes, Nuevos Desafíos: Relaciones Interétnicas en Tecpan y Su Entorno Departamental, 1871–1935​ (2002)​and​the​coauthor,​with​Víctor​Gálvez​Borrell,​of​The Mayan Movement Today: Issues of Indigenous Culture and Development in Guatemala​(1997). FernanDo garcés v. ​ received​ his​ M.A.​ in​ social​ sciences​ from​ Flacso -​Quito​ (Ecuador)​and​is​currently​a​Ph.D.​candidate​in​Latin​American​cultural​studies​at​ the​Universidad​Andina​Simón​Bolívar​(Quito).​In​addition​to​working​in​bilingual​ and​intercultural​education​in​both​Ecuador​and​Bolivia,​he​coordinates​the​educational​program​at​the​Centro​de​Comunicación​y​Desarrollo​Andino​in​Cochabamba,​Bolivia,​where​he​has​also​worked​with​the​bilingual​newspaper​Conosur Ñawpagman.​He​has​published​several​articles​on​Quichua​and​Quechua​linguistics​ and​ sociolinguistics​ and​ on​ the​ relationship​ between​ writing​ and​ orality​ in​ Quechua. J. keHaulani kauanui ​ is​ an​ associate​ professor​ of​ anthropology​ and​ American​ studies​at​Wesleyan​University.​Her​first​book,​Hawaiian Blood: Colonialism and the Politics of Sovereignty and Indigeneity,​was​published​in​the​Narrating​Native​Histories​series​by​Duke​University​Press​in​2008.​In​2008​she​helped​found​the​Native​ American​and​Indigenous​Studies​Association​and​was​elected​to​its​council​the​same​ year.​In​addition​to​coediting​three​special​issues​of​journals​and​publishing​widely​ in​professional​journals,​she​is​working​on​two​new​book​projects,​one​on​gender,​ sexual​politics,​and​indigeneity​in​Hawaiian​identities​and​the​other​on​Hawaii​and​ New​Eng​land​colonialism. brian kloPotek ​is​an​associate​professor​of​ethnic​studies​at​the​University​of​Oregon.​He​is​the​author​of​Recognition Odysseys: Indigeneity, Race, and Federal Tribal Recognition Policy in Three Louisiana Indian Communities,​in​the​Narrating​Native​ Histories​(Duke​University​Press,​2011).​He​has​also​published​an​article​on​Indian​

masculinity​and​is​working,​with​Brenda​Child,​on​a​forthcoming​edited​book​on​ Indian​education. Florencia e. mallon ​is​the​Julieta​Kirkwood​Professor​and​chair​of​the​History​Department​at​the​University​of​Wisconsin,​Madison.​She​is​the​author​of​The Defense of Community in Peru’s Central Highlands: Peasant Struggle and Capitalist Transition, 1860–1940​(Princeton,​1983);​Peasant and Nation: The Making of Postcolonial Mexico and Peru​(Berkeley,​1995),​for​which​she​received​the​Bryce​Wood​Award​for​the​Best​ Book​in​Latin​American​Studies​from​the​Latin​American​Studies​Association;​and​ Courage Tastes of Blood: The Mapuche Indigenous Community of Nicolás Ailío and the Chilean State, 1906–2000​(Duke​University​Press,​2005),​which​was​awarded​the​ Bolton-​Johnson​Prize​for​the​Best​Book​in​Latin​American​History​by​the​Conference​on​Latin​American​History.​She​is​also​the​editor​and​translator​of​Rosa​Isolde​ Reuque​Paillalef,​When a Flower Is Reborn: The Life and Times of a Mapuche Feminist​ (Duke​University​Press,​2002).​She​is​one​of​the​founding​editors​of​the​series​Narrating​Native​Histories. abelarDo ramos PacHo ​is​a​Nasa​linguist​and​activist​with​the​Consejo​Regional​ Indígena​del​Cauca​in​Colombia.​He​received​his​M.A.​in​ethnolinguistics​from​the​ Universidad​de​los​Andes​in​Bogotá​in​1987.​He​works​in​the​Intercultural​Bilingual​ Program​of​the​Consejo​Regional​Indígena​del​Cauca.​He​is​the​coauthor,​with​Graciela​Bolaños,​Joanne​Rappaport,​and​Carlos​Miñana,​of​¿Qué pasará si la escuela . . . ? Treinta años de construcción educativa​(2004),​and​the​author​of​numerous​articles​on​ translation,​ethnolinguistics,​and​the​Nasa​Yuwe​language. Joanne raPPaPort ​is​a​professor​of​anthropology​and​Spanish​and​Portuguese​at​ Georgetown​University.​She​has​published​three​books​in​Eng​lish:​Cumbe Reborn: An Andean Ethnography of History​ (University​ of​ Chicago​ Press,​ 1994);​ Intercultural Utopias: Public Intellectuals, Cultural Experimentation, and Ethnic Pluralism in Colombia​(Duke​University​Press,​2005);​and​The Politics of Memory: Native Historical Interpretation in the Colombian Andes​(Cambridge​University​Press,​1990;​Duke​ University​Press,​1998).​Intercultural Utopias,​the​product​of​collaborative​research​ with​indigenous​activists​from​the​Consejo​Regional​Indígena​del​Cauca,​is​a​study​ of​indigenous​intellectuals​and​cultural​planners​in​Colombia. Jan rus ​and​Diane l. rus ​have​worked​in​the​Tzotzil-​Maya​speaking​region​of​highland​Chiapas​since​the​early​1970s.​In​1985​they​became​coordinators​of​the​Taller​ Tzotzil​and​helped​local​communities​organize​discussion​groups​and​publish​native​ language​ books​ on​ such​ themes​ as​ the​ historical​ struggle​ for​ the​ land,​ labor​ contracting​and​coffee​plantations,​women’s​artisan​cooperatives,​the​rise​of​urban​ indigenous​colonias,​and​the​beginning​of​undocumented​migration​to​the​United​ States.​Diane​is​the​coauthor​and​editor​of​Bordando Milpas​(1990),​the​life​history​ of​a​Chamula​weaver,​and​Jan​is​coeditor​of​Mayan Lives, Mayan Utopias: The In244 contributors

digenous People of Chiapas and the Zapatista Rebellion​(2003),​and​the​author​of​the​ forthcoming​“Still​We​Are​Here:​Historical​Ethnography​of​the​Mayas​of​Highland​ Chiapas,​1867–1994.”​Together,​they​are​the​coauthors​of​a​number​of​articles​on​migration​and​economic​change​and​the​editors​of​a​forthcoming​bilingual​compilation​ of​Tzotzil​Maya​oral​histories.

contributors 245

inDex

Abercrombie,​Neil,​42,​53n15 Abu-​Lughod,​Lila,​193n2 Abya​Yala​(mature​and​fertile​earth),​85,​ 119n3 Academia​de​las​Lenguas​Mayas​de​ Guatemala​(Academy​of​Maya​Languages​of​Guatemala),​205–6 Academia​de​Lenguas​Mayas​de​Guatemala,​173n9 academic/activist​collaboration,​5,​9.​ See also​collaboration​and​historical​ writing Acción​Católica​(Guatemala),​209 Acteal​massacre​(Chiapas,​Mexico,​1997),​ 154–55,​174n17 activism,​activists:​academics​and,​5,​9,​ 124,​131,​137,​140;​antiracist,​176;​assassinated​in​Chiapas,​164,​167;​Mapuche​ intellectuals​as,​9–10 “Agreement​of​Wills”​(“Cession”​and​ “Proclamation”;​Rapa​Nui,​1888),​ 56–57,​68,​73,​75n2,​76n11 agriculture,​80,​111–12,​164–65 aico ​(Indigenous​Authorities​of​ Colombia),​142n8 Akaka,​Daniel​Kahikina,​27–28 Akaka​bill,​27–29,​35–43,​48–50,​52n10,​ 52–53n14 Albarracín,​Roberto,​118 Albert,​Bruce,​128 Albó,​X.,​93 Alfabeto Único para el Idioma Quechua​ (Unified​Alphabet​for​the​Quechua​ Language),​120n16

Alfred,​Taiaiake,​15 Allen,​C.,​142n5 American​Indian​Law​Alliance,​44,​​ 53n19 American​Indian​Religious​Freedom​Act​ (U.S.,​1996),​50n1 Americas,​the,​and​the​Pacific,​6–7,​24,​ 219 Añaskitu,​120n14 Anaya,​A.,​93 Andean​Communication​and​Development​Center,​89,​110–12,​120n7,​ 120n14,​121n23 Annals of the Kaqchikels,​199–200 anthropology,​2,​122,​129.​See also​collaboration​and​historical​writing;​ ethnography antimiscegenation​laws,​181,​193n3 Anzaldúa,​Gloria,​17 Apology​Resolution​(U.S.,​1993),​36,​ 52n13 Archipelago​of​Juan​Fernández,​70,​ 72–73 ariki​(chief​or​king),​56–57,​75n3 Arnold,​D.,​121n25 Asad,​Talal,​125–26 Atacama​desert​(Bolivia​and​Peru),​56 Atamu​Tekena,​king​of​Rapa​Nui,​56–57,​ 60 Aubry,​Andrés,​146,​148,​171n1,​174n17,​ 174n20 Australia,​on​indigenous​rights,​45 authenticity,​193n2 authority,​intellectual​/cultural,​4

autonomy:​in​Colombia,​142n5;​culture​ and,​128–30,​140–41;​via​decolonization,​7;​via​deoccupation,​7;​internationalization​effects​on,​22;​in​Rapa​ Nui,​71–72,​74,​78n22;​sovereignty​and,​ 142n5 Avendaño,​Amado,​171n1 Aylwin,​Patricio,​63–64,​70 Aymara​language,​93,​95 Aymara​people​(Bolivia,​Peru,​and​ Chile),​55–56,​86 Ayni​School​(Rumi​Muqu,​Bolivia),​ 106–7 Bachelet,​Michelle,​71 Balmaceda,​José​Manuel,​56,​75n5 Basham,​Leilani,​17 Bastos,​Santiago,​215 Bayonet​Constitution​(Hawaiʻi,​1887),​31 Beloved​(Morrison),​192 Bible​translations,​9.​See also​sil /Wbt bilingual​education,​106–8,​172n2,​173– 74n13.​See also​pebi biotechnology,​116 blue​water​doctrine,​33–35 Bolaños,​Graciela,​130,​141,​143n15 Bolivia:​agrarian​reform​in,​80;​indigenous​peasant​movement​in,​83–84;​ indigenous​vein​in,​86;​War​of​the​ Pacific​and,​55–56 Bolivian​Revolution​(1952),​81 Bordando Milpas​(Ta jlok’ta chobtik;​ D.​L.​Rus),​12,​158–61,​164 Bureau​of​Indian​Affairs,​189 Burstein,​John,​171n1 Bush,​George​H.​W.,​164–65 Bush,​George​W.,​37 Canada,​on​indigenous​rights,​45 Cane​River​Creoles​of​Color​(Louisiana),​ 185–87,​189,​194n7 Caniuqueo,​Sergio,​19n12 248 inDex

capitalism:​communal​organization​and,​ 114;​indigenous​knowledge​and,​116– 18;​on​private​property,​57;​transnational​markets​needed​for​global,​102 Carmack,​Robert,​200,​204 Carmen,​Andrea,​53n19 Carrasco​(Cochabamba,​Bolivia),​88–89 Carrasco,​Patricio,​76n7 Carrera,​Rafael,​211 Catholic​Church​(Chiapas,​Mexico),​ 171n1,​173n9 Catholic​Church​(Rapa​Nui),​59 Catholic​Church​(Tahiti),​56 Cauca,​Colombia,​24;​community​councils​(cabildos)​in,​132,​142n9;​cric ​in,​ 10,​81–82,​124–26,​130,​133–34,​137,​ 142n1,​142n8,​142n9,​143n14,​143n15;​ cultural​heterogeneity​or​syncretism​ in,​129,​138.​See also​pebi celali ,​172n2 cenDa ​(Andean​Communication​and​ Development​Center;​Bolivia),​89,​ 110–12,​120n7,​120n14,​121n23 census,​U.S.​(1910),​185,​188–89,​194n12 cession​of​sovereignty,​77n11 Chakrabarty,​Dipesh,​2,​14,​203 Chamula​(Chiapas,​Mexico),​8,​10,​151– 53,​156,​158,​161,​174n15.​See also​Taller​ Tzotzil Chanteaux,​Michel,​174n17 Chapare​(Bolivia),​90 Chatterjee,​Partha,​214 Chávez,​Adrián​Inés,​200,​202 Cherokees,​192 Chiapas,​Mexico,​24;​activists​assassinated​in,​164,​167;​Catholic​Church​in,​ 171n1,​173n9;​critical​historical​narrative​in,​170;​economic​crisis​in,​10,​ 147,​155,​157–58,​171n4;​human​rights​ abuses​in,​167–68,​174nn17–18;​landowners​vs.​debt-​laborers​in,​162–63;​ minimum​wage​in,​172n7;​political​

and​cultural​changes​in,​147–49,​164,​ 170;​political​and​economic​reform​in,​ 80–81.​See also​Taller​Tzotzil Chicanos’​classification​as​white,​181 Chichén-​Itzá,​(Yucatán,​Mexico),​199 ch’iki​(socially​intelligent​child),​121n24 Chile:​constitution​of,​72–73,​75;​democracy​in,​63–64,​68;​imperialism​of,​ 55–56;​independence​of,​from​Spain,​ 55;​trading​by,​56;​victory​of,​in​War​of​ the​Pacific,​6–7.​See also​Rapa​Nui Chilean​civil​war​(1891),​58,​75n5 Chilean​National​Television​(tVn ),​54 Chimaltenango,​Guatemala,​24,​202–3,​ 208,​211–12 Choctaws​(Mississippi),​11,​181.​See also​ Clifton-​Choctaws Chow,​Rey,​125,​141 Civil​Code​(Chile),​60–61 Cleveland,​Grover,​31–32 Clifton-​Choctaws​(Louisiana),​182–91,​ 194n6,​194n12 Clinton,​William​J.,​36 Cobo,​José​Martinez,​43 coca,​90,​92,​96–97 Cochabamba,​Bolivia,​24;​drought​in,​88;​ ngo s​and​development​projects​in,​ 88;​peasant​organizations​in,​10,​119n4,​ 120n8;​political​militancy​in,​81–82 coDeipa ​(Development​Commission;​ Rapa​Nui),​64–66,​68 coffee​market,​164–65 coffee​workers,​149–51,​165 Cojtí​Cuxil,​Demetrio,​197,​200 Coleman,​Arica,​181 collaboration:​via​diálogo de saberes​(exchange​of​epistemologies),​8,​130;​engagé,​9;​minga​(project​of​collective​ work​for​collective​benefit),​8,​82–83,​ 131–32;​overview​of,​80–84;​respect​for​ difference​and​the​integrity​of​cultures​ as​underlying,​17;​tension/negotiation​

in,​10,​17,​133;​truth​telling​and,​in​research​methodologies,​4 collaboration​and​historical​writing,​ 219;​of​academics​and​activists,​5,​9,​ 124,​131,​137,​140;​collaborative​theorizing​and,​130–33,​142nn7–8,​143n10;​ community​control,​interculturalism,​cosmovision,​and,​137–40;​co-​ theorizing,​131–32;​culture​and​political​autonomy​and,​128–30,​140–41;​ indigenous​theory,​and​definition/ overview​of,​122–24,​127,​131,​142n2;​ interculturalism​and,​126–27,​137–39,​ 141,​143n11;​minority​theorizing,​129;​ pebi ’s​history,​124,​133–37,​141,​143n11,​ 143n15;​theorizing​and​definition​of,​ 220;​translating​theory,​124–26 Colla​people​(Argentina,​Bolivia,​and​ Chile),​55–56 Colombia:​academics​in,​143n10;​constitution​of​1991​of,​83,​124–26,​128,​131– 32;​Free​Trade​Area​of​the​Americas​ accepted​by,​127;​national​integration​ in,​81;​Native​autonomy​in,​142n5 colonialism:​as​central​to​indigenous​ peoples’​history,​7;​colonies​defined​ under​international​law,​43;​colonization​vs.​occupation​and,​34;​definition​of,​197;​internal​colonialism,​12,​ 16,​18n4,​33,​43,​49,​197,​201,​218n19;​ language,​law,​and​archives​as​instruments​of,​3;​racial​hierarchy​established​via,​198,​217n2.​See also​decolonization Comalapa​(Chimaltenango,​Guatemala),​ 202–3,​217n7 Comité​Catholique​Contre​la​Faim​et​ Pour​le​Dévellopement​(France),​171n1 Commerce​Clause​(U.S.​Constitution),​39 Commission​on​Historic​Truth​and​New​ Relationship​with​Indigenous​Peoples​ (Rapa​Nui),​68–69

inDex 249

communal​organization,​111–14,​117–18 community​control,​137–38 conaDi ​(National​Corporation​for​Indigenous​Development;​Chile),​63,​66,​ 70,​73,​77n16 conceptual​prison,​180,​193n2 concientización​(consciousness​raising​or​ empowerment),​144 Congreso​Internacional​de​Mayistas​ (1989),​172n7,​172n9 Conosur Ñawpagman.​See​PCÑ conquest,​sovereignty​via,​77n11 Consejo​de​Ancianos​del​Fondo​de​Desarrollo​Indígena​de​Guatemala​(Council​ of​Elders​of​the​Indigenous​Development​Fund​of​Guatemala),​209 Consejo​de​Organizaciones​Mayas​en​ Guatemala,​205 Consejo​Regional​Indígena​del​Cauca.​ See​cric Coordinación​de​Organizaciones​del​ Pueblo​Maya​de​Guatemala,​205 cosmovision,​137–39,​199 Coushattas​(Louisiana),​189 Creoles​(criollos;​Guatemala),​203–4,​ 211–13,​217n8 cric ​(Consejo​Regional​Indígena​del​ Cauca),​10,​81–82,​124–26,​130,​133– 34,​137,​142n1,​142n8,​142n9,​143n14,​ 143n15.​See also​pebi Cruikshank,​Julie,​14 csutcb ​(United​Confederation​of​Bolivian​Workers​and​Peasants),​89,​114 culture:​colonizer​vs.​colonized,​1–2;​ continuity​of,​218n21;​minority​forms​ of,​129;​political​autonomy​and,​128– 30,​140–41;​revival​of,​127 Çxayu’çe,​136,​143n13 debt-​laborers,​162–63 Decades​of​Indigenous​Peoples​(un ;​ 1990–2000,​2000–2010),​22 250 inDex

Declaration​on​the​Granting​of​Independence​to​Colonial​Countries​and​ Peoples—Resolution​1514​(un ,​1960),​ 33–34,​43–44,​51n5 Declaration​on​the​Rights​of​Indigenous​ Peoples​(un ;​2007),​22,​28,​43–48,​ 53n19 Declaration​regarding​Non-​Self-​ Governing​Peoples​(un ,​1945),​43 decolonization,​25;​to​combat​racism,​ 192–93;​definition​and​scope​of,​28;​ deoccupation​vs.,​23,​28–29;​racial​and​ evolutionary​bases​of​colonial​power​ and,​2;​violence​engendered​by,​17 decolonizing​methodologies,​6,​176,​ 219–20 Decolonizing Methodologies​(Smith),​ 192–93,​193n1 Defensoría​de​la​Mujer​Indígena​(Indigenous​Women’s​Defense​Office;​Guatemala),​205–6 Deloria,​Vine,​Jr.,​193n2 Delsing,​Riet,​7,​23 democracy,​123,​126–27 Denetdale,​Jennifer,​17 deoccupation:​arguments​for,​35,​46;​decolonization​vs.,​23,​28–29;​definition​ and​scope​of,​28;​internal​colonialism​ denied​by,​49;​international​laws​of​ occupation​and,​34 Departmental​Peasant​Federation​ (Cochabamba,​Bolivia),​89 Department​of​Hawaiian​Home​Lands,​ 36–37 Development​Commission​(coDeipa ;​ Rapa​Nui),​64–66,​68 diálogo de saberes​(exchange​of​epistemologies),​8,​130 Dindicué,​Benjamín,​133–34 Dole,​Sanford​Ballard,​32 double​consciousness​(second-​sight),​ 122–23,​141–42n1

Duarte,​Carlota,​173n8 Du​Bois,​W.​E.​B.,​122,​129,​141n1 Duquesne,​Isabelle,​173–74n13 Easter​Island.​See​Rapa​Nui East​Timor,​34 Edmunds,​Petero,​72 education:​bilingual,​106–8,​127,​172n2;​ intercultural,​127;​for​Maya,​201–2,​ 206,​212,​216;​social​change​and,​127.​ See also​pebi Education​Reform​(Bolivia),​115,​121n25 eib ​(Educación​Intercultural​Bilingüe​ project;​Intercultural​Bilingual​Education;​Bolivia),​107–8 Ejército​Zapatista​de​Liberación​ Nacional​(eZln ;​Chiapas),​84,​167,​ 174n17 El Mizqueño,​88,​93 El Totoreño,​88,​93 enganche​(contract​labor),​149 Ernantes,​Chep​(José​González​Hernández),​148,​153,​173–74n13 Esquit,​Edgar,​11–12,​176–77 ethnicity​and​progress,​211 ethnic​movements,​122,​129–30 ethnic​organizations,​124,​127–28,​137 ethnic​studies,​U.S.,​180 ethnography:​autoethnography​vs.,​141;​ of​particular,​193n2;​perspective​and​ methodology​in,​24–25,​125–26;​as​ translation,​125–26.​See also​anthropology Eurocentrism,​102 European​Community,​171n1 exclusion,​forms​of,​85 Explora​hotels,​65 eZln ​(Ejército​Zapatista​de​Liberación​ Nacional;​Chiapas),​84,​167,​174n17 Fanon,​Frantz,​163 feminist​movement/research,​123–24

Fermín,​Tata,​118–19 Field,​L.,​142n5 Fischer,​E.,​218n21 Five​Civilized​Tribes​(Oklahoma),​181–82 Foley,​Neil,​194n9 FoMMa ​(Fortaleza​de​la​Mujer​Maya),​ 173n8 Fondo​Indígena​(Indigenous​Fund;​ Guatemala),​205–6 Fondo​Nacional​de​Artesanías​ (Fonart ;​Mexico),​159 Forbes,​Jack,​189 forests,​communal​ownership​of,​114 Fortaleza​de​la​Mujer​Maya​(FoMMa ),​ 173n8 free​trade.​See​trade​agreements Free​Trade​Area​of​the​Americas,​127 Freire,​Paulo,​144 Frichner,​Tonya​Gonnella,​53n19 Friends​of​Easter​Island​(Chile),​78n19 frontier​as​painful​or​uncomfortable,​17 Garcés​V.,​Fernando,​10–11,​81–83 gender​and​power​relations,​12,​19n7.​See also​women,​indigenous Gilroy,​Paul,​129 globalization,​82–83,​116,​176–77,​214,​ 218n19,​220 Gómez​Vargas,​J.​H.,​78n22 Grandin,​Greg,​211,​217n2 Great​Depression,​80 green​revolution,​112,​117 Grube,​Nikolai,​198–99 Guambiano​History​Committee​ (Colombia),​128 Guambiano​peoples​(Colombia),​81 Guatemala:​colonialism​in,​and​Maya​ movement,​197–98;​four​peoples​of​ (Maya,​Garífuna,​Xinka,​and​ladino),​ 205,​213,​218n11;​ladino​control​of,​197;​ mining​in,​206;​power​relations​of,​ 217n9.​See also​Maya

inDex 251

Guatemalan​civil​war​(1962–96),​176 Guzmán,​Salvador,​153,​159,​164,​168–69 Guzmán,​Soledad,​120n13 Guzmán​Böckler,​Carlos,​200 Hague​Convention​IV​(1907),​34 Hale,​Charles​R.,​16–17 Hanga​Roa​(Rapa​Nui),​59–60,​62,​67–68 Harrison,​Benjamin,​31 Hawaiʻi,​24,​43–45,​47–50;​autonomy​ movement​in,​7;​capitalism​and​Christianity’s​effects​on,​31;​independence​ movement​in,​27–28,​34–38;​kingdom​ restoration​movement​in,​34–35,​51n7;​ land​claims​in,​32–33,​37–38,​41–42,​ 46,​53n14;​Mahele​land​division​(1848),​ 30–31,​46;​occupied​state​of,​34–35;​ recognition​of,​as​independent​kingdom,​7,​23,​28–30,​39,​51n2;​Republic​ of,​32,​52n13;​secession​vs.​independence​of,​46;​self-​government​and​ self-​determination​by,​27,​33–37,​40,​ 46,​51n3;​sovereignty​claim​of,​under​ international​law,​28–29,​34,​38–39;​ statehood​of,​29,​33–36,​51n3,​52n13;​ territorial​integrity​of,​46;​U.S.​colonization​and​annexation​of,​6,​23,​28–35,​ 46,​52n13;​use-​rights​concessions​by,​6;​ U.S.​militarism​in,​40–41;​U.S.​treaties​ with,​29–30;​white​foreign​population​in,​30–31.​See also​Kanaka​Maoli;​ Native​Hawaiian​Government​Reorganization​Act;​State of Hawaii v. Office of Hawaiian Affairs Hawaiian​Independence​Action​Alliance,​28 Hawaiʻi​Institute​for​Human​Rights,​28 Henderson,​Timothy,​Mexico Reader,​168 Herbert,​Jean-​Loup,​200 Hernández,​Domingo,​215 Hernández,​José​González​(Chep​ Ernantes),​148,​153,​173–74n13 252 inDex

Hill,​Robert​M.,​200 Hill,​Roberta,​6 Historia de un pueblo evangelista​ (R.​Pérez),​174n13 historical​writing.​See​collaboration​and​ historical​writing honi ​(Hui​o​Na​Ike),​28 Honolulu​Rifles,​31 Hotel​Hanga​Roa​(Rapa​Nui),​72 Hotus,​Alberto,​77n14,​78n24 Hotus,​Carolina,​71 Hui​Aloha​ʻAina​and​Hui​Kalai​ʻAina​ nationalist​groups,​32 Hui​Pu​(Hawaiʻi),​28 I, Rigoberta​(Menchú),​145 Ibañez,​Pedro,​65 Identity​and​Rights​of​the​Indigenous​ Peoples​Accord​(Guatemala,​1995),​205 ilo ​Convention​169​(International​ Labor​Organization;​1989),​22,​206 inareMac ​(Instituto​de​Asesoría​ Antropológica​para​la​Región​Maya,​ A.C.),​159,​167–68,​171n1,​173–74n13,​ 174n17 Indian​Gaming​Regulatory​Act​(U.S.,​ 1988),​53n14 Indian​Reorganization​Act​(U.S.,​1934),​ 52n10 Indians’​antiblack​racism​(southern​ United​States),​188;​Anglo-​American​ racist​and​colonialist​origins​of,​186– 87;​decolonization​to​combat,​192–93;​ Indian​identity/denials​of​black​ancestry​and,​183–87,​189–91,​194n12;​ overview​and​background​of,​179–82;​ racial​formation​and,​181,​192–93,​ 194n9,​195n22;​regulating​racial​categories​and,​186–93;​research​in​Louisiana​Indian​communities,​182–86,​ 194n6;​research​methodologies​for​ studying,​179–80,​184–85,​191–93,​

193n1,​193n2;​tradition​of,​181–82,​184;​ Virginia​antimiscegenation​laws​and,​ 181,​193n3;​white​supremacy​and,​179,​ 186–87,​191–93,​194n8 Indian​Schedules​(population),​188 Indian​studies,​180 Indian​Trade​and​Intercourse​Act​(U.S.),​ 53n14 Indigenous​Authorities​of​Colombia​ (aico ),​142n8 Indigenous​Caucus​(un ​and​oas ),​47 indigenous​identity:​definitions​of,​12;​ double​consciousness​about,​142n1;​ Indian,​and​denials​of​black​ancestry,​ 183–87,​189–91,​194n12;​Rapanui,​23,​ 54–55,​67–68,​74–75 indigenous​organizations,​83,​90,​119n3,​ 122–24,​127–31,​133,​162,​177.​See also under names of individual organizations “Indigenous​Politics:​From​Native​New​ England​and​Beyond,”​53n19 indigenous​rights:​Convention​169​ (International​Labor​Organization)​ on,​206;​Declaration​on​the​Rights​ of​Indigenous​Peoples,​22,​28,​43–48;​ under​international​law,​vs.​states’​ rights,​29;​Native​American​rights​and​ privileges​extended​to​Kanaka​Maoli,​ 27,​50–51n1;​of​peoples​vs.​people,​44,​ 48;​preexisting​human​rights,​43;​self-​ determination,​33–34,​43–48,​51n5;​ sovereignty​and,​46–47;​territorial​ ​integrity​and,​46–47 indigenous​sovereignty,​4 indigenous​universities,​124,​142n2 indio permitido​(permissible​Indian),​ 16–17 inea ​(Instituto​Nacional​de​Educación​ Adulta),​152–53,​173n9 ini ​(Instituto​Nacional​Indigenista;​ Mexico),​152,​172n2,​172–73n7

inscription,​4 inside​vs.​outside,​4,​129–30 Instituto​de​Asesoría​Antropológica​para​ la​Región​Maya,​A.C.​See​inareMac Instituto​de​Estudios​Indígenas​of​the​ Universidad​Autónoma​de​Chiapas,​ 172n2 Instituto​Nacional​Indigenista​(ini ;​ Mexico),​152,​172n2,​172–73n7 integrationism,​2,​61–66 intellectual​property​rights,​116–17 interculturalism,​126–27,​137–39,​141,​ 143n11,​205 International​Coffee​Agreement,​164–65 International​Forum​of​Indigenous​ Peoples​(Fipau ),​69 International​Indian​Treaty​Council,​ 53n19 intertextuality,​10–11,​83,​91–92 Jacobs​Research​Fund​(Bellingham,​ Wash.),​171n1 Jaima,​93 Jena​Choctaws​(Louisiana),​182,​189–90 Johnson,​M.,​98 Jones,​Delmos,​122 Joseph,​Gilbert,​Mexico Reader,​168 Juan, the Chamula​(Pozas),​172n5 kainga​(ancestral​lands),​58,​60,​65,​73,​ 75n4 Kalakaua,​king​of​Hawaiʻi,​31 Ka​Lei​Maile​Aliʻi​Hawaiian​Civic​Club,​ 28 Kamehameha​III,​king​of​Hawaiʻi,​30 Kanaka​Maoli​(indigenous​​Hawaiians):​ Akaka​bill’s​impact​on,​42–43;​assimilationist​policies​imposed​on,​​ 35;​decolonization​eligibility​of,​34,​ 42–43;​federal​recognition​for,​7,​28,​​ 48;​Hawaiians​defined,​51n1;​historical​struggle​of,​22–23;​Hui​Aloha​

inDex 253

Kanaka​Maoli​(continued) ʻAina​and​Hui​Kalai​ʻAina​nationalist​ groups​among,​32;​international​law​ strategies​of,​28;​kupuna​(elders)​and​ kumu​(educators),​49;​as​a​minority​in​ Hawaiʻi,​49;​Native​American​rights​ and​privileges​extended​to,​27,​50– 51n1;​Native​Hawaiian​Government​ Reorganization​Act,​27–29,​35–43,​48,​ 52–53n14;​oppression​and​subordination​of,​by​white​supremacists,​35,​49;​ “Urgent​Open​Letter​to​U.S.​President​ Barack​Obama,”​49–50;​U.S.​apology​ to,​36,​51–52n8,​52n13;​voting​by,​31,​33,​ 36,​51n3.​See also​Hawaiʻi Ka​Pakaukau,​28,​34 Kaqchikels,​177,​199–200,​202–3,​206,​ 218n14 Katarismo,​86 Kauanui,​J.​Kehaulani,​5,​7,​22–23,​80 K’iche​language​and​people,​177,​200,​ 202–4,​209–12,​217n10,​218n16 Kimsa Pacha Ara Mboapi,​93 Kipaltik​collective​(Chiapas,​Mexico),​ 159–66 Klopotek,​Brian,​5–6,​11–12,​176–77 knowledge:​coproduction​of,​146;​geopolitics​of,​102–3,​108;​indigenous,​and​ capitalism,​116–18;​jawamanta yachay​ (knowledge​from​abroad),​118;​local​ vs.​universal,​102–3;​modern,​as​essentialist/binary,​102;​neocolonial​domination​and,​116;​peasant,​technology’s​ appropriation​of,​112,​116–17;​Quechua​ peasant​vs.​Western​urban,​103–5;​ racial/evolutionary​bases​of​colonial​ power​as​underlying​construction​of,​ 2;​scientific,​primacy​of,​116–17.​See also​peasant​knowledge Koani​Foundation,​28 Komes,​Maruch​(María​Gómez),​12,​ 158–62,​164–66 254 inDex

Komike​Tribunal,​28,​34 Kopenawa,​Davi,​128 Ko Tu’u Aro Kote Mata Nui​(Rapa​Nui),​ 58 Ko Tu’u Hotu Iti Mata Iti​(Rapa​Nui),​58 Koyaso​Panchin,​Marian,​156–57 Kurus,​Xalid.​See​Rus,​Jan Kurus,​Tina.​See​Rus,​Diane​L. Kusman,​Xalik​(Salvador​Guzmán;​ Mariano​Peres​Tsu),​153,​159,​164,​ 168–69 labor,​intellectual,​132 La​Castalia,​172n2 ladinos​(Hispanicized​people;​non-​ Indians),​12,​19n5,​197,​202–4,​211–13,​ 217n1 Lagos,​Ricardo,​68 Lakoff,​G.,​98 Lâm,​Maivân​Clech,​46 Lame,​Manuel​Quintín,​139;​Los pensamientos del indio que se educó dentro de las selvas colombianas,​143n14 language:​diglottic,​91,​115,​120n10;​neologisms​in,​92,​115–16,​125;​power​and​ empowerment​and,​3,​11,​13;​subalternized​indigenous,​86–87,​108.​See also​Quechua​language​and​knowledge;​Taller​Tzotzil La Prensa,​93 Latin​America:​class-​based​social​and​ political​movements​in,​16,​80;​indigenous​intellectuals​in,​15,​19n12;​indigenous​movements​in,​15–16;​indigenous​peoples​of,​vs.​United​States,​80;​ national-​popular​states’​emergence​in,​ 80–81.​See also under names of specific indigenous movements Laughlin,​Miriam,​173n8 Laughlin,​Robert​M.,​172n2 Lenkersdorf,​Carlos,​172n2 Lenkersdorf,​Gudrun,​172n2

Levil,​Rodrigo,​19n12 Ley​Indígena​(Indigenous​Law;​Chile,​ 1990),​63–66,​68,​74 Ley​Pascua​(Easter​Law;​Chile,​1966),​ 61–63,​67–68,​74 Ley​Pinochet​(Pinochet​Law;​Chile,​ 1979),​62–64,​74 Libro de registros de propiedades llevado por la Armada de Chile, Isla de Pascua​ (Chilean​navy),​59–60 Lili’uokalani,​queen​of​Hawaiʻi,​31–32,​ 52n13 literacidad,​119n1 Living​Nation,​28 llawar​(blood),​98,​101 Lomnitz-​Adler,​Claudio,​213 López​Pérez,​Antonio,​148 Los Acuerdos de San Andrés,​174n20 Los​Chorros​(Chenalhó,​Chiapas,​ Mexico),​154,​157,​173n11 Los pensamientos del indio que se educó dentro de las selvas colombianas​ (Lame),​143n14 Louisiana,​24.​See also​Indians’​antiblack​ racism Louisiana​Inter-​Tribal​Council​(Clifton),​ 189–90 Loving v. Virginia,​181 Lumbees​(North​Carolina),​181 Luykx,​A.,​115 majï​(labor),​132 maki​(hand),​98,​100 Mam​language,​217n10 Mana ​(Movement​for​Aloha​No​Ka​ ʻAina),​28 Mapuche​(Chile),​9–10,​55 Marimán,​Pablo,​19n12 Maya:​ancestors​remembered​by,​204,​ 209–10;​domination​of,​217n2;​education​for,​201–2,​206,​212,​216;​exclusion​of,​208,​217n9;​government​sup-

port​of,​205–6;​in​Guatemalan​civil​ war,​176;​historiography​and​archeology​of,​203–4,​217n9;​ladinos​and,​ 12,​202,​204,​211–13;​as​merchants,​ 217n6;​perceived​as​backward,​204,​ 208;​political​transitions​challenged​ by,​84;​repression​of,​202;​struggle​for​ self-​determination​by,​176,​215;​subsistence​economy​of,​202;​unified​vs.​self-​ created​official​history​of,​11;​women,​ 211;​women’s​weaving​and​embroidering​cooperative,​12;​Yucatekan​and​ Guatemalan,​198–99 Maya​movement,​196–217;​alternative​ histories​and​present,​213–17,​218n20;​ colonialism​in​Guatemala​and,​197– 98;​definition​of​Maya​and​Mayanists,​ 197;​educated/professional​vs.​uneducated​Maya,​202–3,​217n6;​elite-​and​ state-​constructed​multiculturalism​ and,​201,​205–8,​210,​213–16;​elites’​ identification​with​liberal​state​ideology,​203;​elites’​redefining​of​identities​ and​power​relations,​196–97,​208–13,​ 218n21;​elites’​version​of​history,​ 202–5;​guerrilla​groups,​203;​imagining​new​histories,​198–201;​Maya​continuity​vs.​conquest​and​assimilation,​ 199–200;​Maya​demand​for​rights,​ 211–13;​Maya​protests​and​repression​ and,​206,​212,​215,​218n14;​Maya​spirituality,​205,​209,​216;​memories’​role​ in,​214;​overview​and​background​ of,​177,​196–98;​patriarchy​and,​196,​ 211,​215–16;​political​parties​and,​203;​ professionals’​role​in,​203,​210,​217n7;​ Protestant​and​Catholic​visions​and,​ 196,​203,​216;​workshops​on​ancient​ writing​and,​198–99 McKinley,​William,​32 Memorias, Balances, Inventarios y Registro de Propiedades​(Chilean​navy),​59

inDex 255

Menchú,​Rigoberta:​I, Rigoberta,​145 Merrell,​James,​181 mestizos​(Hispanicized​people),​19n5,​ 126,​162,​167 Mexican​Revolution​(1910),​80–81,​148,​ 162,​164 Mexico:​agrarian​reform​in,​80,​164–65;​ economic​crisis​in,​10,​144,​147,​155,​ 157–58,​171n4;​Salinas’s​reforms​in,​ 164–65 Mexico Reader​(Joseph​and​Henderson),​168 Mignolo,​Walter,​102,​217n2,​218n19 Mihesuah,​Devon,​2,​15 Miles,​Tiya,​195n19;​Ties that Bind: The Story of an Afro-Cherokee Family in Slavery and Freedom,​192 Millalén,​José,​19n12 Millamán,​Rosamel,​16–17 Miñana,​Carlos,​142n7 minga​(project​of​collective​work​for​collective​benefit),​8,​82–83,​131–32 Ministry​of​Education​(Guatemala),​206 Mizque​(Cochabamba,​Bolivia),​88–89,​ 106 Mizque​Provincial​Trade​Union​(Cochabamba,​Bolivia),​89 Mobile​Unit​for​Rural​Patrolling​ (Bolivia),​92 Montejo,​Víctor,​2,​19n6,​200,​202 Morales,​Evo,​81–84,​120n8 Morrison,​Toni,​194n9;​Beloved,​192 Mosoco,​Colombia,​125,​131–32 Movement​toward​Socialism​(Mas ;​ Bolivia),​89,​120n8 Movimiento​Al​Socialismo,​81–83 Moyapampa​Union​(Cochabamba,​ Bolivia),​89 Moyopampa​Agricultural​Union​(Totora,​ Carrasco,​Bolivia),​88 mulattoes,​181,​184–85,​188–89,​194n12 multiculturalism:​in​Guatemala,​201,​ 256 inDex

205–8,​210,​213–16;​interculturalism​ vs.,​126–27;​neoliberalism​and,​176,​ 207 Muyolema​(also​Muyulema),​Armando,​ 15,​119n3

naFta ​(North​American​Free​Trade​ Agreement),​116–17,​164–65 najtir​(ancient),​217n10 Nā​Pua​No’eau​(Center​for​Gifted​and​ Talented​Native​Hawaiian​Children),​ 37 Narrating​Native​Histories​conference​ (University​of​Wisconsin,​Madison,​ 2005),​1–5,​219 Narrating​Native​Histories​series,​2–4 Nasa​peoples​(Colombia),​8,​81,​126 Nasa​Yuwe​language:​alphabet​and​ orthography​for,​143n13;​board​game​ and,​136;​translating​the​Colombian​ Constitution​into,​125–26,​128,​131–32 National​Corporation​for​Indigenous​ Development,​63,​66,​70,​73,​77n16 National​Historic​Preservation​Act​(U.S.,​ 1966),​50n1 National​Institute​for​Adult​Education​ (Instituto​Nacional​de​Educación​ Adulta;​inea ),​152,​173n9 National​Museum​of​the​American​ Indian​Act​(U.S.,​1989,​amended​ 1996),​50n1 Native​American​Graves​Protection​and​ Repatriation​Act​(U.S.,​1990),​50n1 Native​American​Languages​Act​(U.S.,​ 1990),​50n1 Native​American​Programs​Act​(U.S.,​ 1974),​50–51n1 Native​Americans:​Akaka​bill’s​impact​ on,​52–53n14;​antiblack​sensibilities​ among,​11–12;​federal​classification​ and​recognition​of,​187–91,​194n12,​ 194n14;​land​held​in​trust​for,​53n14;​

tribal​identities​of,​181;​whites​and,​ 180–81.​See also​Choctaws;​Indians’​ antiblack​racism Native​and​indigenous​movements,​2,​4,​ 123,​128 Native​Hawaiian​Bar​Association​ (nhba ),​42,​53n15 Native​Hawaiian​Education​Act​(U.S.,​ 2004),​51n1 Native​Hawaiian​Government​Reorganization​Act​(Akaka​bill;​U.S.,​2009),​ 27–29,​35–43,​48–50,​52n10,​52–53n14 Native​Hawaiian​Health​Care​Act​(U.S.,​ 1988),​51n1 Native​Hawaiian​Interagency​(U.S.),​42 Native​intellectuals​in​the​academy,​6,​ 13,​15 Native​peoples’​intellectual​agency,​2–3 nature,​101,​121n21 Navajo​Nation,​45 neoliberalism,​176,​207 Newlands​Resolution​(U.S.,​1898),​32,​ 52n13 New​Zealand,​on​indigenous​rights,​45 nFip —Hawaiʻi,​28 nhba ​(Native​Hawaiian​Bar​Association),​42,​53n15 Nimatuj,​Irma​Alicia,​211 North​American​Free​Trade​Agreement​ (naFta ),​116–17,​164–65 North​and​South,​219;​differences​in​indigenous​intellectuals’​place,​4,​15,​17,​ 19n12;​historical​differences​between,​ 4,​15;​North-​centrism,​102 “not-​yet”​principle​of​historical​evolution,​2 Obama,​Barack,​37,​49 objectivity​in​writing,​95,​121n19 occupation,​34,​76n11 Office​of​Hawaiian​Affairs,​36–37,​ 51–52n8,​52n13

ʻOhana​Koa,​28 ojtxe​(remote​past),​217n10 Omi,​M.,​195n22 one-​drop​rule,​11–12,​189 oral​history/tradition,​13–14.​See also​ Quechua​yachay orality​vs.​textuality,​3,​10,​94–95,​139 Organic​Act​(U.S.,​1900),​32–33 Organization​of​American​States​(oas ),​ 47 pacha​(space​and​time​in​which​we​are​ located),​87,​119n5 Panama​Canal,​56 pan-​Mayanist​movement.​See​Maya​ movement Papa​Ola​Lokahi​(Native​Hawaiian​ Healthcare),​37 Pari,​A.,​121n21 Partido​Revolucionario​Institucional​ (pri ;​Mexico),​154,​165–66 Partido​Socialista​de​los​Trabajadores​ (pst ;​Mexico),​154–55 Past,​Ámbar,​173n8 Pate,​Timoteo,​76n6 patriarchy,​196,​211,​215–16 Paz,​Sarela,​86 PCÑ ​(Conosur Ñawpagman):​articles​ for,​120n9;​background​on,​88–90,​ 120nn7–9;​bimonthly​publication​ of,​90;​on​communal​organization,​ 112–13,​117;​distribution​and​sale​​ of,​10,​89–90;​on​education,​106–8;​ Garcés’s​collaboration​with,​81,​118;​​ meaning​of​Ñawpagman,​119n1;​metaphors​and​similes​in,​99–102;​oral​ presence​in,​94–97;​on​patents​and​​ technology​that​appropriate​peasant​ knowledge,​112;​on​peasant​mobilizations​(1992),​121n20;​on​plagues,​111;​ politics​of​written​orality​and,​90–93,​​ 95;​Quechua​in,​10–11,​85,​91–94;​on​

inDex 257

PCÑ ​(continued) Quechua​peasant​vs.​Western​urban​ knowledge,​103–5;​quotations​in,​ 96–97;​researching​writing​via,​115–16;​ Spanish​in,​91–94;​stories​in,​concluding,​94,​97;​subjects​addressed​in,​90,​ 103;​on​weather​prediction,​110–12.​See also​Quechua​yachay Peace​Camps​(Mexico),​174n14 peasant,​meanings​of,​85–86 peasant​knowledge:​anthropomorphization​of,​101–2;​modern​technology​vs.,​ 88,​110–12,​117,​121n23;​nature​as​teaching,​121n21 peasant​organizations​in​Cochabamba,​ 10,​119n4,​120n8 pebi ​(Bilingual​and​Intercultural​Education​Program;​Colombia):​history​of,​ 124,​133–37,​141,​143n11,​143n15;​influence​and​success​of,​134;​objectives​of,​ 134;​overview​of,​82;​political​program​ of,​134–35,​137 Peres​Tsu,​Mariano,​153,​159,​164,​168–69 Pérez,​Manuel,​Salvador,​and​Pedro,​168 Pérez,​Ricardo,​Historia de un pueblo evangelista,​174n13 Peru​in​War​of​the​Pacific,​55–56 petroglyphs,​128 Pewewardy,​Cornel,​191 Pinochet,​Augusto,​62 place,​defense​of,​102 plagues,​111 pluralism,​126–27,​134 política de estado,​70,​78n20 popular​movements,​129 Pop​Wuj​(Popol​Vuh),​200 Portales​Center​(Simón​Patiño​Foundation;​Bolivia),​88 Portelli,​Alessandro,​14 Pozas,​Ricardo,​Juan, the Chamula,​172n5 prescription,​sovereignty​via,​76–77n11 Presencia,​93 258 inDex

pri ​(Partido​Revolucionario​Institucional;​Mexico),​154,​165–66 Programa​Nacional​de​​Solidaridad​ (National​Solidarity​Program;​ ​pronasol ;​Mexico),​165–66 progress,​1–2,​211 Pro-​Kanaka​Maoli​Independence​Working​Group,​28,​34 pronasol ​(Programa​Nacional​de​Solidaridad;​Mexico),​165–66 Protestants​vs.​traditionalists,​151–52,​ 155–57 Proyecto​Fotográfico​Maya,​173n8 pst ​(Partido​Socialista​de​los​Trabajadores;​Mexico),​154–55 Quechua​language​and​knowledge,​85,​ 87–90,​95–100,​118–19,​120n13;​alphabet,​120n16;​Bolivian​linguistic​policy​ toward,​115;​colonial​subalternization​ of,​86;​discrimination​against,​108–9;​ liberation​via,​109;​in​Movimiento​Al​ Socialismo,​82–83;​neologisms​in,​115– 16;​in​newspapers,​93,​120n14;​normalization​of,​94,​114–15,​120n16;​orality​ as​basis​of,​120n17;​pan-​Andean​unification​of,​115;​on​radio,​93;​revitalization​of,​11,​115;​Spanish​and,​10–11,​ 91–93,​109,​115;​written,​promotion​of,​ 114–15,​121n25;​yachayniyku​(politics​of​ Quechua​knowledge),​101–14,​117.​See​ also​PCÑ ;​Quechua​yachay Quechua​people​(Peru,​Ecuador,​Bolivia,​ Chile,​and​Argentina),​55–56,​81,​86 Quechua​yachay:​community​and​cultural​roots​of,​103,​110–14,​117–18,​ 121n24;​on​development/modernization,​111–12;​forms​of​local​knowledge​ in,​vs.​Western​categories,​83;​knowledge​and​territoriality​and,​116–18;​ language​and,​103,​108–10;​orality​ and​meanings​of,​86–87;​in​school​

and​community,​103,​105–8;​subjects​ ​related​with,​103;​value​of,​103–5 Quetzaltenango​(Guatemala),​211 Racancoj,​Víctor,​200 racial​formation,​181,​192–93,​194n9,​ 195n22 racism:​antimiscegenation​laws,​181,​ 193n3;​decolonization​to​combat,​ 192–93;​one-​drop​rule,​11–12,​189;​segregation​and​oppression​of​blacks,​ 187;​“speaking​secrets”​about,​176–77;​ struggle​against,​118;​U.S.​racial​atmosphere​and,​141–42n1;​white​privilege​ and,​2,​11–12;​white​supremacy​and,​35,​ 49,​179,​186–87,​191–93,​194n8.​See also​ Indians’​antiblack​racism Radio​Educación​(Mexico),​159 Raibmon,​Paige,​193n2 Ramos​Pacho,​Abelardo,​8,​10–11,​17,​ 82–83,​130,​141,​142n3,​143n10.​See also​ collaboration​and​historical​writing Rapa​Nui​(Easter​Island),​24;​“Agreement​ of​Wills,”​56–57,​68,​73,​75n2,​76n11;​ airport​in,​67;​autonomy​of,​prospects​ for,​71–72,​74,​78n22;​casino​debate​in,​ 65–66;​Chilean​annexation​of,​6,​54,​ 56–57,​60,​66;​Chilean​consolidation​ of​hold​on,​59–60;​Chilean​evolution/ imperialism​and,​23;​Chilean​inscription​of​(1933),​60–61,​76–77nn10–12;​ Chilean​naval​presence​in,​58–60,​ 66–67,​76n7,​76n9;​clan​system​and​ leaders​of,​56–59,​70–71,​74,​75n3,​ 76n9;​collective​landownership​proposal​in,​72,​78n23;​colonialism​to​ self-​determination​for,​path​of,​66–73;​ Commission​on​Historic​Truth​and​ New​Relationship​with​Indigenous​ Peoples​in,​68–69;​Compañía​in,​ 58–61,​67;​Council​of​Elders​in,​62,​64,​ 66,​69,​72,​77n14,​77n16,​78n24;​Devel-

opment​Commission​(coDeipa )​for,​ 64–66,​68;​diseases​introduced​onto,​ 58–59;​early​Chilean​colonization,​ 57–61,​66;​foreign​investments​in,​65;​ history​of,​55–57;​identity/memory​ in,​revitalization​and​recovery​of,​23;​ immigration​to,​78n23;​independence​ for,​7–8;​integrationism​in,​57,​62–64,​ 73–74;​kinship​in,​7;​land​vs.​territory​ in,​56–57,​59;​Ley​Indígena​(1990)​in,​ 63–66,​68,​74;​Ley​Pascua​(1966)​in,​ 61–63,​67–68,​74;​Ley​Pinochet​(1979)​ in,​62–64,​74;​millennium​celebration​ on,​54;​nonislanders,​influx​of,​67;​partitioning​of,​58;​private​property/land​ titles​vs.​communal/ancestral​lands​in,​ 57–65,​67–71,​73–74,​75n4,​75–76n6,​ 76n8,​77n14;​Rapanui​cultural​identity,​54–55,​67–68,​74–75;​Rapanui​ leaders​and​Chilean​party​politics,​64,​ 77nn16–17;​Rapanui​Parliament,​69,​ 73;​Rapanui​resistance​to​Chilean​rule,​ 54–55,​69,​74,​76n8;​Rapanui’s​Chilean​ citizenship,​61,​67;​real​estate​market​in,​65;​sheep​farming​on,​58,​60,​ 66,​76n9;​slave​raids​on,​58–59;​Special​Territory​status​of,​70–73,​78n24;​ stone​statues​(moai)​on,​54;​use-​rights​ concessions​by,​6 Rapanui​National​Park,​77n12 Rapanui​University,​66 Rappaport,​Joanne,​8–11,​82–83,​130,​141.​ See also​collaboration​and​historical​ writing Rapu,​Mike,​65 Rapu​Haoa,​Alfonso,​78n19 Raqaypampa​(Cochabamba,​Bolivia),​88,​ 106,​110,​112,​118,​120n7 Reciprocity​Treaty​(1875),​30 research​subjects,​identification​of,​163,​ 173n12 Retière,​Alain,​159

inDex 259

Reuque,​Isolde,​12,​19n7 revolutionary​violence,​163 Rice v. Cayetano​(U.S.​Supreme​Court),​ 36 rights-​based​discourse,​16–17 Riroroko,​Simeon,​76n6 Rivera​Cusicanqui,​Silvia,​16–17 Rodríguez,​Carlos,​171n1 Rodríguez,​Demetrio,​197,​200 Romero,​R.,​121n24 Ross,​Elizabeth,​173–74n13 Rountree,​Helen,​181 Ruiz,​Samuel,​171n1,​174n17 Rus,​Diane​L.:​legitimacy​in​the​Tzotzil​ community,​8–9;​Taller​Tzotzil,​overview​of,​8–10,​82–83;​Tzotzil​names​of,​ 8–9,​153,​173n10;​work​of,​on​Ta jlok’ta chobtik​(Bordando Milpas),​12,​158–61,​ 164.​See also​Taller​Tzotzil Rus,​Jan:​legitimacy​in​the​Tzotzil​community,​8–9;​Taller​Tzotzil,​overview​ of,​8–10,​82–83;​Tzotzil​names​of,​8–9,​ 153,​173n10.​See also​Taller​Tzotzil Salinas​de​Gortari,​Carlos,​164–66 Salomon,​Frank,​9 San​Andrés​Peace​Accords​(1996),​ 174n17,​174n20 San​Cristóbal​de​las​Casas​(Chiapas,​ Mexico),​10,​155–56 San​José​de​Mizque​Cooperative​(Cochabamba,​Bolivia),​88 saqra​(cognitively​intelligent​children),​ 121n24 Saunt,​Claudio,​187 Schele,​Linda,​198–99 seeds,​95,​111–12 Settlers​for​Hawaiian​Independence,​28 shamans,​128,​132;​cosmovision​and,​ 137–39,​199 Sieder,​Rachel,​207 Silva,​Noenoe,​12–13,​15,​32,​219 260 inDex

sil /Wbt ​(Summer​Institute​of​Linguistics/Wycliffe​Bible​Translators),​152,​ 172n2,​172–73n7,​173n9 Simón​Patiño​Foundation​(Bolivia),​88 sistematización,​143n15 Smith,​Linda​Tuhiwai,​2,​14–15,​18n2,​176;​ Decolonizing Methodologies,​192–93,​ 193n1 Sna​Jtz’ibajom,​172n2 Sojom,​Jacinto​Arias,​152–53,​172n2 solidarity,​170 sovereignty:​autonomy​and,​142n5;​ Hawaiian,​28–29,​34,​38–39;​indigenous​rights​and,​46–47;​over​territories,​76–77n11;​territory​and,​128 Spanish:​in​PCÑ ,​91–94;​Quechua​and,​ 10–11,​91–93,​109,​115 Spanish-​American​War​(1898),​6–7 Special​Committee​of​24​on​Decolonization​(un ),​51n5 spiral​motif,​128,​136 Spiritual​Nation​of​Kā—Hui​Ea​Council​ of​Sovereigns,​28 State of Hawaii v. Office of Hawaiian Affairs​(U.S.​Supreme​Court),​38,​ 51–52n8,​52n13 Stevens,​John​L.,​31–32 storytelling​traditions’​importance,​4 Street,​B.,​95 struggle,​13,​22–23,​119n3 Suazo,​Siles,​120n16 Subercaseaux,​Bernardo,​75n5 Summer​Institute​of​Linguistics/Wycliffe​ Bible​Translators.​See​sil /Wbt sunqu​(heart),​98–100 Tademy,​Lalita,​194n7 Tahiti,​56 Ta jlok’ta chobtik​(Bordando Milpas;​ D.​L.​Rus),​158–61,​164 Taller​Leñateros,​172n2,​173n8 Taller​Tzotzil​(Chiapas,​Mexico):​author-

ship​of,​145,​153,​156–57,​160,​163–64,​ 169;​bilingual​editions​of,​151–52,​154,​ 157,​160;​Chiapas​in​mid-​1980s,​147– 49;​community​collaborations,​157–64;​ dialect​choice​for,​152–53;​distribution​ and​sale​of​publications,​150,​155–56,​ 159–60,​172–73n7;​documenting​narratives,​149–53;​economic​crisis​and,​10,​ 144,​147,​155,​157–58;​editing​of,​161–63;​ editors’​introductions,​152;​funding​ for,​171n1;​goals​of,​10;​monolingual​vs.​ bilingual​publication,​151–52;​orthography​of,​152,​173n9;​overview​and​ background​of,​8–10,​82–83,​144–47,​ 171–72nn1–2;​photographs​in,​153,​155;​ political​and​cultural​factions​and,​ 153–57,​173n11;​reflections​on,​170–71;​ tape​cassettes​considered​for,​172n6;​ transitions​and,​164–66;​translation​of,​ 160–61;​voices,​150;​women’s​participation​in,​150–51;​Zapatista​uprising’s​ effects​on,​10,​83,​167–69 Taller​Tzotzil,​publications​of:​Abtel ta Pinka,​149–57,​160,​173n7;​Buch’u Lasmeltzan Jobel?​155–58;​“Conversaciones​ininterrumpidas,”​168;​Historia de un pueblo evangelista,​174n13;​ Ja’ k’u x’elan ta jpojbatik ta ilbajinel yu’un jkaxlanetik,​148;​Jchi’iltak ta Slumal Kalifornya,​168–69;​K’alal ich’ay mosoal,​148;​Kipaltik: K’u cha’al lajmankutik jpinkakutik,​159–64;​Lo’il yu’un Kuskat,​151–52,​156;​“Los​primeros​meses​de​los​zapatistas,”​168– 69,​174n19;​San​Cristóbal​shantytowns’​ history​(in​progress),​169;​Slo’il ch’vo’ kumpareil,​166,​173–74n13;​Ta jlok’ta chobtik ta ku’il​(Bordando Milpas),​12,​ 158–62,​164,​166;​“A​Tzotzil​Chronicle​ of​the​Zapatista​Uprising,”​168 Task​Force​on​Native​Hawaiian​Issues,​36 Teave,​Daniel​María,​75–76n6

technology,​modern:​biotechnology,​116;​ from​green​revolution,​112;​peasant​ knowledge​vs.,​88,​110–12,​117,​121n23 Tepano,​Juan,​76n9 territory:​integrity​of,​and​indigenous​ rights,​46–47;​land​vs.,​56–57,​59,​128;​ sovereignty​and,​128;​space​and,​128 testimonio,​160,​172n5.​See also​Taller​ Tzotzil theorization.​See under​collaboration​and​ historical​writing Thiong’o,​Ngugi​wa,​192 Tiawuanaku​manifesto​(Bolivia,​1973),​86 Ties that Bind: The Story of an AfroCherokee Family in Slavery and Freedom​(Miles),​192 Titicachi​(Peru),​121n24 Toro,​Pedro​Pablo,​57–58,​73 Toro​Hurtado,​Policarpo,​56–57 Totora​(Cochabamba,​Bolivia),​88–89 trade​agreements,​116–17,​127,​164–65,​​ 214 traditional​authority,​142n9 transformist​hegemony,​206 translation,​4 translation​vs.​writing/inscription,​8–9.​ See also​Taller​Tzotzil trees,​communal​ownership​of,​114 Tribal​Nations​policy​(U.S.),​27 tribal​vs.​foreign​nations,​39–40 truth,​rules​of​evidence​for,​14 Tuki,​Rafael​(“Rinko”),​73 Tunica-​Biloxi​Tribe​(Mississippi​and​ Louisiana),​182,​189 Tyler,​John,​30 Tzotzil​Maya​people​(Chiapas,​Mexico):​ coffee​work​by,​149–51,​165;​critical​ historical​narrative​among,​170;​migration​of,​10;​Protestant,​151,​155;​as​ undocumented​workers​in​California,​ 168–69;​writing​by,​145,​170,​172n2.​See also​Taller​Tzotzil

inDex 261

udu​(Unión​de​Uniones;​Mexico),​159– 60,​164–65 uma​(head),​98–99 undocumented​migration,​168–69,​174n19 Unión​de​Uniones​(u du ;​Mexico),​159– 60,​164–65 Unión​Revolucionaria​Nacional​Guatemalteca​(urng ),​205,​218n14 United​Confederation​of​Bolivian​ Workers​and​Peasants​(csutcb ),​89,​ 114 United​Nations:​Charter​(1945),​29,​34,​ 43;​Commission​on​Human​Rights,​ 44–45,​47–48;​Economic​and​Social​ Council,​44;​Hawaiʻi’s​inclusion​on​ list​of​non-​self-​governing​territories,​ 33–34,​51n3;​Human​Rights​Council,​ 45,​53n19,​69;​on​indigenous​rights,​ 2,​22–23.​See also​Declaration​on​the​ Rights​of​Indigenous​Peoples United​States:​Constitution​of,​32,​39;​ Hawaiʻi​on​indigenous​rights,​45;​ polarized​racial​atmosphere​of,​141– 42n1;​victory​in​Spanish-​American​ War,​6–7.​See also​Hawaiʻi United​States​Department​of​Defense,​ 40,​42 United​States​Department​of​Justice,​42 United​States​Department​of​State,​40 United​States​Department​of​the​Interior,​39–40 United​States​National​Security​Council,​47–48 United​States​Office​of​Native​Hawaiian​ Relations,​39–40,​42 United​States​Senate​Committee​on​ Indian​Affairs,​42 Universidad​de​los​Andes​(Bogotá,​ Colombia),​124 urng ​(Unión​Revolucionaria​Nacional​ Guatemalteca),​205,​218n14 use​rights​vs.​property​rights,​6 262 inDex

Valparaíso,​Chile,​56–58,​66–67,​70 Varese,​Stéfano,​12–13,​15,​17,​219 Virginia​antimiscegenation​laws,​181,​ 193n3 Waitangi,​Treaty​of,​75n2 War​of​the​Pacific​(1879–84),​6–7,​55–56 Warren,​Kay,​198–99 Watanabe,​J.,​218n21 weather​prediction,​110–12 white​privilege,​2,​11–12 white​supremacy,​35,​49,​179,​186–87,​ 191–93,​194n8 Williams,​Brackette,​206 Williamson​Balfour​and​Company​ (Compañía;​Scotland),​58–61,​67 Wilson,​Angela​Cavender,​2,​15,​17 Winant,​H.,​195n22 women,​indigenous:​Komes’s​weaving​and​ embroidering​cooperative,​12,​158,​161– 62,​165–66;​marginalization​of,​19n7;​ Maya,​211;​writing​by,​150–51,​173n8 Women’s​Organization​of​Kuyupaya,​95 Working​Group​on​Indigenous​Populations​(Wgip ;​un ),​44–46 Workshop​for​the​Handling​of​Potato​ and​Corn​Varieties,​95–96 writing​vs.​orality,​95 yachayniyku​(politics​of​Quechua​knowledge),​101–14,​117 Yapita,​Juan​de​Dios,​121n25 Zapatistas​(Mexico):​eZln ,​84,​167,​ 174n17;​government​repression​of,​167,​ 174nn14–15;​“Los​primeros​meses​de​ los​zapatistas,”​168–69,​174n19;​protecting​leaders’​identities,​164;​rebellion​by​(1994),​10,​83,​144,​150,​154,​ 166–69,​174n19;​Taller​Tzotzil​and,​10,​ 83,​167–69.​See also​eZln Zavala,​Virginia,​119n1,​121n19

Florencia e. mallon ​is​the​Julieta​Kirkwood​Professor​of​History​and​Latin​American​ Studies​ and​ chair​ of​ the​ History​ Department​ at​ the​ University​ of​ Wisconsin.​ She​is​the​author​of​Courage Tastes of Blood: The Mapuche Indigenous Community of Nicolás Ailío and the Chilean State, 1906–2000​(Duke,​2005);​Peasant and Nation: The Making of Postcolonial Mexico and Peru​(1995);​and​The Defense of Community in Peru’s Central Highlands: Peasant Struggle and Capitalist Transition, 1860–1940​(1983)​ and​the​editor​and​translator​of​Rosa​Isolde​Reuque​Paillalef,​When a Flower Is Reborn: The Life and Times of a Mapuche Feminist​(Duke,​2002).

Library​of​Congress​Cataloging-in-Publication​Data Decolonizing​native​histories​:​collaboration,​knowledge,​and​language​in​the​Americas​/​ edited​by​Florencia​E.​Mallon​;​selected​essays​translated​by​Gladys​McCormick. p.​cm.​—​(Narrating​native​histories) Includes​bibliographical​references​and​index.

isbn ​978-0-8223-5137-5​(cloth​:​alk.​paper)​—​isbn ​978-0-8223-5152-8​(pbk.​:​alk.​paper) 1.​Language​and​languages—Political​aspects. 2.​Language​and​culture—America. ​ 3.​Indigenous​peoples​and​mass​media—America. I.​Mallon,​Florencia​E.,​1951– ​ II.​Series:​Narrating​native​histories.

p119.3.D43​2012 306.44′6097—dc23  2011027459